Home
  By Author [ A  B  C  D  E  F  G  H  I  J  K  L  M  N  O  P  Q  R  S  T  U  V  W  X  Y  Z |  Other Symbols ]
  By Title [ A  B  C  D  E  F  G  H  I  J  K  L  M  N  O  P  Q  R  S  T  U  V  W  X  Y  Z |  Other Symbols ]
  By Language
all Classics books content using ISYS

Download this book: [ ASCII ]

Look for this book on Amazon


We have new books nearly every day.
If you would like a news letter once a week or once a month
fill out this form and we will give you a summary of the books for that week or month by email.

Title: Recollections of full years
Author: Taft, Mrs. William Howard
Language: English
As this book started as an ASCII text book there are no pictures available.
Copyright Status: Not copyrighted in the United States. If you live elsewhere check the laws of your country before downloading this ebook. See comments about copyright issues at end of book.

*** Start of this Doctrine Publishing Corporation Digital Book "Recollections of full years" ***


                      RECOLLECTIONS OF FULL YEARS


[Illustration:

  MRS. WILLIAM HOWARD TAFT
]



                     =Recollections of Full Years=


                                   BY
                        MRS. WILLIAM HOWARD TAFT

[Illustration: Logo]

                      WITH NUMEROUS ILLUSTRATIONS

                                NEW YORK
                         =Dodd, Mead & Company=
                                  1914



                            COPYRIGHT, 1914
                    BY THE BUTTERICK PUBLISHING CO.

                            COPYRIGHT, 1914
                        BY DODD, MEAD & COMPANY



                                FOREWORD


I wish to express my grateful acknowledgment to Eleanor Franklin Egan
and my daughter for their valued assistance in the preparation for
publication of these Recollections.

                                                      HELEN HERRON TAFT.



                                CONTENTS


                                CHAPTER I
 INTRODUCTORY                                                          1

          Cincinnati—City of Birth and Early Memories. Educational
          and Musical Advantages. Childhood in Large Family on
          Moderate Income. Meeting Mr. Taft—Political Turmoil. First
          trip to Washington to visit President and Mrs. Hayes.
          Social Gaieties and Serious Undertakings.
          Engagement—Summer in the Adirondacks. Marriage—Trip
          Abroad. Mr. Taft’s Father and Mother. First
          home—“Satisfactory though Mortgaged.”


                               CHAPTER II
 CINCINNATI AND WASHINGTON                                            21

          The Superior Court—First Doubt as to Desirability of
          Judicial Career. Mr. Taft’s Embarrassing Truthfulness. My
          son Robert. Solicitor General—Move to Washington. Mr.
          William M. Evarts. Washington Society Twenty-five Years
          Ago. My Daughter Helen. The Federal Bench. Youngest Child.
          Tranquil Years. The Cincinnati Orchestra. Spanish-American
          War—Results to the Taft Family.


                               CHAPTER III
 TO THE PHILIPPINES                                                   39

          The Second Philippine Commission. Army Transport
          _Hancock_. Honolulu. “Aloha Oe!” Yokohama. Mr. Taft in a
          Jinrikisha. His Size Interests the Japanese. Audience with
          the Emperor and Empress of Japan—A Question of Clothes. I
          Decide to Remain in Japan for the summer. The _Hancock_ to
          Manila.


                               CHAPTER IV
 IN JAPAN                                                             65

          Keeping House in Yokohama—In Quarantine with Measles. A
          Japanese Ménage. Fascinating Oriental Sounds—Alluring
          Shops. First Letter from Mr. Taft. A bit of Philippine
          History. Miyanoshita—Japanese Inns—The Darkest Night. A
          Refugee from China—Boxer Insurrection. Joseph did not
          Commit Suicide; He was only Learning to Sing. More
          Letters. Mr. Bryan’s Complicating Policy. To Manila.


                                CHAPTER V
 FIRST IMPRESSIONS OF MANILA                                          91

          The China Sea. Manila Bay—Strange Scenes and Strange
          Peoples. First Home in Manila—“Getting Used” to my
          Environment. Seventy Thousand American Troops. General
          Arthur MacArthur—Social Coolness.
          Intrigue—Assassinations—Problems. Progress of
          Pacification. A Typhoon. American Presidential Campaign.
          Civil and Military Rule. September first—The Commission
          begins to Exercise Authority.


                               CHAPTER VI
 A STRANGE ENVIRONMENT                                               118

          _El costumbres del pais_—Employes and _Parientes_. A Pair
          of Black Ponies—A Runaway—Filipino Coachmen. Charlie’s
          Playmates. Shopping—Saloons. Manila Society. “He may be a
          brother of William H. Taft, but he ain’t no friend of
          mine!” A Filipino Call. Presents. American Patriotism.
          Friars and Friars’ Lands. A Momentous Decision.


                               CHAPTER VII
 DAYS OF THE EMPIRE                                                  142

          Unrest and Uncertainty—Guerilla Warfare. Re-election of
          Mr. McKinley. Optimistic in the Face of Chaos.
          Christmas—Eighty in the Shade. A New Year’s Reception—Silk
          Hats and Frock Coats. The Federal Party and the Peace
          Movement—Washington’s Birthday. First Visit to a
          Provincial Town. Establishment of Civil Government. Mr.
          Taft First Civil Governor.


                              CHAPTER VIII
 AN HISTORIC TRIP                                                    156

          Through the Southern Islands. Establishing Provincial
          Governments. A Test of Endurance—Filipino
          Bands—_Banquetes_ and _Bailes_—the _Rigodon_. Moroland.
          Aguinaldo—Colonel Frederick Funston of “the Suicide
          Squad.” Zamboanga—Cottabato—the Gulf of Davao—Surigao—A
          Perilous Journey. Cebu. Sorsogon—A Riot of Hospitality.
          “The Sacred Torch of Liberty.”


                               CHAPTER IX
 THE WILD MEN’S COUNTRY                                              182

          Into Northern Luzon—the Wild Men’s Country. A Spanish
          Steamer. General and Mrs. J. Franklin Bell. A Side Trip.
          Impedimenta and Military Discipline. An Amazing Summit.
          Where no White Woman ever was before Igorrotes—Human
          Skulls as House Decorations—Rice Terraces. Down a Long
          Trail. Baguio—Our $2,500,000 Road. Necessity for Haste.


                                CHAPTER X
 GOVERNOR TAFT                                                       206

          The Inauguration of Governor Taft. Two Thousand Guests.
          Moving to Malacañan Palace—Social Activities. The
          Governor’s Working Day. General Chaffee—Continued
          Differences of Opinion. General Corbin. The Assassination
          of President McKinley—Dark Days. Mr. Taft and President
          Roosevelt. Balangiga. A Trip to China—Mr. Taft Ill—Hurried
          Return. Ordered Home on Leave—An Earthquake. We Sail on
          Christmas Eve.


                               CHAPTER XI
 A TRIP TO ROME                                                      233

          Some Unhappy Memories. Business in Washington—The Friar
          Lands Question. A Mission to Rome. Left Behind but Follow
          Shortly. Position and Character of
          Commission—Complications and Embarrassments. Cardinal
          Rampolla. Pope Leo XIII. A Brilliant Society. Vatican
          Politics. An Audience with the Pope. Vallombrosa. Gifts
          from the Pope. Unfinished Negotiations—Mr. Taft to Manila.
          Switzerland.


                               CHAPTER XII
 LAST DAYS IN THE PHILIPPINES                                        251

          A Great Demonstration. Cholera—Rinderpest—Famine—Turmoil.
          The Church Schism—Aglipay. Archbishop Guidi. Ladrones and
          Assassins. Taft declines the Supreme Bench—Mr. Roosevelt
          Insists—Popular Protest. A Letter from Mr. Roosevelt.
          Called to Washington as Secretary of War. A Farewell
          Fête—The Doge of Venice and his Lady—Regretful Good-byes.


                              CHAPTER XIII
 SECRETARY OF WAR                                                    274

          Contrasted Attitudes—Guests of a Nation and “Just Nobody.”
          Settling down in Washington—Difficulties in living up to
          an Exalted Office—Life of a “Cabinet Lady.” The Panama
          Canal—Trip to Panama. Mr. Taft, a Congressional Party and
          Miss Alice Roosevelt. Summer in England. Intervention in
          Cuba—“Those Awful Twenty Days.”


                               CHAPTER XIV
 BUSY YEARS                                                          302

          “The Three Musketeers.” A Political Campaign—the Rush of
          Life. The Supreme Bench again. A Presidential “Boom.” Mr.
          Taft not Interested. I misunderstand Mr. Roosevelt. Athos
          and Porthos. “Sitting on the Lid.” Agitated Days. Growing
          Enthusiasm. Murray Bay. Starting Around the
          World—Yellowstone Park—A Sunday game of Bridge. A Taste of
          Campaign Work.


                               CHAPTER XV
 A HURRIED TRIP AROUND THE WORLD                                     313

          Japan—Shanghai—Manila. Opening of the first Philippine
          Assembly. Trips and Entertainments. Vladivostok. Across
          Siberia. Moscow—St. Petersburg—Berlin. A Shopping
          Expedition and a Perilous Night. The Steamship _President
          Grant_. Return to the United States. Nomination for the
          Presidency—Political Campaign—Election.


                               CHAPTER XVI
 PRESIDENT OF THE UNITED STATES                                      324

          The Evening of March Third, 1909. A Dinner Party at the
          White House. A Stormy Night. Washington Ice-bound and
          Isolated. “I always said it would be a cold day when I got
          to be President of the United States.” The Inauguration.
          At Home in the White House—A Brief Inspection—The McKim
          Restoration. The Inaugural Ball—A Brilliant Scene. “Aunt
          Delia.” The End of the Greatest Day.


                              CHAPTER XVII
 THE WHITE HOUSE                                                     347

          Mistress of the White House—Domestic Responsibilities—Some
          Innovations. The White House staff—Furniture and
          Porcelains. The President’s Hospitality. A Diplomatic Tea.
          Forms and Precedents. My First Dinner Party. Various
          Entertainments. Potomac Drive. Delightful Spring Evenings.
          The Charm of the Home of Presidents. A Passing Glimpse of
          Mental Pictures.


                              CHAPTER XVIII
 SOME WHITE HOUSE FORMALITIES                                        365

          A Long Illness. Garden Parties—The First
          Disappointment—Subsequent Success. The Nation’s Summer
          Capital—A Question of Privacy—The Secret Service Men. The
          Washington Social Season. State Dinners and Receptions.
          First Cabinet Dinner. The New Year’s Reception. “Behind
          the line.” Cutting down the Lists. The Diplomatic
          Reception and Dinner. Serving Refreshments. Various
          Demands.


                               CHAPTER XIX
 CONCLUSION                                                          382

          Mr. Roosevelt Returns from Africa—Calls at Beverly—An
          Agreeable Meeting. A Cruise on the _Mayflower_. The
          President of Chili. A “Whirlwind” Existence. A Cabinet
          House Party. Fitting Charlie out in Long Trousers. Helen’s
          Début. Our Silver Wedding. Renomination. Plans for a Quiet
          Future. An Expression from Mr. Taft.



                             ILLUSTRATIONS


 Mrs. William Howard Taft                                 _Frontispiece_

                                                             FACING PAGE

 Mrs. Taft’s childhood home on Pike Street, in Cincinnati              4

 Mr. and Mrs. John Williamson Herron, Mrs. Taft’s father
   and mother                                                          8

 Members of the salon. Mr. Taft in the centre with the
   author at his right                                                12

 Mr. and Mrs. William Howard Taft at the time of their
   marriage                                                           16

 Mrs. Taft with Robert and Helen, when Mr. Taft was
   Solicitor General                                                  26

 Charlie Taft when he went to the Philippines                         36

 Nikko. An ancient cryptomeria avenue and a glimpse of
   the famous temples                                                 52

 Entrance to the Imperial Palace gardens in Tokyo                     56

 The State Dining-Room of the White House, showing
   tapestry presented to Mrs. Taft by the Empress of
   Japan                                                              62

 Helen Taft in Japanese costume                                       76

 Mrs. Taft in formal Filipina costume                                 90

 A carved _Nara_ or Philippine mahogany bed, now in Mr.
   Taft’s room at New Haven                                           98

 A typical Philippine river scene and some Filipino
   laundry work                                                      104

 (_Left to right_) General Wright, Mr. Taft and Judge
   Ide, as Philippine Commissioners                                  118

 A typical Filipino menu and place card                              148

 Triumphal arch at Bataan                                            152

 Filipino members of the organising party enjoying
   afternoon repose on the deck of the _Sumner_                      158

 The Sultan of Sulu boarding the _Sumner_, followed by
   Mr. Arthur Fergusson, Spanish secretary to the
   Commission                                                        166

 A Moro datu with his retinue, and the favourite wife of
   a datu with her maids-in-waiting                                  170

 Picturesque bead-bedecked Bogobos of the Davao country              176

 Philippine non-Christians: A Bontoc Igorrote (_top
   left_); a Moro and two Kalinga chiefs (_with shields_)            182

 On the long trail in Northern Luzon. Mrs. Taft second
   from the left                                                     186

 Mr. Taft and Charlie enjoying their favourite exercise              186

 An Igorrote Head Dance and a company of _cargodores_
   with their dogs which are to be killed for food                   190

 Views of the extraordinary Igorrote rice terraces.
   Practically all of the wild men’s country is
   cultivated in this manner                                         192

 Igorrote chief proudly displaying his house decorations
   of human skulls and carabao horns                                 196

 Bontoc Igorrotes with _ganzas_ showing handles made of
   human jaw bones                                                   196

 Benguet Road before and after completion. Not the most
   thrilling curve on this spectacular highway                       200

 The Zigzag. How the Benguet Road climbs to an altitude
   of over 5,000 feet in six miles                                   204

 Mr. Taft taking the oath of office as first American
   Governor of the Philippine Islands                                208

 Two views of Malacañan Palace. The first picture shows
   the wide, roofless veranda over the Pásig River                   214

 Scenes attending Governor Taft’s arrival in Manila after
   his first absence                                                 250

 Arch erected by the _Partido Federal_ representing
   Filipina offering another star to the American flag               258

 Mr. and Mrs. Taft with members of their family and staff
   including Major Noble, aide (_at left_), and Mr. Fred
   C. Carpenter, private secretary (_right_), in costumes
   worn at the Venetian Carnival                                     270

 Mr. Taft and Colonel Goethals, in Panama                            290

 (_From left to right_) Mrs. Jaime de Veyra, Mrs. Taft,
   Governor Smith, Mrs. Smith, Mr. Taft, Mr. Sergio
   Osmeña, Speaker of the Philippine Assembly, and
   members of the Assembly in the Ayuntamiento, Manila               312

 The White House as it looked on the evening of the
   Fourth of March, 1909                                             324

 Mr. and Mrs. Taft returning to the White House after Mr.
   Taft’s inauguration                                               330

 The private dining-room of the White House, and the
   family sitting-room at the end of the long upstairs
   corridor                                                          334

 Two White House bedrooms showing fine old colonial beds             338

 Two corners of the White House kitchen                              350

 The East Room                                                       356

 Mrs. Taft on the Potomac Drive                                      360

 The south Portico from the end of the garden                        364

 The White House garden and Washington’s Monument from
   the south Portico                                                 368

 The Taft cottage at Beverly, Massachusetts                          372

 The crescent table in the State Dining-Room arranged for
   the Diplomatic Dinner                                             376

 Mrs. Taft’s own picture of the White House                          380

 The long eastern corridor through which guests arrive
   for state functions                                               388

 The main stairway leading to the President’s private
   apartments                                                        388



                      RECOLLECTIONS OF FULL YEARS



                               CHAPTER I
                              INTRODUCTION


Cincinnati, the city of my birth and early memories, was, in the
‘sixties, about as begrimed and noisy and altogether unattractive as any
place well could be; yet it possessed certain attributes which really
entitled it to the proud designation of “The Queen City of the West.”

It was prosperous; it had hardly yet been surpassed in prosperity by
Chicago; Cleveland was not even spoken of as a rival; and in many ways
it was the most important centre west of New York and east of the
Mississippi.

It owed its early development principally to its advantageous location.
It lay on the great central route from the East to the West, which runs
from Baltimore and Washington to Cumberland and over the Alleghenies to
Pittsburg, thence by the Ohio River to Cincinnati and on west to St.
Louis and south to New Orleans. It had an important trade with New
Orleans and drew commerce from a large territory to the north. But
whatever else may be said of it, its most devoted citizen could not
claim that Cincinnati was beautiful. Its buildings were unlovely; its
streets were badly paved and as badly kept; and it lay under a pall of
soft coal smoke which left its sooty mark upon everything—inhabitants
included.

Yet, ugly as it was, the city boasted an unusual society. During the
first half of the nineteenth century many young men of good stock and
great ability, drawn by the promise of rapid advancement, had moved to
Cincinnati from all parts of the East and South; New Jersey, New
England, Virginia and Kentucky contributing, perhaps, the greatest
number. There were many families of wealth and culture which, without
parade or display, maintained fine homes and dispensed a generous
hospitality. The suburbs, East Walnut Hills, Mt. Auburn and Clifton, on
the heights to the north and east, were famous for their beautiful
country places.

Then there was a large population of the best class of Germans, many of
whom were university men who left their own country after the Revolution
of 1848 and came to Cincinnati to settle. Of these, Frederick Hassaurek,
General Willich and Judge Stallo, who came to Cincinnati when Carl
Schurz went to St. Louis, are perhaps the most prominent. The German
influence upon the community was marked. It made for a more liberal
Sunday; it brought the study of German into the public schools; and it
developed a strong taste for good music. Indeed, the musical advantages
of Cincinnati in my girlhood were better than those of any city in the
United States, with the exception of New York or Boston. Theodore Thomas
was president of the Conservatory of Music and he organised a symphony
orchestra which he continued to direct until he went to Chicago along
about 1890.

Cincinnati in those days, with her educated, wealthy and public-spirited
society, was much in advance of any other city in the Mississippi Valley
in culture and refinement. There was great interest in schools of all
sorts and in every kind of intellectual activity. Away back in 1848 the
Literary Club of Cincinnati was formed by a company of men among whom
were both Mr. Taft’s father and mine, as well as Rutherford B. Hayes,
Stanley Matthews, Manning F. Force and Mr. Spofford, later Librarian of
Congress. This club continues to be a cherished institution and in my
girlhood it was the centre of all interest in literature and
intellectual pursuits.

My father, John Williamson Herron, was a graduate of Miami University at
Oxford, Ohio, and was in college with Benjamin Harrison. He was for
fifty years a trustee of that institution and was devoted to its
interests. My husband’s father, Judge Alphonso Taft, was one of the Yale
class of 1833, was for many years a member of the Yale Corporation, and
had five sons who graduated at that university. My mother’s brother,
Judge Isaac Clinton Collins, and one of my two brothers also graduated
at Yale, while my other brother graduated at Harvard, so it will be seen
that both my husband and I grew up in the midst of strong collegiate
traditions.

To write about one’s childhood is not easy. Memories by the score come
flocking up, but, dear as they are, upon examination they turn out to be
quite commonplace and hardly worth relating. My memories are not
sufficiently “early” to have any special value. The first thing that I
dimly remember is sitting on the front steps of my home watching some
sort of parade in which there were many soldiers, but I was too young
then to know that it was a peace celebration I was witnessing at the
close of the Civil War.

My father was a lawyer who came to the bar of Ohio in the ’forties. He
was United States Attorney under President Harrison, was a State
Senator, and twice declined appointments to the Bench because the salary
attached to these positions was not enough to support his large family.
I was the fourth in a family of eleven, eight girls and three boys. One
boy and two girls died before I can remember.

Our house was one of a block of grey brick houses in Pike Street, at the
east end of Cincinnati, which, at that time, was the fashionable
residence section of the city. Pike Street runs down to the river on a
rather steep incline and, as it was paved with cobblestones, my early
memories are somewhat marred by an impression of the frequent clatter
and clang of heavy wagons pulling their way up the hill from the river
landing.

While our house was not particularly distinguished, being much like
those on either side of it, across the street from us there were two
very striking and imposing residences which lent distinction to the
neighbourhood, and in which, as I grew up, were formed the pleasantest
associations of my life. The one directly opposite was a large, square,
red brick house which had an air of great dignity. It was the home of
Mr. Larz Anderson. There were ten boys in the Anderson family and,
though they were all much older than I and most of them had gone away
before I grew up, I remember that it was a very lively household always.
In my later girlhood we were specially linked to this family by the
marriage of one of the boys, Charles, to my sister Jennie.

The house next to Mr. Anderson’s, on the north, I knew as the Sinton
home. A low, colonial structure, well set in a garden of green lawns and
finely kept shrubbery, it is still one of the most beautiful residences
in Cincinnati, and, indeed, in the whole country. Its architecture
suggests that of the White House and it was, as a matter of fact,
designed by the same architect, an Irishman named Hoban. The Sinton
house is lower than the White House, being only one story high with a
basement, but it has the same classic outlines and it bears, moreover,
the stamp of time, which gives it a character all its own.

It was built about 1800 by a Mr. Martin Baum, but was purchased by the
first Nicholas Longworth in the early part of the century and was the
home of the Longworth family for a generation. Long before I can
remember, it was bought by Mr. David Sinton, one of the most successful
business men in Ohio, and to me it was always the Sinton home. When I
was about twelve years old, Mr. Sinton’s daughter Annie married my
husband’s brother, Charles P. Taft, and as they have always lived in
this old house it has come to be known, since Mr. Sinton’s death in
1901, as the Taft house. It is the only Taft house in Cincinnati now,
the house where my husband was born having been sold after his father’s
death, and it has been the scene of many of the most important events of
my life. It was there that my husband received the announcement of his
nomination for the Presidency; it was there, in front of the house, that
he made his speech of acceptance; and it was there that Charles Taft
gathered a large party of friends on the night of November 6, 1908, to
receive with us the election returns. And it is now to this house, where
my husband’s brother Charles and his wife dispense a generous
hospitality, that we always go when we return to Cincinnati.

[Illustration:

  MRS. TAFT’S CHILDHOOD HOME ON PIKE STREET, IN CINCINNATI
]

My girlhood days were spent quite placidly in Miss Nourse’s school,
which was known in Cincinnati as “The Nursery,” and where all the girls
of the Herron family, as well as Mr. Taft’s only sister, Fanny, received
their education. Miss Nourse was a Maine woman with a thorough New
England education and with a thoroughly New England idea of imparting
it. She insisted, especially, upon languages and literature. Much of my
time, outside of that taken up in regular school work, I devoted to the
study of music, and I practised my scales on the family piano with such
persistence that I wonder the whole neighbourhood did not rebel. Music
was the absorbing interest of my life in those days, the inspiration of
all my dreams and ambitions.

Our house was none too large for the family, but as there was a wide
difference in our ages it happened that my oldest sister was married
while my youngest sister was still a baby in long clothes. Then, the
boys went away to college and were gone the better part of each year, so
it was not often that we were all at home together. Nevertheless, we had
our share of the happy-go-lucky and somewhat crowded existence of a
large family on a moderate income.

My mother was Harriet Collins, and when she was seventeen years old she
came with her mother to Cincinnati, from Lowville, New York, to live
with her brother, Judge Collins, who was my father’s law partner and
continued to be so for more than forty years. Her father, Eli Collins,
was a Member of Congress from the Lowville district of New York. My
mother was in many ways a remarkable, as well as a most attractive,
woman. She had an exceedingly keen wit and a mind alert to the humour in
every situation. With so many children to nurse, to scold, to sew for
and, sometimes, to cook for—in a word, to bring up on a small income—she
would seem to have had little time for outside interests; but she was
very popular in society and I remember that in her busiest years she
went out a great deal. She had a stimulating personality and I do know
that she made her family circle a very amusing and interesting one in
which to grow up.

The only incident of my girlhood which was in any way unusual was my
first visit to the White House as a guest of President and Mrs. Hayes.
Mr. and Mrs. Hayes and my father and mother had been lifelong friends.
Mr. Hayes was, at one time, a partner in my father’s law firm. They had
been closely associated for a great many years and had a very warm
regard for each other. My youngest sister was born shortly after the
election of Mr. Hayes, was named Lucy Hayes Herron, after Mrs. Hayes,
and was taken to the White House to be christened. My mother paid
several visits to the White House and after my sister Jennie was married
Mrs. Hayes invited her and Mr. Anderson to stay a week with her and, to
my intense excitement, she added that she would like to have me
accompany them. I was seventeen years old; I had never been to
Washington and to me it was a very important event. I was not “out,” so
I couldn’t spend my time in the White House as I would have liked, in
going to brilliant parties and meeting all manner of charming people,
but, fortunately for my peace of mind, the Hayes lived very quietly, so
it was not so trying to have to devote myself to seeing the sights of
the Capital like any other tourist.

I didn’t meet my husband until I was eighteen years old. We had been
born and brought up in the same town; our fathers were warm friends and
had practised law at the same bar for more than forty years; during that
time our mothers had exchanged visits, and my sister Maria and Fanny
Taft were schoolmates and close companions at Miss Nourse’s, but the
Tafts lived at Mt. Auburn, a hill suburb of Cincinnati, and after Will
finished Woodward High School he went for four years to Yale, so it is
not at all surprising that we did not meet.

Judge Alphonso Taft was Secretary of War, and later Attorney General, in
Grant’s Cabinet while his son Will was at college, but before the latter
graduated, the family had returned to Cincinnati, so he came straight
home and entered at once upon a law course in the Cincinnati Law School.
It was at that time, when he was still a student and working as a law
reporter on the Cincinnati _Commercial_, that I met him. It was at a
coasting party one winter’s night, I remember very well, when I went
with a party of young people, including the Charles Tafts, to coast down
a fine steep hill in Mt. Auburn. Will Taft was there, and after being
introduced to me he took me down the hill on his big bobsled. After that
we met very frequently.

A small circle of us went in for amateur theatricals with much
enthusiasm and great earnestness. We launched ourselves in our
histrionic careers in “She Stoops to Conquer” which we gave at the house
of one of the company. Then came “A Scrap of Paper” in Mrs. Charles
Taft’s drawing room, in which both Will and I took part. We had become
very ambitious by this time and sent all the way to New York for a
professional stage-manager to help us with the production. But it turned
out a most nervous occasion. We were all overtrained, I suppose. One
thing after another went wrong until at the crisis of the play, where
the hero is supposed to find in the barrel of a gun the scrap of paper
upon which the whole plot hinges, the amateur hero looked pretty foolish
when he discovered there wasn’t any gun. Another one of the company, in
a fit of absentmindedness, no doubt due to overwrought nerves, had
carried it off the stage, and just when the situation was getting tragic
for the hero the culprit came creeping back with it and carefully put it
where it belonged, for all the world as if he thought he were making
himself invisible to the audience.

But our ardour was not dampened. I remember Mr. Taft especially in a
burlesque of “The Sleeping Beauty,” which, in its legitimate form, had
been produced for charity at Pike’s Opera House. The Unity Club, a most
respectable organization of the young men of the Unitarian Church,
decided to give their version of the same story, and it was a huge
success. Mr. Taft played the title rôle and his brother Horace, who is
six feet four in his stocking feet, shared with the Beauty the honours
of the evening as a most enchanting Puck.

Then we had parties in the country, too. Many of our friends had country
places that spread along the Madison Road and the Grandin Road on East
Walnut Hills, and two of my closest friends lived out there in a great
house, looking down over the majestic but tawny Ohio River, above the
point where the sweeping curve begins that carries it by the
amphitheatre in which the business part of the city is built. It was a
long distance to East Walnut Hills and in my girlhood we had to go the
greater part of the way in a clumsy old omnibus that clumped along over
the unpaved roads at the rate of about three miles an hour. But such
little inconveniences didn’t trouble us, and many were the vaudeville
and charade parties that we had, there being enough “talent” among us to
get up an amusing performance at a moment’s notice.

[Illustration:

  MR. AND MRS. JOHN WILLIAMSON HERRON, MRS. TAFT’S FATHER AND MOTHER
]

But in spite of all this gaiety, Mr. Taft was making very satisfactory
progress in his career. As a law reporter he showed his growing interest
in the public welfare by meeting certain elements in Cincinnati politics
with vigorous denunciation. There was a man named Tom Campbell, a clever
criminal lawyer, who had something more than a suspicion against him of
bribery and corruption of both witnesses and juries, and he had
succeeded in organising a political machine that was running the town
according to his directions.

Campbell was counsel for the defence in what was known as the Hoffman
case and was strongly suspected of tampering with the jury, and Mr. Taft
in reporting the case, took special pains to bring out all the fine
points in the lawyer’s character and methods, telling the truth as he
saw it.

This brought him into association with Mr. Miller Outcalt, the Assistant
Prosecuting Attorney, who represented the State in the Hoffman case, and
when Mr. Outcalt succeeded by election to the position of prosecuting
attorney he offered the place of assistant to Mr. Taft, although he had
been at the bar not more than seven months. Mr. Taft served in this
office for fourteen months and the experience he had in the
rough-and-ready practice in criminal trials, in preparing cases for
trial, in examining witnesses, in making arguments to the court and in
summing up to the jury, was the most valuable experience he could
possibly have in fitting him for trial work at the bar.

But this experience was shortened by a circumstance not of his seeking.
Major Benjamin Butterworth was the Congressman from one of the
Cincinnati districts in President Arthur’s administration, and the
President being anxious to relieve the Collector of Internal Revenue,
called on Major Butterworth to suggest the name of another man. Major
Butter worth had been for a long time a warm friend of Mr. Taft, thought
he had a good family name and was too young in politics to have many
political enemies, so he suggested him and wrote to urge him to accept
the appointment which the President immediately offered to him. He
accepted the place and held it for a year, but it proved a serious
interruption in his legal career. He resigned as soon as it was possible
and began practice with Major H. P. Lloyd who had been his father’s
partner before he went to Vienna.

Mr. Taft went abroad in the summer of 1883 to visit Judge and Mrs. Taft
in Vienna, and it was about this time, when we had all spent several
years in frivolities, that several of us became very serious-minded and
decided that we must have something by way of occupation more satisfying
than dancing and amateur theatricals. I secured a position as school
teacher and taught for two years, first at Madame Fredin’s and then at
White and Sykes, both private schools out on Walnut Hills. Then, with
two of my intimate friends, I decided to start a “salon.” We called it a
“salon” because we planned to receive a company who were to engage in
what we considered brilliant discussion of topics intellectual and
economic, and we decided that our gathering should include only
specially invited guests. Among these were the two Taft brothers, Will
and Horace, and other men common friends of us all.

In view of the fact that two marriages resulted from this salon, Mr.
Taft has suggested ulterior motives on the part of those who got it up,
but there was no truth in the charge. We were simply bent on “improving
our minds” in the most congenial atmosphere we could create, and if our
discussions at the salon usually turned upon subjects of immediate
personal interest, to the neglect of the abstruse topics we had selected
for debate, it was because those subjects were just then claiming the
attention of the whole community.

Cincinnati, thanks to the activities of Tom Campbell and his followers,
was then in a tangle of political mismanagement of a particularly
vicious character, and our little circle developed a civic spirit which
kept us alive to local interests to the exclusion, for the time being,
of everything else. Mr. Taft was intimately connected with the reform
movement, and in all its phases, through comedy and tragedy,
disappointment and elation, we fought it out at our salon meetings with
such high feeling and enthusiasm that its history became the history of
our lives during that period.

Then came the famous Berner case. This was in 1884. Berner had committed
a deliberate murder of an unusually appalling nature and with robbery as
the motive, and there was great excitement about it. Campbell became his
counsel and, in a trial which held the attention of the community while
it lasted, he succeeded in getting the man off for manslaughter when the
unanimous opinion was that he should have been hanged. Nobody could see
how an honest jury could have rendered any other verdict. There was
intense indignation throughout the city and a meeting was called to
denounce Campbell as an embracer of juries and a suborner of perjury.

On the evening when the meeting to denounce Campbell was called we were
having a session of the salon and our whole discussion was of the
possible developments which might grow out of the infamous Berner trial.
We were greatly excited about it. I remember the evening distinctly
because of the terrible things that happened. We were disturbed by a
great commotion in the street and we sallied forth in a body to see what
it was all about.

The mass meeting was held at Music Hall and was presided over by Dr.
Kemper, a very effective speaker. The crowd was angry and quickly passed
the condemnatory resolutions which were framed. But with all the
indignation and resentment everything might have been carried out quite
calmly had not the match been applied to the powder. Just as the meeting
was breaking up somebody shouted:

“Let’s go down to the jail and take Berner out!”

It was an appeal to the mob spirit which responds so readily in an angry
crowd; they went; and of course the worst elements immediately came to
the top. They attacked the jail, which was in the rear of the court
house, but were held back until the militia, which had been instantly
summoned, arrived. Then they went around to the front and set fire to
the court house. With the streets packed with raging humanity it was not
possible to fight the fire and the building was completely destroyed.

The militia charged the mob and this inspired somebody with the idea of
raiding a gun store and seizing arms and ammunition with which to make a
resistance. The idea caught on and spread rapidly. One place attacked
was Powell’s gun shop near Fourth and Main. But Powell, either
forewarned or foreseeing some such development, had quietly made
preparations to meet it. He lighted up the front of the store as
brightly as he could, then, with two or three other men who were expert
shots, he put himself behind a barricade in the rear. The mob came on
and as the ringleaders broke into the shop they were picked off by the
men behind the barricade and killed in their tracks. Four or five of
them went down in a heap and the crowd behind them, not expecting such a
reception, instantly was brought to its senses. This was in April, 1884.

Such an outbreak was a disgrace to the city of Cincinnati, but it had
the effect of bringing the Campbell controversy to a head. A bar
committee of ten men, of which both my father and Mr. Taft were members,
was formed to see what could be done to rid the community of the evil
reputation it had acquired. This committee made a thorough investigation
of Campbell’s character and record, prepared charges against him and,
with my father as chairman, presented them, in June, 1884, to the
district court of three judges, and asked a hearing and Campbell’s
disbarment if the charges were proved.

[Illustration:

  MEMBERS OF THE SALON. MR. TAFT IN THE CENTER, WITH THE AUTHOR AT HIS
    RIGHT
]

Campbell had been indicted on a criminal charge of attempting to bribe a
man called on the Berner jury and the prosecutor in this case was our
intimate friend and associate, Mr. Rufus Smith, who had been in Europe
with Mr. Taft the year before. The jury hung, eight to four, although
the evidence was strong against the defendant. This fanned the flames of
popular resentment and I don’t suppose our little salon was the only
place in Cincinnati where Campbell was carefully retried and convicted.
In this criminal case Mr. Foraker, who shortly afterward became Governor
of Ohio, was counsel for Campbell.

The disbarment hearing was set for the following November and some six
months was thus given for taking the depositions of non-resident
witnesses. Mr. Kittredge and Mr. Ramsey, leaders of the bar, were
retained as senior counsel for the committee, and Mr. Taft and Mr. John
Holmes, a warm friend of ours, were junior counsel and were directed to
prepare the evidence. In this work Mr. Taft and Mr. Holmes went all over
the country taking depositions and we kept in constant touch with them.
All the members of the committee expected to have their reputations
assailed, being perfectly certain that Campbell would not hesitate at
any measure he might be able to take to discredit them, but they went
ahead nevertheless.

When the trial came on Mr. Ramsey, of the senior counsel, expected to
open the case, but he became quite seriously ill and was confined to his
house for days. Through his unexpected absence, the duty of making the
opening statement fell to Mr. Taft. He was taken completely by surprise,
but he rose to the opportunity, which was certainly a splendid one for a
man so young. He had then been at the bar only four years, but having
assisted throughout in the preparation of the evidence he knew the case
from beginning to end and he made a speech which lasted four hours and a
half. Mr. Taft thinks this was an opportunity improved which had an
important influence on his career. The special part it played in his
subsequent promotion I shall speak of.

The result in the Campbell case was at first disappointing because the
Court which heard the disbarment charges found Campbell guilty only on
minor charges and, by a vote of two to one acquitted him on those which
would have required his disbarment. But the public disapproval of the
Court’s decision and the moral effect of the proceedings drove Campbell
from the city and the State and accomplished the purpose of the bar
association.

The Campbell trial was finished in December, 1884, and in January, 1885,
Mr. Rufus Smith, an old and intimate friend, entered the office of
County Solicitor and tendered to Mr. Taft the place of Assistant County
Solicitor. The advantage of this office was that it paid $2500 a year
and that, while he acted as counsel for the county, he still was able to
continue the general practice of law with his partner, Major Lloyd.

Mr. Taft and I were engaged in May, 1885, and were married in June of
the following year.

In the summer of 1885 my mother, moved I think by some sentimental
attachment to the scenes of her childhood, decided that she would take
us all up into the Adirondacks, to a little camp near Lowville. My two
older sisters were married so there were only six of us left in the
family, but we were still something of a handful to move in a body.
However, my mother was equal to it. We packed almost a van load of
trunks and set out, and one evening we arrived, over the worst corduroy
road that was ever laid down, at a little cottage beside a beautiful
lake in a setting of pine-clad hills. The scenery indeed was most
satisfactory, but the cottage was so small that the family more than
strained its capacity. Then we took our meals at a sort of boarding
house called Fenton’s, where the only thing on the bill of fare was
fresh beef. I like what is known as “roughing it” as well as anybody,
but even the superlative appetite produced by outdoor living demands
some variety; and variety we did not get.

Mr. Taft had elected to remain in Cincinnati all summer and save money.
It was a Spartan resolution and we all applauded it, but he probably
found Lowville a long way from Pike Street; and I certainly thought
Mother was sacrificing a good deal for the sake of renewing the memories
of her youth. However, the days went on, while the fresh beef grew less
and less tempting.

I had written Mr. Taft something about the Fenton fare and he, wanting
very much to join us, but having no excuse for breaking his admirable
resolution to remain in Cincinnati, hit upon the only plan for escaping
comment on his lack of fortitude. He went down to Peeble’s, a fancy
grocer, and selecting a box as big as a Saratoga trunk, ordered it
filled with every kind of delicacy he could think of or have pointed out
to him and brought it with him to Lowville.

We went rowing on the lake about sundown the evening he arrived, and
right in the middle of a fine long stroke he suddenly dropped his oars,
reached in his pocket and drew out a letter. He laughed a little when he
handed it to me, then picking up his oars he rowed on without a word.
The letter was from his father.

Judge Taft was at this time Minister to St. Petersburg, having been
transferred from Vienna. Will had written him about his engagement and
about his plan to remain in town all summer and devote himself strictly
to business and the accumulation of funds; and this was the answer.

There were a lot of nice complimentary things about me, with the warmest
congratulations and good wishes; then the letter closed by saying: “I am
very much pleased with your decision to remain in Cincinnati this
summer. I myself have found it not at all bad if you take care of
yourself, and there is no doubt that during the quiet months one can
make and save considerable money by staying at home. I congratulate you
on your strength of character.” We really had a delightful summer at
Fenton’s after that.

My father had given me a very nice lot at the end of McMillan Street on
the site of an old quarry, which commanded a fine view of the Ohio River
and the surrounding country, and Mr. Taft and I determined to build a
house on it which should be ready for us when we got back from our
wedding trip. So the winter before our marriage was filled with
architects’ plans, contractors’ estimates and all the other fascinating
details of building, and we thought that we had finally settled upon a
design that met with every requirement of good taste and modern comfort.

For our wedding trip, we went abroad, and I had my first taste of the
foreign travel of which I had always dreamed. We crossed on the _City of
Chester_ which was the oldest, and therefore the cheapest ship of the
Inman line. We chose her for the simple reason that her rates accorded
with our means, but we found, much to our astonishment, that we were the
only people on board who had deliberately selected her. Everybody else
had been forced to take her because of some emergency or some mishap.
One man had to miss the _Germanic_ in order to give his dentist time to
relieve a very troublesome tooth. Another man was called to court just
as he was about to board the _Britannic_. Those were the proud ships of
the Atlantic in those days and it was not at all difficult to understand
why anybody should prefer them to the _City of Chester_, but it amused
us greatly to hear the shamefaced excuses of our fellow passengers. My
husband and I were not ashamed, nor were we so particular about our
comforts that we did not thoroughly enjoy ourselves. Besides, we had the
gratifying consciousness of the money which the low rates had left in
our pockets to be spent much more profitably abroad.

[Illustration:

  MR. AND MRS. WILLIAM HOWARD TAFT AT THE TIME OF THEIR MARRIAGE
]

The trip was full of interest to us both. We spent the greater part of
the summer in England and saw the sights of London and the cathedral
towns in great detail. Our only trip on the Continent was through
Holland to Paris. I remember that in Amsterdam I bought some old and
rather large Delft plates. They wouldn’t go into any trunk we had, so I
had them carefully packed in a wicker hamper and this article became
thereafter a part of our hand luggage, and was the occasion for a
decided disagreement between my husband and me as to what the true
object of travel was. He used to say that he “toted that blamed thing
all around Europe and after all it arrived in Cincinnati with its
contents in small pieces.” Which was true. He had “toted” it all around
Europe, but when we arrived in New York I entrusted it to an express
company with the result that when we opened it we found its contents in
such a condition that only an accomplished porcelain mender could put a
sufficient number of pieces together to make what my husband always
afterward referred to as “the memento of our first unpleasantness.”

Our trip from Cincinnati to Cincinnati took just one hundred days and
cost us just one thousand dollars, or five dollars a day each. I venture
to say that could not be done nowadays, even by as prudent a pair as we
were.

During a subsequent trip abroad, two years later, I was able to indulge
my desire to hear music. We went to Beyreuth, to the Wagner festival,
and heard _Parsifal_ and _The Meistersingers_ gloriously rendered; after
which we went to Munich and attended operas and concerts until Mr. Taft
rebelled. He said that he enjoyed a certain amount of music just as much
as anybody, but that he did want to get something more out of European
travel than a nightly opera and a daily symphony.

So—we went to Italy and saw Rome and Florence in true Baedecker style.
When we arrived in Rome we opened our Baedecker and read that there was
almost no foundation for Rome’s awful reputation as an unhealthy place.
“Rome is a very healthy place,” said Baedecker, “at all times of the
year except the first two weeks in August, when a visit there is
attended with risk.” We had arrived for the first two weeks in August!

When we came home from our wedding trip we found that our house was not
yet completed, so we went to stay with Judge and Mrs. Taft for a month
at the old house in Mt. Auburn. It was a nice old place, with about
three acres of ground, but the air around it was just about as sooty as
if it had been located down under the factory chimneys. Mt. Auburn is on
a sort of promontory which juts out into the city; it is on a level with
the tops of the smoke stacks and it catches all the soot that the air
can carry that far.

Judge and Mrs. Taft had come home from their European mission in time
for our wedding. Judge Taft had been ill in St. Petersburg and had given
his family a great deal of anxiety, but he was now settled down to the
business of quiet recuperation and the enjoyment of well-earned rest.

My husband’s father was “gentle” beyond anything I ever knew. He was a
man of tremendous firmness of purpose and just as set in his views as
any one well could be, but he was one of the most lovable men that ever
lived because he had a wide tolerance and a strangely “understanding
sympathy” for everybody. He had a great many friends, and to know him
was to know why this was so.

Mr. Taft’s mother, though more formal, was also very kindly and made my
visit to her home as a bride full of pleasure. The two, the father and
mother, had created a family atmosphere in which the children breathed
in the highest ideals, and were stimulated to sustained and strenuous
intellectual and moral effort in order to conform to the family
standard. There was marked serenity in the circle of which Judge and
Mrs. Taft were the heads. They had an abiding confidence in the future
of their children which strongly influenced the latter to justify it.
They both had strong minds, intellectual tastes, wide culture and
catholic sympathies.

Not long after we arrived my husband came to me one day with an air of
great seriousness, not to say of conciliation and said:

“Nellie, Father has got himself into rather a difficulty and I hope I
can rely on you to help him out—not make it too hard for him, you
know,—make him feel as comfortable about it as you can. The truth is he
used to have a messenger at the War Department in Washington whom he was
very fond of. He was a bright man—colored, of course—and he was very
devoted to Father. Now this man called on Father down town to-day. He’s
here on a private car and Father says he’s made a great success as a
porter. Father got to talking to him, and there were lots of things they
wanted to talk about, and besides the man said he would like very much
to see Mother,—and Father, who was just about ready to come home to
lunch said—right on the spur of the moment—you understand he didn’t
think anything about it—he said to this man, ‘Come on home and have
lunch with us.’ He’s downstairs now. Father came to me and said he had
just realised that it was something of a difficulty and that he was
sorry. He said that he could take care of Mother if I could take care of
you. So I hope you won’t mind.”

As soon as I could control my merriment caused by this halting and very
careful explanation, I went down to luncheon. I didn’t mind and Will’s
mother didn’t mind, but the expression on the face of Jackson, the negro
butler, was almost too much for my gravity. I will say that the porter
had excellent manners and the luncheon passed off without excitement.

We made a short visit at my mother’s on Pike Street before we moved into
our new house on McMillan Street; but we began the year of 1887 under
our own roof which, though it was mortgaged, was to us, for the time
being, most satisfactory.



                               CHAPTER II
                       CINCINNATI AND WASHINGTON


One day after we had been married less than a year my husband came home
looking so studiously unconcerned that I knew at once he had something
to tell me.

“Nellie, what would you think,” he began casually, “if I should be
appointed a Judge of the Superior Court?”

“Oh, don’t try to be funny,” I exclaimed. “That’s perfectly impossible.”

But it was not impossible, as he soon convinced me. My father had just
refused the same appointment and it was difficult to believe that it
could now be offered to my husband who was only twenty-nine years old.
It was a position made vacant by the retirement from the Bench of Judge
Judson Harmon who was my husband’s senior by more than a decade.

One of the most prominent and prosperous law firms in Cincinnati was
that of Hoadley, Johnston and Colston, and both Mr. Hoadley and Mr.
Johnston had been invited to go to New York and become partners of Mr.
Edward Lauterbach who was then doing an enormous business.

They went, and the old firm in Cincinnati being broken up, Mr. Colston
asked Judge Harmon, who was then on the Superior Court, to take Mr.
Hoadley’s place. Mr. Harmon decided to do so, but he was anxious to
resign his judgeship in such a way as to leave a long enough vacancy to
attract a good man. It was an elective office and the law provided that
a vacancy occurring within thirty days before election could not be
filled by an election until the following year. Judge Harmon resigned so
as to make the appointment for a period of fourteen months. After my
father declined it, the choice lay between Mr. Taft and Mr. Bellamy
Storer. Mr. Taft always thought that but for his opportunity in the
Campbell case Judge Hannon would not have recommended him and Governor
Foraker would not have appointed him. That is why he says he traces all
his success back to that occasion. Mr. Foraker was opposing counsel in
the Campbell case, but he had a lawyer’s appreciation for a lawyer’s
effort.

After the first pleased surprise at the honour which came to us so
unexpectedly I began to think; and my thinking led me to decide that my
husband’s appointment on the Bench was not a matter for such warm
congratulation after all. I saw him in close association with men not
one of whom was less than fifteen years older than he, and most of whom
were much more than that. He seemed to me suddenly to take on a maturity
and sedateness quite out of keeping with his actual years and I dreaded
to see him settled for good in the judiciary and missing all the
youthful enthusiasms and exhilarating difficulties which a more general
contact with the world would have given him. In other words, I began
even then to fear the narrowing effects of the Bench and to prefer for
him a diverse experience which would give him an all-round professional
development.

He did not share this feeling in any way. His appointment on the
Superior Court was to him the welcome beginning of just the career he
wanted. After serving the interim of fourteen months he became a
candidate for the office and was elected for a term of five years. This
was the only elective office Mr. Taft ever held until he became
President.

My own time and interest during that winter was largely spent on my
house. We had been very particular about the plans for it and had fully
intended that it should combine outward impressiveness with inward
roominess and comfort. It was a frame structure, shingled all over, and
with certain bay window effects which pleased me exceedingly. In fact,
with our assistance, the architect had made a special effort to produce
something original and, while I don’t claim that the result was a
conspicuous architectural success, to my mind it was anything but a
failure. And our view of the Ohio River and the surrounding country was
really superb.

But I was not destined to enjoy my satisfaction with my surroundings
very long. The section had been at one time a stone quarry, and the man
who had levelled off the land and filled in the gulches made by the
quarry operations, took as a part of his compensation two building lots
which happened to be just across the street from ours. He forthwith
proceeded to put up a sort of double house which looked more like a
gigantic dry-goods box than anything else, and I felt that it quite
robbed the neighbourhood of the “tone” which I had confidently hoped our
house would give it. The double house had just one quality and that was
size.

I think the owner, whose name was Jerry something, lived in one side of
it, and he had a tenant in the other who hung clothes out of the front
windows. But tastes in architecture differ, as we soon found out.

We were paying taxes on our house at an assessed value of $4000 and the
undervaluation had been troubling my husband’s conscience for a long
time, in spite of my assuring him that tax collectors ought to know
their own business. Some men from the board of equalization were to call
one day to make a new appraisement and I had very much hoped that my
husband would not be at home. But he was; he was there to welcome them
and give them every possible assistance. Without waiting for an
examination of the premises, he addressed one of them, an Irishman named
Ryan.

“See here, Mr. Ryan,” he said, “I understand that Jerry, my neighbour
across the street, has his property assessed at $5000. Now I don’t think
that’s fair. I’m assessed at only $4000 and I’m sure my house cost a
good deal more than his. As a matter of fact it cost over $6000. Now I’m
a Judge of the Superior Court; I get my income out of taxes and I
certainly have no disposition to pay any less than my share.”

“Well, Judge, your Honour,” said Mr. Ryan, “that is a sentiment very
befitting your Honour. Now I’ll just be after goin’ over and lookin’ at
those houses of Jerry’s, and then I’ll come back and look at yours.”

I watched them as they went over to the other houses; then I saw them go
up the street a way and down the street a way, looking us carefully over
from every possible view-point. When they came in they wore a very
judicial aspect and I expected to see taxes go up with one wild leap.

“Well, Judge, your Honour,” began Mr. Ryan, “I think you’re givin’
yourself unnecessary concern. We assess houses for what they’re worth
and not for what they cost. While your house no doubt suits your taste,
it has a peculiar architectural style that wouldn’t please very many
people, and certainly it ain’t to compare with those houses of Jerry’s.
There’s a modern polish about those houses that will rent, Judge, your
Honour.”

My son Robert was born in this house on McMillan Street in September,
1889. In the following February an interruption occurred in our peaceful
existence which was welcome at least to me. President Harrison offered
the appointment of Solicitor General of the United States to Mr. Taft
and he, with a few regretful glances at his beloved Bench, accepted it.
I think that once again it was Major Butterworth who suggested my
husband’s name to the appointing power. I was very glad because it gave
Mr. Taft an opportunity for exactly the kind of work I wished him to do;
work in which his own initiative and originality would be exercised and
developed. I looked forward with interest, moreover, to a few years in
Washington.

Mr. Taft made his first official arrival in Washington alone. My baby,
Robert, was only six months old and I concluded to remain in Cincinnati
until my husband could make arrangements for our comfortable reception.
His description of his first day in Washington is, in the light of later
events, rather amusing.

He arrived at six o’clock on a cold, gloomy February morning at the old
dirty Pennsylvania station. He wandered out on the street with a heavy
bag in his hand looking for a porter, but there were no porters. Then he
stood for a few moments looking up at the Capitol and feeling dismally
unimportant in the midst of what seemed to him to be very formidable
surroundings. He wondered to himself why on earth he had come. He was
sure he had made a fatal mistake in exchanging a good position and a
pleasant circle at home, where everybody knew him, for a place in a
strange and forbidding city where he knew practically nobody and where,
he felt sure, nobody wanted to know him. He lugged his bag up to the old
Ebbitt House and, after eating a lonesome breakfast, he went to the
Department of Justice to be sworn in. After that ceremony was over and
he had shaken hands with the Attorney General, he went up to inspect the
Solicitor General’s Office, and there he met the most dismal sight of
the whole dismal day. His “quarters” consisted of a single room, three
flights up, and bearing not the slightest resemblance to his mental
picture of what the Solicitor General’s offices would be like. The
Solicitor General’s stenographer, it seemed, was a telegrapher in the
chief clerk’s office and had to be sent for when his services were
required. Altogether it must have been a very disheartening outlook.

As Mr. Taft sat looking over briefs and other papers, and trying to get
some definite idea about his new work, a messenger brought in a card.

“Mr. Evarts, New York,” it read.

Evarts was a well-known name, of course, but it was hard for Mr. Taft to
believe that _the_ William M. Evarts, leader of the American Bar and
then Senator from New York, could be calling on the Solicitor General of
less than a day. He knew that Wm. M. Evarts had known his father.

Mr. Evarts entered.

“Mr. Taft,” he said, as he gave my husband’s hand a cordial grasp, “I
knew your father. I was in the class of ’37 at Yale and he had graduated
before I entered; but he was there as a tutor in my time and I valued
his friendship very highly.”

Then the visitor came straight to the point.

“Mrs. Evarts and I are giving a dinner to-night for my former partner
and his wife, Mr. and Mrs. Joseph Choate. Mr. Choate is in Washington
for a short time to argue a case before the Supreme Court. Now,
unfortunately, one of our guests has sent word that he can’t come and I
thought, perhaps, considering my long-standing friendship with your
father, you might consent to waive ceremony and fill the place at our
table at this short notice.”

My husband accepted the invitation with almost undue alacrity, and when
his guest left started in on his new duties feeling that, after all,
Washington might afford just as friendly an atmosphere as Cincinnati,
once he became accustomed to it.

There is just one incident in connection with the dinner party which Mr.
Taft adds to his account of that day. As he sat down to dinner the
ladies on either side of him leaned hastily forward to see what was
written on his place card. “The Solicitor General”—that was all. Of
course neither of them knew who the new Solicitor General was and it
didn’t occur to him to enlighten them until it was too late to do it
gracefully. So he allowed them to go on addressing him as “Mr. Solicitor
General” while he, having them at an advantage, addressed them by the
names which he had surreptitiously read on their place-cards. They were
Mrs. Henry Cabot Lodge and Mrs. John Hay.

[Illustration:

  MRS. TAFT, WITH ROBERT AND HELEN, WHEN MR. TAFT WAS SOLICITOR GENERAL
]

When my husband had been in Washington two weeks I joined him and we
took a small house on Dupont Circle where for two years we lived a life,
sometimes amusing, sometimes quite exciting, but, on the whole, of quiet
routine.

Washington society was much simpler then than it is now. Since that time
a great many people of very large means have gone to Washington to live
because of its unusual attractions and its innumerable advantages as a
residential city. They have changed Washington, by their generous
hospitality, into one of the most brilliant social centres in the world,
where large dinner parties, balls, receptions, musicals and other
entertainments are of daily and nightly occurrence throughout the
season. The very character of the streets has changed. The small, red
brick houses, closely grouped together and neighbouring, even in
fashionable quarters, on negro shacks and cheap tenements, are being
everywhere replaced by marble and granite residences of great beauty and
luxury.

In 1890 Society in Washington still consisted, chiefly, of the “best
families” of the old city, the Diplomatic Corps and the highest among
the government officials. A dinner party of twelve was still considered
large, and only a few people had weekly evenings At Home. There were
occasional big receptions, but for nobody was society the mad rush that
it is to-day. We ourselves lived very simply even for those simple days.

My daughter Helen was born in 1891, so for the last year in Washington I
had two small babies to care for. In order that he might get a little
much needed exercise Mr. Taft bought a horse and, fortunately, for us,
he secured a most adaptable creature. He was supposed to be a riding
horse, but he didn’t mind making himself generally useful. The Attorney
General lent us a carriage which he was not then using—a surrey, I think
it was called—and we hitched him to that; and the whole Taft family
drove out of a Sunday afternoon to the Old Soldiers’ Home, which was the
fashionable drive in those days, or up the aqueduct road to Cabin John’s
bridge. My sister Maria who visited us used always to speak of our steed
as “G’up,” a name suggested by Bobby’s interpretation of his father’s
invocations to the good-natured and leisurely beast. Poor old “G’up”! I
suppose with his “horse sense” he finally realised that he was leading
such a double life as no respectable horse should lead; he gave up and
died before we left Washington.

The Justices of the Supreme Court and the Attorney General, the men with
whom Mr. Taft came most in contract, were, with their wives, very kind
and attentive to us, including us in many of their delightful parties.
Chief Justice Fuller was then the head of the court and I have the
pleasantest memories of his and Mrs. Fuller’s hospitality. Justice Grey
had married a Miss Matthews, a daughter of Mr. Justice Matthews. I had
known Mrs. Grey in Cincinnati before her marriage.

During the course of my first weeks in Washington Mr. Taft had taken
special pains to impress on me many times the necessity for my calling
on Mrs. Grey without any delay. Much importance attached to the
formality of first calls and I was the newest of newcomers who had to
call on the wives of all my husband’s official superiors before they
noticed me. Still, it was a full month before I had time to go to Mrs.
Grey’s and I was considerably worried about it. But when, finally, I did
go and had been most kindly received, I explained at once that the
settling of myself and my small baby in a new house had, until then,
kept me too busy for any calls. Mrs. Grey hastened to assure me that she
understood my position perfectly and had not thought of blaming me.

“Indeed, my dear,” she said, “I knew that you had a small baby in the
house and that you must be kept constantly occupied. As a matter of fact
I should have waived ceremony and come myself to welcome you to
Washington except for one thing which I could not very well overlook,
and that is—that Mr. Taft has not yet called on Mr. Justice Grey.”

I think I have rarely seen anything more satisfactorily amusing than the
expression on my husband’s face when I told him this.

But, in spite of the friendliness of the Justices and others, we really
went out very little. On one occasion when my sister Maria had been
visiting us for several weeks we went for a Sunday night supper to the
house of a lady whom Maria had known very well in Cincinnati. She was
living that winter in Washington and seemed to be rather well pleased
with her social success. She talked loftily throughout supper, and
during a good part of the evening, about the dinner parties she had
attended and the grand people she had met. Then just as we were about to
start home she turned to my sister and said:

“And have you been much entertained, my dear Maria?”

“Oh, I’ve been enjoying myself tremendously,” was the answer.

“Well, with whom have you dined, dear?” persisted our hostess.

“Why, we’ve dined with the Andersons, with the German Ambassador, with
the Chief Justice, and with the Maurys, and with the French
Ambassador,—and with, oh, a number of other people.”

Our hostess was visibly impressed.

“Why! you really have been very gay, haven’t you, dear!” she exclaimed.

When we got into our cab to go home Maria turned to my husband and said:

“I had my eye on you all the time I was talking, Will Taft. I was
perfectly certain that your terrible sense of fact would overcome you
and that you would blurt out that I dined with all those people on the
same evening at the same dinner party!”

President Harrison, in March, 1892, appointed my husband on the Federal
Circuit Bench, so once more I saw him a colleague of men almost twice
his age and, I feared, fixed in a groove for the rest of his life.
However, he was greatly pleased and very proud to hold such a dignified
and responsible position at the age of thirty-four. I think he enjoyed
the work of the following eight years more than any he has ever
undertaken.

We moved back to Cincinnati. Mr. Taft’s circuit included parts of Ohio,
Kentucky, Tennessee, and Michigan—reached in fact, from Lookout Mountain
to Marquette, and he was much away from home. My own life during those
years in Cincinnati was very busy, for, in addition to my occupation
with family and friends, I became interested in a number of civic
movements.

My principal work was the organisation and management of the Cincinnati
Orchestra Association. I found, at last, a practical method for
expressing and making use of my love and knowledge of music.

We had not had a good symphony orchestra in the city since Theodore
Thomas left, but with our music-loving population it was only necessary
that somebody should take the initiative and arouse definite enthusiasm
and keep it going, in order to establish and maintain such an
institution. There were many public-spirited citizens, some of them true
music-loving Germans, and I saw no reason why I should not get strong
popular support for my project. I was not disappointed. From the first
the response was general and generous and we did not have much
difficulty in raising the necessary funds for financing the orchestra,
although in addition to our box-office receipts, we had to secure
$30,000 a year for six consecutive years. It could not have been done
had it not been for such liberal friends as my brother and sister, Mr.
and Mrs. Charles P. Taft, Mr. Charles Krippendorf, Mr. M. E. Ingalls,
Mr. and Mrs. L. A. Ault, Mrs. Charles Fleishmann, Mr. J. G. Schmidlapp
and others.

For the first year we had three different directors, Mr. Seidl, Mr.
Schradick and Mr. Van der Stücken, who came to Cincinnati and led two
concerts each. Then we secured Mr. Van der Stücken as a permanent leader
and he remained with the orchestra ten years.

I think I regretted the Cincinnati Orchestra Association more than
anything else when we left for the Philippines, but I left it in good
and well-trained hands. Mrs. C. R. Holmes, who succeeded me as President
of the Association, had taken a great part in the original work of
organisation and management, as had my sister-in-law, Mrs. Charles P.
Taft, and others. Through their efforts the orchestra has been enlarged
and improved and it is still a source of great pride and satisfaction to
the city of Cincinnati. Mrs. Charles Taft is now the President and
through her interest, activity and generosity it has been enabled to
grow in excellence.

Except for the orchestra, our life was tranquil; quite too settled, I
thought, and filled with the usual homely incidents connected with
housekeeping and the entertaining development of small children. My
youngest child, Charles, was born in 1897, and my family was thus
complete.

I come now to the years which we gave to the Philippine Islands and I
must say that I wonder yet how our lot happened to be so cast.

There had never been any unusual interest in our family as to the
results of the Spanish-American War. Like most patriotic Americans we
had been greatly excited while the war was in progress and had discussed
its every phase and event with a warmth of approval, or disapproval, as
the case might be, but it did not touch us directly, except as citizens,
any more than it touched the vast majority of the people of the United
States. And yet, it came to mean more to us personally, than any other
event in our times. The whole course of my husband’s career was destined
to be changed and influenced by its results.

Mr. Taft was strongly opposed to taking the Philippines. He was not an
anti-imperialist in the sense that he believed the Constitution required
us to keep the boundaries of the United States within their continental
limits, but he thought the Antipodes rather a far stretch for the
controlling hand, and he thought the taking of the Philippines would
only add to our problems and responsibilities without increasing, in any
way, the effectiveness and usefulness of our government.

Oddly enough, he had expressed himself to that effect when he happened,
during the Spanish War, to be dining with a number of judges including
Justice Harlan who, although later an anti-imperialist, was at that time
strongly upholding the policy of taking over Spanish territory in both
oceans.

Mr. Taft knew just about as much about the Filipino people as the
average American knew in those days. What he definitely knew was that
they had been for more than three centuries under Spanish dominion and
that they now wanted political independence. He was heartily in favour
of giving it to them.

It was one day in January, 1900, that he came home greatly excited and
placed before me a telegram.

“What do you suppose that means?” said he.

“I would like to see you in Washington on important business within the
next few days. On Thursday if possible,” it read. And it was
signed—William McKinley.

We didn’t know and we couldn’t think what possible business the
President could have with him. I began to conjure up visions of Supreme
Court appointments; though I knew well enough that Supreme Court
appointments were not tendered in that fashion and besides there was no
vacancy.

Mr. Taft lost no time in responding to the President’s summons and I
awaited his return with as much patience as I could muster. In three
days he came home with an expression so grave that I thought he must be
facing impeachment. But when he broke his news to me it gave me nothing
but pleasure.

“The President wants me to go to the Philippine Islands,” he said, in a
tone he might have used in saying: “The President wants me to go out and
jump off the court house dome.” “Want to go?” he added.

“Yes, of course,” I answered without a moment’s hesitation. I wasn’t
sure what it meant, but I knew instantly that I didn’t want to miss a
big and novel experience. I have never shrunk before any obstacles when
I had an opportunity to see a new country and I must say I have never
regretted any adventure.

“The President and Mr. Root want to establish a civil government in the
Philippines,” said Mr. Taft, “and they want me to go out at the head of
a commission to do it.” It was only after I had accepted the invitation
to go ten thousand miles away that I asked for an explanation.

In answer to the President’s proposal, Mr. Taft said that he didn’t
approve of the acquisition of the Philippines in the first place, and
that in the second place he knew nothing about colonial government and
had had really no experience in executive work of any kind. But Mr.
McKinley did not accept these objections as final. He called in Mr.
Root, who was then Secretary of War, and who would be Mr. Taft’s chief
in the proposed mission to the Philippines, and together they presented
the case so strongly that my husband could not help but waver in his
decision. Neither Mr. McKinley nor Mr. Root had rejoiced in the taking
over of the Philippines for that matter, but that was beside the
question; the Philippines were taken, and it behooved the United States
to govern them until such time as their people had learned the difficult
art of governing themselves.

Mr. Root said:

“The work to be done in the Philippines is as great as the work
Livingston had to do in Louisiana. It is an opportunity for you to do
your country a great service and achieve for yourself a reputation for
the finest kind of constructive work. You have had a very fortunate
career. While you are only slightly over forty you have had eight years
on the Federal Bench, three years on the State Bench and two years as
Solicitor General. These places you have filled well, but they have been
places which involved no sacrifice on your part. Here is a field which
calls for risk and sacrifice. Your country is confronted with one of the
greatest problems in its history, and you, Judge Taft, are asked to take
immediate charge of the solution of that problem 7,000 miles away from
home. You are at the parting of the ways. Will you take the easier
course, the way of least resistance, with the thought that you had an
opportunity to serve your country and declined it because of its
possible sacrifice, or will you take the more courageous course and,
risking much, achieve much? This work in the Philippines will give you
an invaluable experience in building up a government and in the study of
laws needed to govern a people, and such experience cannot but make you
a broader, better judge should you be called upon again to serve your
country in that capacity.”

My husband promised to consult with me and with his brother Charles and
give his answer in a few days. He didn’t know whether or not I would be
willing to go, but that was a question soon settled.

His resignation of his judgeship was the greatest difficulty. The
President told him he did not think it would be at all necessary for him
to resign since the work in the Philippines would take only about six
months—nine months at the longest—and that he could absent himself from
his duties for that length of time, and for such a purpose, without fear
of any kind of unfortunate consequences. Mr. Taft’s investigation and
study of the situation immediately convinced him that Mr. McKinley was
wrong in his expectation that the work could be done so quickly. Nor did
Mr. Root have any such idea. Even with the meagre information which was
then available, my husband at once saw that it would be years before the
Philippine problem would begin to solve itself. So he resigned from the
Bench; the hardest thing he ever did.

After sending in his acceptance he went immediately to Washington to
discuss with Mr. McKinley and Mr. Root the whole situation and,
especially, the names of four other men who were to be chosen to serve
with him on the Commission. He had met Mr. Worcester, a member of the
first Commission, and had got from him a great deal of valuable data. If
Professor Shurman, the chairman of the first Commission, had become a
member of the second, he probably would have been at its head, but he
did not, and this position fell to Mr. Taft. He was thereafter known as
President of the Commission, until civil government was organised in the
Philippines and he became governor.

After he had gone to Washington I began at once to make hasty, and I may
say, happy preparations for my adventure into a new sphere. That it was
alluring to me I did not deny to anybody. I had no premonition as to
what it would lead to; I did not see beyond the present attraction of a
new and wholly unexplored field of work which would involve travel in
far away and very interesting countries. I read with engrossing interest
everything I could find on the subject of the Philippines, but a
delightful vagueness with regard to them, a vagueness which was general
in the United States at that time, and has not, even yet, been entirely
dispelled, continued in my mind. There were few books to be found, and
those I did find were not specially illuminating.

I gave up my house in Cincinnati and stored my belongings, packing for
shipment to the Orient only such things as I thought would be absolutely
necessary. We were to leave almost immediately and I had very little
time in which to do a great many things. Mr. Taft came back to
Cincinnati for a short period and we entered upon a busy season of
good-bye hospitality. Everybody we knew, and we knew nearly everybody,
wanted to give us a farewell dinner or entertainment of some sort. Mr.
Taft, especially, was fêted in a way which proved to him how much more
widely he was valued in his native town than he had ever realised. In
the opinions of people then we were going, sure enough, to the ends of
the earth, and many of our friends were as mournful about it as if they
had private foreknowledge that it was to be a fatal adventure.

When the banquets and dinners and luncheons and receptions and teas had
all been given; when the speeches had all been made, and the good-byes
had all been said, Mr. Taft hastened off to Washington once more to meet
his colleagues and make final arrangements, and I was not to see him
again until we met in San Francisco a week before the date set for
sailing.

I asked my sister Maria to go with me for the first year, and she
accepted with delight. So, one morning in early April, with our world
waving at us from the platform of the station, we started south to join
the Southern Pacific railroad at New Orleans and to make our way from
there to Los Angeles and so to San Francisco.

[Illustration:

  CHARLIE TAFT WHEN HE WENT TO THE PHILIPPINES
]

I had with me my three children, Robert, Helen and Charlie. Robert was
ten years old, Helen eight, while Charlie, my baby, was just a little
over two. It did not occur to me that it was a task to take them on such
a long journey, or that they would be exposed to any danger through the
experience. They were normal, healthy and very self-reliant little
people and I made preparations for their going without giving the matter
a moment’s unhappy consideration. But I was to receive a few shocks in
this connection later on. One of these came when I learned that some
members of the party had left their children at home for fear of the
Philippine climate. Then one day, at the old Palace Hotel in San
Francisco, I was sitting on guard over Charlie as he played up and down
a wide corridor, and reading a book at intervals, when along came an
odd-looking elderly gentleman who stopped to regard the boy with a smile
of the kindliest amusement. Charlie was an attractive child. Even I
couldn’t help but see that, and I was used to having people stop to
watch him. He had big, dark eyes, soft, brown curls, very deep dimples,
and a charming smile that was always in evidence. The elderly gentleman
stood watching him for some little time, his face growing gradually very
grave, and I wondered what he was thinking about. He didn’t keep me
wondering long. After a few moments he stepped deliberately up to me and
said:

“Madam, I understand you are going to the Philippine Islands. Now I want
to know if you are going to take that great, big, beautiful boy out to
that pest-ridden hole and expose him to certain destruction.”

I grabbed my great, big, beautiful boy and rushed off to my room, and it
was a relief eventually to learn that the awful Philippine climate, at
least so far as children were concerned, existed, largely, in people’s
minds.

We found intense interest in our mission in California and San
Francisco. If there were any anti-imperialists there, they successfully
concealed themselves. The East was uncomfortably crowded with them in
those days, but the evident interest and profit that the West coast
would derive from a large Philippine trade may have been responsible for
the favourable attitude of the Californians. However, we must not
impeach their patriotism, and we ought to attribute some of their
enthusiasm in reference to the Philippines, and our assuming control
over them, to the natural enterprise of a people who had themselves gone
so far in a land of development and hope.

Everything that could be done to make smooth the path of the new
Commission was done. At their own request the powers of the
Commissioners were carefully defined so that complications with the
military government then in force in the islands, might be avoided. They
were given equal rank with ministers plenipotentiary in the matter of
naval courtesies and precedence; and Mr. Root drafted a letter of
instructions, which the President signed, outlining their duties in such
precise and correct detail that it was afterward adopted and ratified in
its entirety in the act of Congress by which the Philippine government
was established.

So—I believed we were going to have “smooth sailing” in every sense,
when we started on the long voyage with which began this interesting
experience.



                              CHAPTER III
                           TO THE PHILIPPINES


The United States Army Transport _Hancock_ had been assigned to the
Commission for the trip from San Francisco to Manila and it was at noon
on a pleasant day in mid-April—the seventeenth—that she pulled away from
the crowded dock and headed straight for the Golden Gate and the long
path across the Pacific that leads to the other side of the world. There
were forty-five people in our party and, although most of us had met for
the first time in San Francisco, we soon became well acquainted, as
people do on shipboard, and proceeded at once to prove ourselves to be a
most harmonious company.

The _Hancock_ was the old _Arizona_, a one-time greyhound of the
Atlantic, which the Government had purchased and remodelled for service
as an army transport. A considerable fleet of such vessels plied the
Pacific at that time, carrying large consignments of troops to and from
the Philippines and, though there are not so many now, I still read with
interest of the comings and goings of ships whose old, friendly sounding
names became so familiar to us in the course of our residence in the
East. The _Grant_, the _Sherman_, the _Sheridan_, the _Thomas_, and
others, all named for great American generals, awaken memories of
interesting days. The _Hancock_ was later given up by the Army and
turned over to the Navy on account of her heavy consumption of coal. She
is now used as a recruiting ship at the Brooklyn Navy Yard.

We found her very comfortable. There were few people aboard besides the
members of our party, and, as she was equipped to carry the officers and
men of an entire regiment, we found ourselves commodiously quartered.
Moreover, the commissary of the transport service had received
instructions to give us excellent fare; this, I believe, through the
thoughtful kindness of Mr. McKinley himself.

Mr. McKinley never failed to take a personal interest in the everyday
welfare of all those in his administration who came under his own
observation and we were made to feel this throughout our experience on
the Philippine Commission, while he lived. On every appropriate occasion
we were certain to receive from him some kindly compliment, a cablegram
or other communication, and it made everybody who came within range of
his influence anxious to serve him well and to make the work which was
being done satisfactory and pleasing to him. I owe to our connection
with President McKinley’s administration some of my happiest
recollections.

The men who made up the second Philippine Commission were Mr. Taft,
General Luke E. Wright of Memphis, Tennessee; Judge Henry C. Ide of
Vermont, Professor Dean C. Worcester of the University of Michigan, and
Professor Bernard Moses of the University of California. A short
introduction of my husband’s colleagues and the members of their
families who went with them to the Philippines will be necessary at this
point, because I was destined to be constantly associated with them
during four of the most interesting years of my life. Our co-operation,
social and governmental, was based upon a common purpose, and our
attachment to this purpose, as well as the bonds of friendship which
united us, were greatly strengthened by the opposition we had to meet
for some months after we reached Manila, not only from the Filipinos,
but also from the military government which the Commission was sent out
gradually to replace.

The men of the Commission, coming, as they did, from different parts of
the United States, were widely contrasted, no less in associations than
in their varied accents and family traditions.

General Wright was, and is, one of the ablest lawyers in Tennessee, and
enjoyed, at the time of his appointment on the Commission, the finest
practice in Memphis. He is a Democrat; and old enough to have been a
lieutenant in the Civil War on the Confederate side. But perhaps his
finest laurels for bravery and devotion to duty were won at the time
when he exerted himself to save Memphis in the days when she was in the
grip of a terrible epidemic of yellow fever. I don’t know the exact
year, but the epidemic was so out of control that all who could, left
the city, while General Wright remained to organise such resistance as
could be made to the spread of the dread disease.

Mrs. Wright was a daughter of the famous Admiral Semmes of the
Confederate Navy and for some time after the war she travelled with her
father in Mexico and abroad, thereby acquiring at an early age a very
cosmopolitan outlook. Admiral Semmes was a great linguist and Mrs.
Wright inherited his gift. She had learned to speak Spanish in her
girlhood, so when she arrived in Manila she had only to renew her
knowledge of the language. General and Mrs. Wright had with them their
daughter Katrina, who was then about fourteen years old, but their two
sons, one a naval officer, did not join them in the Philippines until
later.

General Wright had, on the whole, the most delightful social qualities
of anybody on the Commission. He had a keen sense of humour and could
recount a great number of interesting personal experiences with a manner
and wit which made him, always, a delightful companion. He was a devotee
of pinochle and he instructed the entire party in the game until it was
played from one end of the ship to the other. He was slow to anger, very
deliberate and kindly in his judgments, and offered at times a decided
contrast to his wife who was a little more hasty and not infrequently
founded judgments on what he would jocosely criticise as “a woman’s
reason.”

Judge Ide was born and bred a Vermonter and had many of the rugged
characteristics of the Green Mountain State, not the least among which
is a certain indefinable, but peculiarly New England caution. In
addition to a large and active law practice in both New Hampshire and
Vermont, he had banking connections through which he had gained a better
knowledge of business and finance than is possessed by the average
lawyer. Moreover, a long term as Chief Justice of Samoa had given him
diplomatic experience and a knowledge of the Polynesian races which were
to serve him well in his work in the Philippines. As Chief Justice he
exercised diplomatic and consular as well as judicial functions, and his
position brought him in close relations with the English and German
officials of the joint protectorate of the Samoan islands and in
constant social contact with the naval officers of many countries whose
ships very frequently called at Apia. He was a widower with two young
daughters.

These daughters, Anne and Marjorie, or “the two Ide girls” as they were
then popularly known, displayed no sign of Puritan ancestry or
upbringing. They were just remarkably beautiful and altogether charming
and delightful. A large part of their girlhood had been spent in Samoa;
they were the product of an intermittent, but very picturesque
education, and there was ingrained in them some of that happy-go-lucky
attitude toward life, and that freedom from useless convention which the
Occidental is not unlikely to acquire in the Orient.

These girls had, in Samoa, been great friends of Robert Louis Stevenson.
Anne, the elder, was the especial favourite of the beauty-loving invalid
and he willed to her his birthday, as can be learned from his Samoan
letters. She was born near Christmas time and had never known what it
was to have her birthday celebrated, a great deprivation in childhood.
But she now celebrates as her own the birthday of Robert Louis Stevenson
and it is, I believe, her most cherished possession.

Marjorie, whose career, ever since our first trip together, I have
followed with the greatest affection and interest, had even more of the
care-free attitude than Anne. She used to convulse us with cruelly funny
accounts of her adventures with admirers, of whom there were many, and
with descriptions of some of the strange acquaintances she made during
her travels with her father.

Among the passengers on the _Hancock_ was Dr. Kneedler, an army surgeon,
with his wife and two little girls. These little girls were exceedingly
bright and inquisitive. Young ladies and gentlemen had particular and
irresistible attractions for them and the Ide young ladies kept them
very much occupied. The Ide young ladies didn’t encourage their
attentions and this fact engendered their hostility. They therefore
referred to the Misses Ide as “them there Ides.” With their delightful
sense of humour the Ides, of course, rejoiced in the designation and in
all the thirteen years since then they have never met Mr. Taft or me
without presenting themselves as “them there Ides.”

The Misses Ide were destined to be the unrivalled belles of Manila
society for six years and then to move on to broader social spheres.
Anne was married to Mr. Bourke Cochran shortly after her father left the
Philippines, but Marjorie continued to be her father’s companion for
several years, going with him to Madrid when he was appointed Minister
to Spain and presiding over the American Legation there until she
married Mr. Shane Leslie and went to London to live.

General Wright, Judge Ide and Mr. Taft were the lawyers on the
Commission and it was felt that their familiarity with law and
governmental matters greatly enhanced the strength and preparedness of
the Commission for the work they had to do.

Mr. Worcester was an assistant professor at the University of Michigan.
He too was a Vermonter, with quite as much _fortiter in re_, but with
somewhat less of the _suaviter in modo_ than Judge Ide inherently had,
or had acquired in his Samoan experience.

Mr. Worcester was the only member of the party who had ever been to the
Philippines before. I think he had been there twice with scientific
expeditions before the Battle of Manila Bay had thrust the guardianship
of the Filipinos upon our country, and in the course of his trips, with
his fluency in Spanish as it is spoken in the Philippines, he had
acquired a very intimate knowledge of the people and their customs, as
well as of the flora and fauna of the islands. He had written a book on
the Philippines which came out at a most fortunate time, just when
Dewey’s victory had turned the eyes of the country upon that
never-before-thought-of corner of the world. This book led to his
appointment on the first Commission and his useful, loyal, courageous
and effective labours with that body led Mr. McKinley to appoint him on
the second.

He is a large, forceful man with rather abrupt manners and very decided
opinions and perhaps no greater contrast could be imagined than exists
between him and Mrs. Worcester, who, in outward seeming, is the frailest
kind of little woman, with a sweet face and engagingly gentle manners
which suggest timidity. Mrs. Worcester has proved herself to possess the
frailty of flexible steel. At that time we were quite concerned about
her, I remember, thinking she would not be able to endure the Philippine
climate even for a short period. But she has lived there from that day
to this. She has been with her husband through many experiences from
which the strongest woman would shrink, toiling with him over hundreds
of miles of mountain and jungle trail on his frequent expeditions into
the countries of the wild tribes and meeting every difficulty without
comment. She is in excellent health and is a living refutation of the
familiar exaggerations as to the effect of the climate. They had with
them two little white haired children, one of them quite delicate, who
have grown up in the Philippines strong and healthy and have received
most of their education in the schools established there under American
government.

The last member of the Commission was Professor Bernard Moses of the
political and historical department of the University of California. He
was a man of profound learning, a Connecticut Yankee, combining a very
excellent knowledge of business with his unusual qualifications as an
historian, economist and student of politics. He was especially familiar
with all Spanish-American countries, had travelled extensively in the
South American republics and had written a learned book on the
constitution of Colombia. My husband always says that he thinks Mr.
McKinley exercised the wisest discretion in the selection of all the
members of this Commission since they possessed, among them,
qualifications for every line of work in practical government and
original research.

Mrs. Moses, a graduate from the University of California, was a very
attractive woman. She had a gift for vivid description and for seeing
the funny side of every situation. Her book, “Unofficial Letters of an
Official’s Wife,” gives an interesting and accurate picture of social
life in the early days of military rule, which are known in Manila
history as “the days of the Empire” and of that period when American
civil government was in the process of organisation. Her wit sometimes
had a suggestion of the caustic in it, but she never failed to
contribute her quota to the day’s amusement.

There were many other interesting members of the party, including Mr.
Arthur Fergusson, the Spanish secretary, and Mrs. Fergusson, Mr. Frank
A. Branagan, the disbursing officer, and Mrs. Branagan, and several
private secretaries with their families.

The voyage from San Francisco to Honolulu was quite perfect. As we
sailed toward the tropics the weather gradually grew warmer and the
sheltered decks became the most attractive part of the ship. The
promenade deck of the _Hancock_ reaches from bow to stern. I believe
there is a regular term to describe such ship construction,—“decked over
all” is it?—but to me it was just a very long deck which served
unusually well for exercise. The Commission held regular business
sessions in a cabin which had been fitted up for the purpose, but when
work was over they would start on a long march around and around the
deck, covering many miles each day. My husband was especially
industrious and walked one man after another “off his feet” until,
finally, he was obliged to finish his long tramp alone. He set himself
the task of so many miles a day, so many times around the deck being a
mile, and to keep count of laps requires some concentration. His quiet
persistence in this kind of exercise was calculated to make the lazy
onlooker intensely nervous, and when I had done my modest little turn I
was always glad to indulge in a sort of counter-concentration at a whist
table, or at General Wright’s ever constant pinochle.

Altogether the days passed very pleasantly and we were a very merry and
friendly party by the time we reached Honolulu.

At Honolulu I got my first glimpse of real tropics, and I was enchanted.
It was a glorious sensation for me that April morning when I saw these
mid-Pacific islands, for the first time, rise before me out of a
white-capped sea; clear-cut in an atmosphere which seems never to be
blurred by mist.

American energy, ambition and initiative have wrought great material
changes in the islands and these, which were even then important, were
brought to our admiring attention later on. I shall always think of
Hawaii,—of the island of Oahu, rather,—as it appeared to me then when
our ship steamed past Diamond Head, skirted the high breakers of Waikiki
and made its way up through the bright waters of the bay into the
harbour of Honolulu. Honolulu is a little, modern city lying, all in
sight, against the green of a narrow, gently-sloping, peak-encircled
valley.

The Punchbowl, a spent and emptied volcano, outlined in perfect form
against the higher hills behind it, plainly tells the story of the
spectacular construction of the islands and makes it almost possible to
visualise their sudden rise from the sea. They are not very old,
according to scientific measurements of time, but they are old enough,
at any rate, to have clothed themselves in the most brilliant
luxuriance, which is the first thing to impress the traveller as his
ship sails into the harbour.

The brilliance from the ship’s deck is the brilliance of every
imaginable shade of green, massed against the towering, pointed hills
and picked into contrasts of high-light and shadow by a sun and
atmosphere peculiar to the tropics. Once ashore, the green foliage
becomes the background for a wealth of blooming flowers, flowers
everywhere, of unnumbered different varieties, with the flaming hibiscus
in every garden, striking the high note of colour. Until we left
Honolulu laden with “leis”—long festoons of flower petals which are
thrown upon the shoulders of departing friends and visitors—there were
always flowers.

And with the flowers and the foliage and the tall palm trees and the
warm tropic sunlight, there is music, the music of the native which
greets one in welcome at the dock and contributes constantly to the
spirit of festivity until the departing ship gets too far from shore to
catch the strains of the farewell song “Aloha” whose closing words:
“Until we meet, until we meet again,” linger long in the mind of the
grateful recipient of Hawaiian hospitality.

The first thing we were to learn when our ship came up into the harbour
was that the bubonic plague had been epidemic in Honolulu for a long
time. It was our first encounter with this terror of the East. There had
been seventy-one cases in all, and sixty-one deaths. Six Europeans had
contracted the disease and of these four had died. When we dropped
anchor we were at once boarded by the local health officer, Dr.
Carmichael of the Marine Hospital Service, who was accompanied by United
States Minister Sewell and Consul General Hayward. They wanted us to
land, of course, and we were very anxious to do so, but as the
quarantine was not yet raised they could not answer for the attitude of
the Japanese health officers when we got to Yokohama. Our going ashore
might result in a long detention in quarantine for ourselves and, aside
from the discomfort of this, we could not afford the delay. There was no
particular danger for us personally, since no new cases had been
reported for twenty-four days, but it was all a question of being able
to land later in Japan. It was really too much of a disappointment;
there was not a dissenting voice on that score, and Honolulu kept
getting more and more attractive as the possibility dawned on us that we
might not see it at all. But it was arranged. We sent for the Japanese
vice-Consul and explained matters to him and he finally agreed to hold
himself responsible for our breaking the quarantine, in so far as it
concerned Japan, if we would keep our ship out in the stream instead of
tying up at the dock, and permit no member of the crew to go ashore
during our stay. This we readily agreed to do and made our plans
accordingly. We, too, were to live on board the _Hancock_, but there
were any number of harbour launches put at our disposal.

We were received by the Americans in Honolulu with the utmost cordiality
and immediately found ourselves sharing the exhilarating suspense with
which the people were then awaiting the passage of the bill in Congress
which was to make the Hawaiian Islands a part of the United States. The
first thing the Commission did was to call on President Dole, of the
provisional republican government, and with him they met the Ministers
of the Treasury and the Interior, Mr. Damon and Mr. Young. Indeed, we
met all the people who had the affairs of the islands in hand and were
most delightfully entertained by them. We found them of one mind, just
anxiously waiting to be annexed to the United States. The men, who
realised the importance of our mission to the Philippines, were eager to
foregather with the Commission and discuss with them, long and
earnestly, this broad American venture and its possible effect upon the
future prosperity of the Hawaiian Islands, but in so far as I was
concerned, nothing in the way of state problems was allowed to intrude
itself upon their purely social hospitality. There were dinners and
luncheons and teas and receptions, and, in the intervals, sightseeing.

There are a number of entertaining things to do in Honolulu and while I
do not wish to make this, in any way, a book of travel, I must record my
impressions of the world as they came to me.

The Hawaiian Islands have a background of romantic history which makes
the museums, the public buildings and even the cemeteries of the capital
extremely interesting. Besides all of which there are some wonderful
views which every one must see.

The trip to Nuuani Pali is the first thing to be undertaken in Honolulu,
perhaps because it is the greatest thing on the island of Oahu. We
didn’t know what the Pali was,—had no idea. It was just _the_ place to
go, so we went,—the very first day. We drove up the valley over a
perfect road which wound in and out past beautiful, palm-shaded country
homes, and along the bank of a noisy, crystal-clear little mountain
stream, until we came to a point which looked to me like the “jumping
off place.” And it is; the “jumping off place” is the Pali. The road
turns sharp around the solid rock wall of the cliff and winds its way on
down into the valley on the other side, but it is a distinct surprise to
find that it doesn’t end right there. The Pali is the Pass of the Winds;
the meeting place of all the young hurricanes of the Pacific. They say
the winds in the Pali are never still. We were flattened out against the
wall of the cliff, our hats were torn from our heads and we had to hold
onto our coats for dear life, but before us lay one of the grandest
spectacles in the whole world. Coral-tinted, purple, rose and bright
blue sea; beetling, pointed, terrible cliffs, and a broad, green plain
running down to a surf-washed ribbon of beach; a panorama as wide as the
compass of vision. I have been back since then thinking that, on first
sight, I might have overestimated the grandeur of the Pali. But I
didn’t. It is one of the world’s great views. And it has its touch of
savage history too. It was up these hills and over the cliffs of the
Pali that King Kamehameha drove to certain death the offending hordes in
arms against his sovereignty. There was no escape for them. Once in this
pass they had either to go over the precipice or back against the spears
of the enemy. This being history, and not myth, it adds much to the
thrill of the spectacle.

After a visit to the indescribable “aquarium of the painted
fishes”—painted, I suppose, by the bright sun-rays in the coral shallows
of the tropic seas—we went, as guests of Mr. Carter, a prominent member
of the American colony, who afterward became governor of the islands,
out to Waikiki Beach for surf-bathing,—or, surf-riding, as it is more
aptly called.

Surf-riding at Waikiki Beach is a great game. In the first place the
surf there doesn’t look as if any human being would dare venture into
it; but when you see a beautiful, slim, brown native, naked save for
short swimming trunks, come gliding down a high white breaker, poised
like a Mercury, erect on a single narrow plank—it looks delightfully
exhilarating. It took me some time to make up my mind, but after
sufficient persuasion I finally decided to risk my life with the others.
Dressed in bathing suits, we were taken out beyond the line of breakers
in long canoes with outriggers and, with a native at prow and stern
armed with broad paddles to guide the craft, we rode in on the crest of
the waves. Even this modified version of the natives’ foolhardy
performance is dangerous enough. There is every likelihood of an upset
and not any of us could be said to swim expertly, so there was great
excitement when one member of the party after another was plunged, out
of depth, into the foaming and seething water. Two members of our party,
indeed, had a narrow escape, though we didn’t know it at the time.
General Wright and Judge Ide were capsized in a particularly vicious
breaker and Judge Ide at once began to make frantic efforts to attract
attention and secure aid, but in the confusion his signs of distress
were taken for indications of vast enjoyment and he would have been left
to drown if he hadn’t been washed ashore by the force of the surf.
General Wright, though much the better swimmer, had no less difficulty,
and they were both quite white and shaken when they crawled up on the
beach.

We stayed four days in this “Paradise of the Pacific,” during which we
made many interesting trips, were introduced to many strange Hawaiian
customs and were regaled with many feasts, not always, I may say,
particularly appetizing. I have had in my time, for politeness’ sake, to
eat various queer messes in all sorts of odd corners of the earth, but
to me “poi” will always be “poi”—in a class by itself. It is the true
Hawaiian dish and is offered to guests by the natives in the same spirit
of compliment with which we offer to “break bread” with our friends. It
is the custom for Americans residing in Honolulu to introduce visitors
to this dish, and the native viands which go with it, in entertainments
which are called “poi dinners,” and we were treated to as many of these
as our time would permit. “Poi” bears an unpleasant outward resemblance
to cockroach paste and, try as I would, I was never able to cultivate a
taste for it. But foreigners do learn to like it, for I found Americans
in Honolulu eating it with the greatest relish and dipping it up with
their fingers in true Hawaiian style.

On our last evening in Honolulu, after a morning of sightseeing, a
luncheon, an hour in the buffeting surf, and a large tea-party, we were
given a particularly elaborate “poi dinner” where we all sat on the
floor and at which all the guests appeared in native costume with “leis”
around their necks and in their hair. The Minister of Foreign Affairs,
Mr. Mott Smith, sent the Hawaiian Band, whose leader came out from old
Emperor William to King Kalakaua, and they serenaded us with most
wonderful Hawaiian music, interspersed, for their own pride’s sake, with
well rendered selections from the finest operas. The girls came in
flaming bright “Mother-Hubbard” dresses, crowned and covered with
“leis,” to dance for us the curious folk-lore dances of the old-time. It
was a delightful whirl of music and lights and colour—added to fish and
poi and a cramped position—but I was tired enough not to be sorry when
the time came for the singing of “Aloha Oe” and our departure for the
ship which lay out in the harbour ready to up-anchor at daybreak and
start on its way to Japan.

On the evening of the tenth of May we reached the estuary near the head
of which is Yokohama and further on is Tokyo. For at least two hours we
steamed past a low-lying shore line before we came in sight of the sweep
of steep cliff to the southward which forms the great outer harbour.

[Illustration:

  NIKKO. AN ANCIENT CRYPTOMERIA AVENUE AND A GLIMPSE OF THE FAMOUS
    TEMPLES
]

There was just one thing that we could really look at; one insistent,
dominant point in the landscape which caught us and held us
fascinated,—Fujiyama. I had seen Fujiyama on screens and fans and
porcelains all my life, but I had no conception of it. For one half hour
this “Queen of Mountains”—rightly called—rising thirteen thousand feet
out of sheer sea-level, perfect in form, snow-capped, majestic, blazed
for us against the western sky. Then a cloud curtain fell,—and the sun
went down.

As we steamed up close to the breakwater in the grey light of late
evening we could see nothing but the dark outlines of many ships and a
long row of substantial looking buildings, under high arc lights,
stretching along a wide, water-front street which I was afterward to
know as The Bund.

We wanted to go ashore, but it was not possible. We had to lie outside
the breakwater and wait for the doctors to come aboard. “Wait for the
doctors to come aboard;” how familiar that proceeding becomes to the
traveller among the ports of the East, and especially, of Japan. You
arrive at Yokohama and are examined there; you go just around the bend
of the coast line and arrive at Kobe and you are examined there; you go
on through the Inland Sea to Nagasaki and again you are examined.
Wherever you arrive in this land of much caution you must “wait for the
doctors to come aboard.”

But our doctors didn’t keep us waiting long. About eight o’clock half a
dozen of them, important little men with much gold lace, came smiling up
the gangway. We worried, rather, about the plague we had braved,—and we
did hope none of our crew would develop symptoms,—but, having faith in
the Japanese Vice-Consul in Honolulu, we hoped for special leniency. We
were not disappointed. They examined the ship’s company with great care,
but our examination was a mere formality, a sort of apologetic
enumeration as a matter of fact, and after giving us a clean bill of
health the doctors bowed themselves most courteously away. But we had a
narrow escape. Charlie’s nurse developed a suspicious sore throat the
very next afternoon and gave us many days of anxiety for the baby and
the other children. And, as I shall make plain further on, our anxiety
was not without cause.

In reading over my own and my husband’s letters, written on that trip to
various members of the family, I find that Charlie was very much in
evidence at all times. I suppose he was spoiled because, certainly,
everybody took a hand in his misguidance, but the spoiling process at
least kept him in high good humour, unless it happened to take the form
of secret indulgence in prohibited sweets; then I had to meet the
consequences. I find my husband writing to his brother Charles: “Charlie
continues to be as full of spirits and as determined to have his own way
as ever. We call him ‘the tornado’; he creates such a sensation when he
lands in the midst of the children on board the ship. He is very badly
in need of discipline and I long for the time to come when he will be
better able to appreciate it. Maria has become quite as much a slave to
him as Nellie and you may tell his Aunt Annie that I am still the only
hope the boy has of moral training.” This sounds so much like the
average father that I thought I ought to quote it.

When Bessie, Charlie’s nurse, was taken away from him and quarantined we
got for him a Japanese “amah” who filled him at first with indignation,
not unmixed with fear. But she was so patient, and followed him around
so much like a faithful watchdog, that he grew to be exceedingly fond of
her and straightway proceeded to exchange his small English vocabulary
for, to him, more useful Japanese words.

The first thing to claim our attention in Yokohama Harbour was the
American cruiser _Newark_, the Admiral’s flagship of the Asiatic fleet,
with Admiral Kempff aboard. As soon as we came inside the breakwater she
fired a salute of seventeen guns, and we wondered what it was all about,
until suddenly we remembered that the Commissioners had the rank of
ministers plenipotentiary and decided that it was meant for us. It was
the first time in my husband’s life that he had ever been saluted. In
his later career he reached a point where he would have been almost
willing to assume a disguise in order to escape the thunder of the
twenty-one guns that roared at him whenever he approached a naval vessel
of any kind, but I think he was rather elated by this first tribute to
his official standing.

We found later that an old friend, Captain McCalla, was in command of
the _Newark_. We had known Captain McCalla in Washington when my husband
was Solicitor General. He had been court-martialed and suspended from
the Navy for a year for striking an unruly and insubordinate sailor and
at his request Mr. Taft read the record of the court-martial. Mr. Choate
had been his counsel, but the case was given a great deal of unpleasant
publicity. He displayed such bravery at the Battle of Guantanamo, in
Cuba, that the files he had lost were restored to him. He also rendered
distinguished service in the Philippines, taking over the surrender of
one of Aguinaldo’s generals at Caygayan; and later on, in China, he was
in the van of the allied troops that relieved Peking and was severely
wounded. Being a man of broad intelligence and great enterprise he
appreciated the importance of the Philippine Commission and lost no time
in extending to them all the courtesies at his command.

Shortly after we landed and got ourselves comfortably settled at the
Grand Hotel, an ensign from the _Newark_ came to ask when the Commission
would receive the Admiral. The hour was set for this formality and when
it had been duly disposed of, Captain McCalla called on us unofficially,
with much news for our hungry ears from the big world that we had known
nothing about for eleven long days. That was before the wireless era
when going to sea was really going to sea, and seldom has the world
known a more exciting year than 1900. Grim talk about the terrible Boxer
insurrection was on every tongue and Captain McCalla told us that the
_Newark_ was lying in readiness to proceed to China at an instant’s
notice. The British were just then pressing the Boers northward in South
Africa, and our own troubles in the Philippines were by no means over.
We had nearly seventy thousand troops in the field, and we heard of
decisive engagements between the division under General Young and some
religious fanatic _insurrectos_ in northern Luzon. We found ourselves
feeling very much in touch with big events.

The Commission went out to the _Newark_ to return the Admiral’s call and
when they got back to the hotel they were full of valuable information
and advice about sightseeing in Japan, housekeeping in the Orient and
other important things. Among other bits of news they had to tell their
wives was that we would all probably be received at the Japanese
Court,—which was quite exciting.

My experience is that the most formal branch of the government service
is the naval branch. The state department may be as formal, but I doubt
it. The ceremony on board naval vessels is constant, and the severity of
the penalties for any failure to follow the regulations impresses itself
upon every naval officer. Therefore, every naval officer must have
diplomatic training and must be alert in finding out and in carrying out
the duties of polite intercourse which prevail in every country.

Captain McCalla regarded the Commissioners as pro-consuls going to an
important province, quite equal to the foremost diplomatic
representatives of the United States anywhere, and he thought it was
incumbent upon them to make the fact of their presence in Japan known at
the Imperial Court and to apply for an audience with the Emperor. It
hadn’t occurred to them. Their minds were so full of the weighty
problems confronting them at Manila that they had given no consideration
to any possible intervening formalities, and, anyhow, Mr. Taft said he
thought the Emperor wouldn’t lose much sleep if he did miss seeing them.
But this was not the proper attitude at all, and Captain McCalla,
expostulating with them for their too casual conduct, finally prevailed
upon them to communicate with the American Minister in Tokyo and ask to
have application made for the audience. They were immediately informed
that their arrival had been expected and that the matter had already
been attended to.

[Illustration:

  ENTRANCE TO THE IMPERIAL PALACE GARDENS IN TOKYO
]

The Commission had only a week in Japan and, although their purpose in
stopping had been to coal ship and get some clothing suitable for the
tropic heat they were going into, they naturally were anxious to see
something of the country during their stay, so the days were filled with
expeditions around Yokohama and Tokyo and to points of interest nearby.
My sister Maria and I did not accompany them on many of these trips
because we were planning to remain in Japan for the summer and wanted to
view its attractions at our leisure.

The trip to Nikko was made memorable by Mr. Taft’s most triumphal
progress. On account of his unusual proportions he had already been an
object of tremendous interest to the Japanese.

Nikko is nearly a day’s ride from Tokyo, up in the hills to the north,
and when you get there you find that the railway station is a long way
from the hotel and that much of the distance is a steep incline. The
only kind of conveyance available is a jinricksha, and when my husband
climbed into one of these little perambulators the unfortunate coolie to
whom it belonged began to utter strange sounds. He rolled his eyes and
gesticulated frantically until he prevailed upon a second man to help
him in propelling his unaccustomed burden. But even then his excitement
did not abate. As they approached the first rise in the road some of the
villagers along the way, attracted, no doubt, by the coolie’s weird
cries, came out to stare and, as usual, remained to laugh. The little
’ricksha man began chattering and grimacing at all of them and kept it
up until he had enlisted the services of at least half the population of
the village to help him in attaining the crest of the hill.

Two days before the _Hancock_ was to start on her way toward Manila the
great event of our visit to Japan transpired. We had our audience with
the Emperor and Empress.

The first thing the ladies all asked, of course, was, “What shall we
wear?” It was a most important question. I supposed we should have to
wear evening gowns and was congratulating myself that I had a very nice
new one that would do beautifully. But only on the afternoon before the
day appointed, it was decreed that we should appear in high-necked
frocks with trains. That was more difficult,—especially the trains. I
didn’t own an afternoon frock that I considered good enough. I was going
to the tropics and had got a supply of thin white muslins and linens,
but I had nothing that would do for a cold May day in Japan. Mrs.
Wright, Mrs. Worcester and Mrs. Moses were as greatly concerned as I,
but we finally managed. I solved the problem by having a Chinese
dressmaker in Yokohama make me, overnight, a lace guimpe which I wore
with my perfectly acceptable evening gown.

Judge Ide had been particularly interested in the audience and in the
fact that the ladies would also be received and he was very much
chagrined when he found that “the ladies” meant only the wives of the
Commissioners and that he could not take with him his two beautiful
daughters. He quite lost interest in the whole proceeding, and we didn’t
blame him in the least.

The Palace in Tokyo is not a “Forbidden City” literally, as the old
palace in Peking used to be, but it looks from the outside just as
“forbidden,” or more so. It is surrounded by a wide, deep moat which is
crossed at intervals by curved and gracefully balustraded bridges. On
the other side of the moat is a high stone wall. There is nothing of the
palace to be seen except a few low, tiled roofs which peep out from the
midst of many trees. The Imperial gardens are vastly more impressive
than the palaces,—there are several within the walled enclosure,—and I
would have wanted to linger and really look at things if I had not been
so keenly interested in the experience which awaited us. Our carriage
hurried on over the beautiful drives, through the most entrancing little
artificial landscapes, past lakes full of little rock islands on which
were perched tiny pavilions with uptilted roofs and the most beautiful
polished wood and snow-white paper windows. It was all most fascinating
and much too wonderful to be merely glanced at, but it was only a few
moments before we approached a low, grey building and drew up before the
door. It didn’t look at all like a palace, but it seemed that we had
arrived.

We were ushered into a large reception room which was neither Japanese
nor European, but a curious mixture of both. The walls were of gold leaf
and were decorated with beautiful Japanese paintings in exquisitely soft
colourings, but the furniture was mostly of the heavy foreign type. It
was unexpected to say the least and I thought what a pity it was that
the Japanese had not met the European invasion in their own original and
picturesquely beautiful style, instead of trying to conform to western
customs, or rather, to engraft western customs upon their own unique
orientalism. But so it is. They either like our ugly heaviness, or think
they confer a polite compliment on us by adopting it.

We were not kept waiting long. We were separated from the men of our
party and were led into another room, much like the first, where the
Empress awaited us attended by three or four ladies of her court. We
curtseyed very low, not without difficulty on the part of most of us in
spite of much practice, and after receiving a gracious smile and bow
from Her Majesty, we were able to stand erect and observe her at our
leisure. Both she and her ladies-in-waiting were dressed in European
costume which made them look much smaller than they would have looked in
their own beautiful _kimonos_. Her Majesty’s face was sweet and almost
timid looking, and her voice was peculiarly gentle. Our conversation,
carried on through an interpreter, was commonplace in the extreme, but
her manner was pleasant and cordial. I was tremendously interested
because I had been reading Japanese history and was duly impressed with
the hoary antiquity of this court of the Son of Heaven. The Empress
addressed a few remarks to each of us, after which we curtseyed again
and retired. That was all.

Our husbands were received in a similar manner by the Emperor, though
His Majesty granted a separate interview to each of them. Mr. Taft
entered first with the Minister of the Household in charge of the
ceremony. He bowed when he entered the door, bowed again half way up the
long room, and yet again when he arrived before the Emperor. The others,
also bowing, followed close behind but remained just outside of the
audience chamber while my husband’s audience was in progress. Mr.
Nagasaki, who acted as interpreter, said that His Majesty was very much
pleased to see the Commission in Japan. Mr. Taft expressed his
appreciation of the audience. The Emperor asked if he had ever been in
Japan before. He said he had not. The Emperor asked when he was going to
leave Japan. He replied, “In two days, Your Majesty.” After which this,
his first audience with the Mikado, was at an end and he left the
chamber while the rest of the Commissioners, each in his turn, went
through the same ceremony.

After our husbands had been received by the Empress also, they rejoined
us and we were conducted through some other rooms in the palace which
interested us greatly. They all showed a curious mingling of Japanese
and European objects of art and nobody could see them without deciding
that, in that particular setting at least, the Japanese objects were far
the more beautiful.

The Japanese Court is much inclined to imitate things European and the
results are sometimes astonishing. Years later, when my husband was in
Japan without me, the Empress presented him with a tapestry for me which
had been copied from a Gobelin piece. It represented the meeting of
Columbus and Isabella, and, it shows the most exquisite workmanship, but
the faces have a curiously Oriental cast.

There is a story in connection with this tapestry which I think I must
tell. My husband was Secretary of War when it was presented to me; and I
say me with emphasis, because thereby hangs the story. He brought it
home and displayed it with great pride and satisfaction, but it was so
enormous and, from my standpoint, so useless, that I rather protested
and wondered why, as long as he was getting such a gorgeous present he
couldn’t have managed in some way to make its size correspond with my
circumstances.

“Oh, well,” said he, “never mind. I’m going to present it to the
Smithsonian Institute anyway, because you know, my dear, it is against
the Constitution for an official in the United States government to
accept any kind of favours from foreign courts.”

This was not the first time in my life that I had met the Constitution
face to face, but theretofore I had been able to accept its decrees with
what I had hoped was patriotic resignation. But now that tapestry
suddenly became to me a most desirable thing. It had been sent to me by
the Empress of Japan and I wanted to enjoy the mere possession of it,—at
least for awhile. So, as my husband would say, I took the question up
with him. I tried to convince him that I was not an official of the
United States government and that he, as an official, had nothing
whatever to do with my present from the Empress of Japan. He stood
firmly by the Constitution, as usual, and eventually I had to submit the
question for arbitration to President Roosevelt, who agreed with me that
I was a private citizen and had a perfect right to accept the gift. I
afterward hung it in one of the big wall spaces in the state dining-room
of the White House and had the pleasure of watching many a guest vainly
endeavouring to locate its origin and figure out its meaning.

We concluded our first audience at the court of Japan by signing our
names in the Imperial album, after which we went to the American
Legation to a beautiful luncheon which the Minister had arranged in our
honour. Our Minister in Tokyo then—it was some years before the Legation
was raised to an Embassy—was Mr. Buck of Georgia, a most affable and
agreeable gentleman. He had invited a number of his diplomatic
colleagues to meet us and, among others, we met for the first time Baron
and Baroness Rosen, of the Russian Legation, who were afterward with us
in Washington.

I sat on the right of the Minister and next to Baron Sanomiya, the Court
Chamberlain, who had conducted our audience. I was greatly interested in
Baron Sanomiya’s wife. She was an Englishwoman at least twice his size.

At Mr. Taft’s request the Minister had invited an old classmate of his,
Baron Tajiri Inajiro. At Yale he was known as Tajiri, and the first two
letters of both their names being “Ta” he and my husband had been
brought together in the classroom, seated alphabetically, and had
enjoyed a pleasant association. So Mr. Taft looked forward with great
pleasure to renewing the acquaintance in Japan. Baron Tajiri, like most
Japanese, was a little man, and his teeth were so formed that he was
never able to master the pronunciation of English in such a way as to
enable one to understand him easily. But he seems to have acquired at
Yale a sound knowledge of business and finance since he became Assistant
Minister of Finance under Yamagata and had taken an active part in the
change of the Japanese currency from the silver to the gold standard,
which was a great step in Japan’s progress toward a place among the
world’s powers. He had been made a life peer and sat in the Upper House.
At the luncheon he wore a frock coat which Mr. Taft felt confident he
recognised as an old college friend of the ‘seventies. In those days the
Japanese wore their “foreign clothes” only on “foreign occasions” or at
court. They kept them carefully folded up and put away, and they had not
yet come to recognise the desirability of pressing them when they took
them out for use. Also a silk hat once was a silk hat always; vintages
didn’t trouble them, and they didn’t mind in the least which way the nap
was brushed.

[Illustration:

  © Harris S. Ewing.

  THE STATE DINING-ROOM OF THE WHITE HOUSE, SHOWING TAPESTRY PRESENTED
    TO MRS. TAFT BY THE EMPRESS OF JAPAN
]

Baron Tajiri wanted to be appointed Minister of Finance when Yamagata
retired, but he was put, instead, at the head of the Board of Audits, a
life position. Marchioness, now Princess Oyama, wife of the Field
Marshal, told my husband this on the occasion of his second visit to
Japan, and said that the disappointment had made Tajiri very much of a
recluse. In any case, Mr. Taft has never seen him again, although he has
tried to seek him out and has made inquiry about him every time he has
been in Japan.

We were very much interested in our Legation at Tokyo. It was the first
one we had ever seen that the American government owned. The house was
not what it ought to have been, but it was surrounded by spacious and
beautifully kept grounds and was so much better than the nothing that we
have in other countries that we liked to dwell upon it as an honourable
exception to the disgraceful and miserly policy pursued by Congress in
dealing with our representatives to foreign capitals.

Mrs. Wright, with her daughter Katrina, had decided to remain with us in
Yokohama for the summer, so we took a cottage together on The Bluff, a
high foreign residence section of the city, and prepared to make
ourselves most comfortable.

Two days later the Commissioners and the rest of the party went aboard
the _Hancock_ and we waved them good-bye from a harbour launch as they
steamed away toward Manila.



                               CHAPTER IV
                                IN JAPAN


To be quarantined in a house too small for the number of its occupants,
behind closed doors, each one of which bears aloft a sinister yellow
placard across which is printed in large, black letters: “Diphtheria,”
is no way to begin a visit to a strange and interesting country.

No sooner had Bessie, Charlie’s nurse, been released from quarantine by
the doctors in Yokohama than our older boy, Robert, developed suspicious
symptoms which, upon diagnosis, were pronounced to be diphtheritic. The
sore throat began before Mr. Taft left for Manila, and he was loathe to
go, but as the new serum treatment for diphtheria had robbed the disease
of much of its terror, and as we were in the hands of an excellent
American physician, Dr. Eldridge, I felt confident there was no cause
for serious apprehension.

We sent Helen and the baby to be taken care of at the Grand Hotel, while
Mrs. Wright, Maria and I resigned ourselves to a long and tedious period
of isolation. Robert’s diphtheria did not develop to a dangerous stage,
but the sore throat persisted and it was three weeks before we were
released upon a none-too-welcoming world. Our long quarantine had marked
us as objects to be avoided—in a social sense—even after the doctors had
pronounced us safe.

Mrs. Wright and my sister and I spent that entire three weeks only
wishing that we were in our own land where some friendly voice might at
least shout an inquiry about us from a distance, and not in this
far-away place where only strange and very foreign sounds came floating
in to us from curious and crowded streets whose every nook and corner we
were aching to explore.

Our house was charming. All the “foreign” houses in Japan seem to me to
be charming. The solidity of Occidental construction, with the light
touch of Japanese interior decoration, make a fascinating combination,
especially in that environment. The Japanese landscape is—well,
peculiarly Japanese, and the gardens, however “foreign” they may be,
have an air quite unique and unmistakably oriental.

The Foreign Settlement in Yokohama consists of a broad business section,
solidly built, on the low lands fronting the harbour, and The Bluff. The
Bluff is a garden of beautiful homes. At one end it rises high above the
bay and commands a wide view of harbour, town and Pacific Ocean, while
the other end runs inland to meet the higher hills beyond and forms a
deep valley in which has been built up a teeming native quarter full of
colour, of picturesque outline and of never-ending oriental clamour.
Around this village are terraced, bright-green rice paddies and high
hills covered with dark, Japanese pines which grow at curious angles.

Our house, a spreading bungalow in a large and well-kept garden, was on
the inland side and overlooked this valley. From a Buddhist temple on
the opposite hill, a quaint structure with uptilted roof and great stone
_torii_ gateway, came the ceaseless drone of a priest repeating over and
over an endless invocation to the constant, measured tum-tum
accompaniment of little wooden drums, while from the narrow streets
below rose the strange cries of itinerant food venders. Throughout the
whole long evening sounded the long wail of the blind _masseurs_ who,
with their thumping bamboo sticks, tramp from door to door seeking
patronage. At intervals the single low tong of a great temple bell set
the hills to vibrating.

We rented the house from an Englishman who was “going home” on vacation,
and with it we rented a complete _ménage_, including a most efficient
little Japanese woman named Matsu who served us both as waitress and
housekeeper and answered to the call of “Amah!”—meaning either nurse or
maid. Besides the Amah, there was only a cook, an excellent one, but the
two contrived to run the house with a smoothness and an economy which I
have never seen equalled. They were so economical, in fact, that we had
difficulty in getting them to serve to us enough of their well-prepared
food. There were six of us in family, not including Charlie, or Baby San
as he was called, and at each meal Matsu would bring in just six
portions of whatever there was, six chops, six croquettes, six little
fishes, always six—no more. We resorted to strategy sometimes and
announced, well in advance, that there would be guests.

“How many, O Ku San?” says Matsu cautiously.

“Well, maybe two,” says we.

Whereupon we would get eight little chops, or eight little croquettes,
or whatever it might be. But we couldn’t play this game very often
because we were afraid that if too many guests failed to materialise the
time would come when we really would be giving a party and be forced to
act out the “Wolf! Wolf!” story to our own very great embarrassment. I’m
glad to say this never occurred; Matsu always obeyed orders; but when an
unexpected guest dropped in we had to exercise the principle of “family
hold back” in real earnest.

However, while Matsu was in command none of us had any cause for
complaint. She had plenty of native shrewdness and didn’t neglect her
own interests to any appreciable extent, but she displayed none of the
traditional oriental duplicity which we had been warned to look out for
in all Japanese servants. She relieved us of all the responsibilities of
housekeeping and left us free to wander around among the fascinating
shops and to go off on long sightseeing expeditions at our pleasure.

While we were still in the midst of the miseries of quarantine I got my
first letter from my husband, and as he had sailed away into what to me
then was a very far distant and somewhat unreal world, I was exceedingly
glad to hear from him.

The _Hancock_ had stopped at Kobe and had then gone on to Nagasaki where
it had to lie for two days taking on coal. The Commissioners seem to
have begun by that time to chafe at delays and to long for their
settled, definite employment. But they had to go to Hongkong on some
business matters and it was from Hongkong that my first long letter
came. They were received by the British authorities with the usual
formality; pompous calls to be returned as pompously; dinners,
luncheons, club privileges, launch parties and much entertaining gossip;
but they were interested, principally, in meeting for the first time the
genus Filipino irreconcilable.

The Filipinos, after three centuries of Christian education, which had
taken the form of religious instruction only, had, with reason, risen in
revolt against the Spanish system of friar domination and had demanded
some measure of freedom and a voice in the control of their own affairs.
This is a long and complicated story which can only be touched upon
here.

They were engaged in a hopeless struggle with Spanish authority when the
Spanish-American War, unexpected, undreamed of, suddenly turned the
tables and placed them in an entirely new situation. They saw Spain
defeated and turned from the islands she had held since Magellan’s first
voyage, while another flag quickly rose above their ancient forts and
strongholds. Then it was that the handful of ambitious “illustrados,” or
well-to-do and educated ones, began freely to preach independence and
were encouraged by not a few Americans, including some in official
relation to the situation, who, in complete ignorance of real
conditions, approved the so-called aspiration and gave hope of its early
fulfilment.

The idea of these Americans was that our forefathers had fought for
independence and that it was against our most cherished principles to
hold any people against their will. But they didn’t take into
consideration the fact that the Filipinos were Malays, not ten per cent.
of them with even a primary education, used only to a theocratic and
absolute government and without any experience in the rule of the
people. Nor did they consider that our forefathers had, for a century
and a half before the revolution, been carrying on what was really
self-government and were better fitted by training and tradition to make
self-government work than any people in the world. They indulged in
sentiment to the exclusion of thought; and so the situation was created.

The idea of complete independence was never shouted from the housetops
in Spanish times, but the new flag represented free speech, a free
press, and such freedom generally as the Filipinos had never dreamed of
in their wildest aspirations and the “illustrados” and the men who had
tasted power in the insurrection against Spain were not slow to take
advantage of it. An alluring conception of independence, freedom from
all restraint and the enjoyment of luxurious ease, really, was sent
abroad among the densely ignorant masses by the handful who had
education, with the result that by the time the American government was
free really to face the issue, the demand for our immediate withdrawal
was unanimous, or nearly so.

But it couldn’t be done. Aguinaldo tried his hand at a government for
six months and failed miserably. Corruption was rife. Chaos reigned; the
country was impoverished and absolutely unprotected; and it didn’t take
the Americans long to recognise the fact that “independence” meant
nothing more nor less than the merciless exploitation of the many by the
few and the establishment of worse conditions than any the people had
ever known.

So we stayed; there was nothing else to do; and the insurrection against
constituted authority was taken up where it left off when Admiral Dewey
steamed up Manila Bay. It was hopeless from the start, and one after
another of the leading _insurrectos_, as the months went by, abandoned
the struggle in favour of prosperous peace and came in to Manila to take
the oath of allegiance to the United States. But as pacification
progressed a few of the leaders declared themselves to be
“irreconcilable” and either took to the hills with marauding bands of
_ladrones_, or went over to Hongkong and joined the little Filipino
colony there. This colony in Hongkong—which still exists, by the way—was
known as the “junta” and its business in life was to hatch schemes for
murderous uprisings, smuggle arms and incendiary literature into the
islands, raise money for carrying on hostilities and make itself useful
generally.

The methods employed by these “irreconcilables” were peculiarly their
own. They consisted, mainly, of coercion and threats of assassination
among Filipino people who were staying at home and endeavouring to keep
out of trouble. Then, too, they were reported to have made a great deal
of money by compelling Filipino hemp and tobacco planters to sell to
them these valuable products at prices fixed by themselves, and later
disposing of them in Hongkong at the regular market price which gave
them a tremendous margin of profit.

These were the conditions—merely sketched—which existed in the
Philippine Islands when the second Commission was sent out, and the
first Filipinos Mr. Taft ever met, he met in Hongkong. They were not
members of the “junta” but were high-class, wealthy, non-combatant
refugees named Cortez, who lived under a threat of assassination, who
had had all their property confiscated because of their sympathy with
the insurrection against Spain, had secured restitution through the
government at Washington, and who came now to beg the Commission for
protection against their own people and for the speedy establishment of
peaceful American rule in the islands.

Then came Artacho. Artacho had been Aguinaldo’s rival in the
insurrection against Spain and he very much resented the selection, by
the Americans in command, of Aguinaldo as the leader of the Filipino
forces when Dewey went into Manila. He was sufficiently annoyed to leave
the country and take refuge in Hongkong. He professed entire ignorance
of the activities of the “junta” and unqualified loyalty to the
government of the United States, but, as he had with him a “secretary”
who very carefully listened to all he had to say, and as he seemed to be
very cautious in all his expressions, Mr. Taft decided that he was being
watched and was, if not actively connected with the “junta,” at least
“on the fence” and in his call only “casting an anchor to windward” in
case the Americans should succeed in pacifying the Islands and
establishing a government there with which it would be very nice indeed
to be connected. It must have been a very diplomatic, a very soft-spoken
and a most amusing meeting.

Among other things the Commission had to do in Hongkong was to secure
Chinese servants. They had been told that this was absolutely necessary
because the unsettled state of affairs in Manila made Filipino servants
entirely undependable.

Captain McCalla, of the _Newark_, had given to my husband in Yokohama, a
letter to one L. Charles, a Chinese who ran a sort of employment agency
in Hongkong, but when L. Charles came out to the _Hancock_, in response
to a message from Mr. Taft, he brought with him the surprising news that
the servants had already arrived from Shanghai and had been waiting for
several days. Mr. Taft was greatly astonished, as he was unconscious of
having made any arrangements at all, but L. Charles smilingly explained
to him that Admiral Dewey had attended to it. Then Mr. Taft remembered
that, sure enough, Admiral Dewey had, several months before in
Washington, offered to secure servants through his own Chinaman, Ah Man,
but he, himself, had forgotten all about it.

However, he sent for the men and when they came aboard one of them
proudly produced a note from the flag officer of the _Brooklyn_,
enclosing a note to Ah Sing, the steward of the _Brooklyn_, from Ah Man,
Admiral Dewey’s servant. It read:

  _My dear Ah Sing_:

  It is a new Governor-General coming up to Manila City. His name is Mr.
  Wm. H. Taft and he is going to sail from here first of April. The
  Admiral asked me to write to you and ask if you please find him some
  good Chinese servants for Mr. Taft. He like to have a very good cook
  just like myself the Admiral said and two men to wait on table a
  butler and second man just like you. Now would you be so kind as to
  try to find some very nice people that will take good care and will
  understand their business. The Admiral will be very much oblige to you
  I am

                                                     Your truly friend,
                                                                 AH MAN.

This is an example of what is known in the East as “flen-pidgin,” which
may be literally translated as “friend-work.” It is a Chinese system,
but it has been adopted by the representatives of every country in the
world to be met out there and it is by no means the least of the
elements which enter into the charm of the Orient.

One of the objects for stopping in Japan was to enable the Commissioners
to get white duck and linen clothes for the tropics and Mr. Taft had the
worst of luck in getting anything to fit him. In the beginning we had
some rather heated discussions as to the style of dress that he should
adopt. He had been assured that the most comfortably dressed men were
those who wore “straight button ups” as they are called. These are coats
which have a high, round collar and button straight down from the
chin—plain military jackets, in fact. They are worn without shirts,
collars, ties or anything except underwear and trousers and are, no
doubt, very nice for the tropic heat. But I did not consider that such a
severe style would bring out the lines of my husband’s figure to the
best advantage, so I prevailed upon him to have all his clothes made
with sack coats which should be worn with the usual accessories. It was
a sad experience in Yokohama, but he left for Hongkong full of hope,
having been told that the tailors there were much better. He wrote in
utter disgust. The tailors were not good; he had been to every shop in
town looking for wearing apparel of all kinds and could find nothing
large enough for him. He said he had imagined that Englishmen were, as a
rule, large enough to demand men’s sizes,—but evidently not. He had to
have everything, shoes, stockings, underwear, shirts, collars and hats
made to order—and then they didn’t fit.

My husband’s letter, full of strange names, of assassination, of
smuggled arms, of dark intrigue and unrest generally, left a vague
impression in my mind that he was going into a country where he would be
subjected to murderous attacks every few minutes. Then I reflected that
he was not quite alone; that General MacArthur and about seventy
thousand American troops were down there too, and that they could
probably be depended upon to do everything in their power to protect
him.

Our life in Yokohama was very placid. It was some time after our yellow
placards were removed before our neighbours began to call on us, and we
didn’t blame them. No doubt they felt that it would be foolish to risk
getting diphtheria just for the sake of being formally polite. We were
delightfully entertained, both before and after the Commission sailed,
by Mr. and Mrs. T. Williams McIvor, who are among the old American
residents of Yokohama. Mr. McIvor had been American Consul General, but
when we met him he was engaged in a private law practice, representing
the American Tobacco Company and other large foreign concerns. As Consul
General he had taken care of the Chinese during the Japan-China War and
had sent about eight thousand of them out of the country. He was now
representing the foreign business community in its dispute with the
Japanese government as to whether or not the property known as the
Foreign Concession, or The Settlement, was taxable. This area had been
granted by the Japanese government on perpetual lease at the time the
first treaties with Japan were made, and the holding of it by foreigners
was conditioned on the payment of a ground rent to the government which,
it was provided, should never be increased beyond a certain amount. But
now Japan was greatly in need of money, was taxing its own people in
every way possible, and eventually decided to levy a tax on the houses
and improvements upon this land, on the theory that improvements on land
are not a part of the land itself. But by the Civil Law and the Common
Law the provision in the treaties that no tax should be paid on the
property greater than that fixed in ground rent would have prevented the
levying of any tax on the buildings because, by such laws, improvements
are considered to be a part of the land. But in Japanese law it was said
they were not so regarded and the question was whether the treaties were
to be construed according to Japanese law or according to the laws of
foreign governments. The subject was one of endless discussion while we
were there, and Minister Buck had already referred the question to the
State Department at Washington.

We also dined with Mrs. Scidmore, whom I was to meet many times in after
years. Mrs. Scidmore is the mother of Eliza Ramaha Scidmore, the well
known writer about Far Eastern countries, and is, I suppose, the most
notable foreign figure in the Orient. She had lived in Japan since the
early days, not so long after the country’s doors were opened to the
world. Her son was in the Legation service when I met her and she had a
charming house on the Bund, in which was gathered a remarkable
collection of Japanese curios and objects of art. Mrs. Scidmore was then
nearly eighty years of age I think, but she was as bright and young as a
woman of fifty. The last time I saw her she was nearly ninety and she
entertained us at luncheon in Nagasaki, where her son was American
Consul. She dresses with as much care and is as interested in fashions
and fabrics as any girl, and it is a rare pleasure to see her, with her
snowy hair piled up on her head and a white silk gown spread out about
her, sitting in the centre of a group of people discussing, with great
animation and entire comprehension, general topics of current interest.
She afterward went to “keep house” for her son in Seoul, Korea, where he
became Consul General, and she continues to be a sort of uncrowned queen
of foreign society.

Leaving our children at the bungalow with their nurses, Mrs. Wright,
Maria and I went about, to Nikko, to Kamakura, to Kyoto and other
interesting places, and we spent the intervals, indeed all our time, in
restraining our intense desire to purchase everything we saw in the
extraordinarily attractive little shops.

About the last of July, when the heat began to be rather more than we
could stand, we left Yokohama and went up into the Hakone Mountains to
Miyanoshita. The trip to Miyanoshita includes a two hours’ climb in
’rickshas up a steep incline from a village on the railway, where there
was then no sort of accommodation for “Europeans,”—only Japanese inns
which, though they may have been excellent from a Japanese standpoint,
did not seem to us to have been built for inn purposes. When we got out
of the train it was seven o’clock in the evening. There were Mrs. Wright
and her maid, her daughter Katrina, my sister Maria, the three children,
Bessie the nurse, and I. We wanted dinner above all things else and we
decided to get it. It all had to be prepared “European style” at one of
the little inns, so by the time it was served and disposed of the night
was upon us, and, I may say, the blackest night I ever remember seeing.
We debated at length the possibility of taking the two hours’ ’ricksha
ride in such darkness, but the chattering coolies, mainly by gesture and
facial expression, succeeded in convincing us that it was the most
desirable thing in the world to do. Incidentally, and aside from our
objection to the bedless inns, we were most anxious to reach our
journey’s end. So—we set out, in eight ’rickshas, six for us and two
piled high with hand luggage. I put Helen and Robert together in one and
took Charlie in with me, and each of us had an extra man behind to push,
also two men each for the baggage ’rickshas, which made sixteen men in
all. We made quite a cavalcade and I felt fairly satisfied, not to say
mildly festive, until we got away from the lights of the town and
discovered, to our amazement, that for some reason or other, the
’ricksha men had failed to bring lights. I believe the idea was that
they could keep the road better without them. We went along for a short
distance in the Stygian darkness, then Maria decided that she wouldn’t
have it. Whatever we might do, she was going back for a lantern. We were
not in an argumentative mood, so we let her go without a word, while we
plunged on.

[Illustration:

  HELEN TAFT IN JAPANESE COSTUME
]

By that time the wind was tearing down through what seemed to be a very
deep, and what certainly was a very dark, canyon, and it was raining
steadily. My coolies lagged behind and the first thing I knew I found
myself entirely alone. The others had gone so far ahead that I couldn’t
even hear the sound of their ’ricksha wheels, though the ’ricksha of
those days was a very noisy little vehicle. I had been nearly two months
in Japan, had had plenty of experience with ’ricksha coolies and I knew
them to be the most inoffensive little men in the world, but the
darkness and the wind-driven rain and the discomfort generally, must
have got on my nerves because I began to be perfectly sure that my two
men were nothing less than brigands and that the separation from my
party was a prearranged plan for murder and robbery. I didn’t know how
wide the road was, but I knew that on one side there was a very deep
chasm because I could hear the roar of a mountain torrent far down and
directly below me. Then the coolies chattered and grunted incessantly,
as Japanese coolies always do, and I was convinced that they were
arguing about which should take the initiative in violence. But I sat
tight and said nothing, which was the only thing I could do, of
course—except to soothe Charlie who was crying with discomfort and
fright—and after awhile—ages it seemed to me—I came upon the rest of my
party where they had halted in the road to give their men a breathing
spell. I couldn’t see them; I couldn’t even make out the outlines of a
’ricksha, but I could hear Helen sobbing and stammering something about
having lost her mother for good and all.

The coolies were chattering at each other at a terrific rate and I
judged, from their tones, that they liked the night no better than we.
While we were standing close together in the road, all talking at once
and trying to tell each other what horrible experiences we had had, we
saw a faint glimmer away in the distance, growing more and more distinct
as it came up the long hill. It was the dauntless Maria with a light. We
fell upon her with the warmest welcome she probably ever received in her
life, and everybody at once cheered up. Even the coolies got happier and
seemed to chatter less angrily in the lantern’s dim but comforting
yellow glow. Nor did we separate again. Everybody wanted to keep close
to that light. It revealed to us the reassuring fact that the road was,
at least, wide enough for safety, and so we rolled soggily along, with
no other sound but the rattle of many wheels and the splash of mud,
until we arrived at the Fujiya Hotel, sometime after ten o’clock, in a
state of utter exhaustion.

I am not going to describe Miyanoshita because it has been very well
done by scores of writers, but I will say that the Fujiya Hotel, away up
in the mountains, at the head of a glorious canyon, is one of the most
splendidly situated, finely managed and wholly delightful places I ever
saw.

And there are plenty of things to do. We were carried in chairs over a
high mountain pass to Lake Hakone, which, still and bright as a
plate-glass mirror, lies right at the base of Fujiyama and reflects that
startlingly beautiful mountain in perfect colour and form.

Then there are temples and wayside shrines, and tea-houses—tea-houses
everywhere. We were coming back from a tramp one day and stopped at a
tea-house not far from our hotel where we encountered an Englishwoman
who gave us our first conception of what the terrible Boxer Insurrection
was like. She entered into talk with us at once and told us a most
tragic story. She was a missionary from the interior of China and had
been forced to flee before the Boxers and make her way out of the
country in hourly peril and through scenes of the utmost horror. Her
husband had elected to remain at his post and she didn’t then know but
that he might already have died under the worst imaginable torture. She
made our blood run cold and we were tremendously sorry for her, though
she did tell her harrowing story calmly enough. It seems she had with
her a young Chinese refugee who was a convert to Christianity and,
because of that fact, in even more danger in China than she.

We expressed our sympathy and good wishes and continued on our way. But
we hadn’t gone far when we heard a frantic shouting behind us:

“Have you seen my Chinaman! Have you seen my Chinaman anywhere on the
way!”

It was the missionary, distracted and running violently after us; and,
we had not seen her Chinaman. She rushed past and up into the woods
faster than one would have thought she could run, and all the time she
kept calling, “Joseph! Joseph!” at the top of her voice. We decided that
Joseph was the Chinaman’s new Christian name since we had heard that
they all get Biblical names at baptism. We hastened along, thinking she
might have gone suddenly mad and we wondered what in the world we should
do. But as we came around a bend in the road we saw her coming toward us
with a grinning little queued heathen marching meekly before her. She
was looking very much relieved and stopped to explain her rather
extraordinary conduct.

“I was perfectly certain that boy had committed suicide,” she began.

“Why, what made you think that?” I asked.

“Well, he wrote that, and I found it!” And she thrust into my hand a
piece of paper on which was scrawled in printed characters:

                 Just as I am, without one plea,
                 Save that Thy blood was shed for me,
                 And that Thou bid’st me come to Thee,
                 O Lamb of God, I come, I come.

She explained that Joseph had had a great deal of trouble; was away from
his people; that Chinamen didn’t care anything about their lives anyhow;
and that she had been afraid for some time that he would grow despondent
and do something desperate.

But there stood Joseph, broadly smiling and looking for all the world
like an oriental cherub who would have liked very much to know what all
the commotion was about. Poor chap, he didn’t understand a word of
English and had been merely trying to learn the words of an English hymn
by copying them, in carefully imitated letters, on bits of paper.

In the meantime my husband had arrived in Manila and had already sent me
several letters through which I came gradually to know something of the
situation he was facing.

The principal impression I received was that between the Commission and
the military government, in the person of General Arthur MacArthur,
there did not exist that harmony and agreement which was considered to
be essential to the amicable adjustment of Philippine affairs. In other
words, General MacArthur seemed to resent the advent of the Commission
and to be determined to place himself in opposition to every step which
was taken by them or contemplated. It was not very easy for the
Commissioners, but as far as I can see now, after a careful reading of
all the records, they exercised the most rigid diplomacy at times when
it would have been only human to have risen up and exercised whatever
may be diplomacy’s antithesis.

The description of the arrival of the Commission made me rather wish I
had accompanied them;—except for the heat. It was June and my husband
said the sun beat down upon and came right through the heavy canvas
awnings on the decks of the _Hancock_. The men had, by this time, become
accustomed to their ill-fitting white linens, but they had not yet
mastered the art of keeping them from looking messy, and they must have
been a wilted company during their first few days in Manila.

They came up into the harbour on Sunday and during the course of the day
received many interesting visitors. General MacArthur was not among
them, but he sent a member of his staff, Colonel Crowder, to present his
compliments and make arrangements for the going ashore ceremony the next
day. Then came the _Americanistas_, as the Filipinos who sympathised
with American control were called. These had been recognised by General
Otis before General MacArthur had arrived and many of them have always
been prominently associated with the American government in the Islands.
Among others were Chief Justice Arellano, Mr. Benito Legarda and Mr.
Pardo de Tavera. The Commissioners talked about the situation with these
gentlemen, through Mr. Arthur Fergusson, the Spanish Secretary of the
Commission, and found them not altogether despondent, but certainly not
optimistic about the outcome. They thought the Commissioners were facing
very grave problems indeed, if not insurmountable difficulties.

The next day—“just when the sun got the hottest,” wrote Mr. Taft—all the
launches in the harbour gathered around the _Hancock_, many whistles
blew, many flags and pennants fluttered, and the Commission was escorted
to the shore. They entered the city with great pomp and circumstance,
through files of artillerymen reaching all the way from the landing at
the mouth of the Pásig River, up a long driveway, across a wide moat,
through an old gateway in the city wall and up to the Palace of the
Ayuntamiento where General MacArthur, the Military Governor, had his
offices. But it was not a joyous welcome for all that. All the show was
merely perfunctory; a sort of system that had to be observed. Their
reception was so cool that Mr. Taft said he almost stopped perspiring.
There were few Filipinos to be seen, and as General MacArthur’s
reception to the Commission was anything but cordial or enthusiastic
they began to feel a discomforting sense of being decidedly not wanted.

If they had any doubts on this point General MacArthur soon cleared them
up. He frankly assured them that he regarded nothing that had ever
happened in his whole career as casting so much reflection on his
position and his ability as their appointment under the direction of the
President. They suggested that he could still rejoice in considerable
honour and prestige as a man at the head of a division of more troops
than any general had commanded since the Civil War and that he was,
moreover, still enjoying the great power of Chief Executive of the
Islands.

“Yes,” said he, “that would be all right if I hadn’t been exercising so
much more power than that before you came.”

Whereupon Mr. Taft gently reminded him that he had been exercising that
power for about three weeks only and said he hoped he had not become, in
that time, so habituated to the situation as to prevent his appreciating
the rather exalted position in which he would still be left. They
afterward exchanged some correspondence as to what powers each did have,
but they seemed to have disagreed from the first.

General MacArthur succeeded General Otis in command of the United States
Army in the Philippines and he had fallen heir to a policy with which he
was entirely out of sympathy. General Otis had scattered the troops in
small divisions and detachments all over the Islands, and General
MacArthur found himself in command of about seventy thousand men, but
with only a few regiments where he could lay his hands on them for
action in his own immediate vicinity. He believed that the only way to
get rid of the predatory bands and bring order out of a chaotic state,
was to concentrate the army on the island of Luzon where most of the
active _insurrectos_ operated. And he thought it would be many years
before the Filipinos would be ready for anything but the strictest
military government. But the trouble was that thousands of Filipinos all
over the Islands had already sworn fealty to the United States, or had
gone quietly back to work, and it was known that the lives of many of
these would not be worth a moment’s purchase if the protection of the
American troops was withdrawn from them. That was the situation.

The last engagement between real insurgents and American troops had
taken place in February before the Commission arrived. There had been
men of some ability and real patriotism in Aguinaldo’s cabinet and among
his followers at Malolos, but by this time the best of them had come in
and taken the oath of allegiance to the United States, others were in
prison slowly making up their minds as to whether they would or would
not follow this course, while still others had gone over to Hongkong to
join in the activities of the “junta.” Aguinaldo was still roaming
around the mountain fastnesses of Luzon, posing as a dictator and
issuing regular instructions to his lieutenants for the annihilation of
American regiments; but the insurrection had degenerated.

The companies of men who still kept the field did so, for the most part,
because they found that the easiest way to make a living. Money was
getting scarce and the people were steadily refusing to contribute to
the cause. A letter from one of Aguinaldo’s lieutenants was intercepted
in which he said that he had found a certain town obdurate and that he
thought it would be necessary to take four or five lives before the
people could be induced to give money. Murder and rapine, torture and
robbery; these were the methods employed, and very little of the money
realised ever found its way into the general revolutionary coffers. Most
of the remaining “patriots” had become _ladrones_ and were harrying
their own people much more than they were opposing the American forces.

These conditions led the Commission to think the time had come to
organise a native constabulary, under American officers, with which
thoroughly to police the Islands. But General MacArthur did not agree
with them; thought it would be folly to trust any Filipino with arms and
cited instances of where those who had been armed as scouts had proved
entirely untrustworthy. But the suggestion was received by many of his
own officers with the utmost approval and one man, in the Ilocos country
in northern Luzon, said he had only to issue a call and he could have
five thousand as loyal men as ever wore uniform enlisted in twenty-four
hours. I may say here that the Filipino people are divided into a number
of distinct tribes and that some of these never did take much, if any,
part in the insurrection. The insurrection is to-day referred to as the
Tagalog rebellion, the Tagalogs being one of the principal tribes,
though not the largest.

There had always been a great number, a majority in fact, of Filipinos
who did not like the awful conditions created by the insurrection and
who easily could be persuaded to an attitude of loyalty toward any
decent and peaceful government; and it was from this number that the
Commission wanted to recruit a native constabulary. But no. The
Commission would not begin to exercise such powers as it had until
September and in the meantime General MacArthur was absolute and in
answer to this proposition he merely reiterated his belief that the only
way to meet the situation was with additional American troops.

In my husband’s earliest letters he characterised the Filipino people
much as he did after years of experience with them. He wrote me that of
the six or seven millions of Christian Filipinos about two per cent.
were fairly well educated, while all the rest were ignorant, quiet,
polite people, ordinarily inoffensive and light-hearted, of an artistic
temperament, easily subject to immoral influences, quite superstitious
and inclined, under the direction of others, to great cruelty. He
thought them quite capable of becoming educated and that they could be
trained to self-government. He was inclined to think that they had,
because of their environment and experience under Spanish rule, capacity
for duplicity, but he did not think they had the Machiavellian natures
which people attributed to them. Some of those who call themselves
“_illustrados_”—the higher class—took to political intrigue with great
gusto.

Almost the first experience which the Commission had with Filipino
Machiavellian methods involved them in a complication which might have
proved quite serious. If there is one thing in the world that the
Filipino people, as one man, love, it is a _fiesta_. A _fiesta_ is a
holiday, a celebration with music, marching, many flags, best clothes
and plenty of high-flown speech-making. Now there was one Pedro A.
Paterno, an unctuous gentleman, who, while he had taken the oath of
allegiance and had fairly put himself in the pocket of American
authority, was still supposed to be more or less in sympathy with
Aguinaldo. He made himself the mediator between General MacArthur and
Aguinaldo and occasionally promised Aguinaldo’s surrender. Nobody ever
knew what he promised Aguinaldo, but it was known to a certainty that he
was “carrying water on both shoulders” and doing his best to keep in
well with both sides. He had played the same rôle in Spanish times. He
made what is known in history as “The Peace of Biacnabato,” between the
_insurrectos_ and the Spanish government, by the simple means of
“interpreting” to each the demands of the other in perfectly
satisfactory terms. He did all the translating, on both sides, himself
and the “Peace” was signed. Then before its irregularities were made
clear he asked of the Spanish government, as his reward, a dukedom and a
million dollars upon which to live up to the title. His letter to the
Spanish governor is still extant.

This gentleman one day, out of a clear sky, proposed what he called an
Amnesty Fiesta; a grand banquet in honour of General MacArthur to follow
a day of celebration and all-round relaxation from the strain of
hostilities. General MacArthur didn’t see that it would do any harm, but
said he would not attend the banquet in his honour and that all the
speeches that were to be made would have to be carefully censored. To
this Pedro readily agreed and went immediately to work to make elaborate
preparations for the occasion. He got a committee together and sent them
to wait on the Commission with an invitation to the banquet. Only three
of the Commissioners were in town, but these, after making careful
inquiry as to the nature of the entertainment and discovering that no
incendiary speech-making was to be allowed, decided to accept the
invitation. Paterno was in high feather and nothing but the _fiesta_ and
the _banquete_ was talked about for days. But gradually information
began to reach the ears of Mr. Taft that all was not as it should be. He
learned that arches were being erected across certain streets bearing
inscriptions that were insulting to the American flag. One arch, in
front of Malacañan Palace, where General MacArthur lived, had a picture
of President McKinley on one side and a picture of Aguinaldo on the
other, and it was said that General MacArthur had ridden under this arch
without noticing it. That would be taken for sanction by an ignorant
Filipino. But as soon as notice was called to them all the objectionable
features of the arches were removed and preparations went on. But
rumours kept coming in about the speeches until Mr. Taft became curious.
He went to General MacArthur and asked who was doing the censoring.

“Why, Pedro Paterno,” said the General; as much as to say, “What more
could you ask?”

Mr. Taft went back to the office and straightway set about to get copies
of those speeches. And, he got them. Some of them were already in type
at a local newspaper office and were to be printed in full the next
morning. This was the day of the _fiesta_ and it was proving a very
quiet affair. There was little enthusiasm on the streets, but there was
plenty of interest in the coming _banquete_. The Commissioners looked
over all the speeches and found them, without exception, seditious in
the extreme. So, of course, they could not go to the banquet. They could
not sit by and listen to misrepresentations without getting up
immediately and making vigorous denial and protest and they could not
lend the sanction of their presence to an entertainment that had been so
arranged. The _banquete_ was in General MacArthur’s honour and the
speeches glowingly promised everything short of immediate evacuation and
complete independence.

The Commissioners wrote a polite little note to Señor Paterno and said
they were very sorry to find that it was not possible, under the
circumstances, for them to be present that evening.

Mr. Taft and General Wright were living together in the house that my
husband had secured for us, and they went home and had a comfortable
dinner in their everyday white linens and were enjoying post-prandial
talk on the cool verandah when Pedro Paterno came rushing in and,
figuratively, threw himself on his knees before them. He begged them to
come with him to the _banquete_; the crowd had assembled; it was past
nine o’clock; and he would be placed in a terrible situation if the
gentlemen of the Commission did not reconsider their cruel decision. The
gentlemen of the Commission asked how about the carefully censored
speeches. Paterno vowed that no speeches at all should be delivered,
that no word of any kind should be said, but that they must show
themselves to the people, if only for a little while. All right. They
quickly got into their hot evening clothes and went down to the banquet
hall. They sat through a couple of silent, weary hours, took a few sips
of wine, smiled a few smiles, shook a few hands, and then went home.
That was all there was to it. But Pedro was discredited in both camps.
His purpose had been to have the speeches made before the Commissioners,
claim all the credit with his own people for getting the Commissioners
there and then to deny to the Commissioners all responsibility for the
occasion.

The forms of military government were being strictly observed; there was
a nine o’clock curfew and nobody was allowed on the street after that
hour without a pass. Mr. Taft wrote of several trying experiences when
he went out in the evening and forgot his pass and, starting home about
half past ten, was held up by one sentry after another who demanded an
explanation at the point of a gun.

Mr. Bryan was running for President at this time and he was making a
good deal of political capital out of the Philippine situation. He had
promised to call a special session of Congress, if he were elected, to
consider means for settling the Filipinos in immediate self-government,
and he had a large following of mistakenly altruistic anti-imperialists
supporting him. Mr. Taft was inclined to think that the whole
anti-American demonstration, which was to culminate in the Amnesty
Fiesta banquet, was planned by a Mr. Pratt, an American politician then
visiting Manila, who wanted the “grandly patriotic” speeches to publish
in American newspapers. They probably would have been perfect material
for the anti-imperialists to grow sentimental over.

In the meantime Mr. Bryan’s promises and the possibility of his being
placed in a position to redeem them, were retarding pacification. All
that was needed to discourage the last of the _insurrectos_ was Mr.
McKinley’s election, and the Presidential campaign of 1900 was probably
not watched anywhere with more breathless interest than it was in the
Philippine Islands.

Such were the lessons in letters that I got from my husband, and my
imagination was fired. He had great projects in hand. The Commission
proposed to establish municipal governments wherever conditions made it
possible and among the first things they undertook was the framing of a
municipal code upon which to base such governments. They sent this to
General MacArthur for his comments, but his comments consisted in a
rather pointed intimation that military rule was still in force and that
he thought they were several years ahead of possibilities, but that they
might go on and amuse themselves since their municipal code would not
deter him in any action he found it necessary to take at any point where
it was in operation. All this was couched in most excellent diplomatic
language, of course, but it amounted to just that. An equally diplomatic
reply seems to have brought the General to a realisation that the powers
of the Commission were well defined, that their object was peaceful
pacification wherever it was possible and that they would probably be
supported by Washington in any reasonable measures they might take to
that end.

They had many plans already; a big general school system for the
organisation of which they had engaged a superintendent from
Massachusetts; good roads to open up the country for commerce; harbour
improvements; health measures; a reliable judiciary; a mountain resort
where American soldiers and civilians might recuperate from tropic
disease, thereby saving many lives to say nothing of millions of dollars
to the government in troop transportation charges; and they were already
attacking the vexed friar question that had caused all the trouble in
the first place.

The letters made me anxious to finish my visit in Japan and get down to
Manila where so much of vital and engrossing interest was going on. My
husband wrote rather discouragingly about the house he had taken, but he
was having some improvements made and, though I did not expect to find
comfort, I was sure I should manage to get along. I had purchased in
Japan a number of bright and artistic objects in the way of house
decorations and I thought that, with these, I should be able to make
almost any place look inviting.

The Boxer rebellion was troubling us more than anything else at the
moment. We wanted very much to go to Shanghai, but were told that it
would be absolutely unsafe for us to go anywhere in China except to
Hongkong. I didn’t know much about the East at that time and was ready
to believe anything that was told me. However, I remembered that there
were thousands of foreign residents in Shanghai who were going on about
their daily affairs much as if there were no such thing as a Boxer. So
we, too, decided to go on our usual tranquil way and we set sail for
Manila, via Shanghai and Hongkong, on the Japanese steamer, _Kasuga
Maru_, on the tenth day of August.

[Illustration:

  MRS. TAFT IN FORMAL FILIPINA COSTUME
]



                               CHAPTER V
                      FIRST IMPRESSIONS OF MANILA


The China Sea has an evil reputation. On its shores one hears much about
the typhoon season and the changing monsoons, and bad sailors would, no
doubt, like to have their sailing dates determined by the Weather
Bureau; but this is not always possible.

The _Kasuga Maru_, on which we made the voyage from Yokohama to Manila,
lay in Hongkong Harbour while one of the great mid-August storms tore up
from the south and set skippers and seamen agog with fears of dreadful
conditions we would have to meet on the trip across to Manila. In the
China Sea there are cross-currents which make for bad going at the best
of times, and when they are piled up by a typhoon into great, warring
waves the result is likely to be extraordinary.

My husband cabled me to take a larger vessel, a United States army
transport which left Hongkong about the same time we did, but I was
comfortably located with my family on the little _Kasuga Maru_; the
transfer of baggage was a troublesome task; and I figured that as long
as the _Kasuga Maru_ had been afloat in south seas for a good many
years, she might be trusted to keep afloat for a few days longer.

We caught the calm between two storms. The sea had been beaten down by
torrential rains; and while great, smooth waves rose under us and sent
us rolling in a sickening zigzag all the way across, there was in them
no threat of destruction, and I really began to feel that the China Sea
had been maligned.

A feeling of intense curiosity got me out of my stateroom bright and
early on the morning of our arrival in Manila.

To the northward lay a stretch of unbroken, mountainous shoreline; while
we were headed for a narrow channel guarded by rock islands against
which the surf broke in clouds of spray.

“Corregidor,” said the skipper, pointing to a high, green hill behind
the rocks. Corregidor,—it was the first time I had ever heard the name
which since has become synonymous, in so many minds, with Gibraltar. On
the other side of the entrance to Manila Bay stood Meriveles, a
beautiful mountain, sloping gently back from the sea and up into soft,
white clouds. But Manila,—where was Manila? Cavite,—where was Cavite?
And where did the Spanish ships lie, when Dewey sailed in past
Corregidor not knowing what he would find? Questions, these, which
everybody asked in those days. Manila was twenty miles ahead at the far
end of the Bay, while Cavite, across on the south shore, in the nearer
distance, lay flat and almost invisible under low-spreading trees.

Flat; that is the word which occurs to everybody who sails for the first
time into Manila Bay. The city is built on the lowlands; low, as I
afterward learned, to the point of being below sea-level in certain
places, and subject to sudden floods in the big typhoons. But far behind
the flats are towering ranges of blue and purple hills, with here and
there a softly rounded mountain standing, seemingly, alone.

The hot sun beat down on the glassy surface of the Bay and sent back a
blinding glare which brought an ache into eyes and nerves, but we were
all too interested to seek shelter in the darkened cabin.

While our ship was still miles from shore we could see long lines of
low, red roofs and the white gleam of many domes and spires; and off to
the right we had pointed out to us the eloquent wrecks of some of the
Spanish fleet whose masts and battered hulks rose high out of the
shallow water in which they were sunk.

But for ourselves, for me, for Mrs. Wright, for Maria and the children,
the most important thing in sight was a little fleet of harbour launches
which came hurrying down the Bay to meet us. I saw my husband and
General Wright standing in the bow of one of these long before they
could pick us out in the crowd of passengers lining the rails of the
_Kasuga Maru_.

Then came the happy welcomings which make absences worth while; excited
children; everybody talking at once; explanations begun and never
finished; interruptions by customs officials—American soldiers in those
days; comments on the heat and the bright white light, and laughing
assurances that it wasn’t hot at all and that the climate was perfect;
transferring baggage to the launch; glimpsing, occasionally, strange
scenes and strange peoples; asking and answering a thousand questions;
busy, bustling, delightfully confusing hours of landing in the farthest
orient.

Our husbands turned themselves into willing “Baedekers” and instructed
us on the way. We steamed up in our little launch to the mouth of the
Pásig River, wide and deep and swift, and covered with what looked to me
like millions of small, green cabbages.

“Carabao lettuce; the river’s full of it,” explained Mr. Taft, but I was
much too occupied just then to stop and ask what “carabao lettuce” might
be.

We came up past a bristling fort at the corner of a great, grey,
many-bastioned and mediæval wall which stretched as far as I could see
down the bay shore on one side and up the river on the other.

“The Old Walled City,” said General Wright, and I knew at once that I
should love the old Walled City.

“The oldest parts of the walls were built in the seventeenth century,”
continued our animated guide-book, “and the fort on the corner is
Santiago. The big dome is the Cathedral and all the red tile roofs are
convents and monasteries. The twentieth century hasn’t reached here yet.
To all intents and purposes the Walled City is still in the Middle
Ages.” The truth is that only part of the walls are really very old—some
parts have been built within seventy years.

The river was full of strange craft; long, high prowed, cumbersome
looking boats, with rounded deck-houses roofed with straw matting and
painted in every conceivable colour and pattern, which, we were told,
were _cascoes_—cargo boats which ply the length of the Pásig and bring
down the cocoanuts and sugar-cane and other products from the middle
provinces. The only visible propelling power on these _cascoes_—and the
only power they have—are natives, naked to the waist, armed with long
bamboo poles upon which, having fixed them firmly in the mud at the
bottom of the river, they push steadily as they walk the length of the
narrow running board along the outer edge of the deck. I should say they
might make a mile in about two hours.

Then there were the curious little _bancas_; narrow canoes, hewn out of
single logs and kept on an even keel, usually, by graceful outriggers of
bamboo.

Across the river from the Walled City is the Custom House, and there, in
a few moments, we drew up at a slippery, low, stone landing and climbed
ashore. My feet, at last, were on Philippine soil.

If I had, for the time being, forgotten that a war was going on I was
immediately reminded of it. The Custom House was in the hands of the
Military Government and it was surrounded by khaki-clad guards who all
stood stiffly at attention as my husband and General Wright passed. All
our necessary luggage had been released and put into the hands of
orderlies to be delivered, so we were free to start at once for home.

My husband had written me that the Philippine horses and the Philippine
cockroaches were just about the same size, but I was hardly prepared for
the diminutive turn-out to which he proudly escorted me. Two little
brown ponies, no higher than my shoulder, and with very shaggy manes and
foretops, were hitched to a Victoria which had been built to fit them.
When I stepped in and sat down, with Charlie on my lap, I felt twice my
natural size and it seemed impossible to me that there was still ample
room for Mr. Taft.

On the box were two stolid little men, dignified by the titles of
coachman and footman. They each wore white linen trousers and thin
shirts which hung outside, making them look as if they had forgotten a
most important act in the process of dressing. Their bare feet were
thrust into heelless red carpet-slippers, while on their heads were
wide, flopping, shapeless straw hats which they did not trouble to take
off at our approach.

The streets were full of such conveyances as ours, and others of
varieties even more astonishing. Maria, with Robert and Helen, followed
in a _quilez_—a miniature, one-horse omnibus affair into which the
passengers climbed from the rear. Then there were _calesas_,
_caromatas_, _carretelas_ and carabao carts.

The carabao carts interested me particularly, and there seemed to be
more of them than of anything else. The cart itself was nothing,—just a
few planks nailed together and balanced upon a pair of heavy, broad,
wooden wheels,—but the beast attached to it was really extraordinary.
The first carabao I saw had horns at least six feet across. Indeed, they
all have very long horns, and how they keep from obstructing traffic in
the narrow streets I never did understand. They do obstruct traffic, as
matter of fact, but not with their horns; only with their slow motions.
Nobody can possibly know just what the word slow signifies until he has
seen a carabao move. Great, grey, thick-skinned, hairless beast; his
hide is always caked with mud, and he chews and walks at exactly the
same pace while the half-naked, sleepy driver on the cart behind him
gives an occasional jerk on the thin rope attached to the ring in his
nose.

It was sometime before I came to know _calesas_, _caromatas_ and
_carretelas_ apart, though their only likeness lies in the fact that
each has two wheels and to each is attached one busy little bit of a
horse. The _calesa_ and _caromata_ are the better class vehicles, while
the _carretela_ is a plebeian public carryall in which there always
seems to be “room for one more.” I saw dozens of these packed with
Filipinos; the driver—always and inevitably smoking—sitting close up
behind his horse and lashing it continually while it struggled sturdily
along and looked every minute as if it would be lifted off its feet by
the overbalancing weight behind it. It was something of a shock to see
many women, in _carretelas_ and on the street, smoking huge black
cigars; while I noticed, immediately, that the men, as a rule, smoke
only cigarettes.

I didn’t look for speed from our little brown creatures, but I was yet
to become acquainted with the Philippine pony. We started off over the
rough cobblestones at a pace that was truly terrifying, and everybody
else seemed to be going at about the same rate. I expected a collision
every moment. Wheels passed wheels without an inch to spare, and without
an instant’s slackening of speed. My heart was in my mouth until we got
through the maze of narrow streets in the wholesale district near the
Custom House and came out into a wide plaza which my husband informed me
was the end of the Escolta, the principal business street of the city. I
was very glad we didn’t have to drive through that; it was just about
wide enough for two carriages to pass, but it had a street-car track
right down the middle, and it was thronged. On the track was a jingling
little horse-car which seemed to get very much tangled up with the rest
of the traffic.

I got an impression of a great variety of colour in which red and yellow
seemed to predominate. The soldiers were in khaki, the officers and
civilians were in immaculate white linen, while the Filipino men and
women of the ordinary class looked as if they had made a heavy draft on
the world’s supply of red and yellow muslin, to say nothing of many
calicoes of extravagant hues and patterns.

We hurried on around the corner and came again to the banks of the river
and the Bridge of Spain. Mr. Taft wanted me to know all about everything
right away, so he kept on busily explaining things to me, but using so
many unfamiliar words that I got only a hazy impression after all.

But here was the Bridge of Spain, originally built in sixteen hundred
and something, the oldest monument to Spanish enterprise in the Islands.
And across on the other side we came abreast of the inner wall of the
city and whirled along awhile beside a wide, stagnant moat. From the
inner side I got a better idea of what the Walled City was like, and I
promised myself an early inspection of its mysteries. I wanted to walk
across the old drawbridges and through the beautiful gateways which
looked so ancient and were so suggestive of piratical and warlike
history.

“Those are the Botanical Gardens,” said Mr. Taft—“the man from
Cook’s”—making a general sort of gesture toward the other side of the
street. What I saw was a small gravelled park with some avenues of fine
palms, some other kinds of trees, and a few clumps of shrubbery. We were
driving under the low-hanging branches of some magnificent old acacias,
but everything looked neglected and run down, and there didn’t seem to
be a bit of grass anywhere; just scorching sand and clay. It was really
a relief to rest one’s eyes on the awful green scum on the surface of
the moat. Manila in those days was not the beautiful, park-like,
well-kept city that it has since become. There were soldiers everywhere,
and it seemed to me we were being constantly saluted.

“And now we come to the far-famed Luneta,” said Mr. Taft, quite proudly.

“Where?” I asked. I had heard much of the Luneta and expected it to be a
beautiful spot.

“Why, here. You’re on it now,” he replied.

An oval drive, with a bandstand inside at either end,—not unlike a
half-mile race track,—in an open space on the bay shore; glaringly open.
Not a tree; not a sprig of anything except a few patches of unhappy
looking grass. There were a few dusty benches around the bandstands,
nothing else;—and all burning in the white glare of the noonday sun.

“Why far-famed?” I asked.

Then he explained in a way which made me understand that the Luneta is
not what it is, but rather what it stands for in the life of the
community. He said that in the cool of the evening there were bands in
the bandstands and that everybody in the world came and drove around and
around the oval, exchanging greetings and gossip, while the children
with their nurses played in the sand on the narrow beach. It didn’t
sound exciting to me, but I was afterward to learn that the Luneta is a
unique and very delightful institution.

We tore on at a terrific rate and came, at last, into a narrow residence
street where the rapid clatter of our ponies’ feet awoke echoes from
closely set houses which looked as if all their inhabitants were asleep.
And they were, of course, it being the _siesta_ hour.

[Illustration:

  A CARVED _NARA_ OR PHILIPPINE MAHOGANY BED NOW IN MR. TAFT’S ROOM AT
    NEW HAVEN
]

The houses were nearly all built in the Spanish style with high stone
basements—covered with mouldy whitewash—and frame superstructures
overhanging the street, and screened from the heat and glare with finely
woven, green bamboo curtains. Here and there the “nipa shack” of the low
class native had elbowed its way into this fashionable neighbourhood,
and through open spaces I caught glimpses of wide stretches of thatch
roofs in the near distance, where hundreds of these inflammable huts
were huddled together in “native quarters.”

When the end of the street came in sight I began to wonder. It seemed to
me we had driven many miles.

“Well, where do we live?” I asked. “Have you taken a house in the
country?”

“Not quite,” said Mr. Taft, “but nearly.”

It was the last house in the street, surrounded by a very formidable
looking, high stone wall. The first thing I knew we had whirled through
a gateway and were driving past a row of soldiers who stood at
attention, with their guns held stiffly in front of them. I knew our
house had to be guarded, but it was something of a shock for a moment,
just the same, to see the guardhouse and the trim soldiers with their
business-like equipment.

If I had expected anything very fine or beautiful in the way of a
tropical garden, I was disappointed. I don’t know whether I did or not.
The wonder to me now is how Americans ever did succeed in getting parks
and gardens made. It only means that the Filipino has learned, or is
learning how to work. He always was willing to work, a certain amount,
but he didn’t know how. My husband’s description of how he got a bit of
grading done is typical. The first conclusion he reached in Manila was
that the people knew nothing about the value of time, and it must have
been a strain on his temperate-zone nervous system to watch a squad of
men at work in his garden.

They deposited the material—as usual—as far as they could from the spot
where it was to be used; then, one after another, barelegged, bare
bodied, incessantly smoking, they would take up small shovels full of
earth, carry them all the way across the garden, resting once or twice
on the way, dump the material somewhere in the vicinity of the place
where it belonged, then drag slowly back and repeat the operation. This
was the sort of thing which made Americans, in the early days, dance
with impatience; the sort of thing which made Mr. Bryan’s campaign talk
about “cheap” Filipino labour invading the United States seem to us so
utterly ridiculous. We knew that Filipino labour was the most expensive
labour in the world; since it took ten men to do one American’s work.

My husband had written me about the difficulty he had had in securing a
suitable house, and had also explained that he was having a number of
repairs and changes made which, he hoped, would put the place in good
order by the time I arrived. The garden was large, but it boasted
neither lawns nor flowers of any kind. A few patches of grass struggling
with the hard white gravel and clay, and looking pretty hopeless,
nothing else. Around a curving drive we swung up under a porte-cochère,
over which hung a magnificent rubber tree, and, stepping from the
undersized Victoria onto the finest of white marble steps, I found
myself at home.

Our house was really the best that my husband could secure. When he
first looked at it he was certain it wouldn’t do at all. It belonged to
Chief Justice Arellano, and the army officer who went with him to look
for quarters assured him that it was the only thing in town that he
could possibly live in; but he didn’t believe it. It had been occupied
by army officers and had been greatly abused. Its furniture was broken
and piled in heaps; its walls were ragged; and its floors were scarred
and dirty.

“I’ll just have a look at some others,” said Mr. Taft.

And he did. He went all over town, and he says that every house he
looked at added some new, desirable aspect to the Arellano house, until,
finally, it became in his eyes a sort of palace which needed only a
touch here and there to make it quite perfect.

It backed directly on the Bay, and among the first things he did was to
have a sea-wall built which he thought added safety to the top-heavy
structure, but which, during the typhoon season, really cost him more
than it was worth. Every time a big wind came and roughed up the Bay a
little, a part of his wall went out. His first complaint to me was that
he had been “holding that wall down” all summer, and that part of it was
always sure to try to get away every time he found himself particularly
occupied with harassing governmental difficulties.

He had had sod laid down between the house and the sea-wall, and had
watched it for awhile with a faith which should have been rewarded, but
the salt spray came dashing over it and he had to have it carefully
taken up and moved around to the sheltered side of the house. Good sod
was scarce in Manila in those days.

My husband was certainly glad to see me, and I don’t doubt that General
Wright was just as glad to see his wife. The two of them had been
“keeping house” together for three months under conditions wholly new to
them, and I gathered that they found a bachelor existence rather
complicated and, in certain details, annoying. In some ways, after the
manner of men, they had permitted the house to run itself and I did not
find it easy to break up the system which had been inaugurated.

The house was not perfect, by any means, but it was big and roomy and
had what a woman knows as “great possibilities”; possibilities which I
found had to be slowly developed with the assistance of a somewhat
taciturn and not altogether willing _ménage_.

Coming in from the grand marble steps one passed up a short, but
spacious hardwood stairway into a wide central hall which opened out on
a tile floored verandah, overlooking the Bay and running the entire
width of the house. This verandah was enclosed by sliding windows
divided into panes about six inches square, not any two of which were
the same colour. All the other windows in the house were made of
beautiful, translucent pearl-shell in four inch sections—more like
screens than windows—which let in the light and kept out the glare, but
on the verandah the architect had tried to surpass himself, with the
result that royal purple, orange, pink, bright blue and green glass
disclosed to one a multicoloured and distracting stretch of otherwise
beautiful bay. The hard white light was a thousand times more bearable
than such a kaleidoscope, and after I got home those windows were seldom
closed.

On either side of the broad central hall were two large rooms; one the
dining-room, the others commodious bedrooms; while over the
porte-cochère was a small drawing room. Downstairs were the baths and
three large rooms and a duplicate of the upstairs verandah. This part of
the house, which was dry and well built, I forthwith turned over to the
children.

Some of the furniture was very fine; big hardwood tables and old Spanish
pieces made from the beautiful woods of the Islands, but everything was
greatly in need of the polisher’s brush and chamois. The floors,
alternating, broad, hand hewn planks of _nara_ and _ipil_, were as fine
as any I ever saw, though they, too, needed long and painstaking
attention. In the bedrooms were high canopied and mosquito-netted beds
with cane bottoms, exactly like cane-bottomed chairs, and without
mattresses. Everything else was wicker.

The thing which caught my attention first, however, were the fans. My
husband had written me, with great pride and satisfaction, that he had
put in electric fans, and that they had “saved his life.” I had some
sentimental attachment for them on this account—until I saw them. But
when I saw them I felt at once that everything else, to be in keeping,
ought surely to be swathed in fly-specked pink gauze. The electric fans
were of the variety associated in one’s mind with ice-cream “parlours”;
two broad blades attached to the ceiling in the middle of the room. They
had been installed in both the dining-room and _sala_—or
sitting-room—and it was not possible in either room to see anything
else. These fans were the subject of endless contention between Mr. Taft
and me, but I gave in and left them to continue their mission of saving
his life. He says yet that I often acknowledged on hot nights that he
was right about them, but I never did.

My husband had secured his house staff in Hongkong, through the kind
offices of Admiral Dewey’s servant, Ah Man, as I have already written,
but being new to the ways of the Oriental, he was destined very quickly
to gather some unique experience. There were four of them: the cook, the
number one boy, the number two boy and the laundryman. The laundryman
was Mr. Taft’s own inspiration. The Filipino laundryman, he had heard,
takes the linen of his master’s household down to some stream,
preferably the shallows of the Pásig, and hammers it into ribbons on
smooth rocks which he uses for washboard purposes. Then he spreads the
articles on the grass to dry, and the consequences were found, not
infrequently, to be a bad outbreak on the master’s skin of what is known
as “adobe itch,” a troublesome disease. So Mr. Taft had engaged a
Chinese laundryman and had sent back to San Francisco for tubs and
washboards and wringers and all the necessary paraphernalia, and had
installed an up-to-date laundry in his own house, where the orders were
to boil the clothes and hang them on a line. It worked perfectly, though
it did take the Chinaman from the wilds of Shanghai some time to learn
the uses of the various modern implements.

In Manila the marketing is usually done by the cook, but in our
household this duty was delegated to the number one boy. One day the
cook and the number two boy came to Mr. Taft with the announcement that
they could not remain in the house with number one boy; that number one
boy was a thief; that he smoked opium all the time he was supposed to be
marketing; and that he was a bad Chinaman generally. Mr. Taft had always
given number one boy the money with which to pay the other boys’
salaries and the cash market charges, so he said to the cook:

“Has number one always paid your wages?”

“Yes,” said the cook, with an eloquent shrug of his shoulders, “just my
wages and nothing more.”

This meant, of course, that number one boy was committing the
unforgivable sin of not dividing the “squeeze.”

There is no use going into what “squeeze” means in the Orient. It may
come partly out of the master’s pocket and partly out of the pockets of
the tradesmen; nobody knows. But the housekeeper soon learns that she
gains nothing by trying to circumvent the system in doing the marketing
herself. The “squeeze” works, no matter who does the buying, and it soon
comes to be recognised as a legitimate part of household expenses. The
only thing that one can do is to make a complaint when it becomes too
heavy.

It seems to have been very heavy in my husband’s establishment, and
investigation proved to him that it was necessary to let number one go,
so when I arrived there were just the two upstairs servants, the cook
and number two, who had been promoted to the proud position of number
one.

[Illustration:

  A TYPICAL PHILIPPINE RIVER SCENE AND SOME FILIPINO LAUNDRY WORK
]

I went immediately to work to order my household as I always had been
used to doing, and there’s where I began to get my experience of the
Oriental character. My cook was a wrinkled old Chinaman who looked as if
he had concealed behind his beady little eyes a full knowledge of all
the mysteries of the East, to say nothing of its vague philosophies and
opium visions. He called me “Missy” and was most polite, but in all the
essentials he was a graven image. He was an unusually good cook, though
he did exactly as he pleased, and seemed to look upon my feeble efforts
at the direction of affairs with a tolerant sort of indifference. He
would listen to my instructions most respectfully, carefully repeat
after me the nice menus I devised, say, “yes, Missy,” then return to his
kitchen and cook whatever suited his fancy.

It took me sometime to get used to this, but I came to value him highly,
especially when I learned that he had, finely developed, one glorious
characteristic of his kind. He could make something out of nothing. If
Mr. Taft sent word at six o’clock, or even as late as seven, that he had
invited four or five of his associates to dinner to continue a
discussion begun earlier in the day, or for some other reason, I had
only to tell Ah Sing that there would be seven or eight instead of three
at dinner, and a perfect dinner would be served. Where he got his
supplies with which to meet these sudden demands I never knew. I learned
to accept the gifts of the gods without comment, which is the only thing
to do in the East.

Ah Sing was particularly proud of his sweets. He loved to make puddings
and pies with lavish decorations upon them, though none of the family
cared much for such delicacies. One evening, shortly after my arrival, I
was giving quite a formal dinner party; I had, as usual, given the cook
a menu well thought out and, I believed, wholly appropriate to the
occasion and the climate. For a sweet I had ordered an ice with some
small cakes, and I was pleasantly surprised to see them duly served. But
just as the party was about to rise from the table and go out on the
verandah for coffee, in came Mr. Number One Boy with a ponderous,
steaming bread-pudding, all covered with coloured ornaments, which he
smilingly displayed for the benefit of the astonished party. It had to
be served, of course, and I felt that my explanations regarding Ah
Sing’s eccentricities didn’t make much of an impression.

Over none of the servants did I exercise the control I thought to be
necessary, but this was due to the fact that for three months they had
been obeying the master; the master had paid them their wages, and to
the master they looked for all orders. It took me sometime to discover
this, but when I did I began to handle household accounts without
assistance.

It was about the end of the typhoon season and the predictions were that
there would be no more heavy storms. But it began to rain and blow one
day with rather more force than I had ever seen before, and I was told
that we were in the midst of a typhoon. “Oh, well,” I thought, “if this
is all I don’t see why there is so much talk about it.” It was just a
very hard and very persistent storm. When I began to think it was about
time for it to have blown itself out I was awakened one night by what
seemed to me to be the bombardment of heavy artillery. My bed was
shaking under me, the house was swaying, and the noise was terrifying. I
jumped up with an instant idea of _insurrectos_, and a feeling that I
must meet the situation on my feet; then I realised, at once, that it
was the typhoon. It was as if all the winds that had blown for two days
had gathered themselves together and were hurling themselves in one
blast upon us. I reached for the electric switch, but there were no
lights; I turned the button time and again; nothing happened. I fumbled
for matches all over my room and could find none. My nerves were just at
the crying out point when my door was thrown open and in rushed Maria,
holding aloft a glimmering candle.

She was shaking with fright.

“Nellie,” she exclaimed, “I just can’t stand it any longer! Do let’s
find everything there is to light and call Will and sit out in the
_sala_. Heaven only knows what’s going to happen!”

We searched around and found some more candles; then I went to call my
husband. He was sleeping as soundly as if nothing at all were happening.
I shook him and called him and shook him again. I thought he never would
wake up, but finally he did, and just then I heard the crash of a tree
blowing down in the garden, while the floor seemed to heave under my
feet.

“What’s the matter?” asked my sleepy husband.

“Will, there’s an awful storm. Please come out in the _sala_ and sit
with Maria and me.”

“All right,” he said, and slowly got himself into an all-enveloping
dressing gown.

We huddled ourselves in chairs in the big hallway and sat listening.
Rain always comes with the wind in typhoons and the dash of water
against the windows and the sides of the house was deafening. But the
noise was suddenly punctuated by a gentle snore. Mr. Taft had settled
himself back in his chair and gone quietly to sleep. Maria’s nerves were
on edge; without a word she jumped up and shook her tired-out
brother-in-law most vigorously, crying above the roar of the storm:

“Will Taft, what do you think we waked you up for? You can’t go back to
sleep. We want you to stay awake and comfort us!”

“All right, Maria,” said he, with the utmost good nature; whereupon he
sat up, changed his position to one more comfortable, and proceeded to
lapse again into peaceful slumber.

The next morning Maria and I drove down through the town to see the
effects of the typhoon. Three trees were uprooted in our own garden, and
across the street a house was flattened out. Groups of Filipinos stood
here and there talking and gesticulating in their usual manner, but
nobody seemed unduly excited. We saw many houses unroofed, and once in a
while we met a native with a piece of nipa or tin roofing balanced on
his head, quietly carrying it back where it belonged.

We drove down through the Escolta and into the crowded Tondo district
beyond, and there we suddenly found ourselves hub-deep in a flood. The
below-the-sea-level quarters were under several feet of water, and we
got a sudden revelation as to why all the nipa houses are built on such
high and unsightly stilts. Crowds of Filipinos were paddling through the
flood, most of them carrying some part of a house, or other belonging,
and nearly all of them playing and splashing like pleased children.
_Bancas_—long canoes from the river—were plying from house to house as
if it were an everyday affair and conditions were quite normal.

I had heard a great deal about the severity of typhoons, but as I had
passed a whole season in the East and had crossed the China Sea during
the typhoon season without encountering one, I began rather to scoff at
the general fear of them. But I never did after that; when anybody said
typhoon I knew exactly what it meant. The water subsided rapidly and in
a day or two Manila showed few signs of the fury which had passed, but
for several days the Commission continued to receive reports pf the
damage done and the lives lost throughout the surrounding country. It
was the worst and the last storm of that year.

When we arrived in Manila we found the social atmosphere somewhat
peculiar. Members of our own party, who had crossed the Pacific on the
_Hancock_, welcomed us at once with dinners and teas and other kinds of
parties; also a number of Army ladies called without delay, and our
circle broadened rapidly. But General MacArthur, who was the Military
Governor and lived at Malacañan Palace, did not entertain anybody except
a select military circle. He sent an aide with cards, of course, and he
accepted our invitations to dinner, but that was all. Not that we
minded, except that it made it rather awkward and added something to the
“feeling” that all was not well between the Army and the new civil
government.

The Commission had been for three months busily engaged in investigating
conditions, as directed by the President, before they assumed any
authority, and then they acted with no haste. We were impatiently
awaiting news from America with regard to the Presidential election. It
was thought to be futile to take any definite steps toward the
establishment of local governments and the inauguration of far-reaching
reforms until the status of American control should be settled. Mr.
Bryan had promised political independence, and if Mr. Bryan were elected
all the Commission’s plans would go for naught.

The provincial and municipal codes were completed; certain important
questions between the Church and the people were being considered, and
many open sessions were held for discussion, with the purpose of
advising the people that they would be listened to by a civil
government. In the meantime the _insurrectos_ were keeping things lively
in a guerilla warfare with small squads of greatly harassed and very
much disgusted American soldiers. There were occasional rumours about
uprisings in Manila—when the guard at our gate would be doubled—but Mr.
Taft assured us that Manila was as safe as New York or Chicago and we
really had few fears.

General MacArthur continued to resent the coming of the Commission and
to consider himself personally humiliated by their being appointed to
divide his power. He was still in command of about seventy thousand men
and had the general executive control of a large civil force, but this,
apparently, was not enough. The tone he adopted in his correspondence
with the Commission kept them in a constant state of controlled anger.
They were very careful in return to observe every courtesy and to
manifest an earnest desire for harmony and co-operation. They were
tremendously interested in their problems and wanted much to succeed,
but their efforts at conciliation did little good. The General objected
to almost every suggestion put forward by them and did not hesitate to
tell them in plain words that he did not welcome advice from them
concerning military or any other matters. It was really a very difficult
situation.

The Commission thought General MacArthur took an entirely erroneous view
of the attitude of the Philippine people in general, and that in
everything he did he moved with an exasperating slowness. They wanted a
large native constabulary which they knew could successfully be
organised and relied upon to render great assistance in the pacification
of the Islands. He did not agree with them and held the matter up for
many months. He was not in sympathy with any move they made, and his
greatest cross was that he had no power to veto their legislation. He
saw military dangers in all manner of things without being able to state
just what they were, and he was always calling for more troops, while
the Commission was entertaining hopes that it would not be a great
length of time before a large part of the troops already there could be
recalled. I find my husband writing at this time:

“General MacArthur, knowing that we differ from him as to the condition
of things in the Islands, makes it a point to send me an account of each
disaster as if it vindicated his view. This is not the spirit of a man
who is likely to succeed in giving energy to a campaign which will bring
about successful results, but the matters will solve themselves in spite
of his slowness of movement and lack of enthusiasm....

“The minute the policy with respect to these Islands is settled by
Bryan’s defeat and the election of McKinley, the leniency which has been
almost too great towards _ladrones_ and these murdering generals will
have to be changed. They must be given an opportunity to come in and if
they do not come in in a short time, they ought to be deported from the
country and sent to Guam. This will have an effect so healthy that a
short time will see accomplished what we desire. There will be a great
awakening for some of these men who have come to rely on the supineness
of the Americans, and who do not understand that we can be severe when
we choose....

“It was General Otis who inaugurated the plan of laughing at the
insurrection, of capturing men and letting them go, and the result is
that they have laughed at us, but with a little tightening of the reins
their laugh will cease....

“They dread deportation more than anything else and I have written to
Secretary Root and asked him to have a prison constructed at Guam to
which we may send those whom we think worthy of a less punishment than
hanging. The insurrection must be suppressed for the benefit of the
United States and, still more, for the benefit of the Filipino people.
The lenient methods, having been tried for two years, must be changed to
those more severe....

“The insurrection, such as it is now, is nothing more than a conspiracy
against the sovereignty of the United States sustained by murder and
assassination of Filipinos by Filipinos....

“MacArthur is drawing the reins a little tighter, though not as tight as
we think he ought to draw them, and he has now imprisoned about fifteen
hundred insurgents. There have been a great many arrests made in Manila,
which has been the head centre of the insurrection in the way of raising
money. I should think there have been fifty or sixty insurgent officers
arrested in the city....

“I sent a telegram to the Secretary of War on Sunday night which was
signed by Buencamino and other prominent Filipinos, about a dozen of
them, in which they spoke out with emphasis about the continuation of
the insurrection. They propose to organise what they call a
counter-revolution; that is, they mean they will organise a military
movement among the Filipinos against Filipinos. They are getting very
tired and weary of this murder and assassination policy without which
the insurrection could not last a week....

“You could hardly believe the closeness with which the Presidential
matters are being watched by the Filipinos, and how they follow the
speeches made against the Republican cause. General Smith, away down on
the island of Negros, told me he had found speeches by Hoar and Bryan,
and other anti-expansionists and anti-imperialists, in the most remote
mountains of his district....

“Every one is waiting and it is not impossible that should Bryan be
elected there might be some riotous demonstration among the natives. The
Chief Justice of the Supreme Court, Señor Arellano, has made
arrangements, should Bryan be elected, to leave the islands three days
after the announcement. He is the ablest Filipino in the islands, by far
the best lawyer and a man of the highest probity. He says that much as
he is interested in the success and prosperity of his fellow citizens,
he knows that they are utterly incapable of self-government and should
the guiding hand of the United States be withdrawn, chaos, conscription
and corruption would follow inevitably....”

I have taken these excerpts at random from my husband’s letters to his
brother during the months of September and October, 1900, and they serve
to show the situation which existed and will illustrate the fact that we
were living in interesting times. But they deal only with the
insurrection, while the main body of his correspondence shows that the
Commissioners were engaged upon legislative matters of the gravest
import which would be rendered entirely superfluous should Mr. Bryan be
elected and his announced policies be carried into effect. In that event
they proposed immediately to turn matters back to the military
government and withdraw, leaving Mr. Bryan to face the problems which
they knew he would soon discover had to be dealt with from the
standpoint of constructive statesmanship.

In the meantime the peace movement was rapidly gaining adherents among
the people in spite of the still active _insurrectos_, or rather,
because of them and their methods; while everybody seemed to welcome the
change from a strictly military to a partially civil government.

The popularity of the Commission, as offering a change from the
strictness of military rule, was becoming every day more marked. Juan de
Juan, a Spaniard, and editor of the lively organ _El Progreso_, which
was always in opposition to anything American, said that on the first of
September when the Commission began to exercise its authority, he
intended to devote the whole front page of his paper to just three
words: “Gracias a Dios,”—Thanks to God! Juan de Juan was a good deal of
a Bohemian and really cared little what happened so long as he got a
sensation out of it. September first came and went, and I don’t remember
whether he made good this extravagant threat or not. I presume he didn’t
for, though I had been in Manila less than a week, I surely would have
remembered.

After the Commission had been in power for just a month, and while the
excited interest in events in the United States was at its height, Juan
de Juan broke out in a characteristic Spanish editorial, a translation
of which has been preserved. We had entertained Juan de Juan at dinner,
and he evidently was impressed. We made it a rule from the beginning
that neither politics nor race should influence our hospitality in any
way, and we came thus to have a very wide and diverse acquaintance. The
editorial in _El Progreso_ gives such a curious picture of attitude and
conditions in general, as well as of my husband, my family and my home,
that I think I must quote it,—at least in part. It is headed simply:

  SEÑOR TAFT

  The most uncompromising jingoes; the rabid partisans of militarism, as
  well as the men of democratic sentiments who consider the occupation
  of the Philippines as an odious Cæsarism, respect and venerate the
  President of the Civil Commission, whose surname serves as the caption
  of these lines. Uprightness and _bonhommie_ always demand recognition.

  Before the _Hancock_, bearing this statesman, had anchored in Manila
  Bay, the echo of his reputation and the radiations of the brilliant
  aureole which his success in the judiciary of his country had
  _imposed_ upon him—and we underline the word imposed because the
  characteristic trait of Mr. Taft is his modesty—had reached the
  Philippines. The Filipinos awaited him with the same pleasing
  curiosity with which a child opens a toy with a concealed surprise,
  and the foreigners as the incarnation of those American patriarchal,
  democratic ideas with which Castelar portrayed to his followers the
  country of Lincoln.

  Behind that spacious brow of the thinker, between his liberal
  tendencies and the incomparable exactions of the enormous burdens
  which his country undertook in Paris, fierce struggles are waging. The
  President of the American Civil Commission has broad shoulders, but
  the weight of a people whom patriotism endows with the strength of a
  colossus is very great.

  We must concede to all the leading authorities whom America has sent
  to the Philippines the trait of being industrious. We know that
  General Otis worked more than twelve hours a day; MacArthur, that
  Daban of the American Army through the rapidity of his advancement,
  follows the same course as his predecessor, and Mr. Taft leaves his
  house every morning at eight and, as unostentatiously as a clerk,
  proceeds to become a part of his chair in the Ayuntamiento. There his
  first occupation is glancing over the American press, and what is of
  interest in the Spanish papers.

  Then the show begins. Paterno, Macabulos, Montenegro, some envoy from
  Cebu, for example, who come to sound him, as the slang saying goes,
  arrive. Mr. Taft has the same respectful smile for all, the same
  courtesy, and addresses them all in the same terms, which his athletic
  Secretary, Mr. Fergusson, repeats in Spanish with the gravity of a
  Sphinx and the fidelity of a phonograph. When the matter warrants it,
  Mr. Pepperman, the chief stenographer of the Commission, enters the
  office and proceeds to take notes of the interview.

  In this way the Americans are forming a luminous record which, united
  to what were our archives, which they preserve through the terms of
  the Treaty of Paris, will guide them well in the administration of the
  Philippines.

  Later Mr. Taft becomes engulfed in the examination of the bills which
  the other members of the Commission present for him to study; he
  discusses their text with his colleagues, listens to all their
  observations, and judging them by a standard most favorable to the
  interests of the Philippines, the most liberal within the instructions
  from Washington—it is proper to say that Mr. Taft is the most
  democratic element of the Commission—he expresses his opinion,
  generous, calm and noble, which assuredly, in view of his personal
  prestige, must carry great weight in the framing of the bills, whose
  execution is entrusted to the Military governor.

  To dissipate the gloomy smoke of the conflagration, to still the
  groans of those who fall in this immense _expoliarium_ into which
  fatality has converted the Philippine fields, is the mission which the
  men composing the American Commission desire to bring to a successful
  issue. To make peace. For this they came, and if fortune does not
  reserve for them the happy chance of accomplishing so beautiful an
  ideal, they will retire, and the factor they represent in the problem
  to be solved, with its distinguishing traits of civil moderation, will
  be substituted as a system that has failed, by another, wherein the
  martial power will prevail over political wisdom.

  As General MacArthur undoubtedly spends many hours over maps of the
  Philippines, Mr. Taft also often rests his gaze on a map covering one
  of the walls of his office, tracing, _in mente_, a railroad which,
  crossing the island, shall drown with the cheery whistle of the
  locomotive the moans of the victims of war. Thus would Mr. Taft like
  to pacify the Philippines.

                  *       *       *       *       *

  It is now one o’clock P.M. and Mr. Taft is at home, where this
  personage stands out more boldly before us, since the trials through
  which the country is passing do not permit us yet to judge him
  politically.

  The President of the Commission, in his private life, has many points
  of similarity with Count de Caspe, that stainless gentleman the
  Filipinos still recall with veneration. Excepting the brilliancy of
  those splendid entertainments with which he endeavoured to blot out
  all racial differences by mingling in fraternal embrace Filipinos and
  Spaniards at the Malacañan villa, there ordinarily reigned in the
  governor’s mansion the placid silence of the home of a well-to-do
  retired merchant. The Countess, who on Thursdays did the honours of
  her _salon_ with exquisite tact, was during the other days of the week
  a housekeeper who did not disdain to go to a grocery store to make
  purchases, or to look over the laundry list.

  The same thing happens in the elegant _chalet_ at Malate where Mr.
  Taft lives. This is a quiet and peaceful home, a temple erected to the
  affections, under whose roof Mr. Taft rests some hours after the
  efforts which his political work demands.

  His table reflects his modest character. Four courses, two kinds of
  fruit, a dessert and sauterne compose the menu of the luncheon where
  Mr. Taft is always accompanied by some guest, either Filipino,
  American or Spanish. During the meal politics are banished; if the
  guest is a Filipino who speaks French Mrs. Taft interrogates him on
  the customs of the archipelago; if he is Spanish, as to the toilettes
  worn in Manila by the ladies at the most brilliant receptions held
  here; as to the favourite musical composer of the Hispano-Filipino
  society; and this conversation increases in attraction when Miss
  Herron, sister-in-law of Mr. Taft and the incarnation of the modern
  woman’s education, takes part therein. Miss Herron speaks French
  correctly, has travelled much, and journeyed through Spain like an
  intelligent tourist. The architectural lace-work of the Alhambra
  charmed her, and she went into ecstasies over the orange blossoms
  growing along the banks of the Guadalquivir. With what Miss Herron was
  not in harmony, and she berates them like an unsubsidised journalist,
  were the Spanish railroads. Miss Herron is right.

  The children, Robert, about eleven years old; Helen, a girl of nine,
  and Charles, a baby of three, who is the king of the household:—the
  McKinley, as it were, of this patriarchal republic—do not come to the
  table; they eat with the governess.

  After the meal, in the fine gallery overlooking the sea, sipping the
  coffee, Mr. Taft talks of the education of his children, of the
  difficulties met in the Philippines in the solution of so interesting
  a problem; and his wife converses of the charitable work she expects
  to undertake when she shall have assumed a more permanent place in the
  Archipelago, which Magellan discovered for Spain, and which, through a
  horrible fatality, is no longer ours. Politics are also eschewed on
  the gallery.

Needless to say this extraordinary editorial afforded us all boundless
amusement; we began to caution Mr. Taft frequently about the careful
preservation of his “aureole” and Maria and I decided that we would have
to walk warily indeed, if we were destined to be so minutely reported.



                               CHAPTER VI
                         A STRANGE ENVIRONMENT


In the Far East one meets certain expressions the significance of which
may be described as adamantine. Each represents a racial attitude
against which it is useless to contend. In Japan it is the equivalent of
it cannot be helped; a verbal shrug of the shoulders with which the
Japanese tosses off all minor and many grave annoyances. “_Masqui_,”
down the China coast, has the same import, but with the added meaning of
“what difference does it make.” In the Philippines the phrase which must
be met and which cannot be overcome by any system of reform is “_el
costumbre del pais_”—the custom of the country.

If it is _el costumbre del pais_ it has to be done and there is nothing
more to be said about it. The _manaña_ habit—putting everything off
until to-morrow—is, perhaps, to Americans, the most annoying of all the
_costumbres del pais_ in the Philippines, but it yields to pressure much
more readily than do many others, among which is the custom of
accumulating _parientes_; that is, giving shelter on a master’s premises
to every kind and degree of relative who has no other place to live.
This is, I suppose, a survival of an old patriarchal arrangement whereby
everybody with the remotest or vaguest claim upon a master of a
household gathered upon that master’s doorstep, so to speak, and camped
there for life.

In my first encounter with this peculiarity of my environment I thought
there was a large party going on in my _cochero’s_ quarters; and an
indiscriminate sort of party it seemed to be. There were old men and old
women, young men and young women, many small children and a few babes in
arms. We had only Chinese servants in the house, but the stables were in
charge of Filipinos and, as I soon discovered, the “party” was made up
entirely of our stablemen’s _parientes_.

[Illustration:

  (_LEFT TO RIGHT_) GENERAL WRIGHT, MR. TAFT AND JUDGE IDE AS PHILIPPINE
    COMMISSIONERS
]

I had a pair of ponies and a Victoria; Mr. Taft had his two little brown
horses and a Victoria; besides which there was an extra horse to be used
in case of accident to one of the others, as well as a pony and _calesa_
for the children. This rather formidable array was necessary because we
found it impossible to take a horse out more than twice a day, and
usually not more than once, on account of the sun. My ponies were taken
out only in the early morning or the late evening, and those of Mr. Taft
had all they could do to take him to the office and bring him home twice
a day. Distances were long and there were no street cars which ran where
anybody wanted to go.

This number of conveyances made a good many stablemen necessary and all
of them, with their families, lived in quarters attached to the stables.
These families consisted of fathers, mothers, sisters, brothers, uncles,
aunts, cousins near and far removed, wives, children, grandchildren, and
a few intimate and needy friends with their family ramifications.
Besides our three _cocheros_ and the stable boys, there was a gardener
with his _parientes_, so it is no wonder that on my first inspection of
the lower premises I should have thought that some sort of festivity was
in progress. I might have lived in Manila twenty years without being
able to straighten out the relationships in this servant colony; it was
not possible to learn who had and who had not a right to live on the
place; and my protest was met with the simple statement that it was _el
costumbre del pais_, so I, perforce, accepted the situation.

Filipino servants never live in the master’s residence; they never want
to; they want the freedom of a house of their own, and these houses are,
as a rule, built on the outer edges of the garden, or compound. I
believe Americans now are learning to meet the _pariente_ habit by
having room for just as many people as they need, and no more. But those
who live in the old places, with their ample quarters, still gather the
clans and are permitted to enjoy a most expansive and patriarchal
sensation.

My horses, when I first saw them, were a source of the greatest pride. A
beautifully matched pair of coal-black, stylishly-paced and glossy
little stallions, hardly larger than Shetland ponies, they looked as if
they had been washed in some sort of shrinking soap and had come out in
perfect condition except that they were several sizes smaller than they
ought to have been. These Philippine ponies are doubtless descendants of
the Arabian horses brought over by the Spaniards and have been reduced
to their present size by the change of climate and the difference in
food and environment, but they still have the fine lines and the general
characteristics of their progenitors.

Mr. Taft secured mine from Batangas, where all the best ponies come
from, through the kindness of Mr. Benito Legarda, the staunchest of
_Americanistas_. Batangas was a most unquiet province, the last, in
fact, to become pacified, and Mr. Legarda had to pay an _insurrecto_ for
bringing the horses through the insurgent lines and delivering them at
Calamba, near Manila. Although he did not know their exact origin when
he bought them, Mr. Taft said that if the facts became known he would be
accused, in certain quarters, of giving indirect aid to the
revolutionists; but he wanted the ponies so he did not return them.

When they were hitched to the shining little Victoria which had been
built for them, they were as pretty as a picture and, as I did not
propose to have such a turn-out ruined by a couple of Filipinos on the
box in untidy _camisas_ hanging outside of as untidy white trousers, I
had made for my _cochero_ and boy, or coachman and footman, a livery of
white and green in which they took such inordinate pride that they
seemed to grow in stature and dignity.

Maria and I felt a sense of the utmost satisfaction the first time we
stepped into this carriage for a drive down to the Luneta where we were
sure to see everybody we knew and hundreds of people besides; but our
vanity was destined to be brought to a sudden termination.

As we were driving along with much satisfaction, a bit of paper floated
down alongside the blinkers of the little ebony steed on the right and
he made one wild leap into the air. His companion gave him an angry nip,
and then the fight was on. Maria and I jumped out, which was not
difficult in a low-built Victoria, and no sooner had we done so than we
saw the complete wreck of all our grandeur. With all the leaping and
plunging and biting and kicking, in the vicinity of a handy lamp-post,
the smash-up was fairly complete. Neither of the ponies was hurt, except
by the lash of the whip, and I must say the little wretches looked
rather funny; like very pretty and very bad children, sorry for what
they had done. But their characters were established and they proceeded
after that to live up to them. We never could have any confidence in
them and my coachman was the only person who could do anything with
them. He was a most unsatisfactory man in many ways and used often to
call for us at dinner parties in a state of gay inebriety, but we didn’t
dare discharge him because everybody else in the stables stood in awe of
the blacks while he seemed greatly to enjoy his constant and spectacular
struggles with them.

The Filipinos are a most temperate people; there is no such thing as
drunkenness among them; but coachmen seem to be an exception in that
they allow themselves a sufficient stimulation of the fiery _vino_ to
make them drive with courage and dash, sometimes minus all care and
discretion. The drivers of public vehicles seem to love their little
horses in a way; they are inordinately proud of a fast paced or
stylish-looking pony; yet they are, as a rule, quite harsh to them. They
overload them and overdrive them, and under all conditions they lash
them continuously.

No Filipino _cochero_ likes to have another _cochero_ pass him, and the
result is constant, indiscriminate racing, on any kind of street, under
any circumstances,—and never mind the horse.

My children were driving with their governess to the Luneta one evening,
when two _caromatas_ came tearing down behind them, each driver hurling
imprecations at the other and paying no attention to what was ahead of
him. The result was a violent collision. The two _caromatas_ went
plunging on, the _cocheros_ not stopping to see what damage they might
have done—which was very characteristic—and the children narrowly
escaped a serious accident. Charlie was hurled out and fell under the
children’s _calesa_ and Robert and Helen both declare they felt a
sickening jolt as a wheel passed over him. The baby, too, vowed that the
_calesa_ “went wight over me, wight dere,” indicating a vital spot; but
upon the closest examination we could discover nothing more serious than
a few bruises. However, it made us very much afraid to trust the
children out alone.

The gardener had two little boys, José and Capito, who were a few years
older than Charlie, but about his size, and he took a tremendous fancy
to them. They were clad, simply, in thin gauze—or _jusi_—shirts which
came down a little below their waists, and I think Charlie envied them
this informal attire. He used to order them around in a strange mixture
of Spanish, Tagalog and English which made me wonder at my wholly
American child; but it was an effective combination since he seemed to
have them completely under his thumb and, as he revelled in his sense of
power, he never tired of playing with them.

Maria and I soon adopted the universal habit of driving down to the
Escolta in the early morning to do such shopping as was necessary. We
found a variety of interesting shops, but with very little in them to
meet the ordinary demands of an American woman. There were delightful
Indian bazaars and Chinese _tiendas_ where all manner of gaudy fabrics
and strange oriental articles were on sale, while the Spanish shops upon
which everybody had to depend in those days, and which had such grandly
European names as Paris-Manila and La Puerta del Sol, catered largely to
the Filipino taste for bright colours.

The Escolta at that time was full of saloons, established by the
inevitable followers of a large army, and the street being very narrow
and the old, rickety, wooden buildings being very wide open, the “beery”
odour which pervaded the atmosphere at all hours was really dreadful.
Mr. Taft decided that as long as this was the only street in town where
women could go shopping, the saloons would have to be removed. There was
opposition on the Commission to the bill which provided for their
banishment, and it was fought from the outside with great vigour and
bitterness, but a majority were in favour of it, so it passed, and the
saloons had to move. There has not been a saloon on the Escolta from
that day to this and, indeed, they have ever since been under such
satisfactory regulation that there is little evidence left of their
existence in the city.

I am afraid it is going to be very difficult to convey an adequate
picture of Manila society during the first years of American occupation.
There had been, in the old days, a really fine Spanish and rich
_mestizo_ society, but all, or nearly all, of the Spaniards had left the
Islands, and the _mestizos_ had not yet decided just which way to
“lean,” or just how to meet the American control of the situation. I may
say here that most of the educated, high-class Filipinos are _mestizo_;
that is, of mixed blood. They may be Spanish mestizo or Chinese mestizo,
but they have in them a strong strain of foreign blood. Besides the
Spanish- and Chinese-Filipinos, there are a number of British mestizos
who are very interesting people. Mr. Legarda, Chief Justice Arellano,
Dr. Pardo de Tavera and Mr. Quezon, the Filipino delegate to the United
States Congress, are Spanish mestizos, while Mr. Arañeta, the Secretary
of Finance and Justice, as well as the Speaker of the Philippine
Assembly and many able lawyers and successful business men are of
Chinese descent. The mestizos control practically all the wealth of the
Philippines, and their education, intelligence and social standing are
unquestioned. It is the only country in the world that I know
about—certainly the only country in the Orient—where the man or woman of
mixed blood seems to be regarded as superior to the pure blooded native.

Dating back also to the Spanish days was quite a numerous foreign
society consisting of a few consuls, some professional men, the managers
of banks and large British and European mercantile firms, and their
families. The leaders of the British colony were Mr. and Mrs. Jones—Mr.
Jones being the manager of the Manila branch of the Hongkong and
Shanghai Banking Corporation. Mrs. Jones, a very beautiful and charming
woman, gave some very elaborate parties during that first winter. Bank
House, the residence maintained by the bank for its manager in Manila,
is a beautiful place in Uli-Uli, a district on the picturesque banks of
the upper Pásig, and it is finely adapted for balls and large
receptions. Then there were several German families who also entertained
quite lavishly, and I remember, especially, one Austrian exile; indeed,
I shall never be able to forget him because my husband took such joy in
pronouncing his name. He was Baron von Bosch.

This was the “set” which entertained the Commission most cordially
during our first season in Manila, while the Army officers, following
the lead of their Commanding General, held themselves somewhat aloof. I
kept up a constant round of parties of different kinds in my house, and
gave a dinner at least once a week at which were gathered companies of a
most interestingly cosmopolitan character. And we did not fail to
observe all the desirable forms. Both Filipinos and Europeans expect a
certain amount of ceremony from the representatives of government and
are not at all impressed by “democratic simplicity”; so believing in the
adage about Rome and the Romans, we did what we could. Beside the spic
and span guard at the outer gate of the illuminated garden, we always,
on dinner party nights, stationed coachmen, or other stable boys
disguised as liveried footmen, on either side of the entrance, to
receive guests and conduct them to the dressing-rooms, and up the stairs
to the reception room.

Our house was nicely adapted for a dinner of twelve and I usually tried
to confine myself to that number. We always had an orchestra, orchestras
being very plentiful in Manila where nearly every native plays some sort
of instrument, and the music added greatly to the festive air of things,
which was enhanced, too, by a certain oriental atmosphere, with many
Japanese lanterns and a profusion of potted plants and great, hanging,
natural ferneries and orchids which were brought in from the forests by
the Filipinos and sold on the streets.

My husband is supposed to be the author of the phrase: “our little brown
brothers”—and perhaps he is. It did not meet the approval of the army,
and the soldiers used to have a song which they sang with great gusto
and frequency and which ended with the conciliating sentiment: “He may
be a brother of William H. Taft, but he ain’t no friend of mine!”

We insisted upon complete racial equality for the Filipinos, and from
the beginning there were a great many of them among our callers and
guests. Their manners are models of real courtesy, and, while their
customs are not always like ours, wherever they are able they manifest a
great willingness to be _conforme_,—to adapt themselves,—and their
hospitality is unbounded.

I shall never forget my first call from a Filipino family. They arrived
shortly after six in the evening: el señor, la señora and four
señoritas. We went through a solemn and ceremonious handshaking all
around. I received them first, then passed them on to my husband who, in
turn, passed them on with a genial introduction to my sister Maria. We
had been sitting on the verandah, and when a semi-circle of chairs had
been arranged, the six of them sat down; el señor noisily cleared his
throat a couple of times while the ladies calmly folded their little
hands in their laps and assumed an air of great repose. It was as if
they had no intention of taking any part whatever in the conversation.

El señor explained in Spanish that they were our near neighbours and
that they had called merely to pay their respects. Mr. Taft had been
studying Spanish diligently ever since he left the United States, but he
is not conspicuously gifted as a linguist, and he had not yet waked
up—as he so often expressed a wish that he might—to find himself a true
Castilian. However, his ready laugh and the cordiality of his manners
have always had a peculiar charm for the Filipinos, and he was able on
this occasion, as he was on many future ones, to carry off the situation
very well. We all nodded and smiled and said, “Si Señor” and “Si
Señora,” to long and no telling what kind of speeches from our guests;
then Maria and I complimented the ladies on their beautifully
embroidered _camisas_, which started things off properly. They praised
everything in sight, and what we didn’t get through the little Spanish
we knew, we got from gesture and facial expression. They got up and
wandered all around, feeling of my Japanese tapestries and embroideries,
breathing long “ahs!” of admiration over my gold screens and pictures
and curios, and acting generally like callers who were being very well
entertained. Then the children came in and they broke out afresh in
voluble praise of them. I assumed the proper deprecatory mien in
response to their laudation of my children, and altogether I felt that
we were acquitting ourselves rather well in this first inter-racial
social experience.

But at the end of half an hour the strain was getting a little severe
and I was wondering what to do next, when our six callers arose and said
they must be going. I breathed an inward sigh of relief and was making
ready to escort them to the top of the stairs, when my husband cordially
exclaimed:

“Why, no! _Porque? Tenemos bastante tiempo._ Why hurry?”
And—they—all—sat—down!

I regretted then even the little Spanish Mr. Taft had learned, though,
of course, he didn’t expect them to heed his polite protest. He knew
nothing at all about Filipino manners; he didn’t know they expected to
receive some sign from him when it was time to go and that they would
consider it discourteous to go while he was urging them to stay. He kept
up, without much assistance, a brave if laboured conversation, and the
minutes slowly passed. Our dinner hour approached and I darted warning
glances at him, for I had a horrible fear that he just might ask them to
remain and dine. But at the end of another hour a strained expression
began to spread itself over even his face, and there was not a word of
protest from him when, at a quarter past eight, our little brown
neighbours once more indicated an intention of going home. We
entertained Filipino callers nearly every day after that, but never
again did we urge them to reconsider their sometimes tardy decision to
depart.

With regard to Filipino manners and customs; I am reminded that we were
nonplussed, though greatly amused by the _costumbre del pais_ which
decreed that some return be made by a Filipino for any and all favours
bestowed upon him. We grew accustomed to this before we left the
Islands, and came to expect a few offerings of sorts almost any day in
the week, but in the beginning it was usually most embarrassing.

One time, soon after our arrival, a very loyal _Americanista_ was shot
down in the street, during the peaceful discharge of his duty, by an
_insurrecto_. His widow, with her children, came into Manila in a state
of utter destitution, to secure some recompense from the government for
her husband’s services, and while her case was pending Mr. Taft, in
great pity for her, sent her money enough to live on. The next day the
whole family, from the wide-eyed boy to the babe carried astride the
mother’s hip, came to call on their benefactor, bringing with them as a
gift a basket containing a few eggs, some strange Philippine fruits and
a lot of sea-shells. Mr. Taft was deeply touched, and with the
brusqueness of a man who is touched, he told her he had given her the
money to buy food for herself and her children and not for him, and he
refused her offering. I know, by the light of a fuller knowledge of the
character of the lowly Filipino, that she went away feeling very much
cast down.

But in connection with such gifts there were always more laughs than
sighs. We invited to luncheon one day a dashing Filipino named Tomaso
del Rosario. Señor Rosario, a man of wealth and prominence who had a
fine Spanish education and was well dressed in the high-collared,
patent-leathered and immaculate-linened Spanish style, was quite
self-confident and enjoyed himself very much. He seemed attracted to
Maria and she, being linguistic, was able to talk to him in a mixture of
many languages. The next day she received from Señor Rosario, not a
floral offering, but a basket filled with nuts, a canned plum-pudding,
some canned chocolates and preserved fruits. This attention did not seem
so remarkable, however, when we learned, to our amusement, that he had
sent exactly the same present to Alice Worcester, then five years old.

Our life, on the whole, was intensely interesting in its unusual
atmosphere and curious complications, but throughout everything we were
made to feel the deep significance of our presence in the Islands; and
the work of the Commission was first, last and always to us the subject
of the greatest moment. Even in our daily round of social affairs we
dealt with tremendous problems whose correct solution meant the
restoration of peace and prosperity to what then should have been, and
what we knew could be made, a great country. That for which the American
flag had always stood began to assume, for many of us, a broader and a
finer meaning; and being so much a part of our flag’s mission in a
strange field a certain zest was added to our patriotism which we had
never felt before. I believe, and I think all those who know the truth
believe, that Americanism, in its highest conception, has never been
more finely demonstrated than in the work done by the United States in
the Philippine Islands; work, the broad foundation for which the
Commission was engaged in constructing during the period of which I
write.

So many were the problems to be met and dealt with that in the beginning
the Commissioners were each given a set of subjects for investigation
and study, their findings being submitted for debate and consideration
in the general meetings.

Taxation, civil service, provincial and municipal organisations,
currency and finance, police, harbour improvements, roads and railways,
customs, postal service, education, health, public lands, an honest
judiciary and the revision of the code of laws; these were some of the
vital problems, but underlying them all was the immediate necessity for
the establishment of tranquillity and confidence throughout the
archipelago.

In order to make clear, in any degree, the Philippine situation as we
found it, it is essential that, briefly, the position of the Catholic
Church and its representatives, the Friars, be explained. For the first
time in its history the American government found itself compelled to
adjust a seemingly insurmountable difficulty between a church and its
people.

With us the Church is so completely separate from the State that it is
difficult to imagine cases in which the policy of a church in the
selection of its ministers, and the assignment of them to duty could be
regarded as of political moment, or as a proper subject of comment in
the report of a public officer, but in the first reports of the
Philippine Commission to Washington this subject had to be introduced
with emphasis.

The Spanish government of the Philippine Islands was a government by the
Church through its monastic orders, nothing less. In the words of the
Provincial of the Augustinians, the Friars were the “pedestal or
foundation of the sovereignty of Spain” which being removed “the whole
structure would topple over.” The Philippine people, with the exception
of the Mohammedan Moros and the non-Christian tribes, belonged, during
the Spanish dominion, to the Roman Catholic Church, and the Church
registry of 1898 showed a total membership of 6,559,998. The parishes
and missions, with few exceptions, were administered by Spanish Friars
of the Dominican, Augustinian and Franciscan orders, and it was to the
nature of this administration that Spain owed the insurrections of 1896
and 1898, the latter of which terminated only upon our assuming control
of the islands.

In 1896 there were in the Philippines 1,124 monks of the Augustinian,
Dominican and Franciscan orders, which body included a company of
Recolletos, who are merely an offshoot of the order of St. Augustine and
differ from the Augustinians only in that they are unshod. In addition
to these there were a few Jesuits, Capuchins, Benedictines and Paulists,
but they engaged in mission and educational work only and did not share
with the other orders the resentment and hatred of the people. Filipinos
were not admitted to any of the orders, but they were made friar curates
and served as parish priests in some of the smaller places.

When a Spanish Friar curate was once settled in a parish he remained
there for life, or until he was too old for service, and because of this
fact he was able to establish and maintain an absolutism which is
difficult to explain in a few words. He was simply everything in his
parish. As a rule he was the only man of education who knew both Spanish
and the native dialect of his district, and in many parishes he was the
only Spanish representative of the government. In the beginning, through
his position as spiritual guide, he acted as intermediary in secular
matters between his people and the rest of the world, and eventually, by
law, he came to discharge many civil functions and to supervise, correct
or veto everything which was done, or was sought to be done in his
pueblo.

He was Inspector of Primary Schools, President of the Board of Health
and the Board of Charities, President of the Board of Urban Taxation,
Inspector of Taxation, President of the Board of Public Works, Member of
the Provincial Council, Member of the Board for Partitioning Crown
Lands, Censor of Municipal Budgets, and Censor of plays, comedies or
dramas in the dialect of his parish, deciding whether or not these were
against the public peace or morals. In a word, he was the government of
his parish; and in addition to all things else, it was he who, once a
year, went to the parish register, wrote on slips of paper the names of
all boys who had reached the age of twenty, and putting these into a
receptacle, drew them out one by one and called every fifth man for
military service. So hateful was this forced duty to the Filipino youths
that many of them would run away into the mountains and hide, become
outlaws in order to escape it. But the civil guard would go after them
and when they were captured they would be put in jail and watched until
they could be sent to their capital.

The monastic orders had behind them a powerful church organisation the
heads of which took an active and official part in the administration of
government. The Archbishop and the Bishops formed part of what was known
in Manila as the Board of Authorities; and they, with the Provincials of
the orders, belonged to the Council of Administration, a body analogous
to the Council of State in Spain or France, charged with advising the
Governor-General on matters of urgent moment, or in times of crises. The
Friars, Priests and Bishops constituted a solid, permanent and
well-organised political force which dominated all insular policies, and
the stay in the islands of the civil or military officer who attempted
to pursue a course at variance with that deemed wise by the orders, was
invariably shortened by monastic influence. Each order had in Madrid a
representative through whom the Court of Spain easily could be reached
without the intervention of any authority.

Upon the morals of the Friars I can only touch. That some of them
brought up families of sons and daughters is beyond question. Such were
guilty of violating their vows of celibacy rather than of debauchery. On
this point the moral standard of the Filipino people was not rigid, and
women were rather proud than otherwise of the parentage of their
Friar-fathered children who were often brighter, better looking and more
successful than the average Filipino. The truth is that this charge was
urged with more eagerness and emphasis after the Filipinos began to
appeal to the American government than during Spanish times, and when
the standard of morality in the Filipino priesthood of the period was
considered, it seemed as if the accusers thought the charge would have
more weight with those they sought to influence than it did with
themselves.

The three great orders of St. Francis, St. Augustine and St. Dominic
owned, in different parts of the Islands, more than 400,000 acres of the
best agricultural land, and this they rented out in small parcels to the
people. Their income from these immense holdings was not what a prudent
and energetic landlord would have realised, but they paid no taxes,
while the Filipino was taxed in every possible way.

In the province of Cavite alone the Friar estates amounted to 131,747
acres, and it was in the province of Cavite, which is just across the
bay from Manila, that the two insurrections against Spain, or rather
against Friar domination, began.

When we arrived in Manila all but 472 of the 1,124 Friars had either
been killed or had fled the country. In each of the uprisings many of
them lost their lives, and many more were taken prisoners. Indeed, the
last of them were not released until the rapid advance of the American
troops in our own encounter with the _insurrectos_ made it necessary for
the insurgent army to abandon all unnecessary impedimenta. All the
Friars remaining in the Islands had taken refuge in Manila.

Strange to say, this resentment against the Friars interfered in no way
with the Filipino’s love for the Church. With a strong and real emotion
he loves the religion which has been given him; and the elaborate and
beautiful forms of the Roman Catholic Church are calculated, especially,
to make a powerful appeal to his mind. It is really an astonishing
commentary on the character of these people that they should be able to
rise against the men who administered the sacraments which they so
deeply loved and revered. Or, is it more of a commentary on the
conditions which caused the uprisings?

Without exception the Spanish Friars had been driven from their
parishes, and the most burning of all the burning political questions
which the Commission met and had to settle, was whether or not they
should be permitted to return. It was impossible to make the people
understand that the government of the United States and the government
of Spain were two different matters, and that if the Friars were
returned to their parishes they would exercise no secular functions of
any kind. The people had the proverbial dread of the “burnt child” and
no amount or kind of reasoning could move them from the position they
had taken, nor could any of them, from the highest to the lowest, talk
calmly and rationally about the subject. The one point upon which the
Filipinos were united was that the Friars should never be reinstated.

Universal agitation, uneasiness, fear, hatred, a memory of wrongs too
recently resented and resented at too great a cost; these were the
factors which made necessary the stand which the Commission finally
adopted. The question with the Friars became one, largely, of getting
value for their property, their title to which was never seriously
disputed, and it was decided that on condition of their leaving the
Islands, the insular government would undertake the purchase of their
vast estates. The intention was then to make some arrangement whereby
the lands might be sold back to the people in homestead tracts, and on
terms which the poorest man might be able, in time, to meet.

It was to negotiate this transaction, involving the expenditure of
$7,000,000 that my husband was sent to Rome the following year as an
emissary of the United States government to the Vatican. This was in the
time of Pope Leo, and it made a most interesting experience which I
shall detail in another chapter.

The first thing, really, that the Commission undertook when they arrived
in Manila, was the settlement of a definite dispute between the Church
and the People as to which had the right to administer the affairs of
the Medical College of San José. Their manner of procedure in this case
instituted in the Islands a new and never-before-thought-of system of
evenly balanced justice, and made a tremendous sensation.

The case was called: “T. H. Pardo de Tavera, and others, for themselves
and other inhabitants of the Philippine Islands—against—The Rector of
the University of Santo Tomas, a Dominican monk, and the Holy Roman
Apostolic Catholic Church, represented by the Most Reverend, the
Archbishop of Manila, and the Most Reverend, the Archbishop of New
Orleans, Apostolic Delegate.” Its importance, under the conditions then
existing, can hardly be exaggerated.

San José was one of the oldest institutions in the Islands; it was
founded, as a matter of fact, in 1601, by virtue of a legacy left by a
Spanish Provincial Governor named Figueroa who provided that it should
always be managed by the head of the Jesuits in the Islands. It was
originally a college for the education of Spanish boys, but through
various vicissitudes, including the expulsion of the Jesuits in 1766, it
had changed from one thing to another until, finally, it had become a
college of physicians and pharmacists and was made a department of the
University of Santo Tomas, the Rector of which was a Dominican Friar.
One of the Philips had granted to the college a Royal charter, and
within the last hundred years the Crown had asserted its right of
control. So when the American government took over all the public
property in the Philippines, General Otis closed San José, but he did
not issue an order as to its management. The Church was petitioning for
a restitution of what it regarded as its rights in the property, and the
Commission was called upon to settle the controversy.

They conducted their examinations in open meetings so that all might see
the full and free workings of a wholly equitable system, and the
Filipinos were enabled to behold, for the first time, the, to them,
astonishing spectacle of high ecclesiastics presenting in open court the
arguments upon which they based their claims.

The first hearing Mr. Taft describes as “an historic scene.”

“There were the two Archbishops in their archiepiscopal cassocks,” he
writes, “with purple girdles and diamond crosses, accompanied by a
Secretary of the Dominican order robed in white; while opposed was a
Filipino lawyer, Don Felipe Calderón, who derived his education in the
University of Santo Tomas. Accompanying him were a lot of young Filipino
students and others of the Medical Association interested in wresting
San José from the University. The Archbishop of Manila made a speech in
which he was unable to restrain the feeling of evident pain that he had
in finding the rights of the Church challenged in this Catholic country.
He made a very dignified appearance.”

And at the second hearing:

“Both Archbishops were again present, and the same scene was re-enacted
except that we had rather more of a formal hearing. We had them seated
on opposite sides of a table, just as we do in court at home, and had
seats for the spectators.

“Señor Don Felipe Calderón, who represents the Philippine people, was
given an opportunity to make the first speech. He had printed his
argument and read it, having given us translated copies with which we
followed him. His argument was a very strong one, lawyer-like and
well-conceived, but he weakened it by some vicious remarks about the
Dominican order. The Archbishop of Manila, once or twice, felt so much
outraged at what he said that he attempted to rise, but Archbishop
Chapelle prevented him from doing so. At the close of the argument
Monsignor Chapelle asked for ten days in which to prepare an answer and
we granted him two weeks. The scene was one I shall always carry with me
as marking an interesting period in my Philippine experience.”

The Commission did not settle the question. After careful consideration
and many hearings, they left the property in the hands of the
Dominicans, but appointed a Board of Trustees to prepare and present an
appeal to the Supreme Court of the Islands, appropriating at the same
time, five thousand dollars to pay the expenses of the litigation.

Archbishop Chapelle did not like this decision and telegraphed to
Secretary Root asking him to withhold his approval. Then he asked the
Commission to modify the law and give him an opportunity, in case the
decision in the Supreme Court should go against the Church, to appeal to
the Congress of the United States. This the Commission refused to do on
good and sufficient grounds, whereupon the Archbishop cabled to the
President, declaring that the decision as it stood would retard
pacification. Although he had always been strongly opposed to the
continuation of military government, we were much amused to learn that
in his cable to the President he took occasion to remark, significantly,
that “General MacArthur is doing splendidly.”

But if Archbishop Chapelle was displeased with the action of the
Commission, the Filipino press was delighted, and the editorial
encomiums heaped upon them can only be described as brilliant. The
_Diario de Manila_, the next morning, was absolutely unable to express
itself, and it concluded a more or less incoherently eulogistic
editorial with the words: “The decision satisfies everybody; it raises a
question which threatened to drag itself over the hot sands we tread,
cleanses it of all impurities, and makes it the beginning and the end of
a most transcendental principle of sovereignty and law.” The Filipino or
Spanish editor is nothing if he is not hyperbolic.

When we arrived in Manila it was a source of great worry to us that we
could not send our children, eight and ten years old, to school. The
Jesuits had a school for boys in the Walled City, and Mr. Taft
considered for awhile the possibility of sending Robert there, where he
might, at least, learn Spanish; but so strong was the feeling against
the Friars that this would have been taken by the people as a certain
indication that the President of the Commission was leaning toward the
Church in his deliberations on the vital subject. As I have said, they
could not look upon this question, in any of its bearings, in a
reasonable light.

We eventually settled Helen in a convent where she made an effort to
learn Spanish, and Robert we turned over to Mrs. LeRoy, the wife of Mr.
Worcester’s Secretary, who was a graduate from the University of
Michigan and a most excellent teacher.

Mr. and Mrs. LeRoy went to the Philippines as bride and groom. They were
classmates, graduated together, and this was their first big venture
into the world. They were a valued part of our little pioneer circle,
and it was with the greatest dismay that we learned, after about two
years in the Islands, that Mr. LeRoy had developed tuberculosis. He had
either brought the germs with him from the United States or had
contracted the disease there, where, indeed, it is most prevalent. He
continued to act as Secretary for Mr. Worcester beyond the time when he
should have gone to another climate to devote himself to a cure, but
finally, when he realised that the sentence was upon him, he decided to
leave the Islands, and my husband was able to secure for him, because of
his splendid efficiency, a position in the Consular service under Mr.
Hay, at Durango, Mexico. This post was chosen because it is in a dry,
mountainous region where the ravages of tuberculosis are supposed to be
checked.

Mr. LeRoy was an exceedingly well-informed and studious man. He was a
natural linguist, spoke Spanish with ease, and soon was able to acquire
enough Tagalog to enable him to go among the people and get their point
of view at first-hand. He immediately became interested in writing a
history of the Islands and wanted much to go to Spain to examine
Spanish-Philippine documents at Seville and other places, but he was
never able to do so.

In the days when death faced him in New Mexico, whither he had gone
after leaving Durango, he wrote, as Grant wrote, on a book which he
hoped might furnish some means to his wife after his death. He died
before he was able to complete what Mr. Taft says is a very accurate,
comprehensive and interesting history of the Archipelago from the
beginning down to, and including, Dewey’s victory, the taking of Manila
and the work of the first Commission. He had planned to give a full
account of the work of the second Commission, with which he was so
intimately connected, but his pen dropped before his purpose was
fulfilled. His history has been only recently published.

Mrs. LeRoy later went to Washington, and Mr. Taft appointed her to one
of the few clerical positions not covered by the Civil Service law. This
is in the Land Office where she signs the President’s name to land
patents. She is the only person in the government who has the right and
power, given by special act of Congress, to sign the President’s name to
a document.

Throughout the autumn of 1900 the insurrection dragged itself along;
behind any bush the American soldiers were likely to find a lurking
“patriot”; and the uncensored reports of the “brave stand” of the
Filipinos were being sent out daily by Democratic reporters, to help
along the anti-expansionist cause, represented by Mr. Bryan, in the
United States.

The _insurrectos_ were being assured by their incitants to violence that
the eyes of the world were upon them. They were being told that they
were winning undying renown throughout the civilised universe; and they
believed it. They read with avidity all the anti-imperialistic
newspapers which came out to the Islands and accepted as a true estimate
of themselves the laudations therein contained. Besides, the promoters
of the insurrection pretended to translate from other languages still
more extravagant praises, and they certainly were enjoying a most
exalted opinion of themselves.

We understood that Aguinaldo was trying to concentrate for one
spectacular move shortly before election, in order to add to the chances
of a Democratic victory; and there was some cause for alarm. The
Filipinos are born politicians and many of them knew much more about the
campaign between Bryan and McKinley than the Americans in the Islands
knew.

Apropos of this: Archbishop Chapelle told Mr. Taft that Aguinaldo had,
through Archbishop Nozaleda, requested an interview with him. Monsignor
Chapelle went to General MacArthur and asked that Aguinaldo be allowed
to enter Manila. The General readily gave his consent, and even offered
the revolutionary Dictator the hospitality of his own roof. Aguinaldo,
in due military form, acknowledged this courtesy and fixed the time for
his arrival in Manila. He clearly indicated that he was discouraged and
had decided to solicit permission, through Archbishop Chapelle, to leave
the Islands. But just then the news of Bryan’s plan for calling an extra
session of Congress to settle Philippine independence came out, so the
insurgent general sent word that he had decided not to come. No American
knew just where he was, but he probably got the papers and telegrams
just as soon as any of us.

I remember the sixth of November as a very nervous day. We had received
all manner of reports from home; we were so far away that mail and
newspapers were a month old when they reached us; and the cable reports
had been contradictory in the extreme. We really were on our tiptoes
with excitement. And the worst of it was that because of the thirteen
hours’ difference in time between Washington and Manila, we lived
through the day knowing that the United States was asleep, and went to
bed just about the time voters began to go to the polls. We kept getting
all manner of doubtful telegrams throughout the next morning—when it was
night in the United States and the votes were being counted—but just at
one o’clock, as we went to lunch, Mr. Taft received a despatch from
General Corbin in accordance with his previous agreement. It read: “Taft
Manila McKinley Corbin.” It had been sent from the War Department in
Washington at eleven o’clock the night of the election and had taken
just forty-five minutes in transmission. This was record time for a
cablegram then between Washington and Manila, despatches having to be
sent by numerous relays.



                              CHAPTER VII
                          “DAYS OF THE EMPIRE”


There was a trying period of unrest and uncertainty in our early
experience in the Philippines, during which we lived in a state of
suspense which can hardly be described; a state of suspense which
included among its various elements the excitement of an intermittent
guerilla warfare and frequent threats of native uprisings in Manila.
Established order and a fixed governmental policy, so necessary to the
tranquillity of the normal citizen, were non-existent, and one
experienced a sense of complete detachment which made plans for even the
immediate future seem entirely futile. To unpack all one’s things; to
establish a satisfactory home and give one’s attention to its
ornamentation; to supply one’s self with the necessities of a long
residence in the tropics; in other words, to settle down to the pursuit
of a usual mode of existence; all these things had to be done, but,
needless to say, they were not done with the enthusiasm incident to a
feeling of permanence, nor did such enthusiasm begin to manifest itself
in the local atmosphere until after the re-election of Mr. McKinley in
1900 when it became certain that the American flag was in the islands to
stay as long as its presence there should be deemed requisite to the
peaceful development of the country and the fitting of the people for
self government.

There were those who saw long years ahead,—not all Americans, by any
means,—and soon the American spirit began to make itself felt in
business, in schemes of civic progress, in social life, in everything.
We were there for a purpose which was at last defined, so we cheerfully
confronted chaos and went to work.

We were sorry to note that the election of Mr. McKinley and the
consequent establishment of the American status in the Philippines did
not change the military attitude toward the manner of solving the
governmental problems. The Commission was definitely pledged to the
rapid adjustment of affairs on a civil and generally representative
basis, but the military authorities still maintained that military rule
would continue to be a necessity for an indefinite period.

However, the Civil Commission went on its way mapping out a programme of
peaceful pacification and carrying it into effect as promptly as
possible, while its activities engaged universal attention and formed
the chief topic of conversation wherever two or more people were met
together. Society became frivolous enough, but nobody ever got very far
away from the questions of absorbing interest with which many of us were
so closely associated.

Our first Christmas surely would have saddened us in our peculiar exile
had we been able to realise its approach, but this was not possible. The
“Christmas spirit” does not thrive in a temperature of eighty-odd
degrees, and I think I would have taken little interest in preparations
for the holidays had not my children been there to remind me that
Christmas is Christmas no matter what the thermometer may say about it.
It was still the most important day in the year for them and it was
almost pathetic to see them trying to defeat the climate through sheer
force of their imaginations. It was a “green Christmas” with a
vengeance, and very hot.

Our friends at home had not forgotten that we were more than a month’s
journey away and letters began to arrive as early as November in each of
which some mention was made of a box which would be sent from Cincinnati
in time to reach us before Christmas and, naturally, we began at once to
imagine its contents. For weeks our children’s favourite amusement was
exchanging guesses as to what sort of gifts their affectionate relatives
had sent them. Nor were their Aunt Maria and I any less excited. There
were transports every two weeks in those days and we were not at all
disappointed not to receive our box on the early December ship. There
would be another one in on Christmas day and it would be much nicer, we
thought, to get it then, and never a doubt did we have that it would
come. Mr. Taft had a messenger ready to get it and bring it to the house
as soon as it could be landed.

From our balcony we watched the transport steam up the bay; we felt the
interest that only a Christmas box from home, ten thousand miles away,
could excite; we forgot that it was eighty in the shade; it was really
Christmas. We waited as patiently as we could for our messenger, but
when he arrived he had only sympathy to offer us. The box had not come.
It was a most depressing disappointment, and the children were
inconsolable. However, everybody cheered up about dinner time. I had
done what I could with red ribbons and greenery, with cotton wool and
diamond dust to create the proper atmosphere; then we had invited a
number of homeless young secretaries and others to take Christmas cheer
with us, and though the cold storage turkey was tough and the cranberry
sauce and plum-pudding were from Commissary cans, we managed a near
approach to a Yuletide air, and little Charlie went to bed with his
Escolta toys quite as happy as he would have been had he been at home in
his own country. I assured the three children that the box from home
would come in on the next transport and promised that we would then have
Christmas all over again. But I reckoned without knowledge of the
shipping methods of the transport service. Transports came and
transports went; our hopes were dashed to earth any number of times and
it was endless weeks before our carefully prepared and holly-decked
presents finally arrived.

On New Year’s morning General MacArthur gave a reception at Malacañan
Palace. It was such an affair as is spoken of in social circles
everywhere as “the event of the season.” It was a very special event to
all the members of the Commission and their families, because not one of
us had ever been invited to the Palace before.

There was much discussion of the serious subject as to what the civil
government officials should wear at the New Year’s reception and, if
gossip can be relied upon, it came very near causing several family
riots. The men naturally inclined toward the comfort of their white
linens, but they were overcome by argument and it was eventually decreed
that they should present themselves in frock coats and silk hats. This
may sound reasonable, but it wasn’t. It was intensely funny, however,
and that helped some. A silk hat which has reposed in a box throughout a
rainy season in the Philippines is a curious object. It is not the
glossy, well turned and dignified article which a silk hat should be.
Its rim is warped, its nap is dulled and roughed beyond repair; it is
very sticky, and it has an odour all its own. In Judge Ide’s hat some
mice had made a nest and had eaten a small hole through its one-time
shiny crown, but it was the only one he had and, as silk hats are not
carried in Philippine shops, he had, perforce, to wear it.

My husband communed with himself during the process of getting into his
heavy frock coat with all its stiff and its woollen accessories,—for the
first time in seven months and in the bright white heat of a tropic
morning,—but we were finally ready and on the way, in our diminutive
Victoria behind the prancing black stallion ponies of uncertain
disposition.

When we arrived at Malacañan, quite early as we thought, we found
ourselves in a long block of carriages which moved up slowly and, one by
one, discharged their occupants under the porte-cochère of the Palace.
Considerations of rank and precedence had escaped our minds for the
moment and this was evidently a very important matter. However, we found
a capable staff of military aides who knew just where everybody
belonged, and they adopted the method of marshalling the crowds into a
room on the first floor and letting them out in the proper order of
precedence. In consequence we found a more or less annoyed throng
awaiting our arrival. We had plenty of rank, my husband being the
ranking civil officer in the Islands, but as everybody in Manila had
been invited, the process of forming the line was a long and laborious
one and many were the caustic comments of the delayed and rankless
multitude. It reminded one forcibly of similar receptions at the White
House, except that in Washington everybody knows the rules of precedence
governing diplomatic circles and recognises the necessity for following
them, while in Manila it was a departure which did not meet with full
and general approval.

General MacArthur and his staff were receiving at the head of the grand
staircase on the second floor, and, as the spacious rooms became filled
with military men in dress uniforms, with gaily attired women and
black-coated civilians, the scene was sufficiently dignified to make one
feel that a brilliant local society was an established fact. But there
was no denying that it was hot and that the Army officers in trim white
duck had the frock-coated, camphor-ball-scented and profusely perspiring
civil government officials at a disadvantage.

Nowadays—and always after that first experiment—the man in a
temperate-zone costume is a sadly conspicuous figure at a social
gathering in Manila. The accepted formal evening dress is white linen
with either a short mess jacket or a dinner coat of the usual pattern,
while for morning or afternoon affairs a man may wear anything his
laundryman can turn out for him. As a matter of fact, in the early days
in Manila women, as well as men, enjoyed emancipation from the tyranny
of clothes. It was a case of discovering how unnecessary many supposed
necessities are. There were no fashionable gowns to be had, therefore
simplicity, or a more or less rundownedness of one-time respectability,
became the fashion. There were no hat shops, so women ceased to wear
hats. We went shopping on the Escolta in the early morning hatless; we
went to luncheon parties hatless, and in the later afternoon we made our
calls and drove on the Luneta minus the millinery which is considered so
dear to a woman’s heart. I do not say that the women liked it; there
were many plaintive protests; but it was one of the crosses of their
environment which saved them numerous jealous pangs as well as much
expense. It is different now. The importer of fashionable millinery and
sumptuous garments has invaded the field and the women in Manila to-day
are about as finely gowned and hatted as they are anywhere, but I doubt
if they are as care-free and comfortable as we were in “the days of the
Empire.”

It was expected that the New Year’s reception at Malacañan was intended
to inaugurate a gay season of hospitality at the Palace, as General
MacArthur announced a dinner and reception to follow early in January.
But they were unquiet times; for various reasons there were many
postponements; then came the death of Queen Victoria, whereupon the
British community went into mourning, and, as it was deemed courteous to
observe a period of social inactivity, it was many weeks before we again
went to Malacañan.

The campaign of pacification, due to the election of McKinley, the
activity of the army, and the actual legislation and organisation work
of the Commission, was making great progress throughout the Islands and
hardly a day passed that did not bring news of the capture or surrender
of insurgent officers and forces in the provinces, while in Manila they
were being arrested and imprisoned by the hundreds. They were given an
opportunity to take the oath of allegiance and those who persisted in
their refusal to do so were banished to Guam. This vigorous policy was
having a marked effect upon the spirit of the insurrection and it was
rapidly approaching total collapse.

The peace movement was greatly assisted, too, by the activities of the
Federal party, a strong political organisation, pledged to the
acceptance of American control and American principles, which numbered
among its leaders and adherents many of the best men in the Philippines.
In its directory were Chief Justice Arellano, Don Benito Legarda, Dr.
Pardo de Tavera and General Ambrosio Flores, a one-time leader of the
insurrection.

Perhaps the most extraordinary demonstration any of us ever saw in
Manila took place on Washington’s birthday in 1901. The Commission had
already begun its long task of instituting provincial and municipal
governments and its members had just returned from a trip into the
country north of Manila where they had been received with great
enthusiasm, and where the people had shown every indication of a glad
determination to stop all hostilities and settle down to peaceful
pursuits under the representative and democratic system which the
Commission was inaugurating.

On the evening of February 20, General MacArthur gave a splendid
reception at Malacañan, where Americans and Filipinos mingled together
in perfect amity, the Filipinos being in the majority. They seemed
greatly pleased with the spirit of the occasion which served to
demonstrate in a particular manner the fact that America was in the
Philippines as a friend rather than as an arbitrary ruler; that there
was to be none of the familiar colour or race prejudice, so far as we
were concerned, in the association of the two peoples; that the best
thing to do was to acknowledge a mutual aspiration and strive for its
fulfilment in friendly co-operation; and there was a heart-lift for us
all, Americans and Filipinos alike, in the whole tone of the evening. On
the night of the 21st, the Partido Federal gave a famous dinner at a new
hotel where a French chef prepared the menu. Before this my husband had
jokingly written to Secretary Root that he thought some sort of pension
should be provided for the widows and orphans of the men who fell in
action before the fearful onslaughts of native hospitality, but at the
banquet of the Federal party there were none of those mysterious viands
to which the Commissioners had been trying to accustom themselves in the
provinces, and in consequence the quality of mutual enjoyment was not
strained, the Filipino, unlike the Japanese, being as fond of foreign
cookery as he is of his own. The speeches were all of the friendliest
character and the “dove of peace,” verily, seemed to be hovering near.

[Illustration:

  A TYPICAL FILIPINO MENU AND PLACE CARD
]

The next morning, the 22nd of February, the Federal party, many
thousands strong, marched through a flag-decked city to the Luneta where
a speakers’ stand had been erected for the celebration of the day. There
were scores of bands, each, as usual, playing its own tune in its own
way regardless of what the others were doing; the populace, in its
gayest attire, crowded in the wake of the procession; the spirit of
festivity was rampant; and altogether it was a most interesting scene.

As close as ten thousand people could get to a speakers’ stand ten
thousand people massed themselves, and they listened in respectful
silence to the words of both the American and Filipino speakers, each
one of whom made a spirited appeal for peaceful co-operation in the
solution of the problem which America had acquired through no fault or
desire of her own and which she could not, in honour, abandon. General
Wright was the American speaker of the day and the frank friendliness of
his speech was translated, paragraph by paragraph as he delivered it, by
Mr. Arthur Fergusson, the Secretary-interpreter for the Commission,
whose extraordinary command of Spanish made it possible for him not only
to translate the words themselves, but to infuse into them the poetic
fervour of the Spanish tongue. Never was Washington’s birthday so
celebrated, and it marked a new era of mutual toleration which was to
grow into sympathetic understanding disturbed only by the agitation of
the few whose aspirations were in no way in those days shared or
condoned by the many.

The method adopted by the Commission for organising provincial
governments was extremely simple. The people were instructed to send
delegates from all the towns in a province to meet the Commission on a
given date at the provincial capital. Having gathered this popular
assembly in the largest available hall Mr. Taft, or some other member of
the Commission, would proceed to read and explain the new Provincial
Code which covered every governmental function and which provided for
the appointment by the Commission of a provincial governor, a treasurer
and a secretary. It was the intention of the Commission to name a
Filipino for governor in each province, thereby giving them an immediate
opportunity for the exercise of self-government, but in several
instances they were almost unanimously petitioned by the people to
appoint to this office the American Army officer who had been in command
in the district. Considering the attitude of the Filipinos toward
military rule and their eagerness to substitute a purely civil form of
government, it was really astonishing that they should have wished to
retain any representative of the hated régime, but personality counts
for a great deal with the Filipinos, and the Army officer who displayed
tact and kindly justice in his dealings with them was sure to win for
himself a peculiar popularity.

For treasurer an American was almost invariably chosen. During Spanish
times the Filipinos had not learned much about the proper use of public
funds and they have had to be very painstakingly taught that government
money is for government purposes only. To our poignant and everlasting
shame object lessons had to be given them by the drastic punishment
meted out to certain American treasurers who were unable to resist
temptation. The penalty prescribed in Philippine law for the misuse of
public funds or the falsification of a public document is terribly
severe, and there is a little band of white men in Bilibid prison in
Manila to-day because of their venality and breach of trust. Our mission
in the Philippines is based upon the highest principles and we have
always striven to maintain a high moral tone in the government
personnel, so it is particularly painful to the small American community
when, as happened too often at first, an American went wrong.

Though the Commission proceeded with the establishment of civil
government in a conspicuously simple manner as much cannot be said of
the Filipinos. They were bent upon making the most of a rare opportunity
for the enjoyment of great and ceremonious festivity.

On the 23d of February, following the extraordinary celebration of
Washington’s birthday, the Commission, accompanied by a considerable
number of prominent Filipinos and by several of the ladies, took a
government launch and steamed across the Bay to the town of Balanga, the
capital of the province of Bataan which lies directly opposite Manila
where the sun goes down in tropic splendour behind the Meriveles
Mountains. This trip was a new experience for me and was the beginning
of my long acquaintance with Filipino hospitality.

As we approached the Bataan shore there were splashes of brilliant
colour all over the surface of the Bay, which, on nearer view, turned
out to be the decorations of a great fleet of _bancas_ coming out to
meet us. There must have been a hundred or more and, while they were of
all sizes, some of them were large enough to hold twenty and thirty
rowers. The _banca_ is a long, narrow dugout which usually looks as if
it were just about to sink. Some of these had outriggers, some had not,
but each and every one of them was loaded to capacity, and each was
covered with the most gorgeous decorations. Bunting and paper flowers of
every hue were mixed with long palm leaves and branches of bamboo and
everything in the nature of an ornament that could possibly be used,
while from every angle and at every point fluttered small American
flags, some of them homemade and only approximately correct. Then there
were two huge flat affairs with decorated awnings over them which we
found were nothing less than rafts prepared for our own use, the water
in the little harbour being too shallow for our big steam launch. These
rafts were made of split bamboo flooring lashed to the tops of large
_bancas_ and, though they looked exceedingly unsafe, we found they would
hold as many as could stand upon them without being pushed over the
edge.

In ten minutes this gay and unusual fleet had surrounded us; the rafts
came alongside and over our rails clambered the reception committee, a
half dozen Filipinos in more or less nondescript, heavy black clothes
with silk hats! Where these garments came from I have no idea. Most of
the hats looked like heirlooms, just as the silk hats of our own
husbands looked, but the chief concern of their owners seemed to be
their protection. Never have I seen silk hats so cautiously handled.

Having got safely aboard the launch each man went through a deliberate
process of straightening himself out and carefully adjusting his attire
before he advanced to the stern of the launch where we waited to receive
him. Then there were some set speeches of welcome in which the chief
sentiment seemed to be that never had the province of Bataan been so
highly honoured and that, therefore, it and all it contained was, with
feelings inexpressible, laid at the feet of the honourable Commission.
Mr. Fergusson translated the flowers and figures of oratory and all the
soaring flights of sentimental generosity into literal English, then,
with equal solemnity and impressiveness, he rendered Mr. Taft’s matter
of fact, though cordial, replies into a marvellous flow of Spanish
eloquence.

[Illustration:

  TRIUMPHAL ARCH AT BATAAN
]

This formality disposed of, the reception committee invited us to step
upon the pavilioned raft and be wafted ashore. It sounds like a
dignified proceeding, but of course it was not. We had to climb over the
rails of the launch and, more or less, slide to a secure footing on the
frail floor of the curious craft. Contrary to my secret expectations it
kept afloat and we were soon landed at a little fishing village down on
the beach, where Army ambulances waited to take us to the town of
Balanga, a mile inland. Just outside of Balanga we passed under a great
bamboo arch, the sort of thing the Filipinos erect and ornament with
great skill and ingenuity. This one was so thickly decorated, however,
with small American flags that little of its intricate frame-work was
visible. A piece of white bunting stretched across the top of it bore,
in large letters, the inscription: “Glory Honor to the Commission.”

We drove into the town and found the place _en fete_. I never saw so
many American flags in one place in my life. Four thousand of them had
been bought in Manila for the occasion; and four thousand flags go a
long way in decorating a small provincial town. There was not much of
the town left uncovered.

When we got to the provincial building where the meeting was to be held,
we found all the delegates gathered from the different villages a-tiptoe
in an atmosphere of intense excitement. Bataan had never been a rich
province and we discovered that few of the Filipinos understood Spanish.
They spoke only Tagalog. This was due to the fact that the province had
been for generations under the control of the Dominican Friars who did
not believe in encouraging the natives to learn Spanish. In consequence,
all the speeches had to be translated from English to Spanish, from
Spanish to Tagalog, and vice versa. Felipe Calderón, the Manila lawyer
who handled the San José College case for the People, acted as Tagalog
interpreter, and I have often wondered just how much of the familiar
Spanish hyperbole was convertible into the phrases of that primitive
language. It made the proceedings very long and tedious, but we sat
through them and they finally came to an end with much cheering for the
newly appointed officials.

The Filipinos were greatly pleased at having the Commissioners bring
their wives and daughters along. It was new to them and they were not
slow to grasp its significance. Much to the disgust of the military
authorities present, we all shook hands with everybody and assumed the
friendliest kind of attitude. That the Army officers did not approve of
our cordiality toward the Filipinos can hardly be wondered at. They had
been subjected to the risks of a campaign of ambush and assassination
for many months, and even then they were trying to bring in a band of
about one hundred and fifty insurrectos, with as many rifles, who were
hiding in the Meriveles Mountains and preying upon the people; so, it
was natural for them to think that a policy of disdain and severity was
the only one suited to the apparent unreliability and deceitfulness of
the native. However, these same officers very shortly admitted to us,
though rather unwillingly, that our mode of dealing with the people had
had an extraordinary effect on the general tone in Bataan.

It was about this time that President McKinley communicated through
Secretary Root the intention of the Administration to abolish the
military governorship and to install a civil Governor under the power of
the President as Commander-in-Chief, and to create civil departments
also. When Mr. Taft received a cable from Secretary Root advising him of
this fact, he went to see General MacArthur for the purpose of
discussing with him the mode of procedure and to get his ideas as to how
and when the transfer of power should be made.

The General had begun to look upon the work of the Commission from a
somewhat less prejudiced angle and was by this time freely admitting
that the establishment of provincial and municipal governments was
having a good effect. He, of course, did not wish to surrender his power
as military governor and remain in the Islands in a less important
position, but he thought somebody would soon be named to succeed him and
that the proper time for the transfer was after his successor arrived.
Mr. Taft was going, with the other members of the Commission, on a long
organising trip through the southern islands, and he thought he could
not be ready for the adjustment of affairs before the end of June, so it
was decided that the civil Governor should be inaugurated on the 4th of
July, and my husband soon received assurances that he would be asked to
serve in that capacity.



                              CHAPTER VIII
                            AN HISTORIC TRIP


The Philippine Islands as mere territory do not seem to have impressed
themselves very forcibly upon the general American mind, and the average
person one talks with really has but a vague conception of their
importance as regards number and area. There are enthusiasts who do not
hesitate to declare for the edification of wondering friends that there
are more than three thousand islands in the group, but it is necessary
to explain that a vast majority of these are mere dots upon the map not
to be considered in the sum total of habitable area. And yet the
archipelago is one of the finest on earth and not much smaller in point
of arable land than the whole Japanese island empire with its fifty-odd
millions of inhabitants.

It is a rather widely distributed territory and its population, some
seven millions six hundred thousand in number, comprises a variety of
peoples, each of which has its own language and its own traditions,
though all Christian Filipinos are much alike in general
characteristics.

Personally to superintend the establishment of civil government
throughout the Islands at a time when many of the people were still in
sympathy with armed resistance to our authority was a tremendous task
for the Commission to undertake, but it was thought that only through
direct contact could anything like sympathetic understanding be
obtained. Tranquillity had, as speedily as possible, to be restored, and
while the ungentle persuasion of armed force continued for some time to
be a necessity, the methods adopted by the civil officials never failed
to make a visible and lasting impression.

It was decided in the beginning that the ladies should accompany the
Commissioners on their long organising trip through the southern islands
and the success of our visit to Bataan proved to us that as members of
the governmental party we could make ourselves distinctly useful.

We wanted to get away much earlier than we did but the exigencies of the
still active military operations made it impossible for the Commanding
General to supply us with a transport, so it was not until the tenth of
March that we started out on what proved to be one of the most unique
expeditions of my life.

It begins to get very hot in the Philippines in March and this being our
first “hot season” in the Islands we felt it particularly. It is always
warm enough but there is a variety in the temperature which one soon
begins to appreciate. From November to February it is almost always
delightful, just warm enough; and sometimes, in the evenings, cool
enough for light wraps. But in March the heat becomes intense and not
until the rains begin in June or July can anything pleasant truthfully
be said about the climate.

However, this southern island trip was not a pleasure jaunt and it was
of such historic interest that none of us was willing, out of
consideration for personal comfort, to forego the privilege of making
it.

General MacArthur assigned to the Commission for the southern trip the
transport _Sumner_, which contained sufficient cabin space to
accommodate in comfort a large party. Besides all the ladies in the
civil government, the Commission had invited some newspaper men and a
number of prominent Filipinos who were pledged to the restoration of
peace under American control. Among them were representatives of all the
peoples in the southern islands to be visited. Then, too, we all took
our children. We had to; and it was fortunate for us that they were such
experienced and adaptable little people else they might have proved a
great nuisance in such a mixed party and on a trip where we were to stop
at twenty-odd different towns and attend innumerable meetings,
_banquetes_ and _bailes_. But, as it was, they gave us little trouble.
Mrs. Moses’ little daughter, who had just come out from San Francisco,
my daughter Helen and my son Robert, Mr. Fergusson’s son Arthur and
young Jack Branagan, were all about the same age, and they never tired
of devising games that could be played around such parts of the decks as
were not infested with grown-ups. Then, to while away the hours when
their elders were attending ceremonies on shore, they explored bays and
rivers in a sailboat which was rigged out for them by Captain Lyman, of
the _Sumner_, a most fatherly man who seemed to enjoy this unusual
opportunity to indulge his love for children. On the beaches they
collected an infinite variety of shells, corals and malodorous marine
curiosities, but these they kept on the lower decks where they could
enjoy them in peace. Charlie was, of course, the ship’s baby. He was
younger than either of the Worcester children and, I am afraid, somewhat
less well behaved. He scorned their rather quiet amusements and led a
strenuous and independent existence which gave me some uneasiness. He
rushed around over the ship with the utmost carelessness, delivering
orders in a strange jargon to his little Filipino nurse, who was always
rushing after him just far enough behind to be utterly useless in case
anything should happen to him. It was a certainty that should he fall
overboard she would reach the rail just in time to see him sink. Some of
the deck rails were low, but strange to say he came through without
accident. I think Charlie must have acquired some of the surefootedness
of a cat. He had been twice around the world before he was eight years
old, and that he managed to grow up into an unscarred and quite decorous
young man was certainly not due to natural caution on his part nor to
over-restraint on ours.

[Illustration:

  FILIPINO MEMBERS OF THE ORGANISING PARTY ENJOYING AFTERNOON REPOSE ON
    THE DECK OF THE “SUMNER”
]

It was an interesting party gathered on the _Sumner_. Among others were
the Atkinsons. Mr. Atkinson was the Superintendent of Public Instruction
who had recently come out from Springfield, Massachusetts, and who was
making this trip for the purpose of seeing what steps should or could be
taken to introduce a system of public instruction in a practically
schoolless land. The Commission had appropriated just as much for the
establishment of public schools as the treasury could spare, this being
the natural American thing to do under the circumstances, and no time
was to be lost in getting down to practical work. And, I should like to
note, that in no enterprise which America has undertaken in the
Philippines have we received such enthusiastic support and co-operation
from the Filipinos as in this. That they were tremendously alive to the
value of the educational privileges offered to them is proved by the
phenomenal success attained by the public school system which was
introduced. District schools, village and town schools, the high school
and the normal school are to-day as much a cherished part of Philippine
life as such institutions are a part of the great “American idea” in the
United States. And in addition to these a University has been founded
which promises to become one of the finest institutions of learning in
the whole East. Whatever may be said about the American Constitution
there can be no dispute about the fact that education follows the flag.

The Filipinos in our party, who were invited to go in order that they
might give the Commission information and advice and also, in some
measure, explain to their own compatriots the intentions of the American
Government, included Chief Justice Arellano, the two Supreme Court
Judges, Llorente and Araneta, and the originators of the Federal Party,
Don Benito Legarda, Doctor Pardo de Tavera and General Flores. The
Federal Party expected to organise in the far provinces and it was hoped
this would have a healthy effect on insular politics. There were about
sixty of us in all and I think we must have seemed rather a formidable
host to some of the nervous reception committees that were forced to
encounter us.

It was all wonderfully interesting. Our first stop was at Lucena in the
Province of Tayabas. We arrived there in the late afternoon so we had to
lie at anchor until next morning, but while the daylight lasted we gazed
eagerly at the shore through our field glasses and were astonished to
see the crowds of Filipinos not only lining the beach but wading in
throngs out into the Bay, as far as they safely could. It was as if they
had decided to walk out to meet us. And the town was decorated,
decorated magnificently. There were bamboo arches a-flutter with flags
and flags flying everywhere, to say nothing of bunting and palm leaves
and myriads of gay paper streamers.

Bright and early the next morning the reception committee came out in a
steam launch, accompanied by Colonel Gardiner, the American Army officer
in command of the garrison. The Filipinos, immaculate little
ex-insurrectos to a man, proudly climbed the gangway, stopped to adjust
their attire, then proceeded to bid us welcome with the utmost grace.
Their spokesman made the usual cordial speech, which Mr. Fergusson
solemnly interpreted. He laid at our feet everything to which he or the
town of Lucena had any claim, and assured us that the honour of our
visit was most deeply appreciated by the entire community; then he and
his companions stood smiling before us while Mr. Fergusson turned my
husband’s simple words of thanks and appreciation into Spanish metaphor
and hyperbole.

I have often thought that America never could have won the friendship of
the Filipinos if it hadn’t been for Mr. Arthur Fergusson’s clever
tongue. My husband’s smile and frank geniality accomplished much, but
his interpreter’s suavity struck a deeper and more familiar chord and
together they created harmony. They were a remarkable pair as they stood
side by side. Neither of them weighed less than three hundred pounds,
but Mr. Taft was blond and ruddy, Anglo-Saxon no less in appearance than
in manner and speech, while Mr. Fergusson was dark and rather dashing
and seemed naturally to assume the lofty mien of a Spaniard when he
spoke the beautiful Spanish tongue. Mr. Fergusson became Executive
Secretary of the Islands when Civil Government was established and
continued in that office until his death about six years ago. His loss
to the men who were then doing America’s work in the Philippines was
incalculable and the whole community, Filipinos and Americans alike,
joined in the warmest tributes to his memory that have ever been paid to
an American in the Islands.

When we arrived at the landing in Lucena we found a motley throng of
vehicles awaiting us, and were greeted by a roar of vociferous speech
from the _cocheros_ which sounded like imprecations, but which turned
out to be the Filipino equivalent for the deafening “Cab, lady! Cab,
sir!” with which travellers are welcomed at so many American railway
stations.

Mr. Taft and I, who seemed, in the opinions of our hosts, to be the only
persons of real importance present, were ceremoniously escorted to a
diminutive Victoria decorated with flowers, while the rest of the party
indiscriminately clambered into the nearest conveyances. Then started a
mad race down an execrable road, where the holes and ruts were so filled
with dust that there was no way of foreseeing or preparing for the
bumps. Our carriage, being a sedate “flower parade” all by itself, was
soon left far behind by the sportier two wheel vehicles, and when we
arrived at the Municipal Building, where the meeting was to be held,
confusion reigned. I have no doubt that several private secretaries had
been greeted as the honourable “Presidente del Commission,” but if so,
their fleeting honours detracted nothing from the welcome we received.

The streets were crowded with men, women and children waving flags and
shrilly cheering, and just in front of the hall were drawn up two
Filipino bands dressed in gorgeous, heavy uniforms decorated with such
scraps of gold lace as they had been able to procure. Together they
struck up the “Star Spangled Banner,” but they kept together for just
about two bars, each leader having his own fixed idea as to the proper
_tempo_. One band finished several bars ahead of the other, and
immediately, without so much as a lowering of instruments, it hurled
itself into “A Hot Time in the Old Town To-night,” whereupon the uplift
of “Don’t you hear those bells go ding-a-ling” collided merrily with the
solemn sentiment of “Long may it wave!” Yet nobody laughed. We were
cultivating a sobriety of demeanour because we knew we were dealing with
a people whose ears heard not and whose eyes saw not as we hear and see.

The meeting which followed our spectacular reception was exceedingly
interesting. The questions of the Commissioners elicited the information
that Tayabas had been completely pacified for more than a year, although
the surrounding provinces, Cavite, Laguna and Batangas, were among the
most unruly in the Archipelago. This happy state of affairs seems to
have been produced by Colonel Gardiner, in command of the garrison, who
had displayed great tact in dealing with the peacefully inclined
Filipinos and absolute military rigidity in his attitude toward the
insurrectos. That his methods had gained popular approval was evidenced
by the fact that every town in the province petitioned the Commission to
make him Governor. The requisite permission to do this having been
obtained from General MacArthur, who, as Military Governor, had
specially to detail army officers for such service, it was done amid
general rejoicing made violent by brassy discords from the jubilant
bands which nearly drove me out of the building.

There were many speeches and Mr. Taft, as usual, read and explained the
Provincial Code to the assembly. After I had listened almost daily for
more than six weeks to that dry-as-dust document I was sure that I could
repeat it backward if I tried. Mr. Taft finished his speech with a neat
little summing up of conditions in general,—mellifluously embellished by
Mr. Fergusson,—then he introduced Chief Justice Arellano as the ablest
lawyer in the Islands and a man whom any country would be proud to own;
which was literally true. The Chief Justice spoke for some time,
earnestly, appealingly, and with great dignity, and he was listened to
with reverence. I had hoped that his speech would end the proceedings,
but this was only the beginning of my experience with the Filipino love
of oratory and I never thereafter entertained any optimistic ideas with
regard to time limits.

But, as all things must, the meeting came to an end and, stretching our
weary bodies, we accepted an invitation to view the town. Our progress
was triumphal. In our flower-decked Victoria, with the municipal
_presidente_ on the little seat in front of us, Mr. Taft and I moved
slowly along, one band in front of us blaring out “A Hot Time in the Old
Town” with all the force of its lungs, and the other behind us doing its
best to make itself heard and appreciated in a wholly original rendition
of “Ta-ra-ra-ra-boom-de-ay.” Then came the other members of our party in
nondescript vehicles which jolted and creaked.

Speaking of Filipino bands, it may be thought that my partial
description of those in Lucena is exaggerated. Not at all. There are
more bands in the Philippines, perhaps, than any other one thing. The
Filipinos as a people are extremely musical and, in many instances, have
proved themselves capable of reaching a high point of musical
proficiency, but in the early days of American occupation a vast
majority of the musicians were the rankest amateurs who played “by ear”
only. They had never been taught, but they could play, after a fashion,
anything that anybody could whistle, sing or pick out for them on any
instrument. They had listened to the American regimental bands and they
had made selection for their own repertoires of such pieces as were
easiest to play, hence the popularity of “A Hot Time in the Old Town,”
“Ta-ra-ra-ra-boom-de-ay,” “Won’t You Come Home, Bill Bailey” and things
of like character. They did not know the words, or the “sentiment” of
the songs; they knew only the tunes, and these they played at all times,
for occasions either solemn or gay. Of my own experience I can testify
that “A Hot Time in the Old Town” makes a perfectly good funeral march
when reduced to a measure sufficiently lugubrious.

It didn’t take us long to see the town and when my ears could endure the
discords no longer I explained to the pleasant little _presidente_ that
I thought it was necessary for the ladies to return to the transport for
a rest before it was time to dress for the evening festivities. He
protested that the town was ours, that his house and everything in it
belonged solely to us, but I was backed up by my husband and the ladies
finally were permitted to go out to the _Sumner_ for a short respite. No
such luck for the men. They had to attend a prodigious luncheon, an
afternoon _banquete_ really, and then continue, for the rest of the day,
their interviews with Lucena citizens and American Army officers. And,
be it remembered, it was insufferably hot.

The _banquete_ and _baile_ that evening were typical Filipino
entertainments, novelties to me then and intensely interesting. It was a
procession, a meeting, a _banquete_ and a _baile_ every day for nearly
seven weeks unless by a happy turn of events it became necessary for us
to sail for our next port in the afternoon instead of at midnight as we
generally did. Under such circumstances, if any special entertainments
had been prepared for the evening, such as torchlight processions,
illuminations, or fireworks, they were duly produced in broad daylight,
thereby losing much in general effect no doubt, but nothing in their
proof of friendly intentions.

Processions and meetings may be just processions and meetings, but
_banquetes_ and _bailes_ are not just banquets and balls, and that is
why I always refer to them by their Spanish names.

We arrived at the _banquete_ in Lucena at seven o’clock and found, in a
great open room in a public building of some sort, a long table laden
with mysteries. In the centre was a tremendous ornament, made entirely
of toothpicks, built up to represent a flower garden. Whoever made it
was a genius with both imagination and delicacy of touch. All along both
sides of the table were strange, highly ornamental and formidable
looking dishes which were evidently meant to be eaten. I didn’t know
what they were, but having acquired a cosmopolitan attitude toward food
I was not at all dismayed. My chief concern related to the fact that a
Filipino host expects one to eat at least a little of everything that is
served and through endless courses of elaborately prepared meats one’s
appetite naturally becomes jaded.

The most important and distinguished Filipinos did not sit down at table
with us. It is _el costumbre del pais_ for the Filipino host to wait on
his guests, to hover about and see that he enjoys what is given him, and
until one gets used to it it is most disconcerting. The _presidentes_
and _fiscals_ and generals and other _illustrados_ were not as skilful
as trained servants and I found myself leaning this way and that in
momentary expectation that one of them, in his excitement, would
accidentally slip some sticky mixture down my back. There were speeches
of course; there always are; and then more speeches, but we had to get
to the _baile_, so they were not too long drawn out.

The _baile_ was given in the Municipal Building where the meeting of the
morning was held, and when we arrived we found the hall quite filled
with guests. The Filipino women didn’t display so many jewels and fine
garments in those days as now because, in certain quarters, the
insurrectos were still levying tribute, but the girls and women, many of
them quite pretty, were very gay in long, trailing calico skirts and
_jusi_, _sinamay_ or _pina camisas_, while the men were attired in all
manner of garments from calico and white linen to black cloth.

The men are nearly all excellent dancers, but the women are hampered
somewhat in the ordinary “round dances” by their foot gear. They don’t
wear shoes,—nor stockings either. At least, they didn’t in those days.
They thrust their bare toes into little slippers called _chinelas_ and
_cuchos_, which look for all the world like fancy bed-slippers. There
are two kinds: _cuchos_ being considered very “dressy” and having heels
which clatter on the floor, while _chinelas_ are heelless and make a
scuffing, shuffling noise.

The first dance of the evening at any _baile_ is the _rigodon_ which is
really the national dance of the Philippines. I am not going to try to
describe it because I know I can’t, though I have danced it hundreds of
times. It is the real ceremony on such an occasion. It can be likened to
an old-fashioned quadrille, but the square is made up of as many couples
opposite each other as there is space and there are couples. There are a
number of graceful and somewhat intricate but stately figures. It is a
dance unique and, as far as I know, confined to the Philippine Islands.
I’m afraid we made but a poor display in our first attempts at the
_rigodon_, but by dint of watching others night after night both my
husband and I became most proficient at it. I always had for my partner
the most conspicuous _illustrado_ in any community, while Mr. Taft
conferred the honour of his attendance upon the lady of highest rank.
This was important as a recognition of the established formalities.

[Illustration:

  THE SULTAN OF SULU BOARDING THE “SUMNER,” FOLLOWED BY MR. ARTHUR
    FERGUSSON, SPANISH SECRETARY TO THE COMMISSION
]

We left Lucena pretty much exhausted and slightly aghast at the prospect
of sixty consecutive days of such strenuous festivities. Our route on
the map lay like a tangled thread throughout the archipelago, and its
immediate trend was toward the Equator, further and further south. Every
point marked as a stopping place meant a full programme of business and
festivities, but, hot as it was, not one of us willingly would have
turned back. There was strong fascination in the very names of the
places we were bound for.

First came Boak on the island of Marinduque. Who wouldn’t endure a
little discomfort for the sake of seeing Boak? This province could not
yet be organised because it was not sufficiently peaceful for the
successful introduction of civil government. The Commissioners, after
endless interviews with Army officers and with leading Filipinos who
were eager for the restoration of normal conditions, promised to return
to the province on the way back to Manila and complete its organisation
if, by that time, certain stipulations should have been complied with.
This meant the bringing in of a couple of hundred insurrecto rifles and
the gathering together of properly accredited representatives of the
people from all parts of the island. We left behind us a disappointed
but a determined town, and when we returned nearly seven weeks later we
found such a difference as proved the wisdom of delay.

The Commissioners were really walking in the dark. Only through personal
investigation could they learn the exact conditions in any town or
province and this investigation had always to precede any definite
action on their part. This made the proceedings long and arduous for
them and drew the days out endlessly for the rest of us. Romblon,
Masbate, Iloilo, Bacólod; each with its distinct problem, each with its
own impassioned orators, and each offering boundless hospitality; we
left them all in better condition, we hoped, than we found them and,
certainly, we carried away from each in turn a feeling of great
friendliness and gratitude for the courtesies they so enthusiastically
extended.

From Bacólod, in oriental Negros, we set our course straight south to
Jolo, to the Sulu Islands, to the realm of the comic opera sultan, and
we woke up one brilliant morning to find ourselves in the prettiest
harbour imaginable and in the midst of scenes which we could not believe
belonged to the Philippine world. We were in Moroland. Straight before
us, in the curve of the beautiful bay, lay a little white city,
surrounded by bastioned walls which looked age-old, and backed by soft
green hills and groves of tall cocoanut palms. A high white watch tower
at the end of a long pier reminded one of piratical days and of Spain’s
never-ending troubles with her Mohammedan subjects. Off to the right,
against the farthest shore, was the strangest collection of habitations
I had ever seen. To be told that the Moros live on the water is to
imagine them living in boats, but these were houses built far out in the
water, perched up on frail wooden stilts and joined together by crooked
and rickety bamboo bridges.

The harbour was full of curious small craft; high prowed and beautifully
carved war junks, long, graceful _praos_ and slender canoes with bamboo
outriggers, nearly all carrying sails of fantastic design and brilliant
hues. Indeed, there was colour everywhere. Everything afloat was
decorated in gaudy silks and pennants, the American flag predominating,
while all the Moros who wore anything except a loin cloth were attired
in costumes which were lively and strikingly original. These were made,
for the most part, of rich silks of native weave in stripes or plaids of
vivid, crude greens, reds and yellows, and from neck to ankle the more
elegant ones were so tight that one wondered how they stood the strain.
Around his waist each man wore a bright silk sash under which was thrust
a long cruel looking knife in an ornamental and curiously shaped
scabbard.

The picturesque fleet quickly surrounded the _Sumner_ and while we
watched the lithe, naked boys diving into the clear depths of the bay
for coins that were thrown overboard for the purpose of testing their
prowess, the American Army officers came aboard to bid us welcome to
Jolo.

They explained that the Sultan of Sulu had given them some diplomatic
difficulties which, they were glad to say, they had been able to
overcome. He had at first decided to play the haughty monarch and to
extend a royal invitation to the American officials to pay their
respects to him at his “palace.” But a little reasoning had convinced
him that the Commissioners were the accredited representatives of the
President of the United States whose sovereignty he acknowledged and
that it was therefore his duty to call on them, so, it was announced, he
was on his way to the landing where the officers’ launch waited to bring
him out to the _Sumner_.

Several large war junks carrying different chiefs, or _dattos_, preceded
the imperial visitor and these men came aboard without waiting for His
Majesty. We found them extremely entertaining. They were by far the most
picturesque figures we had seen, and utterly unlike Filipinos. They were
of a different build, lithe, active and graceful, with a free and
defiant gaze which offered a strong contrast to the soft-eyed modesty of
the Christian tribes. In their sashes they all carried long knives
called _barongs_, _campiláns_ and _krises_, which Mr. Worcester induced
some of them to exhibit to our delighted eyes. They were of the most
exquisite workmanship and design, inlaid, some of them, with gold and
silver, and with hilts of hardwood beautifully carved.

Finally the officers’ launch put out from the dock and we knew that the
Sultan was approaching. As he came alongside the _Sumner_ he received a
salute of seventeen guns while we all stood by holding our ears and
stiffening our nerves against the deafening shock. We were expecting
some one similar in appearance to our friends the _dattos_, except that
we were sure he would be accoutred in three times as much barbaric
splendour. Fancy our disappointment then, when there emerged from the
low awning of the launch a figure quite commonplace; a very short, very
black little man in a heavy uniform of black cloth embroidered in gold
braid, not unlike the uniform of a British Consul. He was awkward and
homely and he had shiny black teeth; that is how I remember him. He had
two attendants who served only to accentuate his own insignificance. The
Commission got nothing out of him either. He had none of the polish and
gentlemanly manners of the Filipino leaders, and conversation of any
kind with him was found to be extremely difficult. Almost the only
interesting remark he made was to invite the ladies of our party to call
on his many wives, a thing I should have greatly enjoyed, but which was
impossible because the Sultan’s “palace” was back over the hills, on the
other side of the island, a long way from Jolo.

[Illustration:

  A MORO DATU WITH HIS RETINUE, AND THE FAVORITE WIFE OF A DATU WITH HER
    MAIDS-IN-WAITING
]

The problem of the government of the territory inhabited by the Moros in
a measure adjusted itself. These Mohammedans have always been unruly and
independent and were never wholly conquered by the Spaniards, and they
absolutely refused, as they have since continued to do, to be placed
under Filipino control. So it was decided to detach them from the
general organisation and to place them under a semi-military system with
an American Army officer of high rank in charge in the dual capacity of
Governor and Commanding General of Troops in the Moro Province. This
system was developed to a point where a high state of efficiency
obtained in the government to the complete satisfaction of nearly
everybody. To solve the problem of _juramentado_, or religious fanatic
outbreaks, a general order for the disarmament of Moros had to be
enforced, but only a comparatively small number of natives took part in
the armed resistance. For all of them it was hard, no doubt, to have to
surrender their beloved and time-honoured weapons, but the wisest among
them recognised the necessity of obedience for the sake of the general
good. If this had not been so it would have been vastly more difficult
to make the order effective. These wise ones are to-day everywhere busy
upholding the American policy of establishing markets and schools and
honest trade relations, and in preaching to their people that, for the
first time in their history, they are being fairly and justly dealt
with. They cling to American protection with determined faith, telling
us in plain words that if we leave them they will fight their
neighbours. So, whatever we may do with the Philippine Islands we cannot
abandon the Moros, and this adds a grave complication to our Philippine
problem.

At Jolo we received the news of the capture of Aguinaldo and his
reception by General MacArthur at Malacañan Palace. General Funston,
then a Colonel of Volunteers, was a conspicuous member of a small
company of Army officers known locally as “the suicide squad,” who
risked their lives in one exploit after another with the utmost
unconcern, not to say glee, so we were not surprised at anything he
might do. But there was a real thrill in the story of his daring venture
into the remote and isolated camp of the insurrecto general and
Dictator, and we cheered his performance with heartfelt enthusiasm,
though our ardour was somewhat dampened by doubts as to what the
arch-conspirator would do in Manila. General MacArthur was not a
politician; he was a soldier,—an officer and a gentleman,—and in his
treatment of his captured enemy he was not likely to take into
consideration the nature of the people with whom he was dealing.

However, that story has been told, well and often. We know that General
Aguinaldo also was “an officer and a gentleman,” proving himself worthy
of all the courtesy extended to him and accepting defeat with great
dignity. He is the most striking figure in the Philippines even to-day,
though one only hears of him as a peaceful and unambitious farmer in his
native province of Cavite whence he emerges only on rare occasions to be
present at some important social event in Manila where, among Americans
in particular, he is most highly regarded. But, it must be remembered
that at the time of his capture the Islands were still in a state far
from satisfactory; that he had lieutenants in all parts of the
archipelago endeavouring, under his orders, and by methods not counted
as “civilised,” to keep alive the spirit of rebellion, and that he had
an extraordinary genius for conspiracy and organisation. So it cannot be
wondered at that my husband was deeply concerned and that he wished he
were back in Manila where he could keep his large but gentle hand upon
the delicate situation.

From Jolo we sailed to Zamboanga, capital of the Moro province, and
thence to Cottabato. At Zamboanga we met an entirely different class of
Moros, more refined, better educated and less spectacular than those in
the Sulu Islands, and were entertained by the American Army officers in
the ancient Fortress del Pilar, which still bears the marks of many a
conflict between the Moros and the Spaniards. We met here two very
interesting men, Datto Mandi, a Moro, and Midel, a leading Filipino.
Mandi was said to be, and looked, part Spaniard, though he denied the
Spanish blood. He was the chief of a tribe of many thousands of people
and wielded a wide influence which the American Government never sought
to curtail. He was a good business man and intensely loyal to the
Americans, giving substantial demonstrations of his loyalty whenever
opportunity offered. He told the Commission what has since proved to be
the truth about Moro customs relative to slavery, the administration, of
justice and other matters, and displayed, altogether, a genuinely
friendly and helpful attitude. Midel, the Filipino, was himself made a
_datto_ by Mandi and seemed inordinately proud of his rank. He was an
odd individual with a doubtful record behind him. Sometime before we met
him he had sent his son to be educated at the University of California,
and it was he who delivered the province over to the American troops as
soon as they arrived, having previously disposed of a couple of
insurgent rivals of his own race who attempted to keep it out of
American hands.

At Cottabato, a long day’s sailing from Zamboanga across Illana Bay, we
met the Moros who inhabit the valley of the Rio Grande del Mindanao, a
large and sinister looking river. We communicated with these people
through their _dattos_, Piang and Ali. Piang is the most powerful
_datto_ in the province. He is the son of a Chinese carpenter and a
common Moro woman, and he won his position through shrewdness,
generosity to his people and native ability. Ordinarily a peaceful
conservative he was not always at peace with Ali, who is inherently
warlike and a _datto_ of royal descent, but a couple of American Army
officers, Colonel Brett and Major MacMahon, in charge of the post at
Cottabato, not only adjusted their differences but induced the royal Ali
to marry the commoner Piang’s daughter. Colonel Brett was Ali’s “best
man,” while Major MacMahon stood sponsor for the bride. There are
American Army officers who have seen strange service in our Far Eastern
possessions.

A few years after the time of which I write a daughter of Datto Mandi
was married at Iligan in northern Mindanao and, to quote from Foreman’s
“History of the Philippines”: “Several American officers were present on
the occasion, accompanied by a Spanish half caste who acted as their
interpreter. The assembled guests were having a merry time when suddenly
the festivities were interrupted by the intrusion of a _juramentado_
Moro fanatic, who sprang forward with his _campilán_ and at one blow
almost severed the interpreter’s head from his body. Then he turned his
attention to the other natives, mortally wounded two, and cut gashes in
several others before he fell dead before the revolver shots fired by
the American officers. After the dead and wounded were carried away and
the pools of blood were mopped up, the wedding ceremony was proceeded
with and the hymeneal festival was resumed without further untoward
incident.”

We were very fortunate that, disturbed as conditions were, no “untoward
incident” of this nature occurred to mar the serenity of our first great
trip through the Islands.

To illustrate Datto Piang’s intense desire to establish his status as a
loyal friend of the United States Government I think I must relate, in
part, the conversation my husband had with him in regard to the gutta
percha industry. The forests in the Rio Grande Valley and around Lake
Lanao, in the northern part of the island were thought to be almost
inexhaustible in their supply of gutta percha trees, and Piang was found
to be a large dealer in the product. But inquiry elicited the
information that the most primitive methods were employed in gathering
the gum and that every year thousands of trees were destroyed, no idea
of scientific conservation ever having entered the heads of the Moros.
Mr. Taft asked Piang whether if we sent him an expert who knew how to
have the trees treated he would undertake to enforce regulations which
such an expert would frame. He said he acknowledged the sovereignty of
the United States Government and held himself subject to its orders,
everyone of which he would obey. Moreover, he would make all the other
_dattos_ obey the same orders whether they were willing to do so or not.
Then Mr. Taft explained that the United States Government might desire
to lay a cable from San Francisco to the Philippines and that one of the
great items of expense in such an enterprise was the gutta percha. He
was merely trying to impress upon Piang’s mind the immense value of his
product and the necessity for its proper handling, but Piang immediately
offered to make the United States a present of all the gutta percha it
needed for a Pacific cable, declaring that all he wanted was a note from
the authorities indicating the amount required. He would see that it was
promptly gathered and delivered. Mr. Taft then told him that the United
States always paid for whatever it received from any person, whether
subject to its sovereignty or not, whereupon Piang declared that,
anyway, he preferred to sell his gutta percha to the United States, and
at a much lower price, too, than he was receiving from the Chinese
dealers. He is just a clever, crafty Chinaman himself, is Datto Piang,
but an interesting figure. After a thorough investigation of Cottabato
and a right royal entertainment provided by a number of gorgeously
attired _dattos_ and sultans, of greater or less degree, who had
gathered in the town to greet us, and gaze in wide-eyed curiosity upon
us, we went on our way around the great island of Mindanao.

At Davao we saw thousands of acres of the highest hemp in the world, and
a number of beautiful bead-bedecked hill tribes who had come down into
coast civilisation for the purpose, no doubt, of seeing what we looked
like.

These hill tribes are very interesting people. They are, perhaps, more
picturesque than any of the other non-Christians, and they have
developed to a fine point the art of making bead embroidered clothing.
So beautiful and so unusual are these garments that the ladies in the
party, forgetting everything else, made a grand rush to purchase some of
them from the various tribesmen. Our eagerness, indeed, had finally to
be restrained in order that attention might be given to the efforts of
the Commission to enlighten the people as to our mission, but having
patiently awaited the termination of business we returned to our search
for the bead-work, only to find that the finer specimens could not by
any process of cajolery be secured. Money meant nothing to the hillmen
and we had no substitutes in the way of gewgaws to offer them. The only
one of us who succeeded in getting a really good suit was Miss Anne Ide,
and her success was the result of a curious incident. She met a
chieftain gorgeously arrayed, and at a venture tried upon him the Samoan
greeting and a Samoan song which she had learned in her childhood when
her father was Chief Justice of the Samoan Islands. To her great
surprise the Bogobo answered and seemed greatly pleased. He had already
had conveyed to him the fact that the only thing the ladies wanted was
bead clothing, so he indicated to Miss Ide that he would present to her
his coat and pants, and without further ado, and much to her
astonishment, he began to divest himself of these garments which she
accepted with delight. The incident awakened natural curiosity on our
part as to the relation between the Polynesian language of Samoa and the
vernacular of the hill tribes around the Davao gulf.

From Davao we proceeded on our journey around Mindanao, sailing out into
the open Pacific and up to the province of Surigao in the northeast
corner of the island.

[Illustration:

  PICTURESQUE BEAD-BEDECKED BOGOBOS OF THE DAVAO COUNTRY
]

The town of Surigao lies six miles up a swamp-bound, sluggish river and
we experienced, as we so often did in the whole course of the trip, a
sense of being in uncharted and therefore dangerous waters. We embarked
in a launch when the tide was high and had no trouble in getting up to
the village, but we were earnestly entreated by the officer in charge of
the launch to hurry with our business in order that we might start back
before the tide went out. He assured us that it would be very difficult,
if not impossible, to cross the bar at the mouth of the river at low
tide. His entreaties were in vain. The Commissioners were engaged in
interviews with Surigao citizens which they could not or would not cut
short, so the ladies and children, having seen everything and met
everybody, went back to the landing and sat in the launch patiently
waiting while the daylight slowly disappeared. The launch captain was
visibly agitated, and told us time and again about what a hard time we
were sure to have getting back to the _Sumner_. And he was quite right.

The launch was not large enough to accommodate the entire party so it
towed a cutter which also was fairly well loaded. When the men finally
arrived, full of explanations and good-natured apologies, it was pitch
dark, but, being optimists, we shoved off into the river, feeling sure
that the fears of our commanding officer were groundless.

After steaming merrily along for a few miles, becoming more and more
confident all the time, we suddenly got a shaking bump and found
ourselves fast in the mud. It didn’t take so long, however, to get
afloat again, and we were just congratulating ourselves that the
captain’s bug-bear of a sandbar was behind us when we felt a violent
impact followed by a terrifying sensation as if the keel were grinding
over rocks.

The captain swore softly and said something about striking “the ruins of
that old Spanish bridge,” then hurried forward to see what damage had
been done. The people in the cutter, riding the short waves in our wake,
were thoroughly alarmed and were clamouring to know what had happened to
us. We couldn’t tell them, but it sounded very much as if we had torn
the whole bottom out of the launch. The engine had stopped; it was inky
dark; the children all began to cry; and, to add further discomfort to
the situation, it began to rain in torrents. The launch swayed
sickeningly this way and that, then the engine started again, whereupon
came a most furious clatter aft. There is no denying that it made us
blanch with fear, but it proved to be only a blade of the propeller
which had been bent and was striking the boat with each revolution.

Three times more we slid into the mud; the last time we stuck and no
effort that could be made would get us out, so we were forced to abandon
the launch and wedge ourselves altogether into the little cutter. You
may picture for yourself the scene of men, women and children, in the
rain and with no light save the faint flicker of lanterns, dropping off
a big launch into a small rowboat over an inky stream supposed to be
filled with crocodiles.

When we reached the mouth of the river the captain began to show signs
of nervousness, though he had been entirely self-controlled throughout
the worst of our troubles. We couldn’t see where we were going, but we
could distinctly feel that the open bay lay not far ahead of us. What we
wanted was to have the _Sumner’s_ searchlight turned on our path, but
the only thing we had with us with which to convey this desire to the
ship’s officers were red rockets,—the last resort of the sailor in
distress. There was nothing else to do; the launch captain began firing
them off, and a weirder scene than was revealed by their momentary glare
can hardly be imagined. They produced the desired effect, however, and
in less than ten minutes a great shaft of light, straight from the
bridge of the _Sumner_, was sweeping the banks of the river and bay
shore and affording us just the kind of assistance we required.

But that was not the end. Less than half way to the _Sumner_ we met a
lifeboat, equipped with all the paraphernalia for rescuing us from a
watery grave, and manned by an excited crew in oilskins, who, under the
sharp commands of an almost frantic officer, were pulling in mad haste
for the river’s mouth. When they saw us they lapsed into a state of
utter disgust. They turned and rowed sadly back to the ship, and
afterward I overheard them exchanging very definite opinions as to the
possible future of a sailor who would burn red rockets when all he
wanted was a searchlight.

After calling at Cagayan Misamis, Dapitan, Iloilo, San José Antique and
Capiz, we made straight for Cebu. Cebu is, in rivalry with Iloilo and
next to Manila, the most important town in the Philippine Islands. It is
a receiving station for exports from all parts of the southern islands
and is altogether what is known as a “live” town. It is the capital of
the province of the same name which consists of a single long island
some two thousand square miles in area and with a population (at that
time) of nearly seven hundred thousand.

At Cebu we were rejoined by Chief Justice Arellano, who had left us
sometime before to go back to Manila. We were greatly interested in his
account of the effect of Aguinaldo’s capture and subsequent treatment.
The erstwhile insurgent leader was still in prison, but his prison was
made an honourable abode where he was permitted to be with his family
and to receive his friends. The mass of the people would not, for a long
time, believe he really had been captured. They thought the report was
an American fabrication to delude them and to destroy their faith in
Aguinaldo’s _anting-anting_,—or magic charm against defeat. The
shattering of that faith gave vast impetus to the general peace movement
and, though a few hundred rifles and several insurrecto officers were
still unaccounted for, and though occasional outbreaks and the
activities of marauding bands of outlaws continued for a considerable
length of time, the actual organised insurrection had suffered a
complete collapse.

The Commission kept Cebu on tenterhooks for a time as to whether the
condition of order in the province was such that they could go on with
the establishment of government there, and it was interesting to watch
the effect of this uncertainty. To be included in the general
organisation became at once the warmly expressed wish of a majority of
the people, and there was great excitement throughout the town.
Eventually Justice Llorente, of the Supreme Court of Manila, a member of
our party, and himself a Cebuano, was appointed Governor of the province
under the simple American form, and because of his integrity and real
patriotism, because of the high regard in which he was held by the
people, and because of the enthusiasm and complete faith with which he
entered upon his duties, it was hoped that he would be able soon to lead
his province into the sensible paths marked out for it.

With Cebu and the problems of Cebu behind us, we felt that our long trip
was nearly finished. Bohol, Leyte, Samar, Albay, the Camarines and
Sorsogon, each in its turn brought us nearer to our comfortable homes in
Manila and to relaxation, for which we were beginning to long.

Each district expected us to give them at least a day for business and
an evening for festivity, but this was not always possible. At Sorsogon
we found a veritable riot of decoration, with fine arches and many flags
and every indication that the town had spared no effort to make our
visit there a memorable event. In the evening, beside the _banquete_ and
_baile_, there was to have been a torchlight procession, with a
triumphal car and a Filipino maiden as the Goddess of Liberty. It was a
great pity that we couldn’t stay, but we had to sail that afternoon for
Boak, so the programme had to be advanced several hours.

The extraordinary car, or float, which had undoubtedly cost weeks of
skilled workmanship, came forth into the blistering sunlight bearing the
pretty brown girl in tinsel and white muslin, her long, black hair
almost wholly enveloping her as she held aloft the flickering symbol of
Enlightenment. It was a Filipino adaptation of the “sacred torch” which
we had ourselves been carrying throughout the islands, and I felt that
its production was a fitting climax to our laborious progress.

Two days later when we landed in Manila, after organising Marinduque and
Batangas, we were able to look back upon a singular experience, an
expedition perhaps unique in history, with which was ushered in a new
era, not to say a new national existence, for the people of the
Philippine Islands.



                               CHAPTER IX
                         THE WILD MEN’S COUNTRY


I should like to say here, by way of explanation, which may or may not
be necessary, that I am not trying in this narrative to pose as a woman
endowed with an especial comprehension of such problems of state as men
alone have been trained to deal with. I confess only to a lively
interest in my husband’s work which I experienced from the beginning of
our association and which nothing in our long life together, neither
monotony, nor illness, nor misfortune, has served to lessen; and it
would be practically impossible for me to write a record of memories in
which he did not figure very largely.

In the settlement of American control in the Philippine Islands Mr.
Taft, first as President of the first legislative Commission and, later,
as Civil Governor, had to contend with a varied and complex resistance
which it would be difficult for one not experienced in politics to
comprehend. If it had been Filipino resistance only it would have been
fairly easy to overcome, but Filipino resistance was indirectly
sanctioned and directly assisted by a strong opposition in the United
States to what seemed to us who were on the ground to be the only
sensible and really patriotic measures possible under the circumstances.

For reasons which I have tried to convey, as clearly as I am able, my
husband was not in favour of a continuation of military rule in the
Islands beyond the time when military activity was imperative, nor was
he in favour of abandoning a problem which grew daily more difficult and
more complicated. So he and his colleagues persisted in the tremendous
task of settling a whole people under a sane and sensible form of
government.

[Illustration:

  PHILIPPINE NON-CHRISTIANS. A BONTOC IGORROTE (_TOP_, _LEFT_,) A MORO
    AND TWO KALINGA CHIEFS (_WITH SHIELDS_)
]

The trip through the southern islands was particularly valuable to them
in that it gave them first-hand, working knowledge of existing
conditions in every province. They immediately set about revising their
original Provincial code in accordance with requirements which they were
able to discover only through personal investigation, and at the same
time they took up the grave business of establishing a sound judiciary.

There was always something new to be talked over at our family table, or
during the long evening hours on the verandah overlooking the Bay and,
in spite of the fact that much of our “news” presented itself in the
form of fresh delays and exasperating difficulties, life was very
entertaining.

Not long after we returned from our trip through the South Mrs. J.
Franklin Bell invited my sister Maria and me to go with her on an
expedition, on which she expected to accompany her husband, through the
mountains of northern Luzon which are inhabited by non-Christian tribes
only. General Bell was commander of troops in the North and this was to
be an inspection trip. It meant several weeks on horseback, over
dangerous trails where, in parts at least, no white woman had ever been,
but we were most anxious to go. The trouble was that I had never ridden
in my life, so I looked with considerable trepidation to the prospect of
a long and necessarily intimate association with a horse. I brought the
proposition up in family council and my husband advised me, by all
means, to go. I should probably have gone without this advice, but it
was comforting to have it because if anything happened I could “blame it
all on him.” In fact, I began to do this even before I left. When my
courage dwindled a little I promptly told him that it was all his fault;
that if he hadn’t urged me to go I never should have thought of such a
thing; but that as long as I had promised I should have to see the
adventure through, though I knew I should never survive it. He only
laughed and assured me that we would have a glorious time and that the
trip would do us “all the good in the world.”

Major Stevens, who expected to accompany us, brought me an American
horse, of formidable dimensions, and volunteered to superintend my first
encounter with him. He was as gentle as a lamb. I wouldn’t let him go
faster than a walk the first evening and the fact that I was pretty
stiff at the end of my ride made me almost hopeless. The second evening
I let him out a little, and began, much to my surprise to enjoy the
exhilaration of the exercise. By the third evening I had progressed so
far that I decided for myself that the poor old beast had no speed in
him at all.

We took a Spanish steamer, the _Salvadora_, from Manila up to Vigan,
where General Bell was stationed, and, though I am glad to have had the
experience, I shouldn’t care to repeat it. When we got on board we were
shown at once to a most promising-looking stateroom, quite spacious, and
with four berths in it. The trip to Vigan was to take from Thursday to
Saturday and we were glad to note that we were going to be quite
comfortable. But our self-congratulations came to a sudden end. Upon
inspection we found the room was indescribably dirty, the beds were
without sheets, the pillows were like rocks, there were insects galore,
and the thermometer stood at 110 degrees. Ventilation was out of the
question because the room opened into a sort of public saloon where
innumerable Filipinos, in various states of undress, slept, stretched
out on the floor, on the tables, on chairs, on anything that could serve
as a resting place. The second night I got the Captain’s permission to
sleep on the bridge, since the decks, too, were covered with a
miscellaneous crowd and were rendered additionally uncomfortable by
odoriferous strings of cabbages and other vegetables which hung from the
awnings.

The food on the ship was all Spanish; indeed, I might say, terribly
Spanish; still, I was rather used to it and didn’t mind much as long as
I could get into a wind-swept corner of the deck to eat it. But there
were some American women on board who had just come out from the United
States and they complained violently.

We were put ashore early Saturday morning; much earlier, in fact than we
had been expected to arrive. We had to drive three miles before we
reached the Bells’ house, and when we did get there we were delighted to
find that they were just having breakfast. They were eating real, human
food and, however heroically we had adapted ourselves to the
peculiarities of Spanish cookery, there was nothing we stood so much in
need of. They were a most homelike and comfortable-looking party.
Besides the General and Mrs. Bell there were two young officers, Mr.
Wilcox and Mr. Nolan, and a young lady whose name was Miss Bubb, a
daughter of General Bubb, and whose general characteristics had won for
her the nickname of “Bubbles.”

The first thing we learned was that Mrs. Bell would, after all, be
unable to go with us on the trip through the mountains. She was not at
all well and the doctor had forbidden it. We were greatly disappointed.
Mrs. Bell is so jolly and full of fun that she is an addition to any
party, and on such an expedition as we were contemplating we were sure
to miss her tremendously. But, the party was all made up. General Bell
was to take command; “Bubbles” was going; then, in addition to my sister
and me, there were Major Rice, Major Stevens, Captain Shearer and
Captain Haight—eight in all.

First let me say that the northern part of the island of Luzon bears
just about as much resemblance to the rest of the archipelago as the
Alps bear to the plains of Nebraska. We began to notice the difference
even at Vigan, though Vigan is at sea-level and is as hot as a sea-level
town is supposed to be in that latitude. But it feels and looks like a
little foreign city; foreign, that is, to the Philippines. Its houses
are well built of ancient-looking stone, with heavy red-tiled roofs; its
streets are narrow and crooked and it has a fine plaza filled with
fire-trees which, when I saw them first, were in full bloom. There is no
way to describe the magnificence of a grove or avenue of fire-trees.
They make a veritable cloud of flame which, seen against a background of
blue hills, or overhanging the mouldy, old-world grace of a Spanish
church and convent, fairly “takes one’s breath.” The world-famed cherry
trees of Japan, wonderful as they are, seem pale and soulless in
comparison. I wonder the Spaniards didn’t line the streets of Manila
with fire-trees and make for themselves the reputation of having created
the most amazing city in the world.

While we were at Vigan, and before starting on the long trip, we made an
excursion to Bangued, in the province of Abra. Mrs. Bell went with us.
This town, a short time before, could be reached only by raft up the
Abra River, no launch ever having been built that could go through the
rapids, but the establishment of an Army post made necessary the
building of a piece of road which shortened the journey at the Bangued
end. The first part of the trip, however, had still to be made by water
and all the supplies for the soldiers were sent up on a fleet of twenty
or more rafts which started out together every morning. When there was a
breeze each of them would run up a sail of bright, striped Igorrote
cloth.

We had a grand raft with a bamboo awning. And there were comfortable
rattan chairs, to say nothing of a picnic luncheon and a carefully
wrapped and jealously guarded box of ice. Ice was the rarest of all
luxuries in the provincial towns of the Philippines in those days.

[Illustration:

  ON THE LONG TRAIL IN NORTHERN LUZON. MRS. TAFT SECOND FROM THE LEFT
]

[Illustration:

  MR. TAFT AND CHARLIE ENJOYING THEIR FAVOURITE EXERCISE
]

We moved very slowly against the current of the swift-flowing river, but
we had no desire to hurry. It was really enchanting. From narrow, pebbly
beaches on either bank rose rugged cliffs which seemed to tower mountain
high, throwing deep shadows into the canyon and leaving only a narrow
ribbon of sky above us. And these cliffs were hung with a tangled
undergrowth through which small, white waterfalls rushed and rustled.
Where the river broadened, here and there, we came upon groups of
bright-clad natives who regarded us with great curiosity, and at one
place we saw half a dozen women starting up the steep bank with graceful
brown water-jars balanced on their heads. Each one was carrying at least
six, one on top of another, and all of them full. How they managed it
was beyond comprehension. We watched them until they were out of sight
and not one of them ever raised a hand to her head. As a matter of fact,
they were nonchalantly smoking and chattering away as if they were quite
unconscious of their burdens, though the slightest unrhythmical motion
would have spelt disaster for them all.

At eleven o’clock we reached the village where the road begins and the
whole population gathered around in curious groups and gazed at us.
White women were still a novelty in that region and I’m sure we looked
much more peculiar to them than they looked to us. There were crowds of
school children from the new American school, and one very much
embarrassed little girl, who had had her English book only about four
months, read some English for me very nicely. Likely as not that same
little girl has by this time won a normal school certificate and is
herself teaching English in an “American” school. Such is the history of
many of her generation.

When we reached Bangued the young men in the command of Major Bowen, who
was our host, gave up their house to the ladies, and we had three
comfortable beds, with mosquito nets, in a large, airy room. It was a
fine afternoon for a _siesta_ because it rained in torrents for the rest
of the day and the patter of rain on nipa thatch is a soothing sound.
The young men’s house was just across from the Major’s and by evening
the street was such a river that we had to be carried over for dinner.
But nobody minded; and we enjoyed even the music of the native band
which stationed itself down under our windows and enlivened the occasion
with a wonderful medley of sound. When the band-men came upstairs for
refreshments Mrs. Bell and two of the young officers ran down and tried
their powers on the instruments, and I can only say that the result was
joyful pandemonium.

The next morning we left our hospitable hosts and, escorted by
Lieutenant Ingram, made the return trip all the way down the river. The
water was high and, though it had taken us an interminable time to go
up, it took only three hours and a half to go down; and some of the
rapids were most exciting. We took our lunch basket and chairs ashore on
a lovely, green, shaded knoll and dallied there for several hours. Only
a month before nobody, who was not compelled to, ever went over this
route on account of the danger of being shot, but the last of the Abra
insurgents had surrendered, and so safe did we feel that we were
absolutely unarmed.

If I should try to write a detailed account of this expedition I am
afraid I could not avoid conveying the idea that we encountered nothing
but a continuous downpour. It was the “rainy season” and we were wet
most of the time, but Mr. Taft was right when he promised that we would
have a glorious time and that the trip would do us a “world of good.”
Down in the heat and the political turmoil of Manila I was taking things
much too seriously, while up in the far-away north there was nothing to
do but dismiss all worry and accept things as they came along. After we
left Vigan on the long trail the only way we could get even a letter
through was by messenger who had to travel hundreds of miles through a
most difficult country. So I enjoyed myself thoroughly, as did every one
else in the party, hardships and physical discomforts seeming only to
add to our gaiety.

At first I thought that my riding lessons in Manila were not going to do
me much good. We had had a most luxuriously easy time in the beginning.
We left General Bell’s house in an Army ambulance, instead of on horses,
for our first day’s journey on the “long trail.” General Bell was in
command and he knew what he was doing. All he had to do was to issue
orders; we obeyed. That is what it is to go camping with a soldier. One
learns what discipline means.

We were permitted to take with us only such things as were absolutely
necessary. Even then, the “absolute necessities” which we eventually
discarded as useless impedimenta would have made a long list. Everything
was done up in waterproof bundles and when we started out these were
stuffed so full that they would hardly fasten, but they grew slimmer as
time went on. The most important articles, we found, were our slickers
and wraps. It was wet and cold and we had to have them, but all our
toilet appurtenances together went easily into Miss Bubb’s saddle-bags.

The first day we forded a river—the same river—several times, and,
finally, we had to cross it on a raft which was so small that it could
carry only one thing, or one person at a time. My sister, Miss Bubo and
I sat on the bank above the ford for more than two hours waiting for all
our things to get across. While we waited many natives came along
driving carabaos, and it was amusing to see the two-wheeled, awkward
carts hustled onto the swaying raft—one thing after another falling into
the river—while each poor old carabao was forced to swim, dragged along
by his master who held fast to a string attached to a ring in the
animal’s nose. If I had been able to speak the dialect I would have
said: “Your friend the Carabao, being a water-buffalo, could probably
swim the river much more easily without your assistance.” I have had to
look on and suffer at many things in the Philippine Islands merely
because I was unable to speak a dozen-odd different dialects. In the
provinces Spanish was seldom of any use because the common _tao_ knows
little or nothing of it, and it is with the common _tao_ that one wishes
there to communicate.

On our first day’s journey we did thirty-seven miles in a jolting Army
wagon, but the air was so invigorating, and we were having such a good
time, that we were not exhausted. We didn’t even murmur when we were
told to be ready to start at four the next morning.

This was at Candon and we were joined there by Major Stevens, which made
our party complete. The next evening, at Concepción, we camped in a
lovely, new nipa-thatched house which had been built by a man who was
known generally as “Windy” Wilson, an Army captain. We were extremely
thankful for the shelter, because it was raining as it can rain only in
northern Luzon and we had every reason to believe that this would be the
last house we would be permitted to occupy for many a day. We were
striking straight into the mountains and our shelter-to-be was a small
field tent slung on the cargo saddle of a commissary mule.

Captain Wilson’s house was quite spacious. It had two rooms; one small
and one large one. The ladies slept in the smaller room on Army cots,
while the four stalwart officers of our military escort stretched
themselves out on blankets and slickers on the split bamboo floor of the
larger room. The walls and partitions were of woven nipa palm leaves,
known locally as _suali_, while the two windows were made of braided
bamboo and were set in grooves so, when we wanted to open them, all we
had to do was to give them a gentle shove. There were no “trappings of
civilisation,” but we managed to be perfectly comfortable.

[Illustration:

  AN IGORROTE HEAD DANCE, AND A COMPANY OF _CARGODORES_ WITH THEIR DOGS,
    WHICH ARE TO BE KILLED FOR FOOD
]

The next day, before the sun was very high, we found ourselves in the
midst of mountain-tops, on a trail which rose in great upward sweeps
around the densely wooded slopes, to an altitude of 5600 feet. By this
time we were all on horseback with eight Igorrote boys behind us
carrying a sedan chair to be used in case of accident or a dangerous
washout on the trail. I wish I could describe the magnificence of the
scene which lay all about us when we reached that amazing summit.
General Bell, who had been all through the Rocky Mountains, the
Yellowstone, and the Yosemite Valley, said there was nothing that he had
ever seen which could compare with it. And its grandeur is accentuated
by vivid colouring. The Igorrotes have, for hundreds of years, been
building extraordinary rice terraces and these have gradually climbed
the mountains until, in some places, only the rugged crests are left
uncultivated. The terraces are as symmetrical as honeycomb and are built
in solid walls of finely laid masonry out of which grow ferns and
tangled vines. The brilliant colour of the young rice fairly glows
against the dark greens of pine trees, of spreading mangoes, and of
tropic forest giants whose names I do not know. And wherever one looks
there are peaks, jagged sunlit peaks which rise from sombre valleys
upward into a strange light whose every ray seems to shine in its own
individual hue. In the far distance we could see the ocean, with white
breakers dashing against the cliffs; while in the valley below the Santa
Cruz River, though actually foaming and dashing through its winding,
rocky bed, seemed to us to be lying still, without motion of any kind,
or sound.

In my diary, which I kept on that trip, I find that at each stopping
place I have solemnly set down the observation that: “the scenery to-day
was the finest we have yet found”; and when we reached Sagada I took the
trouble to record for my own future reference that: “I shall not rest
until Will has seen it.” He never has.

At Sagada we found ourselves quite far up in the Igorrote country, where
Filipinos as a rule, do not go. We had come from Cervantes over a trail
where the horses cautiously kept to the inside, and where we were told
to let go of our inner stirrups so, in case a horse went over the edge
of the precipice its rider would have a chance of falling clear on the
_terra-firma_ side instead of being hurled out into open space. There
are a great many people who have to be taken over such trails
blind-folded, but there were no dizzy-heads among us, and as each turn
of the way revealed to us different and more wonderful views, we filled
the day with exclamation points.

Here and there we met bands of Igorrotes, marching “Indian file,”
carrying great bundles of rice up short-cut mountain trails, which wound
through the rice terraces and were “as steep as the side of a house.”
All the men had long, murderous-looking spears, while the women were
evidently the burden-bearers. Along the main trail we came, now and
then, upon a company of men leading home a whimpering and pitiful little
pack of very thin dogs. We knew these were to be killed and eaten and,
naturally, the thought was sickening, but in the Igorrote country the
dog-loving white man has to get used to this. Some day, perhaps, it will
be different, but not until herds and flocks have been substituted and
entirely new ideas have patiently been instilled into the minds of these
people. For the time being dog flesh is their most cherished article of
diet.

I wish it were known just where these curious wild tribes came from;
just what their race history is. They are as unlike Filipinos as
American Indians are unlike Englishmen. They have but one thing in
common with the Filipinos, and that is their colour, which is a soft,
dark brown. There is hardly an American who has ever lived among them
for any length of time who has not a real admiration and affection for
them and yet, to all intents and purposes, they are naked savages. They
are most amenable to civilising influences. They take to education
eagerly. They are, in their physical development, beautiful to look
upon—when they are cleaned up—perfectly formed, straight and muscular,
with features strongly marked and with wide, clear eyes which inspire
confidence. They are entirely fearless; and they are loyal to the “last
ditch.” Also, it is these same incomprehensible “naked savages” who have
built the thousands of acres of rice terraces which are a marvel and a
mystery to every irrigation expert or technical engineer who has ever
seen them.

[Illustration:

  Bureau of Science, Manila.

  VIEWS OF THE EXTRAORDINARY IGORROTE RICE TERRACES. PRACTICALLY ALL OF
    THE NORTH CENTRAL LUZON IS CULTIVATED IN THIS MANNER
]

Bontoc, which we reached after a day’s weary, wet riding over slippery
trails from Sagada, is the capital of what is now known as the Mountain
province. For the first time in their known history the Igorrotes are
united under one central government, each tribe having its lieutenant
governor—an American always. There are the Benguets, the Bontocs, the
Ifugaos, the Ilongots, the Kalingas and others, and they have been
engaged in inter-tribal warfare since time began, their chief pleasure
being derived from the taking of each other’s heads. When I went into
the Igorrote country head-hunting was still in full force and houses
were still decorated with festoons of human skulls, while no man ever
ventured forth, even to his rice fields, without his spear and shield
and head-axe. They all carry spears even yet, but head-hunting, having
been made by the American government a capital offence, is not so
popular. Mr. Dean C. Worcester, as Secretary of the Interior, in direct
charge of all wild tribes, actually succeeded in introducing substitutes
for the sport in the form of baseball and other inter-tribal athletic
contests and peaceful, though rough and strenuous pastimes. For fourteen
years Mr. Worcester was to these children of the hills a most highly
respected _Apo-apo_,—chief of chiefs.

Miss Bubb, my sister Maria and I were the first white women who ever set
foot in Bontoc and to say that we created a sensation is to describe our
reception too mildly. We were the guests of three American miners who
had a comfortable house and who, having lived among the Igorrotes for a
long time—one of them for more than a year without visiting
civilisation—could give us much interesting first-hand information. The
people gathered around us in hordes, but they kept at a respectful, not
to say a reverential, distance. I think they were afraid of us;
especially the women, not one of whom would let us look at her baby. But
we were used to that. Many Christian Filipinos believe firmly in the
“evil eye.” There was one little dwarf who was bolder than the rest and
who followed us everywhere we went. He was like a little, brown,
toy-child, beautifully formed, and looking not more than one year old,
but we were told that he was at least fourteen.

Everybody wanted to give us things. The evening I arrived I received a
present from one of the headmen, of three live chickens, and the next
day, as we were picking our way through the native village, another man
ran after me and, very graciously and gracefully, presented me with two
fresh eggs. We learned to say “_mapud_,” which means “good,” and, in
connection with smiles and gestures, found it served us famously for all
purposes of social intercourse.

Bontoc is in a deep valley, on the bank of a wide, swift river and
surrounded by close sheltering hills, so it is not as cold as it is in
Sagada and some other places we visited; but it is cold enough, and I
failed to understand how the natives could live in a state of almost
complete nakedness. But they do and, in fact, all these people do, even
in the coldest regions. The Bontoc Igorrote wears a very bright-coloured
clout called a “G-string” with a heavy, brass chain around his waist,
while his long, black hair is tucked into a little, flat, straw hat
which is fastened, in some mysterious way, on the back of his head. They
nearly all wear heavy, brass earrings which make their ears unsightly,
and the Bontoc “dandy” usually has a long, black, homemade and
half-smoked cigar tucked behind one ear for all the world like the
pencil of an absentminded bookkeeper.

We had _canyaos_, or bonfires with “head-dances,” and all the strange
varieties of entertainment provided by the village headmen. The musical
instrument of the Igorrote is called a _ganza_, which is a round brass
gong with a handle made of a human jaw-bone, upon which the “musician”
beats a rhythmical measure with a soft, padded mallet as he whirls and
twists in his fantastic dance. These _ganzas_—some of them very old,—are
tribal rather than individual property and it is very difficult to
induce their owners to part with them. Their value is computed in
carabaos instead of in rice, or in dollars and cents. If you should ask
an Igorrote how much he would take for his _ganza_, especially if it
were one associated with tribal history, he would very likely look
smilingly solemn and say: “One hundred carabao,” or any other
prohibitive number that might happen to occur to him. This is a form of
racial pride and deserves respect.

We went from Bontoc back through Sagada to Cervantes, and then started
down the long, narrow trail straight through the mountains to Baguio. At
Cervantes we received our first messages from Manila and, among other
things, was an order to Major Stevens to report for duty. His going gave
us an opportunity to send letters down and report ourselves alive and
not at all anxious to get home, but we didn’t like losing the Major. We
had, by this time, become a very well acquainted, well-disciplined and
congenial party and we disliked seeing the beginning of the end of our
expedition. General Bell directed everything and joined in our sports
and foolishness whenever he could do so without endangering the dignity
of the “corps,” but, while he was kindness itself, he was so strict with
the young officers that we had sometimes to steal our opportunities for
relaxation.

A few hours’ riding south from Cervantes are some famous copper mines
which were owned by a Spanish syndicate. We turned off in their
direction and came into a most extraordinary country. The whole face of
the landscape looks like corroded copper, and the great, scarred gulches
where the ore has been taken out make one think of chaos, or dreams of
an inferno. I don’t know how to express an idea of bigness in a mere
touch of description as I pass on through the story of this trip, but I
want to convey an impression of overwhelming size in everything. It is a
great, wild world where one sees miles in every direction and where
nature seems to have done everything on a gigantic scale.

A mile or so beyond the copper mines we came upon a veritable mountain
paradise,—from our point of view, at least. It was the home of Don José
Mills, a Spaniard who, for some unknown reason, had banished himself to
this out-of-the-world spot and, with what labour and pains can only be
imagined, had made for himself a civilised abode. I was shown to a room
all by myself, which had in it a real bed with springs and a mattress.
It was the first one I had seen for I don’t know how long. I regarded it
with great curiosity at first, then I sat down on it most respectfully.
I lay down and stretched myself out; then I pulled up a soft blanket
and, though it was only midday, nothing short of the gravest emergency
could have induced me to move. The emergency presented itself, finally,
in the form of luncheon and I discovered that Don José had returned
hurriedly from Candon in order to entertain us and that he had brought
with him everything in the form of food and liquid refreshments that he
could find. The result was a triumph, and we decided that we should like
to remain under his hospitable roof indefinitely.

That night, amid much merriment, we initiated our host into the
mysteries and secrets of a little society we had formed and which we
called the Earring Club. Our insignia was a big, brass Igorrote earring,
and we had signs and pass-words, to say nothing of a song which nobody
but ourselves could sing. We appropriated the Cavalry tune of “For Seven
Long Years I’ve Courted Nancy,” but the words were our own and it was
not difficult to supply a new verse to fit each incident or occasion as
it came along. The song began:

[Illustration:

  Bureau of Science, Manila.

  IGORROTE CHIEF PROUDLY DISPLAYING HIS HOUSE DECORATIONS OF HUMAN
    SKULLS AND CARABAO HORNS
]

[Illustration:

  Bureau of Science, Manila.

  BONTOC IGORROTES WITH _GANZAS_, SHOWING HANDLES MADE OF HUMAN JAW
    BONES
]

          For twelve long days we’ve hiked through mountains,
            Heigh ho! Cross roaring rivers!
          For twelve long days we’ve hiked through mountains,
            Ha! Ha! While on our way through wild Lepanto!

Up at Sagada we came upon the only bed of mint that any of us had ever
seen in the Philippines, and as General Bell had almost an inspired
knowledge as to what mint was originally intended for, this gave us
material for three new verses:

        One rainy day we reached Sagada,
          Heigh ho! Among the rice fields!
        One rainy day we reached Sagada,
          Ha! Ha! As we toiled along o’er the hills of Bontoc!

        A place most sweet with fragrant mint-beds,
          Heigh ho! How did it get there?
        A place most sweet with fragrant mint-beds,
          Ha! Ha! ‘Way high up in the hills of Bontoc!

        We didn’t do a thing but make a julep,
          Heigh ho! Without the cracked ice!
        We didn’t do a thing but make a julep,
          Ha! Ha! With the mint we found in the hills of Bontoc!

It was a free-for-all composition contest; anybody was likely to produce
a new verse, or even a whole new song with a different tune, at any
moment, and we shortened many a long mile with such nonsense.

At Don José’s we not only sang all our songs for the benefit of our
host, but one of our number produced a harmonica, on which he played
very well indeed, and we had an impromptu _baile_. Then we “dropped the
handkerchief,” “followed the leader,” gave some original renderings of
German Grand Opera, played Puss-in-the-corner, and finished the evening
with our feet on a fender before a great, open fire, recounting, with
much appreciated embellishments, our interesting experiences.

We knew we should not find any place as delightful as Don José’s
again,—not even in Manila, because Manila would be hot,—so it was with
great reluctance that we obeyed orders to be ready to leave the next
morning at six. This meant getting out of our comfortable, civilised
beds at five o’clock, while the stars would still be out, and when the
ashes of our evening’s fire would be cold and grey on the hearth. It was
a cheerless thought, but we had to “get to Loo” said General Bell.

It was raining—of course—and there was not much scenery visible except
when the clouds would float upward, now and then, like veils lifted off
grand panoramas, but by this time we had ceased to consider the weather.
When we got to Loo we found the “town” consisted of just two empty log
huts, one with a plaited reed floor, the other with no floor at all, and
neither of them with any sort of partition. We stretched a rope across
the middle of the better one, hung Igorrote blankets on it by way of a
screen, and prepared to make ourselves comfortable on the, fortunately
flexible, floor; ladies on one side, gentlemen on the other. But along
late in the afternoon a pack train of mules and Igorrotes and orderlies
arrived from the south bringing us the astonishing news that the
Commissioners were only a few miles behind and expected to camp that
night at Loo!

The rain had settled down into a dreary, soaking patter; it was cold; we
were all wet; there was no place for a fire; and, altogether, we were
fairly uncomfortable.

The Commissioners, Mr. Worcester and Mr. Moses, with their private
secretaries and a doctor—five in all—came along about an hour behind
their pack train. They straggled in one by one, very grumpy, and we
decided right away that they had not been taught, as we had been, to
make the best of everything and to cultivate sociability on the trail.
They had had a much more difficult day’s riding than we because the
trail up is much harder than the trail down, but we were pretty certain,
on the whole, that we were much the better managed party.

With more Igorrote blankets we arranged another partition in the hut to
make room for them, then we gave them a good hot dinner—cooked in the
tent which had been put up for kitchen purposes—and immediately a social
thaw set in. We got all the news from Manila that we were so anxious
for, and all the latest gossip. The news was disquieting. A cablegram
had come announcing that the Supreme Court had decided there should be
no duties in Porto Rico against United States imports, and instructing
the Commission to suspend all legislation in the Philippine Islands
until further notice. This might mean anything, but whatever else it
meant it certainly meant renewed uncertainty and the possibility that no
change in the government would be made until after Congress met.

The politics of the situation were extremely complicated and seemed to
revolve around a question which, because of a rather pugnacious manner
of expressing it, had become a popular clamour. The question was: “Does
the Constitution follow the Flag?” In other words, really, could duties
be collected on imports from one American port to another? In any case,
the question in respect to us was one for Congress to answer and it
seemed to me we were facing another long period of uneasiness and delay.

We knew the entire Commission had expected to make a trip in June for
the purpose of organising the Christian provinces in the far north
beyond the Mountain Province, but they were halted by the order to
suspend definite activities, and Commissioners Worcester and Moses had
taken advantage of the “breathing spell” to run up into the mountains
and inspect proposed routes for roads and railways. That is how we
happened to encounter them at Loo. We shared their opinion that one of
the greatest things that could be done for the country was to make the
mountains of central Luzon, with their glorious climate, easily
accessible. The trails as we found them were mere paths worn by the feet
of Igorrotes and, besides being very narrow, were at such grades as to
make them in many places all but impassable. The party, highly
representative of American authority in the Islands, as it was, sat
around on the bamboo floor, huddled up in blankets, and talked long into
the night about hopes and fears and governmental problems of great
difficulty and importance.

We left Loo at six o’clock in the morning and after eight straight hours
of the hardest work we had yet been called upon to do, we arrived at
Cabayan. According to my own diary: “I was completely tired. The greater
part of the way we rode through beautiful pine forests, but up and down
hills as steep as the side of a house; across rivers, and up a
waterfall.” This sounds like pretty heavy going, but my account of it
written at the time was, I am sure, only slightly exaggerated. I
remember distinctly that from Loo to Baguio, five full days, we walked a
great part of the way; and not only did we walk, but we rendered
necessary assistance to our horses which, giving out one by one, had to
be dragged up the steep grades and “eased” down the opposite sides in a
way that would have been highly ludicrous had we been engaged in
anything but a very serious business. Only the steady old mules plodded
along “without a word,” and found their own way in safety around the
dangerous turns.

[Illustration:

  Bureau of Science, Manila.

  THE BENGUET ROAD BEFORE AND AFTER COMPLETION. NOT THE MOST THRILLING
    CURVE ON THIS SPECTACULAR HIGHWAY
]

After leaving Bontoc we travelled down through Nueva Viscaya and into
Benguet, the southermost division of the Mountain province. At Cabayan
we had for camping quarters a large _presidencia_ and schoolhouse
combined, while a tent was put up and rudely equipped for bathing
purposes. This was luxury indeed, and we began to think that we had left
all hardship behind us; but the next night, after a seven hours’ “hike”
over a terrible trail, we found shelter in a miserable hut with only one
room which we all had to occupy, with Igorrote blankets for partitions.

The Igorrotes grew less and less interesting as we went along and
displayed few evidences of the industry and thrift which characterise
the more northern tribes. The mountains are higher and the scenes are
broader and more wonderful at the southern end of the range, but the
only cultivation we came upon was in the villages and along the banks of
the little rushing streams. It was evident that we were approaching
“civilisation.” Here and there we went through small groves of coffee
trees, beautiful in a wealth of snow-white blossoms, but evidently
deserted, and wretchedly ragged and unkempt.

Baguio, now the summer capital of the Philippine Islands, the
“Philippine Simla,” as it is so often called, lies at the top of what
has become justly celebrated as “the magnificent Benguet Road,” the
building of which has been the subject of more controversy than almost
any other one thing that American authority and enterprise has
accomplished in the Islands. The Benguet Road when I first saw it was
known as “Mead’s Trail,” so named in honour of the engineer who made the
original survey for it, and in some places it was nothing more than a
thin line drawn against perpendicular cliffs to indicate where cutting
was to be done.

Let somebody else argue the question as to whether or not this road has
justified the faith of the men who built it. My husband and his
colleagues were responsible for the beginning of it and Mr. Taft
authorised the payment of the large sums of money which went into it,
but he does not in the least object to honest criticism of the project.
His only question is: “How else could we have accomplished what we did?”
For which there is no satisfactory answer. I have ridden over it since
it was completed and, in common with a majority of those who have
enjoyed this privilege, I am strongly prejudiced in its favour. There
are few, if any roads in the world more spectacular, or which represent
a greater triumph of engineering skill. Fairly hewn out of the almost
solid, but too crumbling, walls of the Bued River Canyon, it winds for
about seventeen miles through constantly changing scenes of
extraordinary grandeur, then it strikes the foothills of the mountains
and rises in a succession of splendid upward sweeps to an altitude of
more than five thousand feet in less than six miles.

The Benguet Road was originally a railway project and was to have been
built by the British company which owns the Manila and Dagupan Railway.
But this syndicate wanted a perpetual grant and a guarantee from the
government which could not then be given. It was necessary, in any case,
to build a wagon-road before railway construction could be started and
Captain Mead, who was sent out at the head of a surveying party,
reported that such a road would cost at least $50,000, or $75,000. The
Commission appropriated the $50,000 and issued orders to have the work
begun, fully expecting to have to add another $25,000 before the road
was finished. Nobody knows what character of road Captain Mead had in
mind when he made his estimate, but it transpired that nothing short of
first-class construction would last through even one heavy rain.
Besides, the Bued River Canyon had to be spanned six or eight times with
tremendous suspension bridges, and before the project was completed an
unwilling government had spent something like $2,500,000 on it. This was
spread over a period of years, of course, and much of it went for
necessary improvements or for the replacement of storm-wrecked bridges
and graded sections, but its enemies like to refer to it as our two and
a half million dollar road.

The Manila and Dagupan Railway company extended its road up to the point
where the Benguet Road begins and thus a way was opened into the only
region in the Philippines where one may find really invigorating air.
And while the road was building Baguio development began. A United
States Army Camp was established on a ridge overlooking a wide range of
pine-covered hills, and a hospital was erected for the accommodation of
invalid soldiers who, before these facilities for taking care of them
were provided, had always, at great expense to the government, to be
sent back to the United States. A civil hospital and tuberculosis camp
were opened; good hotels under private ownership soon took the place of
field tents and rough board shacks; markets and stores were started,
bringing in supplies in wholesale lots, and fair-sized buildings soon
began to go up in a substantial business section; people began to build
houses as rapidly as builders could be found to do the work; churches
and schools began to appear where nothing was before; a summer camp for
the recuperation of thousands of public school teachers was started in a
high valley carpeted with pine-needles, and lecture courses for vacation
instruction were instituted; a country club was organised with golf
links, a baseball diamond, polo grounds, tennis courts and everything
that goes to make a country club successful. The plan of the city was
drawn by Architect Burnham of Chicago, who visited Benguet for the
purpose, and a great central plaza was provided with artistic, but
inexpensive buildings for the accommodation of the two branches of the
government. Cottages in rows went up almost overnight; rich Filipinos
and a few Americans built fine homes; beautifully metalled drives began
to wind in and out and over and around the hills, and a high-class
government automobile ‘bus line was put on the Benguet Road which is the
delight of every American or other foreigner in the Islands, as well as
of many hundreds of Filipinos who annually take advantage of this wholly
novel opportunity to reach a salubrious climate in their own land, and
by a route which in any European country would attract scores of
thrill-seeking tourists.

And so the Philippine Simla was begun. Its friends, or, in other words,
most people have dreams of a great future for it when it shall be a
thriving, prosperous city and a health resort for everybody “east of
Suez” who needs to seek near by a temperate and invigorating climate.

It is six years since I saw Baguio, for I visited it the last time in
1907, but even then I could not believe that it was built on the ground
that I had ridden over and found practically uninhabited only six years
before. At that time a provincial government had been organised, and an
American, Mr. Phelps Whitmarsh, who was a writer and had lived among the
Igorrotes a long time, was appointed governor. But he was governor of a
wild-tribe province which did not then boast any greater signs of
civilisation than winding foot trails and a few groups of low-thatched
huts which were known as towns.

We rode in from Trinidad, not many miles from Baguio, on the morning of
the 23rd of June and went straight to the governor’s “mansion.” We were
welcomed by Mrs. Whitmarsh into a nipa-roofed, _suali_ house which,
though it was quite large, had no partitions except such as were made of
bamboo screens and hangings of bright-coloured Igorrote cloths. But it
had a big, open fireplace and a fine blaze from odorous pine boughs was
crackling up the chimney. This seemed particularly cosy and delightful
to us because we had just been camping in native huts in which the only
place for a fire was a square of earth in the middle of the floor and we
were not only quite frozen but we were thoroughly smoked.

[Illustration:

  THE ZIGZAG. HOW THE BENGUET ROAD CLIMBS TO AN ALTITUDE OF OVER 5,000
    FEET IN SIX MILES
]

At Baguio we got letters and telegrams from Manila and one of the
telegrams announced my husband’s appointment as Governor of the Islands,
so I knew that an adjustment of state affairs had been made and that I
should reach Manila to begin a new era in my Philippine experience. Mr.
Taft wrote me that the plans for his inauguration were practically
complete and that he was issuing cards for a big reception in honour of
General MacArthur at our house on the evening of the Fourth of July.
This filled me with something like panic, because I didn’t expect to
reach Manila until after the first of July and I didn’t see how I could
get ready on such short notice to entertain hundreds of people. However,
it was not for me to enter a protest on such a score, so it was decided
that we would go down as soon as we possibly could.

We spent two days enjoying the delightful hospitality of our friends in
Baguio and in exploring the country round about, and I, after listening
to builders’ dreams of what was to be and now is, proceeded to select a
site for my own future summer home.

We sat around a roaring fire of an evening and sang all our songs,
rather ruefully; we recounted our many adventures, and expressed our
sincere regret that our holiday was over; then on the morning of the
25th of June, at the dreary hour of half past four, we mounted our
refreshed and rested horses and started down the long Naguilian trail to
the coast. I wish only to add that the heat in the lowlands, after our
long breath of white man’s air in the mountains, was almost more than we
could stand, and I made the fatal mistake of leaving Baguio in a heavy
flannel riding shirt and with no thin blouse handy to take its place.



                               CHAPTER X
                             GOVERNOR TAFT


There is no denying that the arrangements made, during my absence in the
north, for my participation in the events attending my husband’s
induction into the office of Governor of the Philippines were enough to
fill me with dismay.

Mr. Taft had issued two thousand invitations for the reception at our
house in honour of General MacArthur, and on my way down from Baguio I
had been spending my time wondering how I should take care of the three
or four hundred I imagined had been asked. I had received no information
more definite than the simple statement that invitations had been sent
out, and it was not until I reached Manila that I learned the startling
number. I thought my husband knew something about the limitations of our
house, but I found that he had not taken this important matter into
consideration at all.

Fortunately we had a large garden in fairly good condition by this time,
so I immediately went to work and had it decorated with long lines and
festoons of Japanese lanterns; I ordered a large refreshment tent put up
in the middle of the wide lawn; then I sat down and prayed for fair
weather. It was the rainy season and I knew that only a specially
importuned Providence could keep the afternoon of the Fourth of July
clear.

The inauguration of the first American Governor was an occasion of great
dignity and interest. The ceremony took place on a platform erected at
one end of a large square in the Walled City which is enclosed on one
side by the Ayuntamiento, or Insular Capitol, and on another by the
Cathedral. The foundations of the Inaugural stand were of historic
interest in that they were originally intended to support a magnificent
residence for Spanish Governors-General and were on the site of the
ancient gubernatorial mansion which was destroyed by an earthquake in
1863. The rebuilding had never progressed beyond the laying of the
massive granite base, and this still stands as a mute reminder to
progressive Americans of the dilatory and otherwise questionable methods
which once obtained in the Philippine government.

The Cathedral Plaza—since renamed Plaza McKinley—presented a memorable
scene that Fourth of July morning. The architectural grace and
time-mellowed colours of the old Spanish buildings blended with the rich
luxuriance of many-hued tropic plants and the green of spreading
acacias. American flags covered the canopied platforms and floated from
every possible point of vantage. Americans and Filipinos, all in gala
attire, were pressed close together in the spectators’ stands which
extended on either side of the central pavilion; the plaza below was
thronged with Filipinos of every rank and condition, in all manner of
bright _jusis_ and calicoes; while above the crowd towered many American
soldiers and sailors in spic-and-span khaki or white duck.

The programme was much like other programmes. General MacArthur and his
staff occupied the centre of the platform. A well trained and finely
conducted Filipino band played several numbers; there was a prayer and
an invocation; then my husband, looking larger even than his natural
size in his crisp white linen suit, stepped to the front of the platform
and stood gravely looking down upon the stocky little Chief Justice of
the Archipelago, Señor Arellano, who administered the oath of office.
Afterward Mr. Taft and Mr. Fergusson stood together and delivered, in
English and Spanish, paragraph by paragraph in translation, the
Inaugural address.

I think only one unfortunate incident occurred to mar the complete
harmony of the occasion, and that was furnished by a United States
Congressman of the Military Committee of the House, who was visiting
Manila at the time.

Tickets of admission to the central pavilion had been sent to him, but
he had forgotten to bring them with him. However, when he arrived at the
plaza he started, with several ladies who were with him, to mount the
steps of the Inaugural platform on which no ladies were allowed. He was
stopped, naturally, and a guard offered to conduct his guests to seats
on a side pavilion, telling him at the time that the central stand had
been reserved for government officials and representatives, among whom
he, of course, was included. This separate seating of the ladies seemed
to annoy him for some reason, and he announced his intention of
remaining with his party. He was then shown to the best available seats
and the incident seemed to be closed. But he was by no means satisfied
with his position, especially when he found that the wives of some of
the Commissioners had seats in front of him. I think the heat must have
been affecting him for he called the Naval Lieutenant, who was in charge
as usher, and made audible protest against “those wives of clerks” being
put before him and his wife. The young naval officer was polite, but
quite firm in his refusal to take any steps to remedy matters.

“You don’t seem to know who I am!” he exclaimed, with manifest
indignation.

“No, sir, I do not,” mildly replied the Lieutenant.

“Well,” said the angry man, “I’m a member of the Military Committee of
the House of Representatives. I helped to make this Army out here and
I’ve come out to see what kind of work I did. I don’t like it, and I’m
going home and unmake it. This treatment of me here is of a piece with
the treatment I’ve received ever since I’ve been in these islands.”

This didn’t sound quite fair. He had been treated with marked courtesy
by everybody and had accepted rather lavish hospitality from both Army
officers and civil officials. In fact, he had received every possible
attention in a most unusually hospitable community. The young Lieutenant
bristled up and said:

[Illustration:

  MR. TAFT TAKING THE OATH OF OFFICE AS THE FIRST AMERICAN GOVERNOR OF
    THE PHILIPPINE ISLANDS
]

“Sorry, sir, but I’m obeying orders; and I’d just like to tell you that
I consider your remarks exceedingly impolite.”

Upon which the gentleman from Washington left the pavilion and went down
to stand in a place which the guards had been ordered to keep clear.

The rest of the story I heard afterward. It seems that both General
Barry and General Davis saw him and took pains to go down and ask him up
into the central pavilion, but he refused to go. Then one of the guards
came up and politely informed him: “Orders, sir, you’ll have to stand
back.” By this time he was infuriated and he turned on the guard and,
after identifying himself, repeated his remarks about having made the
Army and being determined to go back to Washington and unmake it.

“Well,” said the guard, “I guess you can’t unmake me. I’ve just been
mustered out of the United States Army and am a plain American citizen.
I don’t understand that Congress can do much about unmaking American
citizens.” Which all goes to show that it doesn’t do much good to lose
one’s temper. The gentleman took his party and stalked out of the plaza.

My hopes for the evening were blasted. About five o’clock the heavens
opened and such a sheet of water descended upon my refreshment tent and
my strings of gay paper lanterns as one never sees in the Temperate
Zone. It was raining in torrents when our guests began to arrive, and if
many of those invited had not been kept at home by the weather I don’t
know what I should have done with the crowd. I had a wide hall, a small
reception room, a dining-room and the verandah, but two thousand people
are a good many, and I’m sure a large majority of them came in spite of
the weather. It was a “crush,” and a warm, moist crush, but it was a
gala occasion, everybody was in good humour and the evening passed much
more pleasantly than I had any reason to expect. This was the first
entertainment of such proportions that I had undertaken in Manila, and I
saw at once that, as the Governor’s wife, I should need all the
spaciousness of Malacañan Palace.

I think General MacArthur was pleased with our farewell hospitality to
him; he seemed to be; and I think his feelings toward Mr. Taft, when he
left the Islands the next day, were exceedingly friendly. But we heard
later that letters had come from companions of his on the ship which
said that he very keenly resented the fact that the new Governor had not
seen fit to mention him with praise in his Inaugural address. Mr. Taft
said he was very sorry, but, in view of the relations which were known
to exist between the Military government and the Commission, he thought
it would have been very difficult to find the tactful words which would
have satisfied the General, and in uttering which he would not have
stultified himself.

I am quite sure that General MacArthur never disliked my husband
personally. His resentment was against the Commissioners in their
official capacity, whereby his own authority was diminished. In later
years, as Secretary of War, Mr. Taft met him very often and their
relations were always perfectly cordial. After his death there was
considerable newspaper comment to the effect that he had been very badly
treated. There was no refutation of the charges, but everybody familiar
with the facts knew they had no foundation. When Mr. Taft was Secretary
of War, on his recommendation General MacArthur was given the highest
rank in the United States Army, that of Lieutenant-General, and at his
own request was sent by Mr. Taft on a mission to travel through China
with his son, an Army officer, as his aide, and to make a military
report upon the country. On his return, at his own request, he was not
assigned to specific command, but was ordered to his home at Milwaukee
to prepare the report on China, and there he remained by his own choice
until his retirement.

On the morning of July 5, we moved to Malacañan, and General Chaffee,
who succeeded General MacArthur, took our house on the Bay. There was a
great deal of contention with regard to this exchange of houses. Mr.
Taft knew that to the mind of the Filipinos the office of Governor,
without the accustomed “setting” and general aspects of the position,
would lose a large part of its dignity and effectiveness. He also knew
that a Civil Government, unless it were quartered in the Ayuntamiento,
the recognised seat of government, would inspire but little confidence
or respect. The outward semblance is all-important to the Filipino mind,
yet knowing this the Military authorities clung with dogged tenacity to
every visible evidence of supremacy, and it took an order from
Washington to get them to vacate the Ayuntamiento in which they had, in
the beginning, refused the Commission adequate office room. An official
order also turned the Governor’s residence over to the new Governor and,
at the same time, relieved Mr. Taft of the necessity for deciding what
to do with our house in Malate. It was the best available house in the
city and every man on the Commission wanted it, so if the War Department
had not taken it for the Commanding General somebody’s feelings surely
would have suffered. Mr. Taft had about decided to toss a coin in the
presence of them all to see which one of his colleagues should have it.

In some ways we regretted that the move was necessary, for we were very
comfortable in our “chalet,” as Señor Juan de Juan had editorially
called it, and invigorating dips in the high breakers of the Bay had
become one of our pleasantest pastimes. But we knew that no amount of
executive orders could turn our homely and unpalatial abode into a
gubernatorial mansion, so we needs must move for the effect on the
native mind, if for nothing else. Not until we did, would the Filipinos
be convinced that Civil Government was actually established.

Not that I wasn’t well pleased with the idea of living in a palace,
however unlike the popular conception of a palace it might be. I had not
been brought up with any such destiny in view and I confess that it
appealed to my imagination.

Malacañan is old and rather damp and, in my time, some of it had not
been furnished or finished according to modern ideas, but in size and
dignity it leaves nothing to be desired, and it has historic
associations which give it an atmosphere that I found to be quite
thrilling. It contains many fine, old-world Spanish portraits, and there
is one large canvas of especial interest which hangs at the head of the
main stairway. It depicts the ceremony through which Magellan made peace
with the natives of Cebu when he landed on that island in April, 1521.
This consisted of drawing blood from the breasts of the principal
parties to the contract, the one drinking that of the other. The
Spaniards called it the _Pacto de Sangre_, or the Blood Pact, and so the
picture is named. In our own day the Katipunan League, the strongest and
most sinister of all the insurrectionary secret societies, are said to
have adopted this ceremony in their rites of initiation, and members of
the League could be identified by a peculiar scar on the breast.

The grounds at Malacañan contain, perhaps, twenty acres, and in those
days there were fields and swamps in the enclosure as well as lawns and
fountains, flower-beds and kitchen gardens. There were five or six
good-sized houses in the grounds for the use of secretaries and aides,
and the stables were very large.

I would not care to hazard a guess as to the number of _parientes_ we
sheltered in the quarters of our employés. Mr. Taft called these
quarters our “Filipino tenement” and “Calle Pariente,” but screened with
shrubbery and spreading down the sides of a twenty-acre lot the colony
did not seem as conspicuous as our huddled tribe had been in Malate.

The Palace is architecturally Spanish, yet it lacks the large patio,
having two small courts instead. The lower floor, on a level with the
ground, is really nothing more than a basement and has no usable spaces
in it except some raised offices and cloak rooms. Frequently during bad
typhoons I have seen water two and three feet deep in the entrance hall,
but it always receded very rapidly and seldom gave us any inconvenience.
The entrance, which is paved with marble, is very broad, and there is a
wide and imposing staircase of polished hardwood leading to the
reception hall above. The great living-rooms open one into another,
giving a fine perspective, and they lead, through a dozen different
doorways, on to a splendid, white-tiled verandah which runs out to the
bank of the Pásig River. There is a picturesque, moss-covered river
landing on the verandah below.

There are about twenty rooms on the one floor, all of them good sized
and some of them enormous, and it took a great many servants to keep the
place in order. The floors were all of beautiful hardwoods and it
required a permanent force of six _muchachos_ to keep them in a proper
state of polish. The Filipino method of polishing floors is interesting.
Your _muchacho_ ties either banana leaves or some sort of bags on his
bare feet, then he skates up and down, up and down, until the floors get
so slick that he himself can hardly stand up on them. It is easy to
imagine that six boys skating together in the spaciousness of the Palace
might cut fancy figures and have a delightful time generally, if they
thought they were unobserved. Filipinos of the _muchacho_ class always
play like children, no matter what they are doing, and they have to be
treated like children.

The Palace furniture, which must have been very fine in Spanish days,
was of red _narra_, or Philippine mahogany, handsomely carved and
displaying on every piece the Spanish coat-of-arms. But during the
changing Spanish régimes some one with a bizarre taste had covered all
the beautiful wood with a heavy coat of black paint. The effect was
depressingly sombre to me.

The porcelain, however, or what was left of it, was unusually good. The
Spanish coat-of-arms in beautiful colours was reproduced on each plate
against a background of a dark blue canopy. I must say there were quite
as many reminders of Spanish authority as I could wish for and I
frequently felt that some noble Don might walk in at any moment and
catch me living in his house.

But, it didn’t take us long to get settled down in our new domain, and I
soon ceased to regret the sea breezes and the salt baths of Malate.
Malacañan enjoyed a clean sweep of air from the river and our open
verandah was in many ways an improvement on the gaudily glazed one that
we had gradually become accustomed to in the other house. The Malacañan
verandah, being much of it roofless, was of little use in the daytime,
but on clear evenings it was the most delightful spot I have ever seen.
I began to love the tropical nights and to feel that I never before had
known what nights can be like. The stars were so large and hung so low
that they looked almost like raised silver figures on a dark blue field.
And when the moon shone—but why try to write about tropical moonlight?
The wonderful sunsets and the moonlit nights have tied more American
hearts to Manila and the Philippines than all the country’s other charms
combined. And they are both indescribable.

[Illustration:

  TWO VIEWS OF MALACAÑAN PALACE. THE FIRST PICTURE SHOWS THE WIDE,
    ROOFLESS VERANDA OVER THE PASIG RIVER
]

When I lived in Malate and could look out across the open, white-capped
bay to far-away Mt. Meriveles, I sometimes forgot I was in the Tropics.
But at Malacañan when we gazed down on the low-lapping Pásig, glinting
in the starlight, and across the rice fields on the other side where
swaying lanterns twinkled from beneath the outline of thatched roofs,
there was little to remind us that we were Americans or that we had ever
felt any air less soothing than the soft breeze which rustled the bamboo
plumes along the bank.

Our household was in every way much enlarged on our change of residence
and circumstances. There were eight or nine _muchachos_ in the house,
two extra Chinese helpers in the kitchen, and the staff of coachmen and
gardeners increased on even a larger scale. Our stable of ponies
multiplied to sixteen, and even then there were too few for our various
needs. It is difficult for the dweller in the Temperate Zone to realise
how small an amount of work the native of the Tropics, either man or
beast, is capable of.

We thought at first that the salary attached to the office of Governor
of the Philippines was quite splendid, but we soon gave up any idea we
might have had of saving a little of it for a rainy day. Our rainy day
was upon us. It rained official obligations which we had to meet. The
mere cost of lighting Malacañan was enough to keep a modest family in
comfort. I don’t know about conditions at the Palace now, but I imagine
they have not changed much, and I do know that Manila is a more
expensive place in which to live than it was in my time. And yet there
is serious talk of reducing the salary of the Governor-General. It seems
a pity. This would place the office in a class with Ambassadorships
which nobody but rich men can accept. The present salary, with nice
management and a not too ambitious programme, will just about cover
expenses, but I feel sorry for the wife of the Governor who must try to
do what is expected of her on less.

My cook, who had been quite independent of me at Malate, became at
Malacañan wholly unapproachable. I don’t know why, but so it was. He
occupied quarters opening on one of the courts below and connected with
the dining-room by an outside staircase up which I was never able to
inveigle him. I had to deliver my orders from the top of the stairs and
when he had listened to just as much as he cared to hear he would
disappear through the kitchen door, and no amount of calling would bring
him back. As the kitchen was an ante-chamber to a sort of Chinese
catacombs, extending over a good part of the basement, I never ventured
to follow him and I had to swallow my wrath as best I could.

But he was a jewel despite his eccentricities. He could produce the most
elaborate and varied buffet suppers I ever saw and I never knew a cook
who could make such a wonderful variety of cakes and fruit tarts and
cream-puffs. He took a real delight in their construction, and for two
days before a reception he would spend all his time filling every pan in
the house with _patisseries_ elaborately iced in every imaginable
colour.

I began at once to give an afternoon reception every week and if it
hadn’t been for my disagreeable, but capable, old Ah Sing I should have
been in a constant turmoil of engagements with caterers and
confectioners. As it was, I never had to give an order, really.
“Reception Wednesday, Ah Sing,” was all that was necessary, and except
for a glance now and then to see that the _muchachos_ were giving the
floors and the furniture a little extra polish on Wednesday morning, the
only preparations I had to make for receiving two thousand people were
to put on an embroidered muslin gown and compose myself.

These afternoon receptions were public, our only form of invitation
being an “At Home” notice in the newspapers, and considering the
unsettled state of Manila society in those days, it is really remarkable
that we had so few unwelcome guests. There were a great many derelicts
and generally disreputable people, both American and European, trying to
better their fortunes or add to the excitement in our agitated
community, but we suffered no unpleasant consequences from our open
hospitality, though every Wednesday the Palace was thronged and every
Wednesday many new faces appeared. Army and Navy people, civilians of
every occupation and many foreigners—Germans and British mostly—came
nearly always. I remember especially the first instalment of American
school teachers. They were, for the most part, a fine lot of men and
women who had come out with high hopes and ideals and an enthusiastic
desire to pass them on. There were some pretty girls among them and a
number of very clever looking men. I believe they used to enjoy my
parties as much as anybody in Manila. They were homesick, no doubt,
especially the girls, and I suppose the sight of so many friendly
American faces cheered them up.

The Filipinos had to have a little coaxing before they began to avail
themselves very freely of our general invitation. But by asking many of
them personally and persistently to “be sure and come Wednesday” we
prevailed on a good number to believe they were really wanted; and after
a little while there began to be as many brown faces as white among our
guests.

Speaking of school teachers reminds me that it was just about this time
that our minds were relieved of all anxiety with regard to Bob’s and
Helen’s education. My husband had wanted to send our ten-year-old son
back across the Pacific and the United States, all by himself, to his
Uncle Horace’s school in Connecticut, and I had opposed the idea with
all my might without being able to offer a satisfactory substitute plan.
But now a school for American children was opened and they were as well
taught as they would have been at home. Moreover, Bob and Helen found a
large number of congenial companions, and I don’t think I ever saw a
happier set of boys and girls. They lived out of doors and did
everything that children usually do, but their most conspicuous
performance was on the Luneta in the evenings, where they would race
around the drive on their little ponies, six abreast, or play games all
over the grass plots which were then, and always have been, maintained
chiefly for the benefit of children, both brown and white.

My husband’s change in title and station made very little difference in
the character of his duties, but it gave him increased authority in the
performance of them. The onerous necessity for submitting legislation to
an executive whose point of view was different from that of the
Commission came to an end, and he was able to see that such laws as the
Commission passed were put in operation without delay. Under General
Chaffee the feeling on the part of the Army against the encroachments of
civil government gave way, slowly but surely, to an attitude of, at
least, friendly toleration. It was as if they said: “Well, let them
alone; we know they are wrong; but they must learn by experience, and,
after all, they mean well.”

General Chaffee and General MacArthur were two quite different types of
men. General Chaffee was less precise, less analytical. General
MacArthur had always been given to regarding everything in its
“psychological” aspect and, indeed, “psychological” was a word so
frequently on his lips that it became widely popular. General Chaffee
was impetuous; he was much less formal than his predecessor both in
thought and manner, and Mr. Taft found co-operation with him much less
difficult. He made no secret of his conviction, which was shared by most
of the Army, that civil government was being established prematurely,
but he was not unreasonable about it.

He refused at first to listen to the proposition for the establishment
of a native Constabulary. This had been the Commission’s pet project
ever since they had been in the Islands, and it was a great
disappointment to them to find that the opposition which they had
encountered in the former administration was to be continued.

What they wanted was a force of several thousand Filipinos, trained and
commanded by American Army officers, either from the regular Army or
from the volunteers. The same thing had been done with success by the
British in India and the Straits Settlements, by the Dutch in Java and
by our own General Davis in Porto Rico, and as the insurrectionary force
had dwindled to a few bands and to scattered groups of murderers and
ladrones, so acknowledged by everybody, there was no reason why a native
constabulary should not be employed to clear these out.

This plan was among the first things submitted to General Chaffee, but
he was evidently not impressed. “Pin them down with a bayonet for at
least ten years” was a favourite expression of Army sentiment which
sometimes made the Commissioners’ explanations to the natives rather
difficult.

General Wright, on behalf of the Commission, called on General Chaffee
and was much surprised to learn that he had not even read the
Constabulary bill which had been passed some time before and held up
pending the hoped for opportunity to carry it into effect. When General
Wright explained the purport of the measure General Chaffee said,

“I am opposed to the whole business. It seems to me that you are trying
to introduce something to take the place of my Army.”

“Why, so we are,” said General Wright. “We are trying to create a civil
police force to do the police work which we understood the Army was
anxious to be relieved of. You have announced your purpose to
concentrate the Army in the interest of economy, and to let our civil
governments stand alone to see what is in them and we consider it
necessary to have a constabulary, or some such force, to take care of
the lawless characters that are sure to be in the country after four
years of war, and especially in a country where the natives take
naturally to ladronism. The Municipal police as now organised are not
able to meet all the requirements in this regard.”

“There you are,” said General Chaffee, “you give your whole case away.”

“I have no case to give away,” replied General Wright. “We are trying to
put our provincial governments on a basis where they will require
nothing but the moral force of the military arm, and actually to
preserve law and order through the civil arm. The people desire peace,
but they also desire protection and we intend through the civil
government to give it to them.”

The Commissioner then suggested the names of some Army officers whose
peculiar tact in handling Filipinos had marked them as the best
available men for organising and training native soldiers, but General
Chaffee was not inclined to detail them for the work, so General Wright
returned to the Commission quite cast down and communicated to his
colleagues the feeling that they were to have a continuance of the same
difficulties with which they were required to contend under the former
administration.

But a peacemaker came along in the person of General Corbin. He spent
some time with General Chaffee and then came to Malacañan to visit us.
He made a hurried, but quite extensive trip through the Islands and gave
the whole situation pretty thorough inspection. After he left, a change
was found to have come over the spirit of affairs, and it was thought
that he had managed to make clear to everybody concerned that, while
there was a military arm and a civil arm of the government in the
Philippines, they represented a single American purpose and that that
purpose had been expressed by the administration at Washington when the
Commission was sent out to do the work it was then engaged upon.

After that General Chaffee seems not only to have been amenable to
reason, but to have been imbued with a spirit of cordiality and
helpfulness which was most gratifying to the long-harassed Commission.
To facilitate co-operation, a private telephone was installed between
the offices of Mr. Taft and the Commanding General, and it seemed to me
that my husband suddenly lost some of the lines of worry which had begun
to appear in his face.

The Constabulary, as everybody knows, was eventually established and
perhaps no finer body of men, organised for such a purpose, exists. It
took a long time to get them enlisted, equipped and properly drilled,
but to-day they are a force which every man and woman in the
Philippines, of whatever nationality, colour, creed or occupation,
regards with peculiar satisfaction. They include corps enlisted from
nearly every tribe in the Islands, not excepting the Moros and the
Igorrotes. The Moro _constabulario_ is distinguishable from the
Christian in that he wears a jaunty red fez with his smart khaki uniform
instead of the regulation cap, while the Igorrote refuses trousers and
contents himself with the cap, the tight jacket, the cartridge belt and
a bright “G-string.” To the Ifugao Igorrote uniform is added a
distinguishing spiral of brass which the natty soldier wears just below
the knee. It is difficult to imagine anything more extraordinary than a
“crack” company of these magnificent barelegged Ifugaos going through
dress-parade drill under the sharp commands of an American officer. The
Constabulary Band of eighty-odd pieces, under the direction of Captain
Loving, an American negro from the Boston Conservatory of Music, is well
known in America and is generally considered one of the really great
bands of the world. All its members are Filipinos.

Press clippings and some correspondence which I have before me remind me
that even at this period there began to manifest itself in the Taft
family, and otherwheres, a mild interest in the possibility that my
husband might become President of the United States. Mr. Taft himself
treated all such “far-fetched speculation” with the derision which he
thought it deserved, but to me it did not seem at all unreasonable. We
received first a copy of the Boston _Herald_ containing two marked
articles in parallel columns, one of which, headed by a picture of Mr.
Taft, stated that in Washington there had been serious suggestion of his
name as a Presidential candidate and the other giving a sympathetic
account of an anti-imperialistic meeting at Faneuil Hall. We thought the
two articles as “news items” hardly warranted juxtaposition, and it
seemed to us the editor was indulging a sort of sardonic sense of humour
when he placed them so. Not that my husband was an “imperialist,” but
that he was generally so considered. Indeed, he was the most active
anti-imperialist of them all. He was doing the work of carrying out a
thoroughly anti-imperialistic policy, but he recognised the difference
between abandoning the Philippines to a certain unhappy fate and guiding
them to substantial independence founded on self-dependence. It took a
long time to get the shouters from the housetops to accept this
interpretation of our national obligation, but there was reassurance in
the fact that where our honour is involved Americanism can always be
trusted to rise above purely partisan politics.

Mr. Taft’s mother, who took an active and very intelligent interest in
her son’s work and who sent him letters by nearly every mail which were
filled with entertaining and accurate comment on Philippine affairs,
took the suggestion of his being a Presidential possibility quite
seriously. And she did not at all approve of it. Having seen a number of
press notices about it she sat down and wrote him a long letter in which
she discussed with measured arguments the wisdom of his keeping out of
politics. At that time the idea appealed to nothing in him except his
sense of humour. He wrote to his brother Charles: “To me such a
discussion has for its chief feature the element of humour. The idea
that a man who has issued injunctions against labour unions, almost by
the bushel, who has sent at least ten or a dozen violent labour
agitators to jail, and who is known as one of the worst judges for the
maintenance of government by injunction, could ever be a successful
candidate on a Presidential ticket, strikes me as intensely ludicrous;
and had I the slightest ambition in that direction I hope that my good
sense would bid me to suppress it. But, more than this, the horrors of a
modern Presidential campaign and the political troubles of the
successful candidate for President, rob the office of the slightest
attraction for me. I have but one ambition, and if that cannot be
satisfied I am content to return to the practice of the law with
reasonable assurance that if my health holds out I can make a living,
and make Nellie and the children more comfortable than I could if I went
to Washington.”

This letter is dated August 27, 1901, and was written on a Spanish
steamer which the Commission had taken from Aparri, on the north coast
of Luzon, after they finished the last of the long trips they had to
make for the purpose of organising civil government in the provinces.

It was just after they returned from this trip; just when things were at
their brightest; when everything seemed to be developing so rapidly and
our hopes were running high, that we were shaken by the appalling news
of the attack on President McKinley. We had kept luncheon waiting for
Mr. Taft until it seemed useless to wait any longer and we were at table
when he came in. He looked so white and stunned and helpless that I was
frightened before he could speak. Then he said, “The President has been
shot.”

I suppose that throughout the United States the emotions of horror and
grief were beyond expression, but I cannot help thinking that to the
Americans in the Philippines the shock came with more overwhelming force
than to any one else. Mr. McKinley was our chief in a very special
sense. He was the director of our endeavours and the father of our
destinies. It was he who had sent the civil officials out there and it
was on the strength of his never failing support that we had relied in
all our troubles. It might, indeed, have been Mr. Root in whose mind the
great schemes for the development of the islands and their peoples had
been conceived, but Mr. Root exercised his authority through the wise
endorsement of the President and it was to the President that we looked
for sanction or criticism of every move that was made. Then, too, the
extraordinary sweetness of his nature inspired in every one with whom he
came in close contact a strong personal affection, and we had reason to
feel this more than most people. Truly, it was as if the foundations of
our world had crumbled under us.

But he was not dead; and on the fact that he was strong and clean we
began to build hopes. Yet the hush which fell upon the community on the
day that he was shot was not broken until a couple of days before he
died when we received word that he was recovering. We were so far away
that we could not believe anybody would send us such a cable unless it
were founded on a practical certainty, and our “Thank God!” was
sufficiently fervent to dispel all the gloom that had enveloped us. Then
came the cable announcing his death. I need not dwell on that.

Mr. Taft and Mr. Roosevelt knew each other very well. They had been in
Washington together years before, Mr. Taft as Solicitor General, Mr.
Roosevelt as Civil Service Commissioner, and they had corresponded with
some frequency since we had been in Manila. So, in so far as the work in
the Philippines was concerned, my husband knew where the new President’s
sympathies were and he had no fears on that score. At the same time he
was most anxious to have Mr. Root continued as Secretary of War in order
that there might not be any delay or radical change in carrying out the
plans which had been adopted and put in operation under his direction.
All activities suffered a sort of paralysis from the crushing blow of
the President’s assassination, but the press of routine work continued.
We were very much interested in learning that a great many Filipinos,
clever politicians as they are, thought that after Mr. McKinley’s death
Mr. Bryan would become President, and that, after all, they would get
immediate independence.

Then came the awful tragedy of Balangiga. It happened only a few days
after the President died, while our nerves were still taut, and filled
us all with unspeakable horror intensified by the first actual fear we
had felt since we had been in the Philippine Islands. Company “C” of the
9th Infantry, stationed at the town of Balangiga on the island of Samar,
was surprised at breakfast, without arms and at a considerable distance
from their quarters, and fifty of them were massacred. About thirty
fought their way bare handed through the mob, each man of which had a
bolo or a gun, and lived to tell the tale. It was a disaster so ghastly
in its details, so undreamed of under the conditions of almost universal
peace which had been established, that it created absolute panic. Men
began to go about their everyday occupations in Manila carrying pistols
conspicuously displayed, and half the people one met could talk of
nothing else but their conviction that the whole archipelago was a
smouldering volcano and that we were all liable to be murdered in our
beds any night. Of course this made the Army officers more certain than
ever that the Islands should have remained under military control
indefinitely, and I cannot deny that, at the time, their arguments
seemed to have some foundation. It was a frightful nervous strain and it
took several months of tranquillity to restore confidence. If it had
been a regular engagement in which the Americans had sustained a reverse
it could have been accepted with some philosophy, but it was a plain
massacre of a company of defenceless men by many times their number who
had gotten into the town with the consent of the American authorities,
and in conspiracy with the local headman and the native parish priest,
on the pretext of bringing in for surrender a band of insurrectos.

The man, Lucban, who was in command of the Samar ladrones who committed
this atrocity, is now a prominent politico in Manila, and it is
interesting to know that only last year, in a campaign speech, he
referred with dramatic intensity to “our glorious victory of Balangiga.”
He was appealing to an ignorant electorate, many of whom, as he knew,
wore the scar of the awful Katipunan “blood pact,” but it is just to
record that the average Filipino is not proud of the Balangiga
“victory.”

Shortly before these unhappy events my sister Maria was called back to
America by the illness of our mother, and I was left to face the tragic
excitements of the month of September without her comforting
companionship. By October I began to feel that I would have to get out
of the Philippine Islands or suffer a nervous breakdown, so my husband
and I agreed that it would be well for me to “run up to China,” as they
express it out there. Running up to China at that time of year meant
getting out of tropic heat into bracing autumn weather with a nip of
real winter in it, and there was nothing that I needed more.

Mrs. Wright and Mrs. Moses were both anxious to see something of China
before leaving the Orient, and as this seemed an excellent opportunity
to make the trip, they decided to go with me. The Boxer Insurrection had
just been suppressed and the Dowager Empress had not yet returned from
the West, whither she had fled during the siege of Peking. We were used
to the alarums of war and we thought we were likely to see more of China
“from the inside” than if we visited the country during a period of
complete calm. Then there were wonderful tales of valuable “loot” which
interested us. Not necessarily illegitimate loot, but curios and art
treasures in the hands of Chinese themselves who were selling things at
ridiculously low figures and, sometimes, with a fascinating air of great
mystery. There is some allurement in the idea of bargaining for
priceless porcelains, ivories, silks and Russian sables behind closed
and double-locked doors, in the dark depths of some wretched Chinese
hovel. Our Army officers who had helped to relieve Peking brought us
stories of this kind of adventure, and I secretly hoped that we should
be able to have just some such experience. But being the wives of
American officials I thought likely we should be “taken care of” every
hour of every twenty-four. And so we were.

We sailed to Shanghai and went from there straight to Peking, where we
became the guests of Colonel and Mrs. Robertson, who had gone in with
the American troops in the Allied Armies and were quartered in no less a
place than the Temple of Heaven. The casual tourist looking now upon
that glorious collection of ancestral shrines would find it difficult to
believe that they once served as barracks for American soldiers. Most
people who visit the Temple of Heaven find in it an atmosphere of peace
and serenity such as is achieved by few structures in the world, and to
have this deep calm invaded by business-like “foreign-devil” troops must
have ruffled the spirits of the high gods. But the soldiers had to be
quartered somewhere and this great, clean, tree-sheltered enclosure in
the heart of the Chinese city offered ample space.

Mr. Conger was then our Minister to China, and after spending a few very
busy days sightseeing we went to the Legation to visit him. The Legation
quarter, which had been laid in ruins during the Boxer troubles, had not
yet begun to assume an aspect of orderliness, and many were the
evidences of the weeks of horror through which the besieged foreign
representatives had lived.

As the Empress Dowager and her court had not yet returned, we hoped to
be able to see all the mysteries of the Forbidden City, but order had
been restored to a point where it was possible to make the palaces once
more “forbidden,” so we were shown only enough to whet our curiosity.
But the wonderful walls and the temples, the long, unbelievable streets
and the curious life of the people were sufficient to save us from any
feeling of disappointment in our visit. At a dinner given for us by our
Minister we met a number of men and women who had been through the
siege, and I sat next to Sir Robert Hart, of the Imperial Chinese
Customs, the most interesting man, perhaps, that the great
occidental-oriental co-operation has ever produced.

When we returned to Shanghai on our way down from Peking I was greeted
by two cablegrams. It just happened that I opened them in the order of
their coming and the first one contained the information that my husband
was very ill and said that I had better return at once to Manila, while
the second read that he was much better and that there was no cause for
alarm. There was no way of getting to Manila for several days, because
there were no boats going. So I decided to take a trip up the Yangtse
River on the house-boat belonging to the wife of the American Consul. If
I had been doing this for pleasure instead of for the purpose of
“getting away from myself” I should have enjoyed it exceedingly, but as
it was I have but a vague recollection of a very wide and very muddy
river; great stretches of clay flats, broken here and there by little
clumps of round mounds which I knew were Chinese graves, and bordered by
distant, low hills; an occasional quaint grey town with uptilted tile
roofs; and a few graceful but dreary-looking pagodas crowning lonesome
hill-tops. And in addition to all of this there was a seething mass of
very dirty and very noisy humanity which kept out of our way and
regarded us with anything but friendly looks.

I had left my husband apparently perfectly well, but I subsequently
learned that the night after I left Manila he developed the first
symptoms of his illness. It was diagnosed at first as dengue fever, a
disease quite common in the Philippines which, though exceedingly
disagreeable, is not regarded as dangerous. It was about two weeks
before a correct diagnosis was made, and it was then discovered that he
was suffering from an abscess which called for a serious emergency
operation. He was taken to the First Reserve Army hospital and the
operation was performed by Dr. Rhoads, the Army surgeon who afterward
became his aide when he was President.

The children must have been much frightened. They had never seen their
father ill before, and he told me afterward that he should never forget
the way they looked as he was being carried out of Malacañan on a
stretcher borne by six stalwart American policemen. They were all
huddled together in the great hall as he passed through, and while Bob
and Charlie were gazing at the proceedings in open-eyed astonishment,
Helen was weeping.

For twenty-four hours after the operation the doctors were not at all
certain that their patient would live, nor did their anxiety end at that
time. The abscess was of long growth, the wound had to be made a
terrible one, and there was great danger of blood poisoning. Mr. Taft
rallied but a second operation was necessary. By the time I reached
Manila he was well on the way to recovery, though even then there was no
prospect of his being able to move for many weeks to come.

He used to lie on his cot in the hospital and recite to his visitors a
verse of Kipling’s which he thought fitted his case exactly:

             “Now it is not well for the white man
               To hurry the Aryan brown,
             For the white man riles and the Aryan smiles,
               And it weareth the white man down.
             And the end of the fight is a tombstone white
               With the name of the late deceased,
             And the epitaph drear: ‘A fool lies here
               Who tried to hurry the East.’”

It was decided at once by everybody, including the doctors, Mr. Root and
President Roosevelt, that Mr. Taft must leave the Islands as soon as he
was able to travel, and there were several reasons, besides those
connected with health, why it seemed best for us to return to the United
States. The principal one was that Congress was becoming very active
with regard to Philippine matters, and as Mr. Taft was anxious that the
right kind of legislation should be passed, he wished to go to
Washington and present the facts about the situation as he had found
them during his long hand-to-hand struggle with the problem. Mr. Root
cabled him that his presence in Washington was necessary and granted him
a three months’ leave of absence from his duties as Governor, while
General Wright was appointed vice-Governor to fill his place for the
time being.

Mr. Worcester was the ranking member of the Commission, but my husband
felt that he had not quite the same talent for genially dealing with
every kind of person, whether evasive Filipino or dictatorial Army
officer, which General Wright so conspicuously displayed, and, moreover,
Mr. Worcester was entirely engrossed with the problems of his
department, which included health and sanitation and the satisfactory
adjustment of the difficulties connected with the government of the
non-Christian tribes. These were matters which appealed to Mr.
Worcester’s scientific mind and which he vastly preferred to the
uncongenial task of administering the routine of government, so he was
only too willing not to be encumbered with the duties of Governor. This,
I understand, was Mr. Worcester’s attitude throughout his thirteen years
as Secretary of the Interior, during which time he was always the
ranking Commissioner with the first right, under a promotion system, to
the Governorship whenever a vacancy occurred in that office.

The transport _Grant_ was assigned for our use by General Chaffee, and
we made our preparations for an extended absence.

One incident of my husband’s convalescence in the hospital I think I
must relate. In an adjoining room General Frederick Funston was
recovering from an operation for appendicitis and he was sufficiently
far advanced to be able to walk around, so he used to call on Mr. Taft
quite often. Now General Funston, for the benefit of those who have no
mental picture of him, is by no means gigantic. He has the bearing of a
seven-foot soldier, but the truth is he is not more than five feet three
or four inches in height.

One day there was an earthquake of long duration and extended vibration
which would have been sufficient to destroy Manila had it not lacked a
certain upward jerk calculated to unbalance swaying walls. One gets used
to earthquakes in the Orient in a way, but no amount of familiarity can
make the sensation a pleasant one. My husband was alone at the time and
he had decided to hold hard to his bed and let the roof come down on him
if it had to. The hospital was a one story wooden building and he really
thought he was as safe in it as he would be anywhere. Moreover, he was
quite unable to walk, so his fortitude could hardly be called voluntary,
but he had scarcely had time to steel himself for the worst when his
door was thrown open and in rushed General Funston.

“We must carry out the Governor!” he shouted; “we must carry out the
Governor!”

“But how are you going to do that, General?” asked Mr. Taft.

He knew quite well that General Funston, in his weakened condition,
would be incapable of carrying an infant very far.

“Oh, I have my orderly with me,” responded the doughty General, and by
this time he had begun to get a firm grasp on the mattress while behind
him hurried a soldier, shorter even than his chief, but with the same
look of dauntless determination in his eye.

In spite of the straining on the rafters, Mr. Taft burst out laughing
and flatly refused to let them try to move him. Fortunately for them all
the upward jerk necessary to bring down the roof didn’t occur, so there
is no way of telling whether or not, for once in his life, General
Funston started something that he couldn’t finish.

We sailed from Manila on Christmas Eve, 1901, and, much as I had enjoyed
my life and experiences in our new world of the Philippines, I was glad
to see the tropic shores fade away and to feel that we were to have a
few months in our own land and climate, and among our own old friends,
before I sighted them again.



                               CHAPTER XI
                             A TRIP TO ROME


The winter of 1902, the greater part of which we spent in Cincinnati, is
memorable only as a period of bereavement and protracted illnesses.
Perhaps such a record has no place in a narrative wherein it is my wish
to dwell on pleasant memories only, or, at least, to touch as lightly as
possible upon those incidents which, for one’s peace, may better be
forgotten, but a whole winter filled with grief and worry is not so
easily torn from the leaves of the calendar rolled back.

In the first place, when I left Manila in December, 1901, I was very
near to a nervous breakdown. This was due to the long strain of a
peculiarly exacting official life in a trying climate, and an added
weight of uneasiness about my husband’s illness.

Then, too, my mother was very ill. She had suffered a stroke of
paralysis the year before from which she had never rallied and I was
extremely anxious to be with her in Cincinnati.

When we arrived in San Francisco a terrible mid-winter storm was
sweeping the country from one end to the other and we were strongly
advised to delay our trip across the continent, but we were both eager
to go on so we started East at once over the Union Pacific.

When we passed Ogden we found ourselves in the midst of the worst
blizzard I ever saw. The snow piled up ahead of us, delaying us hour by
hour; the bitter wind fairly shook the heavy train; and to turn mere
discomfort into misery the water pipes in the cars froze solid and we
were left without heat of any kind. There was nothing to do but to go to
bed; but even so, with all the blankets available piled on top of us, we
shivered through interminable hours while the train creaked and puffed
and struggled over the icy tracks.

When we reached Omaha I received a telegram telling me that my mother
had died the day before, and I found it no longer possible to brace
myself against the inevitable collapse. We hurried on to Cincinnati and
arrived in time for my mother’s funeral, but I was too ill to be
present. It was two months before I began to recover.

In the meantime Mr. Taft left us and went on to Washington for
consultation with the President and Mr. Root and to appear before the
Philippine Committees of the House and Senate which were then conducting
minute inquiries into conditions in the Islands preparatory to passing a
much needed governmental bill. For a whole month he was subjected to a
hostile cross-examination, but he was able to place before the
Committees more first-hand and accurate information on the subject of
their deliberations than they had theretofore received. This was exactly
what he wanted to come to the United States for, and he would greatly
have enjoyed it had he been in his usual form, but he was not. During
his stay in Washington he was the guest of Secretary and Mrs. Root and
only their friendly care and solicitude enabled him to continue so long.
In March he was compelled to return to Cincinnati for another operation,
the third in five months. Everything considered, it seemed to me the
Taft family had fallen upon evil days.

However, the weeks passed, I began to improve, and as soon as my husband
had fairly set his feet on earth again we began to make plans for our
return to the Philippines. There could be no thought of abandoning the
work in the Islands just when it was beginning to assume an ordered and
encouraging aspect, nor was it possible just then to shift the
responsibility to other shoulders. This would have been too much like
“changing horses in the middle of a stream.”

My husband was able while he was in Washington to present to President
Roosevelt and Secretary Root a very clear outline of Philippine affairs,
together with such details as could never be conveyed by cable, and the
inevitable conclusion reached was that no solution of the problem was
possible which did not include the settlement of the Friar controversy.
The four monastic orders, the Franciscan, the Dominican, the Augustinian
and the Recoleto, which held four hundred thousand acres of the best
agricultural land in the Islands, had won the lasting enmity of the
Filipino people and it was absolutely impossible to establish permanent
peace while the Friars remained and persisted in an attempt to return to
their parishes. Hundreds of them were living in practical imprisonment
in the monasteries of Manila, and that they should not be allowed to
return to their churches throughout the Islands, from which they had
been driven, was the one stand taken by the Filipinos from which they
could not by any form of persuasion be moved.

The solution of the difficulty proposed by Mr. Taft and his colleagues
in the Philippine government was that the United States purchase the
Friars’ lands and turn them into a public domain on the condition that
the orders objected to by the people be withdrawn from the Islands.

As soon as President Roosevelt recognised the importance of
accomplishing these things he decided, with characteristic directness,
that somebody should go at once to Rome and open negotiations with the
Vatican, and after considering various men for this delicate mission he
concluded that Mr. Taft was the man best fitted to undertake it.

The prospect of another novel experience was exceedingly gratifying to
me and I began at once to look forward with interest to a renewal of my
acquaintance with Rome and to the trip back to the East by the Suez
Canal, the Red Sea and the Indian Ocean which, according to Kipling,
“sits an’ smiles, so sof’, so bright, so bloomin’ blue.” So my feet no
longer lagged in my preparations for a long trip with my three children
and another extended residence in the tropics.

To assist Mr. Taft in his negotiations with the Vatican, and to make up
a dignified and formidable looking Commission, the President appointed
Bishop O’Gorman of the Catholic diocese of South Dakota, and General
James F. Smith, at that time a member of the Philippine judiciary and in
later years Philippine Commissioner and Governor-General of the Islands.
His rank of General he attained as an officer of volunteers in the Army
of Pacification in the Philippines, but, a lawyer in the beginning,
after he was appointed to the Bench he became known as Judge Smith, and
Judge we always called him. He is an Irish Catholic Democrat and a man
of very sane views and exceptional ability. Major John Biddle Porter was
made Secretary-Interpreter to the Commission, and Bishop Brent,
Episcopal Bishop of the Philippines, on his way to Manila, decided to go
with Mr. Taft, wait for him until he had completed his business at Rome
and then continue with him the journey to the Philippines. This was the
beginning of a warm friendship between Bishop Brent and ourselves, and
no one can have lived in the Philippines since, or have been familiar
with the affairs of the Islands, without knowing what a blessing his
work and presence have been to the Philippine people, and how much he
has aided the Government in its task.

We engaged passage on the steamship _Trave_, sailing from New York to
Gibraltar about the middle of May; the day for our departure was close
at hand; many good-byes had been said; and, altogether, the immediate
future was looking bright, when suddenly I found myself once more within
the orbit of my unlucky star. My son Robert chose this opportune moment
to develop a case of scarlet fever. Of course that left me and the
children out of all the plans and I was compelled to accept a hastily
made arrangement which provided for my remaining behind and following my
husband and his interesting party on a later ship. Fortunately Robert
was not with the other children when he contracted the disease. He was
visiting friends in another part of town and I had him removed
immediately to the Good Samaritan Hospital, then settled down to my
vigil which might be long or short as fortune decreed.

My husband’s mother was in Millbury while all these things were
transpiring and he called her up on the long distance telephone to tell
her about Bobby’s illness and to say good-bye.

“Then Nellie cannot go with you?’ said Mrs. Taft.

“No, I’m sorry to say she can’t,” said my husband.

“But you have now an extra stateroom, have you not?”

“Yes, Mother.”

“Well, Will, I don’t think you ought to make such a trip alone when you
are so far from strong, so I just think I’ll go with you in Nellie’s
place,” said my mother-in-law.

And she did. The intrepid old lady of seventy-four packed her trunks and
was in New York ready to sail within twenty-four hours, and my husband
wrote that she acted altogether with an energy and an enterprise which
filled him with pleasure and pride. On the steamer, and later at the
hotel Quirinal in Rome, she presided with dignity for more than a month
over a table at which daily gathered a company composed of a Colonial
Governor, a Supreme Judge, a Roman Bishop, an Anglican Bishop and a
United States Army officer.

Her activity and fearlessness kept her family and friends in a state of
astonishment a good part of the time. She went wherever she liked and it
never seemed to occur to her that it was unusual for a woman of her age
to travel everywhere with so much self-reliance. She thought nothing of
crossing the American continent every year to visit her daughter or
sister on the Pacific Coast, and out in Manila we used to laugh at the
possibility of her appearing on the scene at any moment. In fact, she
very seriously considered coming at one time. I was glad that she could
go with my husband to Rome because she really could be a comfort and a
help and not at all a responsibility.

Robert was not nearly as ill as we expected he would be and in a few
weeks I was able to make definite plans for joining my husband. My
sister, Mrs. Anderson, was going to Paris so I took advantage of the
opportunity to enjoy her companionship on the voyage and sailed with her
on the fourth of June, landing in France and going by train to Rome.

That the record of our ill-luck may be quite complete I must add that on
the way across the Atlantic my son Charlie managed to pick up
whooping-cough, and that by the time we reached Rome he had passed it on
to Helen. Her first remark to her father was a plaintive query: “Papa,
why is it we can never go anywhere without catching something?”

I devoutly hoped that we had caught everything there was to catch and
that we might now venture to predict a period of peace.

I found my party very comfortably bestowed. They were occupying a whole
floor at the Quirinal, the largest hotel then open in the city, and were
keeping what appeared to me to be considerable “state.” It looked as if
they had the entire building to themselves, but that was because it was
midsummer when few tourists visit Rome and when all Roman society is
supposed to flock to its mountain homes and to northern resorts.
However, midsummer though it was, a good many members of the “Black,” or
Vatican division of society, still lingered in the city and I found them
evincing every desire to make our stay both pleasant and memorable.
Before I arrived Mr. Taft had already “met, called upon, taken tea with
and dined with Cardinals, Princes, counts, marquises, and distinguished
Englishmen and Americans resident in Rome,” to quote from one of his own
letters, but he had a good many things to do over again in my honour. He
had also had an audience with Pope Leo XIII, and was deep in the rather
distracting uncertainties and intricacies of his negotiations.

He did not have the pleasure of seeing the King of Italy whom he had a
great desire to meet, because, even though the American Ambassador had
made all the arrangements, etiquette did not permit such an audience
until his relations with the Vatican had terminated, and by that time
the King had gone to the military manœuvres in North Italy.

My husband’s position was one of very great delicacy. By the nature of
our national institutions it is not possible for us to send a
representative to the Vatican in a diplomatic capacity no matter what
the emergency may be, and Mr. Roosevelt in sending this Commission to
Rome had no intention that its office should be construed into a formal
recognition of the Vatican, which could not fail to raise a storm of
protest and opposition in this country. So the instructions given to Mr.
Taft by Secretary Root were made very definite on this point. After
reviewing the necessity for taking such action on the part of our
government and covering the favourable reports on the proposed
negotiations submitted by the Philippine Committees of the House and
Senate, the instructions began with paragraph one:

  One of the controlling principles of our government is the complete
  separation of church and state, with the entire freedom of each from
  any control or interference by the other. This principle is imperative
  wherever American jurisdiction extends, and no modification or shading
  thereof can be a subject of discussion.

Following this in numbered paragraphs, a tentative plan for the
adjustment of the Friar difficulties is outlined and the instructions
end with paragraph nine:

  Your errand will not be in any sense or degree diplomatic in its
  nature, but will be purely a business matter of negotiation by you as
  Governor of the Philippines for the purchase of property from the
  owners thereof, and the settlement of land titles in such a manner as
  to contribute to the best interests of the people of the Islands.

These instructions were easier to receive than to carry out, since from
the beginning the Vatican made every possible effort to give the mission
a diplomatic aspect and to cast upon it the glamour of great official
solemnity, and Mr. Taft had constantly to keep his mind alert to the
danger of accidental acquiescence in a misinterpretation of his
position. To take a position which would soothe the feelings of American
Catholics and yet not shock the conscience of any Protestant was
something like being ground between the proverbial millstones. However,
Cardinal Rampolla very graciously met the business-like ideas of the
Commission and arranged a private audience with Pope Leo at which the
propositions of the Philippine government were to be outlined to him.

My husband’s memory of this now historic mission to Rome seems to
include little which was not directly connected with the business in
hand, but Judge Smith displays a more impressionable bent. In answer to
an inquiry as to what he recalls of the visit he wrote Mr. Taft a most
interesting letter. All his memoranda of the trip, including letters,
journals and souvenirs, were destroyed in the San Francisco fire, but he
says:

“After our arrival there was a long wait that arrangements might be made
for an audience with the Holy Father, but finally the date was fixed and
the Commission, at high noon, in evening dress and top hats, went to the
Vatican and passed up the long staircase, lined with Swiss Guards, which
leads to the State apartments. We were received by the Chamberlain and
several other functionaries and were conducted from one apartment to
another until finally we were ushered into the presence of Leo XIII, to
whom you made a statement of the matters which were to be made the
subject of negotiation.

“This statement had been previously translated into French by Bishop
O’Gorman and Colonel Porter, and you will remember there were some
things about Bishop O’Gorman’s French which did not meet with the entire
approval of Colonel Porter. Whether you arbitrated the matter and
selected the appropriate phrase which should have been used I do not
know, but I do know that at one time there was danger of the severance
of the friendly relations which had theretofore prevailed between the
good Bishop and the good old Colonel.

“My recollection of the Holy Father is that his face was like
transparent parchment, that he had the brilliant eyes of a young man and
that he was wonderfully alert of mind, although bent over by the weight
of years.

“Of course, none of us could forget Cardinal Rampolla,—tall, slender,
straight, vigorous in both mind and body, impenetrable, and cold as
fate. A man evidently of wonderful intellect and fully equal to any
demands that might be put upon him as the diplomat of the Vatican.”

I might add that the first part of my husband’s speech, a copy of which
I have, consisted of a few remarks appropriate to the presentation of a
gift from President Roosevelt to the Pope. This gift was a specially
bound set of Mr. Roosevelt’s own works.

When the formal interview was at an end the Pope came down from the dais
on which he sat and indulged in a fifteen or twenty minute personal
conversation with the members of the Commission. “He asked for the
pleasure of shaking my hand,” writes my husband to his brother Charles,
in the usual vein of humour which obtains between them, adding, “a
privilege which I very graciously accorded him.” He also joked about Mr.
Taft’s proportions, saying that he had understood he had been very ill,
but from observation he saw no reason to suppose that the illness had
been serious. He poked gentle fun at Bishop O’Gorman and made kindly
inquiries of Judge Smith and Major Porter; then he walked with the party
to the door and bowed them out, a courtesy which I believe was
unprecedented.

“He had a great deal more vigour of motion,” writes Mr. Taft, “and a
great deal more resonance of voice than I had been led to suppose. I had
thought him little more than a lay figure, but he was full of lively
interest and gesture, and when my address was being read he smiled and
bowed his head in acquiescence.”

“We visited the catacombs,” says Judge Smith, “St. Peter’s, St. Paul’s
beyond the walls, and a few of the basilicas of ancient Rome now
dedicated to Christian worship. The Borghese and various other art
galleries left their impression, as did some of the interesting old
palaces, notably the one which was then threatening to fall into the
Tiber, and the ceiling of which bears the famous fresco of Cupid and
Psyche.

“One day during our first wait we had dinner out at the American College
as guests of Monsignor Kennedy, where you (Mr. Taft) made a speech which
brought much applause from the students in red cassocks, and everybody
was happy. After dinner some of us made a visit to a villa by the Orsini
on the hills overlooking the Campagna, which villa had recently been
purchased by the college as a summer home.

                  *       *       *       *       *

“You will remember our call on Cardinal Martinelli and the dinner we had
with good old Cardinal Satolli who took such a pride in the wine
produced by his own vineyards, a wine, by the way, which was not
unreservedly approved by the owners of other vineyards. One of the most
delightful experiences of all was our dinner with the good Episcopal
Rector, Dr. Nevin, when ox-tongue done in the Russian style was served
as the _piece de resistánce_. You cannot forget how shocked were some of
the circles in Rome to find Bishop O’Gorman and myself at such a festal
board under such circumstances, and how Pope Leo showed his thorough
understanding of American institutions by saying that American Catholics
might very properly do things which would be very much misunderstood if
done by Romans. The Episcopal Rector was a mighty hunter, a great
traveller, and gifted with a fund of anecdote which made him a most
delightful host.”

I found this highly social and sociable party rather impatiently
awaiting a reply to their formal, written proposals to the Vatican which
had been turned over to a Commission of Cardinals. They were giving a
fine imitation of outward leisurely poise, but among themselves they
were expressing very definite opinions of the seemingly deliberate
delays to which they were being subjected. Mr. Taft was anxious to sail
for Manila on the 10th of July, and already had his passage booked on
the _Koenig Albert_, but the immediate prospect seemed to be that he
would be held in Rome for the rest of the summer.

He did not have the greatest confidence that he would succeed in the
mission which meant so much to his future course in the Islands, and,
indeed, it was quite evident that he would not succeed without prolonged
effort to be continued after he left Rome. The various Cardinals lost no
opportunity to assure him that the Vatican was in full sympathy with the
proposals made and that he might expect a very early and satisfactory
termination of the business, but he decided not to believe anything
until he should see the signatures to the contract. The factions and the
politics of the Vatican were most perplexing. The monastic orders were
the conservative element in the negotiations, being willing enough to
sell the Friars’ lands at a valuation to be decided upon by a board of
five members, two representing the church, two representing the United
States government and the fifth to be selected from some other country,
but they were not willing to consent to the withdrawal of the Friars
from the Philippine Islands. Then there were wheels within wheels; Papal
candidates and candidates for Cardinals who thrust into the negotiations
considerations for agreeing or not agreeing which greatly puzzled the
purely business-like representatives of the American government.

But I was not particularly annoyed by the delay. I found much to
interest me in Rome, and I saw my husband improving in general health
and gaining the strength he needed for a re-encounter with the
difficulties in tropic Manila. Prominent Republican leaders had aroused
his impatience at different times by publicly announcing that, in all
probability, he was “going out to the Philippines to die.” He wrote to
his brother from Rome:

“I dislike being put in such an absurd position before the country as
that of playing the martyr. I’m not asking any favours on account of
health or any other cause, nor am I taking the position that I am making
any sacrifice. I think that a great and unusual opportunity has been
offered me and if I can improve it, all well and good, but I don’t want
any sympathy or emotional support.”

He was easily aroused to resentment on the subject, but, just the same,
it was gratifying to observe him quite rapidly regaining his normal
vigour and buoyancy.

My mother-in-law was having a most wonderful time. She was comfortably
established at the Quirinal in rooms next to ours, and was enjoying the
devoted attention of every man in the party whether he wore
ecclesiastical frock, military uniform or plain citizens’ clothes. She
went everywhere and saw everything and was as indefatigable in her
enjoyment as any of us. She met old-time friends whom she had known when
she and Judge Taft were in the diplomatic corps abroad, and with them
she indulged in pleasant reminiscence. After I arrived she became more
energetic than ever and led me a lively pace at sightseeing and
shopping, because, as she wrote to another daughter-in-law, Mrs. Horace
Taft, “Nellie is not at all timid and as she speaks French we can go
anywhere.”

I soon found that in spite of official and personal protest to the
contrary we were considered quite important personages, and the
elaborate hospitality we were offered kept us busy at nearly all hours
when hospitality is at all in order. There were teas and luncheons,
dinners and receptions, and functions of every description, and we met a
great many renowned and interesting people, both Roman and foreign. Mr.
W. T. Stead, the correspondent for the London _Times_ who was lost on
the _Titanic_, was one of them. Then there was Mr. Laffan, proprietor of
the New York _Sun_, and Mrs. Laffan, and Dr. Hillis of Brooklyn who was
in Rome with his son. An attractive personality, who interested us very
much and whose hospitality we enjoyed, was Princess Rospigliosi, the
wife of an Italian nobleman, who lived in an enchanting house. She had a
very beautiful daughter who was at that time keenly interested in the
controversy as to whether or not Catholics should vote in Rome. She was
strongly in favour of their doing so and, with extraordinary directness,
carried her advocacy straight to the Pope and insisted that it was a
great mistake for Catholics not to take advantage of the ballot and by
that means secure the political rights to which they were entitled. Pope
Leo, although very much impressed by what she said, insisted that it was
not yet time to urge the reform suggested, and wound up by saying, “My
good daughter, you go altogether too fast for me!” I don’t doubt that by
this time the young Princess is a warm supporter of woman’s suffrage.

Also, we were entertained by a Mr. McNutt who had been in our diplomatic
corps at one time in Madrid and Constantinople, at another time had been
tutor to the sons of the Khedive of Egypt, and was then one of the Papal
Chamberlains. He had married a woman of wealth, a Miss Ogden of New
York.

Mr. McNutt had one of the most elaborate and beautiful palaces I ever
saw. He had studied the customs of Roman society in the picturesque days
of the Medicis and the Borgias, had rented the Pamphili Palace and
restored it to its pristine glory, and it was here that he entertained
us at a dinner, with cards afterward.

I felt like an actor in a mediæval pageant whose costume had not been
delivered in time for the performance. Cardinals in their gorgeous
robes, with gold snuff-boxes, gave to the scene a high colour among the
soberer tones of Bishops and Archbishops and uniformed Ambassadors. Then
there were Princes and Princesses and other nobilities of Roman society,
the men displaying gay ribands and decorations, the women in elaborate
costumes, and all in a “stage setting” as far removed from modernity as
a magnificent old-world palace could be. To make this reproduction of
old customs complete our host made a point of having liveried attendants
with flaming torches to light the Cardinals to and from their carriages.

Before I reached Rome, Mr. Taft and his associates had been present at a
Papal consistory at which the Pope presided over the College of
Cardinals. They were the guests of the Pope and occupied the Diplomatic
Box. I was sorry to miss this exceptional privilege, but we were given
ample opportunities for seeing and hearing several noteworthy religious
festivals both at St. Peter’s and the church of St. John of Lateran. I
was educated in the strictest Presbyterianism, while my husband’s mother
was a Unitarian, and Puritan in her training and in all her instincts.
We could not help feeling that we had been led into a prominent position
in a strange environment. But, unshaken though we were in our religious
affiliations, we appreciated the real beauty of the ceremonies and knew
that we should rejoice in the unusual privilege accorded us which would
never be ours again.

It was near the end of our stay in Rome that we had our audience with
the Pope,—Mrs. Taft, Robert, Helen and I. I wore a black afternoon gown
with a black veil on my head, while Mrs. Taft wore her widow’s veil as
usual. Helen, I dressed in white and, to her very great excitement, she
wore a white lace veil. Bishop O’Gorman accompanied us and when we
reached the door of the Vatican under the colonnade at the right of St.
Peter’s, we were met by some members of the Swiss Guard in their curious
uniforms, conducted through endless corridors and rich apartments until
we came to a small waiting-room where we were left for a few moments by
ourselves. We had only time to adjust our veils and compose ourselves
when the door on one side opened and we were ceremoniously ushered into
the presence of Leo XIII who sat on a low chair under a simple canopy at
the far end of the room. He rose to greet us as we entered, and as we
were presented one by one he extended his hand over which we each bowed
as we received his blessing.

He began speaking to me in French and finding that I could answer him in
that language he talked with me for perhaps half an hour with a most
charmingly graceful manner of comment and compliment. He spoke of Mr.
Roosevelt’s present and wished that he knew English so that he might
read the books. He referred to Mr. Roosevelt as “President Roomvine”
which was as near as he seemed to be able to get to that very un-Latin
name; said that he himself, in his youth, had been devoted to the chase
and would like very much to read “The Strenuous Life.”

Later he called Robert to his side and gave him a special blessing,
saying that he hoped the little boy would follow in the footsteps of
McKinley and Roosevelt. He asked Bob what he expected to be when he grew
up and my self-confident son replied that he intended to be Chief
Justice of the Supreme Court. I suppose he had heard the Chief
Justiceship talked about by his father until he thought it the only
worthy ambition for a self-respecting citizen to entertain.

When we arose to go, His Holiness escorted us to the door and bowed us
out with a kindly smile in his fine young eyes that I shall never
forget.

Shortly after this I left Rome. It was getting hot and my husband
persuaded me to take the children away, promising to join us for a short
breath of mountain air before he sailed for Manila. It had been decided
that I should remain in Europe for a month or so and I was to choose the
place best suited for recuperation. I went first to Florence for a week,
then to the Grande Albergo Castello de Aquabella at Vallombrosa. The
sonorous name of this hotel should have been a sufficient warning to me
of the expense of living there, but I was not in a mood to anticipate
any kind of unpleasant experience.

It is a beautiful place reached by a funicular railway from a station
about fifteen miles from Florence, and is where Milton wrote parts of
Paradise Lost. The hotel was an old castle remodelled, and as we were
almost the only guests and were attended by relays of most obsequious
servants we managed to feel quite baronial. We spent our time being as
lazy as we liked, or driving in the dense black forests of pine which
cover the mountains and through vistas of which we could catch
fascinating glimpses of the beautiful, town-dotted valley of the Arno
some thousands of feet below.

On the 20th of July my husband came up and joined us in this delightful
retreat. He had just received his final answer from the Vatican and,
while he was disappointed at not being able to settle the matter then,
he was hopeful that a way had been found which, though it would entail
much future labour, would lead to a satisfactory solution of the
problems. An Apostolic Delegate, representing the Vatican, was to be
sent to Manila to continue the negotiations on the ground, and Pope Leo
assured Mr. Taft that he would receive instructions to bring about such
an adjustment as the United States desired. This assurance was carried
out, but only after Leo’s long pontificate had come to an end.

The final note was written by Cardinal Rampolla who rendered “homage to
the great courtesy and high capacity” with which Mr. Taft had filled
“the delicate mission,” and closed by declaring his willingness to
concede that “the favourable result” must in a large measure be
attributed to my husband’s “high personal qualities.”

I had hoped to have Mr. Taft with us at Vallombrosa for a week or so
before he sailed, but the time allotted in our plans for this was taken
up by delays in Rome, so that when he did arrive he had only twenty-four
hours to stay. His final audience with the Pope was arranged for the
following Monday, there were a number of minor details to be attended
to, and he was to sail Thursday morning from Naples on the _Princess
Irene_, to which he had been obliged to transfer from the _Koenig
Albert_.

The last audience with His Holiness consisted chiefly in an exchange of
compliments and expressions of thanks for courtesies extended, but it
had additional interest in that the Pope chose to make it the occasion
for personally presenting to the members of the party certain small
gifts, or souvenirs, which he had selected for them. He had previously
sent an inquiry through Bishop O’Gorman as to whether or not the
Commissioners would accept decorations, but Mr. Taft replied that the
American constitution forbids the acceptance of such honours without the
consent of Congress, so nothing more was said about it.

The presents he did receive were a handsome Jubilee medal displaying a
portrait of His Holiness in bas relief, and a gold pen in the form of a
large feather with the papal arms on it. To me the Pope sent a small
piece of old German enamel showing a copy of an ancient picture of St.
Ursula and her virgins, framed in silver and gold beautifully wrought.
Smaller gold medals were given to each of the other Commissioners, while
President Roosevelt received a copy in mosaic of a picture of a view of
Rome from a corner in the Vatican gardens in which the Pope is seen
seated with three or four Cardinals in attendance. This, together with
letters from His Holiness and Cardinal Rampolla to the President and Mr.
Hay, the Secretary of State, was given to Bishop O’Gorman to be
delivered when he arrived in the United States.

My husband sailed from Naples on the 24th of July, and I, with the three
children and their French governess, started north by Venice and Vienna
to spend a few weeks in the mountains of Switzerland before returning to
Manila.

There were rather terrifying reports of a cholera epidemic raging in the
Philippines and I dreaded the prospects of going into it with my
children, but I knew that heroic efforts were being made to check it and
I felt confident that, in Manila at least, it would have run its course
before I should arrive, so I booked passage on the German steamer
_Hamburg_ and on the 3rd of September sailed for the East and the
tropics once more.

[Illustration:

  SCENES ATTENDING GOVERNOR TAFT’S ARRIVAL IN MANILA AFTER HIS FIRST
    ABSENCE
]



                              CHAPTER XII
                      LAST DAYS IN THE PHILIPPINES


When Mr. Taft reached Manila he found the city _en fete_ and in a state
of intense excitement which had prevailed for two days during which the
people had expected every hour to hear the great siren on the cold
storage plant announce that the little _Alava_, the government
coastguard boat which had been sent to Singapore to get him, had been
sighted off Corregidor.

When the announcement finally came, everything in the harbour that could
manage to do so steamed down the Bay to meet him, and when the launch to
which he had transferred from the _Alava_ came up to the mouth of the
Pásig River and under the walls of old Fort Santiago, seventeen guns
boomed out a Governor’s salute, while whistles and bells and sirens all
over the bay and river and city filled the air with a deafening din.

Wherever his eyes rested he saw people,—crowding windows, roofs, river
banks and city walls, all of them cheering wildly and waving hats or
handkerchiefs. And the thing which moved him most was the fact that the
welcoming throng was not just representative of the wealthy and educated
class, but included thousands of the people, barefooted and in calicoes,
who had come in from the neighbouring and even the far provinces to
greet him.

Mrs. Moses asked Mr. Benito Legarda, one of the Filipino members of the
Commission, whether or not there had ever been a like demonstration in
honour of the arrival of a Spanish Governor, and his answer was:

“Yes, there were demonstrations always, but the government paid the
expenses.”

In this case the very opposite was true. The government had no money to
waste on celebrations and all government buildings, such as the City
Hall, the Post Office and the Ayuntamiento, were conspicuously bare.
Their nakedness was positively eloquent of economy in the midst of the
riot of gay bunting, the flags, the pennants and the palm leaves in
which the rest of the city was smothered. Then there were extraordinary
and elaborate arches spanning the streets through which the Governor was
to be conducted. One of these, erected by the _Partido Federal_,
displayed a huge allegorical picture which had a peculiar significance.
Filipina, a lovely lady draped in flowing gauze, was seen, in an
attitude which combined appeal with condescension, presenting to
Columbia a single star, implying that she desired to be accepted as one
of the States of the Union.

I am indebted to the descriptive art of Mrs. Moses, to photographs and
to my own knowledge of the Filipino way of doing things for the mental
picture I have of this celebration.

At the landing near the Custom House my husband found a great procession
in line, ready to escort him to the Ayuntamiento where the speeches of
welcome were to be made. There were regiments of cavalry, infantry and
artillery, as well as platoon after platoon of native and American
police with as many bands as there were divisions of the procession.
Picked men from the volunteer regiments acted as a special guard for the
Governor’s carriage and they must have added much to the impressive
array, because I know of my own observation that the volunteers were
always as fine a looking body of men as it would be possible to find
anywhere.

When Mr. Taft reached the Ayuntamiento he listened to glowing speeches
of tribute and welcome in the Marble Hall, then he stood for hours
shaking hands with the people who, in orderly file, passed in and out of
the building which was large enough to hold only a very small fraction
of them. When this was over and his audience had settled down he
proceeded to tell them in a clear and simple way all about his
experiences in Rome and how far the negotiations with the Vatican had
proceeded. This was a matter of paramount importance to the Filipinos
and they listened with an intensity of interest which Mr. Taft said
seemed to promise serious consequences if the business could not be
carried to a successful conclusion.

However, despite the joy and festivity with which he was greeted upon
his return, the Governor did not find general conditions in the islands
either prosperous or happy.

Everything that could possibly happen to a country had happened or was
happening. The cholera epidemic was still raging, and while it had
abated to a considerable extent in Manila it was at its worst in Iloilo
and other provinces. There had been from seventy to eighty cases a day
in Manila for a long time, and the quarantine regulations had incensed
the ignorant people to a point where force had to be used to secure
obedience. They did not understand sanitary measures and wanted none of
them; they clung to their superstitious beliefs, and were easily made to
accept as truth wild statements to the effect that the Americans were
poisoning the wells and rivers and had stopped transportation and
business with the sole purpose of starving or otherwise destroying the
entire population. Even the educated ones were not without their
time-honoured prejudices in this regard, for while Mr. Taft was in Rome
he receive a cabled protest from Filipino members of the Commission with
a request that he order the quarantine raised.

When he arrived in Manila the cholera cases had fallen to between ten
and twenty a day and business had been resumed to a certain extent, but
the situation was still critical and a fresh outbreak on account of
polluted water was to be expected at any time. All the sources of water
supply were patrolled by American soldiers day and night and every
precaution was taken; whole sections of the city were burned in an
attempt to stamp out the pestilence, but the disease had to run its
course and it was months before it was completely eradicated.

While the people were dying of cholera the carabaos, the only draught
and farm animals in the Islands, were dying by thousands of an epidemic
of rinderpest. This scourge, too, was fought with all the force of both
the civil and military arms of the government, but before it could be
checked it had carried off a large majority of the carabaos in the
Archipelago with the result that agriculture and all other industries
dependent upon this mode of transportation were paralysed. A general
drought in China made a rice famine a practical certainty, even if the
people should have money to buy rice, so the future looked black indeed.

The cholera and rinderpest had greatly reduced government revenues and
many plans for much needed public works had to be modified or abandoned,
while the condition of the currency added to the general chaos. There
was no gold standard and the fluctuations in the value of silver made it
necessary for the Governor to issue a proclamation about once a week
fixing a new rate of exchange. In this way it was calculated that the
government, with insufficient income at the best, lost a round million
dollars gold during a period of ten months.

To cap all and add exasperation to uneasiness the ladrones had become
increasingly active with hard times and were harrying the districts
around Manila to such an extent that the people were in constant terror.
The ravages of the rinderpest had made the carabao a very valuable
animal and the chief object of the ladrones was to steal such as were
left and drive them off to be sold in distant provinces. Nor were they
at all particular about their highwaymen’s methods or chary of
sacrificing human life. There was a veritable hotbed of ladronism at
Caloocan, a suburb of Manila, which was augmented by the roughs and
toughs from the crowded and miserable districts in the lower city, while
across the Bay in Cavite province, known as the “mother of
insurrection,” there were several hundred rifles in the hands of
marauders who hid away in the hills and jungles and made conditions such
that Mr. Taft was asked by the Director of Constabulary to suspend the
writ of habeas corpus, thus declaring the province in a practical state
of siege. Mr. Taft would not do this, saying that he thought the only
course was to “hammer away with the constabulary until the abuse was
stamped out by the regular methods of supposedly peaceful times,” but
the worst feature of the situation was that wherever ladronism showed
its head there would be cohorts of “irreconcilables”—posing in everyday
life as loyal citizens—ready, within the limits of personal safety, to
encourage and assist it. Anything to hamper and harass the government.

Shortly after Mr. Taft’s arrival in Manila, the vice-Governor, General
Wright, and Mrs. Wright left the Islands for a well-earned vacation and
my husband wrote that the amount of work which confronted him was
staggering. He took on General Wright’s department in addition to his
own duties, and if it hadn’t been that he had at least half way learned
not to try to “hurry the East” he probably would not have lasted long.

Among the first steps to be taken was to provide against the inevitable
famine, and to do this it was necessary for the Government to send to
China and Saigon for large quantities of rice to be stored in public
godowns. They bought and brought to Manila something like forty million
pounds of this first of all necessities to an oriental people, and the
intention was to sell it at cost when the market supply began to run low
and prices began to soar beyond the poor man’s reach. A certain degree
of paternalism has always been, is now, and probably always will be
necessary in the government of the Filipino people.

Mr. Taft besought the United States Congress to appropriate a sum to be
used for the importation of work animals, for the purchase of rice and
the furnishing of work on public improvements. The animals were not to
be given away, but were eventually to be sold at reasonable prices.
Three millions were appropriated and spent.

Congress was also petitioned to establish a gold standard of currency,
and this too was done, to the inexpressible relief of everybody
interested in the Philippine welfare, in the following January. The
currency now is as sound as our own, every silver peso, which
corresponds to the old “dollar Mex,” being worth fifty cents gold.

When I arrived in Manila in early October I found the situation more
interesting than it had ever been, even though it was distracting to the
men who had to deal with it. My first necessity was, of course, to
settle myself once more at Malacañan. During my absence the old Palace
had been all done over, painted and patched and cleaned and redecorated
until it was quite unlike its quaint, old dilapidated self. Some of the
colours were a shade too pronounced and some of the decorations ran a
little more to “graceful patterns” than suited my taste, but I was glad
of the added comfort and cleanliness.

It was difficult in the beginning to accustom myself to cholera
conditions. The disease was communicated to very few Americans or other
white foreigners, but safety was secured at the price of eternal
vigilance. Water could not be drunk unless it was boiled under one’s
personal supervision; nothing uncooked could be eaten, not even a piece
of imported fruit, unless it had first been washed in a carbolic
solution, a process, I may say, which added nothing desirable to its
flavour; a good many other precautions were necessary which made us feel
as if we were living always in the lowering shadow of some dreadful
catastrophe, but, even so, we were surprisingly calm about it—everybody
was—and managed to come through the experience without any visible
ill-effects.

There was one new thing for me, and that was a live cow. For two long
years we had manfully striven to make ourselves believe that we liked
canned milk and condensed cream just as much as we liked the fresh milk
we had been used to all our lives. In fact, we were fond of declaring
that we couldn’t tell the difference. But we could. And in our secret
hearts we all welcomed as the most delectable treat an occasional gift
of skimmed milk from a friend who had been a pioneer in the momentous
venture of importing an Australian cow.

The importation of our cow was a real event, and she straightway took up
a position of great dignity and importance in our establishment. She
roamed at will about the grounds of the Palace and her general conduct
was the subject of daily comment in the family circle. A number of
people brought in cows about this time, but very few of them lived long
enough to prove their dairy worth. Our cow flourished and gave forth
large quantities of milk, and this fact became the subject of what was
supposed to be a huge joke.

Mr. Worcester, who was the high chief health authority in the Islands,
decreed that all animals as they were brought in should be inoculated
for rinderpest, tuberculosis, and a number of other things,—“including
prickly heat,” said General Wright,—but it just so happened that a great
majority of these scientifically treated beasts died almost immediately,
and General Wright could always arouse the wrath of Mr. Worcester—a
thing he loved to do—by suggesting that the only reason our cow lived
was because “she had not been inoculated.”

The presence of the cow having given me a true farmer spirit—at least, I
suppose it was the cow—I decided to have a garden. There were very few
vegetables that the Filipinos knew how to raise at that time, and our
longing for fresh things was constant and intense. I selected a
promising looking spot behind the Palace, had it prepared for planting,
then I bought a supply of fresh American seeds and carefully buried them
in places where I thought they might develop into something. The result
was positively astonishing. The soil was rich and the sun was hot, and
in an incredibly short time we were having quantities of beans and
cauliflower and big red tomatoes and all kinds of things.

My ambition grew with success and I branched out into poultry. The first
thing anybody knew I had a big screened yard full of chickens and
turkeys little and big, which were a source of great enjoyment to us all
both in their noisy feathered state in the chicken yard and done up in a
variety of Ah Sing styles on our very well supplied table. I wonder how
my cook made up the “squeeze” out of which he was cheated by my industry
and thrift.

But, dwelling on these minor details I am getting far ahead of my story.
There were many things in the meanwhile engaging my attention, the most
important of which, I suppose, was the great church schism.

Gregorio Aglipay, an Ilocano priest of the Roman Catholic Church, joined
the original insurrection against Spain, or the Friars rather, at its
inception and was excommunicated. He became an insurgent leader with a
reputation for great cruelty, and continued in the field against Spain,
and subsequently against the United States, until resistance was no
longer possible. He was among the last insurrecto chiefs to surrender in
northern Luzon. When peace was restored he began immediately to solicit
the interest and aid of other Filipino priests, of politicians and
influential men in a plan for organising an Independent Filipino
Catholic Church, and his temporary success must have surprised even him.

[Illustration:

  ARCH ERECTED BY THE _PARTIDO FEDERAL_ REPRESENTING FILIPINA OFFERING
    ANOTHER STAR TO THE AMERICAN FLAG
]

While the people loved catholicism, the failure of the Vatican to accede
to their wishes with respect to the Friars, as expressed by the American
Commission to Rome, added impetus to the rebellious movement and when
the announcement of the new organisation was made it was found to be
based on the strongest kind of support. Aglipay constituted himself
Obispo Maximo, assumed a fine regalia, and conferred upon fifteen or
more of his lieutenants the regular church dignities and titles of a
lesser order. He offered the people the same ceremonies, the same
relief, the same confessional, and the same faith generally to which
they had always been accustomed, so they found it easy enough to
transfer their allegiance, and the new church gained adherents with such
startling rapidity that it seemed as if a majority of the population
would go over to it.

The result may easily be imagined. The Roman Catholic organisation had
controlled Philippine affairs, both temporal and spiritual, for so long
that the possibility of a rebellion of this character had never been
thought of. Every loyal Catholic, and especially every bishop and priest
and friar, was horrified, and an almost frantic controversy began to
rage about the devoted head of the civil Governor as soon as he arrived
in Manila. He was appealed to to take drastic action to suppress the
movement and because he could do nothing even to check it the American
government was reviled in the Catholic press as it had never been
reviled before. Mr. Taft calmly met the storm with an iteration and
reiteration of American principles of religious toleration, and declared
that he had neither right nor wish to try to direct the religious
inclinations of the people, and that all he could do in the matter was
to enforce the keeping of the peace.

The people had been taught by Aglipay and his fellow-conspirators, and,
indeed, by the whole history of church buildings in the Islands, that
church properties belonged to the people and that if they wished to do
so it was right for them to oust the regularly constituted priests from
the churches and to turn these edifices over to the Independent body.
This the government would not allow, holding that any dispute over
property rights must be settled by due process of law. A few riots
ensued wherein the constabulary and police came in violent contact with
the Aglipayanos, but the Filipino is quick to recognise justice, and
this decree of the government was very readily given general acceptance.

Mr. Taft was repeatedly warned by the allies of Rome that the movement
was nothing but a cloak for the worst insurrection against the
government that the Filipinos had yet attempted, and this suspicion was
somewhat strengthened by the fact that many of the least tractable
insurrecto leaders were among its directors, but in the main the
schismatics evinced every desire to obey the injunction laid upon them
not to resort to incendiary methods. And it was thought that the
treatment they received in return would probably do more than all the
preaching in the world to convince them that under American sovereignty
they were actually to enjoy complete religious freedom.

Liberty to take possession of property by force was denied them, but
liberty to think and worship as they pleased was not only given them,
but in the peaceful exercise of this liberty they even enjoyed police
protection, and this was a never-before-heard-of thing which gave them
food for very serious thought. Under Spanish dominion Aglipay would have
been taken to the Luneta and shot as José Rizal was shot, and his
followers would have met and mourned in secret, but the American
authorities held, according to American beliefs, that an Aglipayan, or
independent Catholic organisation, had as much right to parade in the
streets with candles and images as had the Roman Catholic or any other
religious body.

Mr. Taft had vaguely suggested the possibility of some such development
as this during his visit to the Vatican, but it made no impression.
However, now that it had come, it gave the American Commission some
advantage in the Friars and Friars’ lands negotiations because it was
sure to convince the Vatican that the case of the Friars was hopeless
and so inspire speedier action than might otherwise be hoped for.

In the midst of it all the Apostolic Delegate, Archbishop Guidi of
Stauropoli, arrived from Rome! He was an Italian, very friendly and
tolerant, with neither fanatic nor ascetic tendencies. He was by no
means adverse to taking part in any kind of social gaiety and I remember
that at one of our first entertainments after his arrival he expressed
great regret that he could not join in the _Rigodon_. I came to enjoy
association with him exceedingly.

At one of my first receptions that season quite a dramatic scene
occurred in the ballroom. A thousand or more people, perhaps, had passed
the receiving line. Monsignor Guidi came in all his stately regalia, and
shortly afterward Aglipay put in an appearance. The people wandered
around all over the place, circulating through the spacious gardens and
around the verandahs, so there was a possibility that these two would
not meet even though they were both very conspicuous figures. But it was
not long before the Papal Delegate hurried up to Mr. Taft and, in a
state of visible excitement, inquired who the stranger in the striking
religious garb might be.

“That,” said Mr. Taft, “is Aglipay.”

“But, you know,” said the Monsignor, “it is impossible for you to
receive him here when I am present!”

Then Mr. Taft once more laboriously explained the standpoint of the
American government, saying that Aglipay was in his house in his private
capacity as a citizen, that he had as much right there as any other
citizen, and that it would not be possible to ask him to leave as long
as he conducted himself as a guest should.

“Then, I shall have to go,” said Monsignor Guidi.

“I am very sorry,” said Mr. Taft. “I understand your position perfectly
and I trust you understand mine as well.”

So the highest of insular Church dignitaries got his hat and hastened
away while the “renegade and impious impostor” remained—in serene
unconsciousness of the disturbance he had created? Perhaps not. At least
he was serene.

But our relations with Monsignor Guidi continued most agreeable during
our entire stay in the Islands. Mr. Taft thought very highly of him as a
man and an ecclesiastical statesman and diplomat and greatly regretted
his death which occurred after we left the Islands. Through him, the
question of the Friars’ lands was settled as Pope Leo had told Mr. Taft
it would be, satisfactorily to the United States. To bring that story,
which was distractingly long drawn out in reality, to a close, I will
merely add that the government succeeded in purchasing the Friars’ lands
for the sum of $7,000,000; they were turned into a public domain to be
sold under most encouraging conditions, to their tenants and others who
wished to acquire homesteads. The Friars were not sent back to the
parishes and many left the Islands.

However this was not brought about without the protracted exercise of
patience and diplomacy in the very midst of which the long arm of
Washington reached out and touched my busy husband on the shoulder. He
came home one day with a puzzled air and a cablegram from President
Roosevelt. This cablegram read, in part:

  Taft, Manila. On January first there will be a vacancy on the Supreme
  Court to which I earnestly desire to appoint you.... I feel that your
  duty is on the Court unless you have decided not to adopt a judicial
  career. I greatly hope you will accept. Would appreciate early answer.

                                                              ROOSEVELT.

This came before I had been in the Islands a month and when Mr. Taft was
so deep in the complications of his work that he was almost a stranger
to his friends.

There was an accompanying cablegram from Secretary Root strongly urging
acceptance on the score of my husband’s impaired health. Mr. Root
declared that he was most unwilling to lose his services in the
Philippines, but thought it better for him “not to take any serious risk
of breaking down and having to leave the Islands an invalid even after a
considerable period of further service.” As Mr. Taft was feeling
particularly well and was taking daily exercise and keeping himself in
excellent condition this sounded rather like anticipating a very
unlikely calamity, but the last time Mr. Root had seen him he was
anything but robust so it was easy to understand the Secretary’s
friendly concern for him.

What to do? This was not a question which gave Mr. Taft even a shade of
hesitation, because he knew immediately what he must do. All his life
his first ambition had been to attain the Supreme Bench. To him it meant
the crown of the highest career that a man can seek, and he wanted it as
strongly as a man can ever want anything. But now that the opportunity
had come acceptance was not to be thought of. I had always been opposed
to a judicial career for him, but at this point I shall have to admit I
weakened just a little. I remembered the year of illness and anxiety we
had just been through; and sometimes I yearned to be safe in Washington
even though it did mean our settlement in the “fixed groove” that I had
talked against for so long.

Mr. Taft’s plain and unmistakable duty held him in the Philippine
Islands. He knew he could not detach himself completely from the
enterprise upon which he was engaged without grave consequences to it.
His one cause for uncertainty as to what he should do lay in a suspicion
that he might have done something to embarrass the Administration in a
political sense, or that his opponents in the monastic orders and
Friars’ lands controversy might have made representations which caused
the President to consider his removal “upstairs” advisable. He discussed
the matter confidentially with Mr. Benito Legarda and with the Chief
Justice of the Philippines, Mr. Arellano, and the comment of the Chief
Justice was: “There, the influence of the Friars has reached even to
Washington.” Mr. Taft cabled to his brother Henry in New York to make
private inquiries in this connection, since he did not wish to remain in
the islands if his presence there was in any way undesirable, but at the
same time he cabled to the President:

  President Roosevelt, Washington. Great honour deeply appreciated but
  must decline. Situation here most critical from economic standpoint.
  Change proposed would create much disappointment and lack of
  confidence among people. Two years now to follow of greater importance
  to development of islands than previous two years. Cholera,
  rinderpest, religious excitement, ladrones, monetary crisis, all
  render most unwise change of Governor. These are sentiments of my
  colleagues and two or three leading Filipinos consulted
  confidentially. Nothing would satisfy individual taste more than
  acceptance. Look forward to the time when I can accept such an offer,
  but even if it is certain that it can never be repeated I must now
  decline. Would not assume to answer in such positive terms in view of
  words of your despatch if gravity of situation here was not
  necessarily known to me better than it can be known in Washington.

                                                                   TAFT.

He also sent the following cablegram to Secretary Root:

  Secwar, Washington. Referring to cablegram from your office of 26th
  inst. (October, 1902) my health is about as good as when I landed in
  1900, but conditions here would make my withdrawal, unless absolutely
  compulsory, violation of duty. It may be that I shall be ill again,
  but I am more careful now than before. Chance has thrown every
  obstacle in the way of our success, but we shall win. I long for a
  judicial career but if it must turn on my present decision I am
  willing to lose it.

                                                                   TAFT.

In late November Mr. Taft received this letter from the President:

  Dear Will, I am disappointed, of course, that the situation is such as
  to make you feel it unwise for you to leave, because, exactly as no
  man can quite do your work in the islands, so no man can quite take
  your place as the new member of the Court. But, if possible, your
  refusal on the ground you give makes me admire you and believe in you
  more than ever. I am quite at a loss whom to appoint to the Bench in
  the place I meant for you. Everything else must give way to putting in
  the right man; but I can’t make up my mind who is the right man.

                                            Always affectionately yours,
                                                    THEODORE ROOSEVELT.

So ended that period of wondering what we were to do. At least I thought
it was ended, and while I settled down to the continued and continuous
round of social “work” and pleasure, Mr. Taft proceeded with his
strenuous fight against accumulated and complicated difficulties. We had
Major General and Mrs. Miles with us at Malacañan for a time and after
they left I went down to Batangas, where General Bell was in command, to
“rest” awhile in Mrs. Bell’s somewhat less crowded and exciting circle.
I accepted with a high degree of pleasure the prospect of perhaps two
more years in this very interesting field of work, but President
Roosevelt had other views. It was scarcely a month after the Supreme
Court incident was supposed to be closed when Mr. Taft received a letter
which reopened it with a decisiveness which seemed final. Such parts of
the letter as bear directly on the proposal to Mr. Taft I shall quote:

  Dear Will, I am awfully sorry, old man, but after faithful effort for
  a month to try to arrange matters on the basis you wanted I find that
  I shall have to bring you home and put you on the Supreme Court. I am
  very sorry. I have the greatest confidence in your judgment, but,
  after all, old fellow, if you will permit me to say so, I am President
  and see the whole field. The responsibility for any error must
  ultimately come upon me, and therefore I cannot shirk the
  responsibility or in the last resort yield to any one else’s decision
  if my judgment is against it. After the most careful thought; after
  the most earnest effort as to what you desired and thought best, I
  have come, irrevocably, to the decision that I shall appoint you to
  the Supreme Court in the vacancy caused by Judge Shiras’
  resignation.... I am very sorry if what I am doing displeases you, but
  as I said, old man, this is one of the cases where the President, if
  he is fit for his position, must take the responsibility and put the
  men on whom he most relies in the particular positions in which he
  himself thinks they can render the greatest public good. I shall
  therefore about February first nominate you as I have suggested.

                                         With affectionate regard,
                                             Ever yours,
                                                     THEODORE ROOSEVELT.

This seemed final enough as to be quite unanswerable, so I heaved a sigh
of resignation and made some remark about the not unpleasing prospect of
our all getting home alive at any rate. General Wright was to succeed to
the Governorship, which was a great consolation to my husband, and we
began at once to outline a programme of obedience to the President. Mr.
Taft announced his impending departure and really considered that
further argument was useless, but conditions were such that he could not
resist the temptation to hazard one more protest. He cabled to Mr.
Roosevelt:

  The President, Washington, Recognise soldier’s duty to obey orders.
  Before orders irrevocable by action however I presume on our personal
  friendship even in the face of your letter to make one more appeal, in
  which I lay aside wholly my strong personal disinclination to leave
  work of intense interest half done. No man is indispensable; my death
  would little interfere with programme, but my withdrawal more serious.
  Circumstances last three years have convinced these people, controlled
  largely by personal feeling, that I am their friend and stand for a
  policy of confidence in them and belief in their future and for
  extension of self-government as they show themselves worthy. Visit to
  Rome and proposals urged there assure them of my sympathy in regard to
  friars in respect to whose far-reaching influence they are morbidly
  suspicious. Announcement of withdrawal pending settlement of church
  question, economic crises, and formative political period when
  opinions of all parties are being slowly moulded for the better, will,
  I fear, give impression that change of policy is intended because
  other reasons for action will not be understood. My successor’s task
  is thus made much heavier because any loss of the people’s confidence
  distinctly retards our work here. I feel it is my duty to say this. If
  your judgment is unshaken I bow to it and shall earnestly and
  enthusiastically labour to settle question friars’ lands before I
  leave, and to convince the people that no change of policy is at hand;
  that Wright is their warm friend as sincere as they think me, and that
  we both are but exponents of the sincere good will toward them of
  yourself and the American people.

                                                                   TAFT.

After this things began to happen which nobody, least of all my husband,
had anticipated. When the announcement was made that we were to leave
there was, at first, just a buzz of astonishment and incredulity, but
within two days the whole city of Manila was placarded, in all the
necessary languages, with the simple and uniform sentiment: “Queremos
Taft,” “WE WANT TAFT.” Mr. Root’s rendering of this in English was “I
want you, Mah Honey, yes, I do.” These announcements were printed in
letters of all sizes and all colours, but the wording did not vary in
the slightest degree; just, “WE WANT TAFT.”

Then on the morning of the 10th of January—the letter from Mr. Roosevelt
was received on the 6th—we saw marching through the gates of Malacañan a
column of citizens, blocks long, with bands playing, flags flying and
many transparencies bobbing over their heads. These citizens packed
themselves around the entrance of the Palace and proceeded to make a
demonstration. It was rather saddening to us in view of our conviction
that we must go, but we listened with what composure we could command to
the eloquent speeches. The speakers came up into the Palace and
addressed the crowd from a great window over the main entrance.

Dr. Dominador Gomez, one of the popular orators and labour agitators,
began by saying that Mr. Taft was the “saint” who had “the power to
perform the great miracle” of uniting the distinct opinions and contrary
motives of the people, and declared that “this is a spontaneous
demonstration of affection for our Governor which is to be reduced to
expression in a respectful petition to the President.”

Dr. Xeres Burgos, an old insurrecto, said he spoke for no political
party but in behalf of the mass of people which surrounded us,—“this
people who wish to say to you that all those calamities which have
weighed and do weigh upon the Filipinos are as nothing compared with the
evil effect caused by your impending departure from this government,
just at the precise moment when the Filipino people expect, through your
honesty and love for them, an end to all economic and governmental
disturbances, as well as the solution of the agricultural problem which
is so closely interwoven with the Friar question. The Filipino people
trust that the home government will not tear from their arms their
beloved governor upon whom depends the happy solution of all Philippine
questions. In a word: the Filipino people desire the continuation of
Governor Taft in these Islands!”

Tomaso G. del Rosario likened Mr. Taft to a ship’s rudder adept at
“avoiding shallows” and “bringing her safe into port.” Then he said the
Philippines were “rising from the ashes of a momentous revolution and
advancing toward the future with a heart full of enthusiasm and hope,”
and that “a ruler lacking the qualifications so happily combined in Mr.
Taft might faint by the wayside.”

There were other speeches, but the climax came when Pedro A. Paterno
began by comparing Mr. Taft with Jesus Christ, saying that “as Christ
had converted the cross into a symbol of glory and triumph, so had
Governor Taft turned a dying people to the light and life of modern
liberties.”

This sounds quite blasphemous in English, but the Filipinos take strange
liberties with holy names which shock us but which to them are mere
expressions of piety. Jesus is a favourite name for boy babies, while
there is a street of “The Heart of Jesus” in Manila, and many others
equally inconsistent with our more reticent taste.

Needless to say the cable between Manila and Washington was crowded that
day with protests to the President; protests not only from citizens and
committees of citizens, but from all Mr. Taft’s colleagues in the
government, both Filipino and American. Two days later my husband
received a message from Mr. Roosevelt which gave us all a hearty laugh.
It read, simply: “Taft, Manila, All right stay where you are. I shall
appoint some one else to the Court. ROOSEVELT.”

Altogether it was quite an exciting event. After the “smoke of battle”
had cleared away Mr. Taft rose up out of his depression and went to work
with renewed vigour and strengthened confidence, but I began to think
that after all the demonstrations and protestations we should have to
remain in the Islands the rest of our lives whether we wanted to or not.
Six months later, however, we learned, to our consternation, that Mr.
Root was going to resign as Secretary of War in the fall or winter
following, and without a moment’s hesitation as far as we could judge,
the position was offered by Mr. Roosevelt to Mr. Taft. It was urged upon
him, in fact. This was much more pleasing to me than the offer of the
Supreme Court appointment, because it was in line with the kind of work
I wanted my husband to do, the kind of career I wanted for him and
expected him to have, so I was glad there were few excuses for refusing
to accept it open to him. If it hadn’t been that it was merely a case of
transferring his services from the necessarily restricted field of work
in the Philippines to the broader and more powerful field of general
supervision of Philippine affairs in the War Department, he probably
would have declined the appointment and begged to be left where he was,
but the change was not to take place for a year and he knew that as soon
as he had settled the Friars’ question and a few other matters of
importance in the Islands he could be of more use to the Filipino people
in Washington than he could in Manila. General Wright was to succeed
him, with Mr. Ide and Judge Smith, both trained men, in line of
succession to follow General Wright, so with the promise of a few months
in which to close up the affairs in which he was most deeply engrossed,
he accepted the Cabinet office.

Shortly before we left Manila to take up our residence in Washington we
decided to give a final and memorable entertainment. We wanted it to be
something original, so we discussed it and pondered over it at great
length. We thought we had given every kind of party that ingenuity could
devise during our residence at Malacañan, but one evening, sitting out
on the verandah looking across the still, softly-lapping river at the
low-hung lights on the opposite bank, it suddenly occurred to me that we
had an ideal setting for a Venetian Carnival, and a Venetian Carnival
was settled upon without further ado. It was to be a masked ball, the
front gates of the Palace grounds were to be closed and everybody was to
come by boat to the river landing on the verandah below.

As soon as this plan was noised abroad the town was agog with
excitement. The first question, of course, to occur to everybody was:
“What shall I go as?” And pretty soon every woman in town, and many men,
assumed that labouredly innocent air peculiar to a period of preparation
for a masked ball in a community where everybody knows or wants to know
all about everybody else.

[Illustration:

  MR. AND MRS. TAFT, WITH MEMBERS OF THEIR FAMILY AND STAFF, INCLUDING
    MAJOR NOBLE, AIDE (_AT LEFT_), AND MR. FRED. C. CARPENTER, PRIVATE
    SECRETARY (_RIGHT_), IN COSTUMES WORN AT THE VENETIAN CARNIVAL
]

I knew right away what I should “go as.” I would be a Venetian lady of
romance days. But the question of Mr. Taft’s costume was not so easily
settled. If he hadn’t interposed so many ideas of his own it would have
been much simpler. In writing to his brother Charles he says: “It is a
humiliating fact to me that every suggestion of a character for me by me
has been summarily rejected by Nellie unless it involved the wearing of
a gown of such voluminous proportions as to conceal my Apollo-like form
completely. The proposal that I assume the character of an Igorrote
chieftain because of the slight drain on capital and our costuming
resources did not meet with favour. So it is settled that I must assume
the robes and headgear of the husband of the Adriatic, the Doge of
Venice. The question is whether the robe can be made historically
accurate and at the same time so conceal my nether extremities as to
make it unnecessary for me to dye my nether undergarments to a proper
colour, for the entire Orient cannot produce tights of a sufficient
size. The Council of War, meaning Nellie, has not advised me on the
subject, but tights or no tights we shall have a Doge of Venice ‘that
never was on land or sea.’” And we did.

We called a committee of Filipinos to arrange about illuminations on the
river and the decoration of launches, cascoes, bancas, rafts and barges,
and this committee took the whole matter out of my hands and went to
work with the zeal of children playing at some fascinating new game.
They arranged for a number of pavilioned craft decorated with flowers,
and offered a prize for the most beautiful and elaborate private launch,
or boat of any kind. Then on either bank of the river they stretched
lines of coloured electric lights and crossed the river at close
intervals with other lines as far as the eye could see in both
directions. The whole Palace building was outlined in electric lights,
while the great trees and every little bush were wired and strung with a
myriad multicoloured globes, hundreds of them covered with Japanese
lanterns in fantastic colours and designs. All the garden walks and
drives were bordered with tiny coloured lamps burning cocoanut oil, set
close in against the well trimmed lawns, and when it was all finished
and the light turned on the place was like a fairyland.

The date for the Carnival was set for full moon night, the third of
December, and never will I forget the brilliance and beauty of the scene
as one gay and picturesque barge or improvised gondola after another,
full of laughing, chattering and singing people in masks and all manner
of strange costumes, and with mandolins and guitars playing, floated up
under the bright canopy of swinging globes, a million times reflected in
the ripples of the river, to the ancient-looking, moss-grown landing
where Mr. Taft and I, as the Doge of Venice and his Lady, stood
receiving our guests with as much mock stateliness as we could command
in the midst of such a merry throng. It will linger in my memory always
as one of the most entrancing evenings of my life.

Rain was predicted, as usually happens when I give any kind of a garden
party, and all day long I had watched the clouds with a feeling of
helpless exasperation. I wanted fair weather; I wanted the moonlight;
but as night came on the lowering grey canopy seemed to float upward and
spread itself out into a mere haze which softened and diffused the
brightness and made ten times more effective our myriad swinging lamps
and lanterns.

Everybody had done his or her utmost in the matter of costuming, and
with a success that I never saw surpassed. All the fine old collections
of jewels in the rich Spanish and Filipino families were taken out, and
in many cases made over into special designs to deck oriental
princesses, historic queens and noble ladies of storied fame.

Perhaps the most striking costume of all was worn by Mrs. Rafael Reyes,
a tall dark Spanish lady of extraordinary beauty, the wife of a
prominent and wealthy Filipino. Señora Reyes came as the Queen of Night,
and she was literally ablaze with diamonds. Not brilliants nor
rhinestones, but diamonds large and small, sewn all over the long
graceful folds of her sweeping black robe to represent stars. On her
small shapely head, crowned with a wealth of shining black hair, she
wore a large diamond crescent. She caught the light and sparkled, her
vivacious personality sparkling with her jewels. On that memorable
occasion nobody who saw her could possibly forget her.

Dancing and frolicking continued long into the night, but as the evening
wore to a close we began to feel a sense of depression. In a very few
days we were to leave the Islands perhaps never to return, and this was
our last party at old Malacañan. It is not amiss, I am sure, to say that
every laughing face sobered and every voice took on a regretful tone as
one by one our guests came up to say good night—and good-bye.



                              CHAPTER XIII
                            SECRETARY OF WAR


To illustrate what seems to me to be rather widely contrasted views of
the position of Secretary of War for the United States, I think I must
relate two experiences I had in the beginning of Mr. Taft’s career in
that office.

Before we left Manila his appointment had been announced and as we
passed through Japan en route to Washington we were received with all
the ceremony and official dignity that the Japanese naturally would
consider proper to the entertainment of the War Minister of a great and
friendly foreign power. This was experience number one.

It was just before the outbreak of hostilities between Russia and Japan,
and General Kuropotkin, the Russian Minister of War, had very recently
been in Tokyo and had been accorded a welcome so elaborate that it
became historic. It satisfied the Japanese conception of courtesy to an
exalted foreign visitor and we discovered that it was to serve as a
model for our own reception, though our time was so short that the
programme had to be considerably modified.

Had we remained with our ship to Yokohama there would have been no
opportunity to entertain us at all, but a special train was sent to meet
us at Nagasaki, the first port of call on the homeward voyage, and
nearly the whole length of the Empire from Tokyo, and we were whisked
through ahead of everything two or three days in advance of our ship,
which had to make two more stops before proceeding to Yokohama.

We were the guests of the nation and were conducted from one function to
another with the greatest honour and official formality. Among other
arrangements made for our entertainment was a luncheon at the Palace
with the Emperor and Empress, and Mr. Taft was permitted, in his
capacity of a war secretary, to witness the evolutions of a crack
Japanese regiment, of 3,000 troops ready for the field massed on a
single great parade ground.

The Japanese Minister of War, General Terauchi, was a soldier—which
seems fitting, and which is usual in most countries I believe—and he
assumed at once, in common with all the other Army officers whom he
encountered, that Mr. Taft was a soldier, too. This has nothing to do
with my immediate story, but I remember it as one of the most amusing
circumstances of that visit to Japan. Whatever Mr. Taft may be he is not
martial, but these Japanese warriors proceeded to credit him with all
manner of special knowledge which he had never had an opportunity to
acquire and to speak to him in technical terms which, it must be
admitted, strained his ability for concealing his ignorance. He finally
said that if anybody asked him again about the muzzle velocity of a
Krag-Jorgensen, or any like question, he intended to reply: “Sh! It’s a
secret!”

General Kodama, who afterward made himself world-famous as Chief of
Staff during the Russo-Japanese War, had been Military Governor of
Formosa and he was especially interested in Mr. Taft because he
conceived that in the Philippines we had a parallel for their Formosan
problem. He grew quite confidential, telling Mr. Taft many things about
the Japanese administration of Formosan affairs and drawing comparisons
between his difficulties and those that we had encountered under similar
circumstances. He ended by saying:

“We had to kill a good many thousands of those people before they would
be good. But then, of course, you understand,—you know,—you know!”

This story could not have been told at that time because there were
groups of active anti-Imperialists in the United States who would have
pounced upon it as something to be made the most of as an argument for
their cause, but in the light of history that has been made I think it
is safe to tell it now. Mr. Taft had to admit that he was a man of
peace, that so far as he personally was concerned he had never killed
nor ordered killed a single Filipino in his life, and that his whole
endeavour had been to form a friendly alliance with the Philippine
people and to dissuade them from indulgence in the personal danger
involved in their useless opposition to temporary American control.

We made something of a triumphal progress through Japan during our short
stay and were escorted to our ship by numerous dignitaries who were
extremely gracious and who cheered us on our way with such “banzais!”
and such a waving of flags as made me feel that we were quite important
personages. Later on I had my sense of the importance of my position
rudely shaken. There is one thing to be said for the American Republic
and that is that no public official is permitted to retain for very long
a too exalted opinion of himself.

One day shortly after my arrival in Washington, I was at tea at the
house of a friend and found myself in conversation with a lady, the wife
of an Army officer, whom I had known in Manila. We talked around and
about various subjects, after the manner of ladies at a tea, when she
finally said to me:

“You know, Mrs. Taft, I have thought about you so often and wondered how
you liked it here in Washington after your life in Manila. Why, out
there you were really a queen, and you come back here and are _just
nobody_!”

There was another lady who sat next to my husband at a dinner one night.
It was a place of honour, next to a Cabinet officer, and she no doubt
considered it necessary to “make conversation” while the candle-lights
shone. She went along quite successfully for awhile, but eventually
blundered into this:

“Do you know, Mr. Secretary, I really think you ought to go out and see
the Philippine Islands. They say they are so interesting!”

Poor man, most of his reputation, such as it then was, had been made in
the Philippine service, but he replied to her:

“That’s right, I should go. And I’m going, too, just as soon as I can
possibly get away.”

He meant that. He had promised the Filipinos that he would return to
open their first Assembly, and even then he had a fixed desire to lead a
party of American Congressmen to the country whose affairs they were
endeavouring to settle by long distance legislation founded upon very
mixed and, in some cases, greatly distorted, second-hand information.

Mr. Taft became Secretary of War at the beginning of 1904, but I spent
the remainder of the winter after our arrival in the United States in
Santa Barbara and did not join him until May, when I met him at St.
Louis, where he went to open the Louisiana Purchase Exposition.

President Roosevelt was to have done this, but urgent affairs kept him
in Washington, so the Secretary of War was asked to represent him and to
make the speech which announced to the world the inauguration of this
great Fair. I remember the occasion especially because I had been so
long out of touch with the kind of buoyant Americanism which made itself
felt in St. Louis that I had almost lost my own identity with it, and I
began then to think that it was really good to be back in my own
country.

I knew fairly well what it would mean to settle down in Washington as
the wife of a Cabinet officer because I had lived in Washington before.
While I didn’t expect to be and didn’t expect anybody to consider me
“just nobody” I knew that it would not be at all like entering upon the
duties and privileges of the wife of the Governor of the Philippine
Islands. I thought what a curious and peculiarly American sort of
promotion it was which carried with it such diminished advantages.

My first necessity in my generally considered enviable position was to
find a house in Washington large enough to contain my family, to permit
such participation in social life as would be expected of us, and the
rent for which would not wholly exhaust the stipend then allowed to a
Cabinet officer.

Eight thousand dollars a year, sufficient income though it may be
when it is expected to accommodate itself to an ordinary
eight-thousand-dollars-a-year standard of living, shrinks alarmingly
when its recipient is expected to maintain on it the dignity of a
Cabinet position. If we had not had some private resources I don’t
quite see how we could have managed. Fortunately for my husband, and
more so for his successors in office, this figure was raised to
twelve thousand before he left the War Department, and still there
are complaints which I am amply able to appreciate.

We finally settled, on the first of October after my arrival at
Washington, in a pleasant, old-fashioned house on K Street near 16th. It
was not the most elegantly equipped house available, but we preferred a
little extra space to the more elaborate modern conveniences, so we took
it.

We were spared one item of expense by having the use of the War
Department carriage and its big Irish coachman, Quade. Quade was quite a
character. He had been at one time in the artillery service and had
occupied the position in which we found him through several
administrations. He was never able to lose the habits and manners of an
artillery man, and Mr. Roosevelt used to say he never drove behind him
without feeling as if he were on the caisson of a gun wagon going into
action. He kept his horses in fine condition, though a trifle too fat
perhaps, and he took great pride in the speed he could get out of them.
He would swing around corners and dash past street cars and other
vehicles in a way that was anything but soothing to sensitive nerves,
but there was no use protesting. Quade’s character was fully formed.

He used to feed Mr. Taft’s private riding horse at the public expense,
and Mr. Taft didn’t approve of this. He thought he ought to include the
pay for its keep in his personal accounts, and he told Quade so, asking
him at the same time to have a bill made out so that he might settle it.
Quade regarded him in utter disgust for a moment, then said:

“Well, Misther Sicretary, what with the good an’ plinty o’ fodder we got
in the stables, I guess ye can go on a-feedin’ your horse here without
the Government’s a-worryin’ anny.”

I remember going one day to a reception at the house of Justice Harlan
on the occasion of his twenty-fifth anniversary on the bench. President
Roosevelt was already there and as we drove up we found the bicycle
policemen surrounding the entrance waiting for him. Quade, with great
friendliness but with an absolute lack of decorum, leaned over on the
box and shouted to them as we passed:

“Ah, Begorra! Ye’ll be a-waitin’ around fer my boss one o’ these days!”

Faithful Quade lived to see his prophecy fulfilled, but not long
afterward he lost his life at his post of duty in a shocking accident.
He was driving the Department carriage for Secretary of War Dickinson’s
family; the pole broke, the horses became frightened and bolted. There
were young children and a nurse in the carriage, so Quade bravely held
on to the reins and finally succeeded in turning the horses into a
fence. He saved the occupants of the carriage from injury, but he
himself was thrown forward violently, falling in such a way as to break
his neck.

Another War department employé whom we valued highly was Arthur Brooks,
a coloured department messenger, and a major of militia. Arthur was the
most useful individual I ever knew anything about, combining absolute
loyalty with an efficiency and accuracy that were most comforting to his
employers. He went into the War Department during President Arthur’s
administration and gradually won for himself a position of especial
trust. Mr. Root, as Secretary of War, found Arthur most valuable and
reposed the utmost confidence in him.

For me he did all kinds of things which without him would probably have
been done very badly. He “managed” all my larger entertainments, being
present, after I had done all I could by way of preparation, to see that
everybody was properly received, that the service ran smoothly and that
nothing went amiss. When Mr. Taft became President he had Arthur
transferred to the position of custodian of the White House and I shall
have occasion to speak of him in that capacity later on.

Taking things all in all, I think we managed to get on very well indeed,
though I did sometimes sigh for the luxurious simplicity and the entire
freedom from petty household details that I had left behind me in
Manila. I did not find that my very large and very black cook was so
capable as to make me forget the excellencies and the almost soundless
orderliness of Ah Sing; nor did my coloured butler and one housemaid
quite manage to take the places of Ah King and Chang, my two upstairs
“Chinaboys” at Malacañan. As for the six or eight barefoot _muchachos_
who “skated” my Philippine hardwood floors to a state of mirror gloss
and kept everything speckless without ever seeming to do any work at
all, they could have no substitute in a Washington establishment.

The life of a “Cabinet lady” newly arrived in the Capital is one of
rather monotonous stress. In the first place she is expected to call on
nearly everybody who calls on her, and, of course, nearly everybody does
that. This custom in my time was especially insisted upon with regard to
the wives of all the Congressmen and of all the men connected with the
various departments. Then there were the wives of the members of the
Supreme Court, women whose husbands were connected with the many
different bureaus and a large and most attractive civilian society which
contributes so much to the gaiety of the city. And besides all these
there were the Army women, any number of them.

Every afternoon throughout the winter when I was not “at home” myself I
started out on certain rounds of calls, and I think I made as many calls
as any one I knew. Irksome to me as this duty sometimes was, in the
formal discharge of it I made some of the pleasantest friends I ever
had. I have always found Army women particularly delightful, and it is
easy to understand why they are so. In the course of their wanderings
and their many changes of habitation, and in consequence of the
happy-go-lucky attitude toward life that they are bound to assume, they
acquire a cordiality of manner and an all-round generous tone which make
them very attractive.

One morning each week Mrs. Roosevelt held a meeting of the Cabinet
ladies at the White House, but this was not a social affair. We met to
discuss various matters supposed to be of interest to us all, and would
gather in the library from eleven to twelve for this purpose.

After calling, the most important social duty devolving upon a Cabinet
officer’s wife is dining out. We always dined out when we were not
giving a dinner party at our own house, so that from the time Mr. Taft
became Secretary of War we almost ceased to know what it was to have “a
quiet evening at home.” Of course such a life gave us an opportunity for
meeting many interesting men and women who contributed much to the sum
total of what the world seemed to have in store for us.

It has been the custom through a good many administrations for the
President, sometime during the season between December first and Lent,
to dine with each member of the Cabinet, and all other members of the
Cabinet, with only a few outside guests, were usually invited to these
parties. It can easily be imagined that they did not offer much
variation, especially in view of the fact that hard and fast rules of
precedence settled for the hostess just where each of her guests should
sit. Mr. Roosevelt did not care for this custom, so during his last
Administration it became usual to ask to such dinners only people
outside the “official family,” as it is called. The dinner to Mr. and
Mrs. Roosevelt which we gave each year was our most ambitious social
function and it was my desire always to invite as many persons as
possible who would themselves prove entertaining and who would not be
likely to meet the President in the ordinary course of events. I often
asked friends from different parts of the country to visit us for the
occasion.

Every Wednesday afternoon all the ladies of the Cabinet were “at home”
and nearly all Washington called on each of them. Then, too, the casual
visitors to the Capital were free to attend these informal receptions
and I used to be surprised at the number of curious strangers who found
their way into my drawing room.

However, this is only a glimpse in general of the life of a Cabinet lady
during the regular social season. Fortunately for me my husband was,
from the very beginning, a travelling Secretary. I remember most of the
cartoons of those days pictured him either as “sitting on the lid,”
wreathed in cherubic smiles, while President Roosevelt rushed off on
some flying trip, or as himself making a frantic dash for the rear
platform of a moving train. The rush of Mr. Roosevelt was always
expressed by the backward sweep of the ribbon attached to his
eyeglasses, while Mr. Taft was usually pictured with a perspiring look,
his hat lifted off his head by the wind and a busy looking suitcase,
labelled in large letters: “Taft,” swinging wildly along behind him. And
these cartoons were rather accurately descriptive of real conditions.

I had hardly got my house on K Street in order before something happened
in Panama which made it imperative for the Secretary of War to go down
to the Isthmus and give the situation his personal attention. There was
a state of popular discontent among the Panamanians complicated by
question of zone boundaries, jurisdiction, postal regulations, tariff
inequalities and a few other matters, and by that time we had too much
at stake in the Canal Zone to risk long distance or dilatory regulation.

The building of the Panama Canal was not included in the business of the
War Department until after Mr. Taft became Secretary, nor was there at
that time any definite idea of having it done by the Army Engineer
Corps, but it has long been recognised that in the War Portfolio
accommodation can be found for any and every kind of governmental
problem, and Mr. Taft had not been Secretary long before Mr. Roosevelt
transferred the administration of Canal Zone affairs to his already
well-laden shoulders.

I was very glad to have an opportunity to see the beginning of what I
knew was to be the greatest enterprise ever undertaken by the United
States, so I fully approved of my husband’s suggestion that I accompany
him to Panama. Señor Obaldia, the Panamanian Minister to Washington,
went also, and among others in the very interesting party were Rear
Admiral J. G. Walker, President of the Canal Commission, Judge Charles
G. Magoon, law officer of the Commission, and Mr. Nelson W. Cromwell,
counsel for the Republic of Panama.

On this trip Mr. Taft went to Panama as a representative of the
President of the United States for the purpose of presenting to the
President of Panama a message of friendship, and to make, if possible,
an amicable adjustment of the differences between American and
Panamanian interests.

It was in November, 1904. We went from Washington to New Orleans and
were greeted in a kindly manner all along the way. When we arrived we
were met by a most imposing committee of citizens who escorted us to our
hotel. No sooner were we installed, in the midst of all the luxury that
could be prepared for us, than Governor Blanchard, with due ceremony and
accompanied by members of his staff in uniform, called to pay his
official respects. We hadn’t very long to stay, but every hour was
filled with entertainments made memorable by the courteous and highbred
lavishness for which New Orleans is famed, the only private event of our
visit being a dinner with Archbishop Chapelle, now dead, who was
Archbishop of Manila when Mr. Taft first went to the Philippines and
with whom he good-naturedly, but persistently, disagreed on the
important problems connected with the necessary disentanglement of the
affairs of Church and State in the Islands.

We sailed on the little _Dolphin_ from New Orleans to Pensacola, where
the cruiser _Columbia_ lay waiting to take us down to Panama, and it was
to the boom of saluting guns, the cheers of hospitable Pensacola
citizens and the strains of “The Star Spangled Banner” that we got under
way on this first memorable trip to the Canal Zone.

We arrived at Colon on a Sunday morning, and I remember distinctly that
it seemed more like “getting home” than like getting to a strange place.
The whole atmosphere and surroundings, the people, the language they
spoke, the houses and streets, the rank earth odours and the very feel
of the air reminded me so strongly of the Philippines as to give me
immediately a delightful sense of friendly familiarity with everything
and everybody.

We were met at Colon by the vice-President of Panama, Señor Arosemana,
and a number of other Panamanian officials, by General Davis, then
Governor of the Canal Zone, and by Mr. John Barrett, the American
Minister to Panama. A private train was waiting to take us across the
Isthmus and we lost no time in getting started. Our visit had been
“programmed” almost to the last hour of our time, and the first event
was to be an exchange of formalities between the Secretary of War and
the President of Panama that very afternoon.

When we got to the city of Panama just before luncheon we went to the
home of Mr. Wallace, the Chief Engineer, whose guests we were to be
during our stay, and early in the afternoon Mr. Taft, accompanied by
uniformed aides and other Army officers, with enough ceremony to satisfy
even the most formal, went to call on President Amador. The call was
promptly returned with due formality, and the decks were then considered
“cleared for action.”

Negotiations began at once, but the conferences were private, and in our
daily round of sightseeing and social diversions it did not seem that
the delicate machinery of diplomatic transaction was in motion at all.

Our Minister, Mr. Barrett, had a charming house in the old tropic city
and on the Monday evening after our arrival he gave a dinner at which
were gathered many high officials of the Panama Republic as well as all
the interesting Americans who were then directing our great Canal
building enterprise. Mr. Barrett, being a bachelor, placed President
Amador opposite himself; he took Madame Amador at his right; Mr. Taft
sat next to her, while I occupied the place at the right of the
President and had on my other side Señor Arias, the Minister of Foreign
Affairs. General Davis, Mr. Wallace, Colonel Gorgas—“the man of the
hour” during that cleaning-up period,—many Army officers and Cabinet
Ministers in full regalia and many decorations, with their wives, were
seated in order of rank along the sides of the great table, which, laden
with flowers and gleaming glass and candles, made a picture long to be
remembered even by one whose memory is overcrowded with dinner-party
scenes.

The formality of this occasion, however, began and ended with its
costuming and its beautiful tropic “setting.” Nearly everybody,
including the President and Madame Amador, spoke English as well as
Spanish, and the evening was gay from the outset. There is a wonderful
fish caught in Panama waters; I wish I could remember its name; it is
delicious and rare beyond description, and our pleasantries began with
the President’s demand for a second helping which the embarrassed host
and the more than flustered servants were unable to supply. The
persiflage then turned upon the unenviable position of a bachelor
diplomat and we all advised Mr. Barrett to get married. He parried our
jibes as best he could until President Amador volunteered the
information that the American Minister was honorary President of the
Iris Club, an association of some three hundred-odd of the choicest
girls in Panama. “And he can’t get one out of the lot,” said the
President.

After dinner a large reception was held in the salon which, as in all
Spanish houses in the tropics, was on what might be called the second
floor, the first floor being only a sort of plastered and stone-paved
street-level basement. The highly-polished floor of the big room didn’t
look to me to be particularly safe and I suppose Mr. Barrett observed my
worried looks as it “gave” under the weight of my husband. He hastened
to reassure me by telling me that he had taken the precaution to have it
shored up with heavy timbers under the spot where Mr. Taft was to stand
to receive the long line of guests. He seemed to consider this a fine
joke, but I thought it a most commendable measure.

When we arrived in Panama we were not at all certain that we should find
the country in a state of tranquillity; nor did we exactly; though by
prompt action the President had nipped a budding revolution only a short
time before. Hostilities had been averted, but the people were in a bad
temper and it was thought best to keep them “merely guessing” while the
negotiations between the Secretary of War and the Panamanian government
were in progress, and much of Mr. Taft’s time, therefore, was spent
behind the closed doors of President Amador’s council chamber.

In the meantime I made myself familiar with the wonderful American
project which brought the Panama Republic into existence. The Canal then
was a sorry sight. The public clamour in the United States was for
“making the dirt fly,” but it did not look to a mere layman as if we
could ever make it fly fast enough or in sufficient quantities to really
bring the two oceans together. All along the line of operations the old
French machinery lay buried in pathetic ruin in a tropic jungle which
had all but effaced the evidences of the French enterprise, and such
conditions of general unhealthiness prevailed as made it seem almost too
much to expect that any kind of clean-up programme could be made
effectual.

But all that story has been told; told in actual accomplishment with
which all the world is familiar. I am only glad that I saw Colonel
Gorgas and his men in that initial and contagious enthusiasm which,
being sustained, resulted in a record of which we are all so proud.

The Panamanians are nothing if not expansively hospitable. On the 4th of
December, after we had been on the Isthmus a couple of weeks and while
the results of the official negotiations were still, as far as any one
knew, “in the lap of the gods,” an ocean steamship was chartered by a
company of hosts, and about three hundred guests, the élite of the whole
republic, were invited for a picnic party to the Pearl Islands in the
Bay of Panama, and a sail out into the Pacific Ocean. It was an all-day
expedition and included the exploration of the beautiful little group,
some pearl-diving for our especial benefit, a most amazing luncheon, and
a dance on deck, to the music of a stringed band in gay and most
decorative uniforms, at which Mr. Taft made a tremendous “hit.” The tiny
Panamanian woman who first danced with him was thought to be very
courageous, but as one after another followed suit his reputation grew
and it finally was conceded, in the midst of great merriment, that he
was as light of foot as the slimmest Panamanian of them all.

Having always been used to my husband’s dancing, and knowing how much he
likes it, I never thought of it as anything unusual, but during the days
when he was being “boomed” for the Presidency and was therefore much in
the public prints, it was made the subject of frequent jest. I have one
bit of doggerel in my scrap-book which appeared in the Baltimore
_American_ after the reception we gave on the occasion of General
Kuroki’s visit to this country, and the last verse of which runs:

                   That Taft is just a wonder
                      Is a thing which we all know;
                   That as Presidential thunder
                      His big boom is like to go.
                   But as butterfly, blooms sipping,
                      And as waltzer, simply ripping!
                   ’Tis a sight to see Taft tripping
                      On the light fantastic toe!

As a matter of fact he dances exceedingly well, if his wife who has been
dancing with him for the past thirty years may say so.

When we returned from the Pearl Islands to Panama City that evening we
were met by a pleasing surprise. The text of the agreement which had
been reached by Mr. Taft and the government of Panama, and which had not
been mentioned by anybody all day, had been made public during our
absence and newsboys were crying “extras” in all the streets, while
excited groups stood about here and there wreathed in smiles and talking
with great animation. Everybody seemed wholly satisfied and wherever we
went we were met with cheers and cries of “Viva!”

The keynote sounded in this agreement was that justice should be done at
Panama. Mr. Taft interpreted the treaty between our country and the
infant republic; he adjusted the differences with regard to postal
regulations and the tariff; he defined the harbour boundaries; and, much
to the satisfaction of the Panamanians, he kept within the hands of the
American authorities all matters pertaining to the public health. The
people realised the necessity for a pure water supply, for sewer
systems, clean and well-paved streets, and the elimination of the dread
diseases which made the Isthmus a death trap for white men, and all
these things America offered to Panama as a free gift that the great
work of building the Canal might go on. If vociferous cheers are an
expression of gratitude the people were grateful.

The next day a great demonstration took place in Cathedral Plaza. We
stood on a balcony of the Grand Central Hotel, on one side of the square
and opposite the Cathedral, and looked out across a veritable sea of
moving, swaying, white-clad humanity. As far as one could see in every
direction there were people, and when Mr. Taft stepped to the balcony
rail to address them they gave voice to a cheer which made it seem
certain that all cause for quarrel between us had happily been removed.

There had been vague rumours that the deposed War Minister of the Panama
government who had attempted to start the rebellion would, with his
followers, take this occasion to make a hostile demonstration, but he
was evidently sensible enough to realise that his was an unpopular
cause. Moreover, his original army of two hundred and fifty men had been
reduced to twenty-five, and if that were not discouraging enough he had
only to contemplate the natty American Marine corps in the Canal Zone
and the Pacific squadron, including the _New York_, the _Boston_, the
_Bennington_ and the _Marblehead_, lying out in Panama harbour
unobtrusively but very positively guaranteeing peace.

Mr. Taft in his speech to the Panamanians was earnest. He was imbued
with the spirit of conquest as represented in our Panama Canal
enterprise. It was to be a conquest of nature’s own forces in their most
formidable aspects and he expressed a determination to enforce, during
his term of administration, the laws necessary to make that conquest
possible, and capping all his promises of fair treatment to the people
of Panama, he emphasised an insistence upon orderly government in the
little republic which brought forth round after round of applause.

He was destined to have almost endless difficulties of various sorts in
the Canal Zone, but he had the great privilege of occupying an
administrative office, first as Secretary of War and then as President,
until the end of the work was in sight and all the problems had been
fully solved. During those eight years, wherever he might be or whatever
business happened to be temporarily paramount, Canal questions were with
him always and were always given first consideration.

[Illustration:

  MR. TAFT AND COLONEL GOETHALS, IN PANAMA
]

The history of the Panama Canal is divided into two great periods. The
first covers the full discussion and final settlement of the question as
to which route should be adopted, the Nicaraguan or the Panama; the
negotiation of the Hay-Herran Treaty with Colombia, by which we were
given the right to complete the Panama Canal, and under which we secured
all the rights of the French Panama Canal Company; the rejection of the
Hay-Herran Treaty with Colombia; the revolution of Panama; the
establishment of the Panamanian Republic and its recognition by
President Roosevelt, the negotiation of the Hay-Varilla Treaty with
Panama, by which we acquired dominion over the Canal Zone, and the right
to build the Canal from the Republic of Panama, guaranteeing at the same
time the integrity of that Republic. During all this period Mr. Taft was
in the Philippines. In February, 1904, when he became Secretary of War,
the Hay-Varilla Treaty was pending in the Senate. In a few weeks
thereafter, it was consented to by the Senate, the Panama Commission was
appointed, and early that spring the second period of the construction
of the Canal began. The work was placed by the President under Mr. Taft
as Secretary of War. From that time until his retirement from the office
of President, March 4, 1913, the construction was constantly under his
supervision. Sometime this history must be written. The chief crises in
this work as he has recited them were the organisation of the force
under the Commission, the adjustment of the relations of Panama to the
work under the treaty, the change of engineers from Mr. Wallace to Mr.
Stevens, the consideration by an International Commission, with a
divided report, as to the proper type of the Canal, whether sea-level or
lock, the very close fight in Congress to sustain the Administration
view in favor of the lock type, the settlement of the issue whether the
Canal should be built by contract or by Government agency, the selection
of a successor to Mr. Stevens when he resigned, and the placing of the
work under Army engineers and the selection of Colonel Goethals as the
man to take the responsibility, the adjustment of critical labour
troubles, and the confirmation by a Commission of the security of the
foundation of the Gatun Dam. These were the points of critical
importance in Mr. Taft’s Administration. In deciding the questions which
came to him, it was necessary for him to visit the Canal seven times in
as many years, and I went with him on three of his visits. The contrast
between the Canal when we first visited it and were the guests of Mr.
Wallace, the first engineer, and as it was when we were the guests of
Colonel Goethals in 1912, when the Gatun Lake was more than half filled
and nothing but the slides in the Culebra Cut remained for excavation,
it is most interesting to look back upon. I was twice the guest of
Colonel and Mrs. Goethals, and the beautiful view of the Canal Valley
from the windows of their house in the town of Culebra, which has now
disappeared, will long remain in my mind.

It was not long after our return to Washington from the first trip to
Panama before arrangements were completed for the tour of the big
Congressional party which Mr. Taft “personally conducted” to the
Philippines and back, and which was destined to be slightly overshadowed
as a Congressional party by the personality of Miss Alice Roosevelt who,
under the chaperonage of Mr. Taft and Mrs. Newlands, made the trip just,
as Kipling sings, “for to be’old and for to see.”

Knowing that I should have an opportunity to go again to the Far East in
two years to be present at the inauguration of the first Philippine
Assembly, I decided to remain behind this time. I did not think I would
much enjoy this brief busy trip to the Orient with three children and
decided that a quiet summer in England would be better for us all. So I
took a cottage in Oxford for the summer and with my two younger children
and one of my Cincinnati friends and her two children made various trips
here and there and found myself most pleasantly entertained. It was an
exceedingly quiet summer, unbroken save by the somewhat lurid accounts
which we gathered from the British and European press of the progress of
the Congressional party with Mr. Taft and Miss Alice Roosevelt in the
East. One German paper went so far as to announce that Miss Roosevelt
was undoubtedly engaged to be married to her father’s War Secretary.

It was my intention to sail from Southampton and meet Mr. Taft in New
York on his arrival from the East. We had been inveighing all summer
against the British system of handling luggage and when we went to look
after our trunks in the Oxford station we were charmed to find that a
new method of labelling had been introduced and that our luggage would
travel down to London and across London to the station for Southampton
without any assistance from us. We pocketed our British substitutes for
American baggage checks with considerable satisfaction and started on
our way.

When we arrived in London I sent the boys over to the station from which
we were to leave for our steamer to make sure that our baggage had
really been delivered as promised. Unfortunately the boys got to the
station just as King Edward arrived, and they were so excited about
getting a glimpse of the monarch that they gave up trying to look after
baggage. We, having nothing else to do, drove to the station a full hour
before the steamer train was to leave, and had occasion to congratulate
ourselves for being so early. Our trunks were not in the station. My
friend jumped in a hansom and rushed to the station where we had come
in. I spent the time ransacking every corner and looking over piles of
all kinds of luggage and three-quarters of an hour passed before a
telephone message came to say the trunks were found and that they had
started across town.

But the train would leave in five minutes! I was frantic. Otherwise I
should never have played my last card and exposed myself to the jibes of
my family forever after. I rushed into the office of the station-master
determined to overawe him by revealing to him my official position.

“I am Mrs. William Howard Taft of Washington,” I cried. “I must get my
trunks on that boat train. They’ll be here in a few minutes. Can’t you
hold it for me!”

He looked at me blankly.

“My husband is the Secretary of War of the United States,” I went on
desperately.

“I am very sorry, Madam,” he began, then I made my last effort.

“You must have heard of him. He’s travelling now with Miss Alice
Roosevelt.”

At last I had produced the effect I desired. Immediately the station was
my castle. The station-master was my humble servant. He accompanied me
out, ordered the train held, and superintended a whole obsequious force
which hustled our baggage aboard as soon as it arrived. Since we made
the boat, which we would not otherwise have done, I was able to bear the
chaffing of my children and friends when they continued to refer to me
as _The_ Mrs. Taft whose husband was travelling with Miss Alice
Roosevelt.

Early in the autumn of 1906 the American Consul General at Havana began
cabling to the government at Washington that the Cuban republic under
President Palma was rapidly going to pieces. What was described as
“devastating and paralysing civil strife” was rampant, and a serious
insurrection was threatened.

The Constitution of the Cuban republic and the Cuban Treaty with the
United States contains a “self-acting” clause, known as the Platt
Amendment, which was introduced by the United States Congress, and which
provides for American intervention in Cuban affairs whenever such
intervention is deemed requisite to a continuance of peace and good
government in the island.

Sometime during the first week in September the situation became acute
and President Palma, fearing that it would become formidable and knowing
that he had no adequate force to protect life and property, urgently,
though secretly begged our government to send warships to his
assistance. On September 12 he despatched a cablegram imploring that an
American Army be landed in Havana at once to prevent a threatened
massacre of citizens; on September 13 he decided to resign the
Presidency and compel the United States to assume the responsibility of
government; on September 14 President Roosevelt called a conference at
Oyster Bay where it was decided that Mr. Taft should undertake the task
of Cuban pacification, peaceful if possible—and on September 20 Mr.
Taft, accompanied by Mr. Robert Bacon, Assistant Secretary of State, as
a fellow Peace Commissioner, landed at Havana. They didn’t lose much
time.

Then began what Mr. Taft always refers to as “those awful twenty days.”
The people were divided into various warring factions, the result,
largely, of political habits inherited from the old Spanish régime
wherein a new party arose on the slightest provocation, basing its
antagonism to the others on nothing finer nor more patriotic than
individual desire for political patronage.

President Palma still held the reins of government, but camped just
outside Havana were twenty thousand men under arms ready at any moment
to open hostilities. These insurgents, as well as the party in power,
had appealed to the United States for intervention, but neither faction
had any intention of accepting any form of compromise which did not
include all their demands.

For about a week the fiercest storm that Mr. Taft had ever encountered
raged about his head. His one immediate desire was to avoid bloodshed.
His investigations proved that no real obstacle to tranquillity, or to
compromise, existed and he made every effort to induce the Cubans to
settle their differences on high non-partisan grounds, each yielding
something to the other for the sake of the general good. But he found
very little interest in the “general good.” Indeed, all through his
despatches during those days there runs a complaint that except with
President Palma and a few others patriotism was not very apparent, that
petty jealousies and personal ambitions, often of a brazen or a sordid
nature, constituted the chief secret of all the dissension and strife.

Events must have moved with feverish rapidity. The insurrectos demanded
the annulment of the election which continued the Palma government in
power, and the situation developed new complications with every argument
and piece of testimony presented by either side. Finally when it was
decided to begin an investigation of election returns with the hope of
arriving at a just conclusion, President Palma, who had certainly been
elected by irregular methods, though with no connivance on his own part,
promptly resigned; his Congress failed to meet and elect his successor.
To forestall a state of absolute anarchy, with the approval of President
Roosevelt, Mr. Taft issued a manifesto proclaiming an American
provisional government with himself as the provisional governor of the
republic. This happened on the eighth day after his arrival in Havana.

American marines had already been landed to guard the Treasury and a
large force of United States troops, under General Frederick Funston,
was in readiness to sail at once for Havana.

There was a strong sentiment among the better elements of Cubans, and an
almost unanimous expression on the part of foreign residents, in favour
of annexation to the United States. Indeed, feeling ran so high on this
point, and especially among those, of whatever nationality, with
financial interests at stake in Cuba, that it was thought for a time
that an effort would be made to stampede or force the United States
government into such action. But Mr. Taft’s Philippine experience proved
of value to him in this crisis, and his proclamation provided only for a
provisional government “to last long enough to restore order and peace
and public confidence.” The Cuban flag was not hauled down; no Cuban
official was to be disturbed in the discharge of his regular duties; and
the American flag was to fly over nothing but American troops. In other
words, the Cuban Republic was not to cease for an instant to exist. It
was a curious situation.

Shortly after the provisional government was instituted, Mr. Magoon was
appointed to relieve Mr. Taft in the office of governor, and was
instructed to proceed at once to Havana. Mr. Taft cabled me and Mr.
Bacon cabled to Mrs. Bacon, asking if we did not want to accompany Mr.
Magoon, and, of course, we immediately decided to do so. We sailed on
the _Mascotte_ with the battleship _Texas_ in our wake, carrying three
hundred marines from Norfolk, and for the first time in my life I felt
as if I were actually “going to war.” There was such a sense of rush
throughout the whole performance that it seemed tremendously serious. As
a matter of fact, intervention was accomplished without the firing of a
single gun, and when we landed at Havana, on the afternoon of the 10th
of October, just twenty days after Mr. Taft’s arrival on the scene, the
principal enterprise in progress was the disarmament of insurgent troops
which was by that time almost completed.

When we landed in Cuba I found myself once again, although only for the
moment “the first lady of the land,” and we were received with much
ceremony. It reminded me of Manila days.

As we passed the Cabañas fortress at the entrance of Havana harbour the
_Texas_ fired a salute and the echo of the answering guns cracked and
rattled from piers and surrounding sea-walls. Everything in the harbour
dipped its flag as we came in, while from out of the maze of battleships
and cruisers, transports, merchant vessels and shore boats we saw a
launch approaching in the bow of which I could easily make out my
husband’s generous proportions. With him were his colleague, Mr. Bacon,
his aide, Captain McCoy, and a second aide, Captain José Marti, an
artilleryman and son of an old Cuban patriot whom he had appointed to
this position, to the intense gratification of the Cuban people.

A second launch followed, bearing General Funston and his aide, Captain
Cloman, while a third full of Cuban newspaper men brought up the rear.
These newspaper men were the most engaging reporters I ever encountered.
They didn’t approach Mrs. Bacon and me with pads and pencils and a few
ill-considered questions. No, indeed. They came bearing flowers, great,
gorgeous bouquets for each of us, and we were permitted to receive these
without having to say anything more compromising than: “It was a very
pleasant voyage, thank you,” and, “Yes, indeed, we are very glad to get
to Havana.”

When we reached the wharf of the Captain of the Port we found a large
gathering of American naval officers and Cuban citizens, and we were
formally welcomed by Señor Julio de Cardenas, the Mayor of Havana, who
was continuing to exercise his official authority exactly as if nothing
unusual had occurred. He was accompanied by the members of the City
Council and with them later escorted us to the Palace.

As Mrs. Bacon and I stepped into our carriage the commander of the rebel
army and his wife came up to welcome us with what the paper that evening
described as “a floral offering,” but we saw nothing of the deposed
President or his followers. Upon his resignation he had gone down into
the country, where he was said to have been received with marked
enthusiasm and sympathy. Nobody ever accused President Palma of being
anything but an honest man and a sincere patriot, the victim of
political chicanery on the part of his supporters. It was afterward
shown that he could easily have been re-elected without trickery, but
dishonest politics were the only kind of politics that his people had
yet learned how to play.

When we arrived at the Palace, Mr. Taft, Mr. Bacon and Mr. Magoon went
into a long conference in the governor’s office, while I wandered around
the imposing building. It was about as cheerful as a mortuary chapel. It
seemed to be admirably adapted for the display of gold lace, gorgeous
decorations and lofty martial manners. After a brief inspection I sought
the spacious discomfort of my own room and an hour’s repose under a
betasseled canopy.

Mr. Magoon was not to assume the office of governor until disarmament
was completed and an amnesty proclamation had been issued. Mr. Taft
intended to leave him with no insurgents except those who refused to
give up their arms, and these were no longer to be known as insurgents.
They were to be called bandits and were to be hunted down and treated as
such.

I was mistress of the Palace at Havana for just three overcrowded days.
Before our arrival Mr. Taft and Mr. Bacon had been the guests of the
American Minister, Mr. E. V. Morgan, at his beautiful home about nine
miles outside the city. This house stood between two insurgent camps and
the mediators had to pass by automobile through rebel lines every
morning and evening while the uncertain negotiations were in progress,
but the strange part of this intervention was that it was welcomed by
all the parties concerned except the intervening party, so the mediators
were shown every courtesy.

Mr. Taft did not take possession of the Palace immediately after the
President’s abdication, but when Mr. Magoon was arriving he thought it
wise to do so in order that he might induct him into the office and all
its dignities with due form, and so it happened that we found him living
there.

On the afternoon after our arrival Mrs. Bacon and I gave a reception
which I remember as a most notable affair. It was attended by hundreds
of Cubans, by all the members of the different foreign colonies and by
every American Army and Navy officer who was not at the moment on active
duty. Everybody seemed to be especially happy and festive after the
month of gloom, and the pretty white gowns, the gay Cuban colours and
the crisp smartness of American uniforms mingled together in the great
rooms with quite brilliant effect. While we stood shaking hands with the
throng passing by in single file, the Municipal Band in the Park before
the Palace played American music, from the latest ragtime back to
“Swanee River,” interspersed with well-rendered classics and a few gay,
lilting airs peculiarly Spanish.

On the following afternoon Mr. Morgan tried to outdo the affair at the
Palace with a reception in our honour at his house, and succeeded
admirably. Mr. Taft had written of Mr. Morgan: “He is something of a
sybarite. He has a very fine house, a French cook and all the luxuries,
and we are being exceedingly well taken care of;—though I do think we
eat too much!” In fact, Mr. Morgan is a true host, combining imagination
and great ability with the wish to entertain. His house at Havana was
like a scene from some tropical grand opera. Standing in the midst of
fine gardens heavy with groups of big drooping palms and ferns, and
bright with wide spaces of green lawn, it seemed like a veritable
story-book house. It had wide corridors and a quaint, moss-softened
patio, in the middle of which a fountain played over a mass of brilliant
tropic plants. The spacious rooms were filled with curios and art
treasures from all parts of the world, and I was especially interested
in a splendid collection of brass-bound and inlaid Korean chests. Mr.
Morgan was America’s last Minister to Korea, being transferred from
Seoul to Havana when Japan established her Korean protectorate.

Although it was nine miles out to Mr. Morgan’s house, everybody came,
and it was said to be the most representative gathering of the city’s
leading families that had been seen in many a day. Of course there was
music and dancing and refreshments and all the elements which go to make
up an enjoyable entertainment, and even though there was a general
celebration going on in the city, the crowds took their departure
reluctantly.

The general celebration was in commemoration of the anniversary of the
outbreak of the Ten Years’ War in 1858, and it was strange to see all
parties uniting in a demonstration of what seemed to be real patriotism.
Havana was decorated in regular old-fashioned Fourth of July style, and
there were parades and speeches, bands, banners and fireworks, just as
if Cuba were the solidest little Republic in the world. One really
couldn’t take the situation very seriously after all,—except that it was
costing the country a great deal of money and certainly would have cost
many foolish lives had it not been taken in hand so promptly.

The next morning we inaugurated Governor Magoon and took our departure,
leaving him to his uncomfortable fate. I remember later a cartoon
depicting him as sitting in agony on a sizzling stove labelled “Cuba,”
while Mr. Taft appeared in the distance in a fireman’s garb carrying a
long and helpful-looking line of hose. But that illustrated subsequent
history.

We sailed from Havana on the battleship _Louisiana_, escorted by the
_Virginia_ and the _North Carolina_, Mr. and Mrs. Bacon, General
Funston, Mr. Taft and I, on the 13th of October, just twenty-nine days
from the day on which Mr. Roosevelt had called the momentous conference
at Oyster Bay to decide what should be done about Cuba, and we escaped
by only a few hours the terrible storm which swept east from the Gulf of
Mexico that same evening. It was one of the worst storms the locality
had ever known. It did untold damage to property, killed a number of
people and by cutting the island off from outside communication gave the
United States a short period of acute uneasiness on account of the
thousands of American soldiers quartered in Cuba and the big fleet of
American battleships lying in Havana harbour. The waters of Hampton
Roads were so rough that after boarding the _Dolphin_ for the trip up
the Chesapeake and the Potomac to Washington we went ashore at Fort
Monroe and took the train.



                              CHAPTER XIV
                               BUSY YEARS


These were the days when Mr. Roosevelt, Mr. Root and Mr. Taft were known
and very aptly caricatured as “The Three Musketeers,” a thing which both
pleased and amused them. Mr. Roosevelt was, of course, D’Artagnan, Mr.
Root was Athos and Mr. Taft was Porthos, and they worked together in
such harmony and with such high mutual regard as one remembers now with
singular satisfaction.

Mr. Hearst was running against Mr. Hughes for Governor of New York, and
the situation in Idaho, complicated by the murder of Governor
Steunenberg and the activities of the anarchistic element in the Western
Federation of Miners, seemed also to demand special attention from the
Administration, so Mr. Root was delegated to “hurl the spear of
civilisation and right thinking” in New York, while Mr. Taft was sent
into the West with Idaho as the climax of his itinerary.

All this had been arranged for him while he was away on the mission of
averting disaster in Cuba, and when he returned to Washington he had
just time, as he expressed it, “to pack the War Department into a
suitcase” before he was off on a speech-making trip which took him from
Baltimore through Ohio, Illinois, Nebraska, Wyoming and Idaho and back
through Kansas, Oklahoma, Texas and New Orleans to Washington, with only
such time for preparation of speeches as he could get on the trains
between stops.

His letters to me were dictated to his stenographer, and in re-reading
them I get the impression that I was made the victim of his thinking
processes since he poured into them all the politics and the turmoil of
the hour, together with lengthy comments which kept me very much alive
with interest in the campaign in which he was engaged.

About this time there appeared in the New York _Sun_ an editorial which
pleased me and which expressed the rush of our lives with singular
vividness. It said in part:

  Merely to record the movements and missions of the Secretary of War
  requires a nimble mind. He journeys from Washington to Manila to
  reassure ten millions of natives restive under an experimental scheme
  of civil government and turns up in Panama to speed the digging of the
  Isthmian Canal. To give a fillip to a campaign for reform in some
  western State, or direct the southern Republicans in the way they
  should go, or enlighten the people Down East as to the President’s
  home policy, or illuminate the recesses of a problem in jurisdiction
  for the benefit of a bar association, is only a matter of grabbing a
  time table and throwing a change of clothing into a travelling bag.
  Such are mere relaxations and holiday jaunts for the Hon. William H.
  Taft.

  A Cuban revolution would be a poser to most statesmen, and to an
  ordinary Secretary of War a labour of Hercules; but to the business of
  bringing peace with honour to a distracted land, deposing one
  government and setting up another, meanwhile gratifying everybody and
  winning the esteem of the fiercest warrior, Mr. Taft devotes only one
  page of the Calendar and takes ship for the States to resume his
  routine duties as if he had done nothing out of the common.

  But routine duties in Washington do not hold him long. An itinerary is
  made up for him and he plunges into the stress and turmoil of a
  political campaign. He is to make speeches in Ohio and Illinois, and
  Idaho claims him too. From Havana to Pocatello is something of a
  change and a far cry, but it is all in the day’s work for William H.
  Taft ... all nice problems look alike to the Secretary of War who
  should be called the Secretary of Peace, so uniform is his success in
  smoothing the wrinkled front of conflict and making two laughs echo
  where one groan was heard before.

  No emergency, no exigency can put the Hon. William H. Taft down. With
  a heart for any fate, buoyant as hope, versatile as the kaleidoscope,
  indefatigable as fate and indomitable as victory, he is a most amazing
  and effective Secretary of War. “Cabinet help” when William H. Taft is
  the instrument and medium, is tantamount to the energy and force of a
  whole Administration. Yet there are those who would circumscribe his
  activities by investing him with the robes and immobile dignity of
  judicial office.

This subject of my husband’s appointment to the Supreme Bench cropped up
with what seemed to me to be rather annoying frequency. While we were in
Cuba it was rumoured that he would be asked to fill the vacancy created
by the retirement of Justice Brown, but the report correctly stated that
he would be likely to refuse the appointment because of the rapidly
developing possibility that he would be the Republican nominee for the
Presidency the following year.

At this time Mr. Taft was all but impervious to any friendly advice
which, being followed, would have tended to enhance his own political
advantage. He was not playing politics for himself; he was attending
strictly to business, fully imbued with the conviction that the public
desired a continuation of the Administration as it stood. Mr.
Roosevelt’s personal popularity could not be denied nor in any way
belittled, but he had already announced that he was not a candidate for
a third term, and all over the country the party was organising to
support Mr. Taft, while a number of other names were prominently
mentioned as “possibilities.” Mr. Roosevelt had assured my husband that
he could count on his support, and he also urged him to lose no
opportunity to give personal encouragement and impetus to the campaign
that was being started in his behalf. But Mr. Taft paid very little
attention, and never did he cease to regard a Supreme Court appointment
as vastly more desirable than the Presidency. If his letters of that
period could be read it would readily be seen that he was a most
difficult candidate for his loyal and eager supporters to manage.

About this time, in conversation with Mr. Roosevelt in respect to Mr.
Taft’s candidacy, I got the impression that he was discouraged over my
husband as a candidate because he had avoided co-operation with certain
political organisations in the West, and, further, that Mr. Roosevelt
thought he might have to join with other Republicans in supporting
Governor Hughes, because Mr. Taft was such a poor politician.

I reported this to Mr. Taft and urged him to display a little more
enthusiasm on his own account, but in reply I got a good-natured
reminder that there was “plenty of time,” together with an analysis of
the public feeling which, he decided, was not running in his favour at
all. He wrote to Mr. Roosevelt:

  Mrs. Taft writes me that you are disposed to lecture me for not being
  more cordial in co-operation with some of my ... friends who want to
  organise a campaign for me for the presidential nomination. I told
  them just exactly what the fact was and nothing more, and I don’t find
  myself equal to becoming part of any organisation of that sort. The
  truth is in ... and some of the other States, if a man does not join
  in a way as to imply a kind of obligation to look after these people,
  should success follow, there is no particular enthusiasm in his
  favour, and in my state of indifference about it the organisation is
  not likely to follow me.

  Mrs. Taft said that you said you might have to support Hughes for the
  presidency. If you do you may be sure that you will awaken no feeling
  of disappointment on my part. While I very much appreciate your
  anxiety that I shall be nominated, and regard it as the highest
  compliment possible to me, and as a most gratifying evidence of your
  good will, you know what my feeling has been in respect to the
  presidency, and can understand that it will not leave the slightest
  trace of disappointment should you change your views and think it wise
  to make a start in any other direction.

In Mr. Roosevelt’s reply to Mr. Taft, he said I had misunderstood him,
that what he had said was that Mr. Taft must not be too entirely aloof
because if he were it might dishearten his supporters and put all
Republicans in such shape that some man like Governor Hughes, or more
probably some man from the West, would turn up with so much popular
sentiment behind him that there would be no course open but to support
him.

The 1905 campaign was a hotly contested one. The Republicans won in New
York and Idaho, and generally, I believe, though I remember those two
States especially, and I find Mr. Taft writing to Mr. Root from Ft.
Leavenworth, Kansas, on his way back from Boise City:

  _Dear Athos_:

  I saw a copy of your speech when I was in the “wilds” of Idaho, and I
  cannot tell you the comfort it gave me to read it, and how it
  intensified the affection and admiration I have always had for the
  speaker. I can just think of your making up your mind to say the thing
  and do the thing that the occasion demanded.... You selected the
  psychological moment, and I have no doubt that you did a great deal to
  prevent Hearst’s election, and I do not doubt also that you are
  receiving the commendations of your grateful fellow citizens of New
  York, and all over the country, as you ought to, for hurling your
  spear full and fair at this “knight of evil.”...

  From everything I have seen in the west my judgment is that the
  President cannot avoid running again.... There is no real second
  choice where I have been. Of course there are complimentary allusions
  to others.... So far as you and I are concerned I think we are well
  out of it, and whatever may be our ambitions for honourable service,
  there is a compensation in not having to be exposed to the horrors of
  a campaign with this product of yellow journalism whom you have had so
  much satisfaction in sending down to defeat for a time.

Apropos of this victory, Mr. Roosevelt wrote to Mr. Taft:

  Upon my word I do not know which to be the more proud of, what Root
  did in New York or what you did in Idaho.

When Mr. Taft got back to Washington he found the following letter from
Mr. Root, which completes the triangle of this mutual admiration society
of the Three Musketeers:

  _Dear Porthos_:

  I have been disappointed that your most important and admirable speech
  in Idaho has not been more freely published and commented on in the
  East. I have just suggested to the Editor of _The Outlook_ that he
  ought to print it in extenso and call attention to it. He will apply
  to you directly for it and I hope you will let him have it.

  I am going to start Saturday afternoon to be away for a week, and if
  you see any gaping lids about my Department in the meantime, please
  sit on them gently.

                                                     Faithfully yours,
                                                             ELIHU ROOT.

“Sitting on the lid” was not in any sense the stationary and reposeful
performance the expression seems to suggest. Before Mr. Taft returned to
Washington from a tour of inspection of brigade posts, which followed
immediately upon his trip to Idaho, Mr. Roosevelt had gone to Panama,
leaving behind him various questions, including the one which resulted
from the discharge without honour of the three companies of coloured
troops at Brownsville, Texas, for the Secretary of War to keep within
bounds until his return. Then there were many matters of a purely
executive nature which, as long as they did not require the signature of
the President himself, Mr. Taft was authorised and expected to dispose
of. And with the Secretary of State also absent, his office became
government headquarters, practically, where foreign Ambassadors,
Senators and officials of other Departments had to take their chances of
an interview along with visitors or representatives from the
Philippines, Hawaii, Cuba, Porto Rico, Alaska and the Canal Zone, and
with Army officers and War Department clerks.

I finally gave up all idea of ever getting him home to luncheon, but we
nearly always had a dinner engagement, so along about the hour when I
knew he would have just time to rush home and dress I would call him on
the telephone. And then, if I were fortunate enough to get him without a
disgraceful delay, he almost invariably came in, followed by an extra
private secretary bearing a large portfolio of papers to be disposed of
before such hour as he chose to consider bedtime.

The winter of 1906–7 was too busy to remember as anything except a sort
of hazy nightmare lightened in spots by contemplation of the delightful
possibilities contained in a rapidly growing Presidential “boom,” but it
came to an end, and early in the summer I gathered up my family and a
few necessary belongings and went to Murray Bay. We were to leave some
time in August for the Philippines and the trip around the world via the
Trans-Siberian Railway, and I wanted very much to have my husband get
away for a few weeks of absolute detachment from public affairs, feeling
sure that it would be his last opportunity for rest and relaxation for
many a day. But no man can be a candidate for President of the United
States and indulge at the same time in even a short period of complete
tranquillity.

Before Mr. Taft joined me he, in deference to the wishes of the men who
were conducting his “boom,” made another speech-making trip through the
West on the method so aptly described as “whirlwind,” and did not arrive
in Murray Bay until the first week in July.

It just occurs to me that I have covered all these different periods of
our lives without even mentioning Murray Bay, although a large part of
the Taft family has been spending the summers there for twenty years or
more. We went there before the place became in any sense “fashionable,”
when the only kind of hotel accommodation was in quaint old inns of the
real French-Canadian type in which no English was spoken, but where
service of such delightfully simple and satisfactory quality as can no
longer be obtained was smilingly offered at rates which would now be
considered absurdly low. After our first year in 1892 we always had a
cottage,—and on going to Murray Bay we prepared to enjoy ourselves in
the luxury of complete simplicity.

The cottage which we have occupied for a number of years is perched on a
rocky headland overlooking the sixteen miles wide stretch of the St.
Lawrence river and almost entirely hidden in a dense grove of fragrant
pine trees. It is roomy and comfortable, but simple as a camp in the
woods, being finished in unpainted pine and furnished with only such
things as may be locked up and left year in and year out. There is
nothing to tempt any possible robber, the only distinctive things in the
house being some Philippine curios, wall decorations and floor mats,
called “petates,” which we have brought with us at different times from
Manila.

Mr. Taft stayed at Murray Bay about five weeks, but during that time our
cottage in the woods was the United States War Department and
headquarters of a very probable Presidential candidate. Then, too, Mr.
Taft was beset with the nagging necessity for preparing speeches which
were really to launch his campaign for the nomination before he left for
the trip around the world. The campaign in Ohio became centred and
active during the summer, with Mr. Taft far in the lead among possible
candidates, and all over the country organisations were forming which
demanded whole-hearted and unremitting attention.

The busy man wrote to Mr. Roosevelt: “I am enjoying my vacation,” but
his vacation consisted in a release from constant social formalities and
a daily round of golf on the links of the Murray Bay Club which he liked
so much and over which he had played for so many years,—nothing more.

Early in August he left for Washington with the understanding that I
should complete arrangements, and taking Charlie with me, should meet
him at the entrance of Yellowstone Park at the end of the month. In the
meantime he had one more long speech-making trip to begin at Columbus on
the 19th of August and to take him through Ohio, Kentucky, Missouri,
Oklahoma and to Denver.

His mother, to whom the whole family was strongly devoted, was at this
time very ill. It did not seem possible that she could be with us for
long, and all of her sons wished sincerely to be able to remain near
her. One of them, Horace, was able to do so, but when my husband
declared to her his desire to give up the trip to the Philippines and
stay in the United States until she recovered she said to him:

“No Taft, to my knowledge, has ever yet neglected a public duty for the
sake of gratifying a private desire. You promised the Filipinos that you
would be present at the opening of their first Assembly, and if you
should break that promise and neglect your plain duty on my account, it
would give me no pleasure.”

This was the last serious thing she ever said to him, and it gave him
great comfort throughout the long trip as the reports of her failing
strength came to him. He never saw her again.

With my son Charlie, who was then nearly ten years old, I met my husband
and his party at Livingston Junction, on the Northern Pacific Railroad
in Montana, and we proceeded together to Gardiner at the entrance to
Yellowstone Park. There we were met by General Young, the Superintendent
of the Park, and Colonel Henry T. Allen, and by the head of the Park
transportation company and began at once a wonderful three days’ trip,
which included, among other things, the business of inspecting the Army
post with the purpose of making recommendations for changes in the Park
patrolling system.

As our time was very short we had to drive about fifty miles every day,
which meant hurrying on at top speed, with relays of Army mules, and not
much more than a how-d’ye-do and good-bye at every place we stopped. In
consequence we completely lost track of the days of the week and made
what I then thought would prove to be a fatal error.

We got back to the Mammoth Springs Hotel one evening and found the place
quite gay with crowds of tourists. There being nothing else to do, I
suggested that after dinner we play bridge in the lobby where all the
people were and where everything seemed so lively and entertaining. We
did. Mr. Taft and I, General Clarence Edwards and another member of our
party sat there and played until quite late, enjoying ourselves
immensely. Everybody looked at us, and I noticed a few persons taking
special pains to pass close enough for a really satisfactory inspection,
but we were used to being gazed at and paid no attention to it. It was
not until the next morning that every look that was cast upon us assumed
for me a special meaning. The next morning was Monday!

Under any circumstances it would have shocked us somewhat to find that
through forgetfulness we had played bridge during a whole Sunday
evening, but with Mr. Taft generally recognised as a probable candidate
for President, our shock was merged into serious concern with regard to
the effect the story might have on the millions of good Sabbatarians
throughout the country. And there was no possible explanation that we
could make. Playing cards was bad enough, but to have forgotten Sunday
altogether was a great deal worse, so we were perfectly helpless. Up to
the day Mr. Taft was elected I looked for the story to rise up and smite
us. I had visions of glaring headlines: “Taft Plays Cards on the Sabbath
Day.” Having been brought up on strictly Sabbatarian principles myself,
I knew what good use could be made of the incident in the hands of our
political enemies. But we never heard a word from it, and I have a warm
regard for all those good people who failed to avail themselves of such
an opportunity for a bit of valuable gossip. Or had they all forgotten
it was Sunday, too?

On the way from Yellowstone Park to Seattle I had a taste of real
campaign work and always thereafter enjoyed a full realisation of its
difficulties. I got completely worn out as a mere onlooker, and as I saw
Mr. Taft encountering the throngs at every stopping place, speaking
until his voice was reduced to a hoarse whisper, and shaking hands until
he groaned with the ache of his muscles, my political enthusiasm waned
slightly, though temporarily, and I could think of nothing to be more
thankful for at the moment than the fact that we were about to set out
on a two weeks’ ocean voyage, beginning a three months’ trip around the
world.

[Illustration:

  (_FROM LEFT TO RIGHT_) MRS. JAIME DE VEYRA, MRS. TAFT, GOVERNOR SMITH,
    MRS. SMITH, MR. TAFT, MR. SERGIO OSMEÑA, SPEAKER OF THE PHILIPPINE
    ASSEMBLY, AND MEMBERS OF THE ASSEMBLY IN THE AYUNTAMIENTO, MANILA
]



                               CHAPTER XV
                    A HURRIED TRIP AROUND THE WORLD


I have not the space to give a detailed account of this trip around the
world. After a pleasant voyage on the steamship _Minnesota_ we were
given in Japan the same warm welcome that we had always had there, and
Mr. Taft and I were entertained at the Shiba Detached Palace, one of the
Imperial residences. We lunched with the Emperor and also with Prince
Fushimi, and we met the admirals and the generals who had won such
distinction in the Russo-Japanese War. These included Admiral Togo and
Field Marshal Prince Oyama. It was explained to Mr. Taft by the Court
Chamberlain that we were regarded as personal guests of the Emperor.
Marquis Saionji was then Premier, but Prince Katsura, whom he had
succeeded and who was our old friend, was still powerful in the
councils. Mr. Taft held a number of interesting and useful interviews
with these statesmen of Japan, and also with the Minister of Foreign
Affairs, Count Hayashi, and with Marquis Terauchi, the Minister of War,
who has now become Governor of Korea. He was able, from what they told
him, to understand the attitude of Japan toward the United States, and
to feel confident of her wish to remain in bonds of amity with us. At a
dinner in Tokyo, given by the Minister of Foreign Affairs, Mr. Taft made
a speech in which he pointed out the absurdity of a war between Japan
and the United States, and showed how the true interests of both nations
required a strengthening of the bonds of friendship between them. This
speech attracted much attention throughout the Orient and was cabled
back to the United States as an expression of the Administration on the
subject. The Japanese residents of Yokohama presented to Mr. Taft and me
on this visit a very handsome silver tea set.

Our course took us by way of Shanghai and we stopped there for just one
busy day. In the morning Mr. Taft dedicated a Young Men’s Christian
Association building which had just been constructed and to the cost of
which a number of Chinese Mandarins, though not Christians, had made
substantial contribution. The afternoon was devoted to shopping and to a
most elaborate and picturesque reception and tea which was given for us
by the Chinese guilds of the city. At this tea I was presented with a
very curious and interesting bowl of Chinese silver which is among my
most valued possessions. In the evening a great banquet was given by the
leading citizens of Shanghai at the Astor Hotel, where provision was
made for the ladies to hear the speaking from a platform erected at one
end of the room. Mr. Taft made a speech on the subject of the relations
of the United States to the development of China, which was long
remembered as a succinct and forcible presentation of the policy of the
United States toward that country, then in an interesting stage of its
awakening from a long lethargy.

In Manila, at the formal opening of the first Assembly, Mr. Taft laid
down the purposes of the Administration in the passage of the Philippine
Act, plainly saying to the Philippine people that independence was not
near at hand, and that it could only come after a period of earnest
effort on their part to fit themselves for complete self-government. His
candour and frankness did not please many of the Assembly, but his view
has always been that the only way in which to deal with the Filipino
people is to tell them the exact truth, unpalatable though it may be,
and to fulfil promises with the greatest care. Filipinos may be very lax
in discharging the full measure of their own assurances, but the way to
maintain influence over them is to pursue a policy of clear and candid
statement, full performance and exact justice. They are prone to accept
every declaration in the same sense in which they would like to construe
it, and the utmost care must be taken to prevent their being misled.
Demagoguery with them is likely to be most pernicious in its ultimate
results.

During this visit we were the guests of Governor-General Smith at
Malacañan Palace and I experienced a pleasant renewal of old impressions
and sensations. Mr. W. Cameron Forbes, who succeeded Governor Smith, was
then Secretary of Commerce and Police and, in this capacity, was in
charge of Public Works. He had built for himself at Baguio a fine
country residence which he called “Topside,” a name which fits it
exactly, since it stands, literally, at the “topside” of the island of
Luzon, at an elevation of more than five thousand feet, and overlooks
the broadest and most colourful stretch of mountain scenery imaginable.
We visited Mr. Forbes at “Topside” and were able to see for the first
time the splendid achievements in the development of the summer capital
which I anticipated in Chapter IX. Mr. Taft assured an enthusiastic
enquirer that he was not surprised at the magnificence of the Benguet
Road because he had authorised the expenditure of a sufficient amount to
produce something unusual, and that he would, indeed, have been
surprised if it hadn’t been done. But he had to confess to a little
surprise at the improvement of the town of Baguio. The difference was so
great that it was almost impossible to recognise the place as the site
of the ragged little Igorrote village where I had spent such pleasant
and “uncivilised” days just before my husband’s inauguration as the
first governor of the Philippines.

It would be useless for me to attempt to detail the thousand and one
events of this visit to Manila. Upon our arrival we were handed a
printed schedule of dinners, luncheons, teas, receptions, balls,
meetings, celebrations, trips of inspection, and business conferences
which we had to do our best to carry out. Fortunately provision was made
for a few hours of rest which could be used for other things when we got
behind with the programme.

On a day in November, when blue Manila Bay lay sparkling in the sun, we
set sail for Vladivostok on the U. S. S. _Rainbow_, flying the flag of
Admiral Hemphill, and convoyed by two other naval vessels. The most
amusing incident of this trip, which was quite a tempestuous one, was
the gradual freezing up of our Filipino orchestra. They left Manila clad
in natty white uniforms, responding with enthusiasm to the strains of
the many bands on shore and on the fleet of harbor launches which
accompanied us down the bay. They played for us at dinner that night and
gave a concert on deck the next day, but then began the rapid descent of
the mercury in the thermometers and the consequent undoing of our
tropical musicians. They first changed into heavy blue uniforms and
tried their best to look comfortable. Then they put on their overcoats
and kept them on. Finally they deserted the deck altogether and their
rather disconnected strains came up to us through a partly open hatch
just over the engine room. When we reached the forbidding harbour of
Vladivostok, where the temperature stood below zero, the poor bugler was
so thoroughly cold that he couldn’t adjust his lips to his bugle to pipe
distinguished visitors aboard. Our party on this trip around the world
was small, including only my son Charlie, Mr. Taft’s secretary, Mr. Fred
C. Carpenter, General Clarence R. Edwards, Mr. and Mrs. Martin Egan and
two other newspaper correspondents.

Shortly before we reached Vladivostok there had been a mutiny on one of
the torpedo boats in the harbour, and a woman anarchist had induced the
crew to take the boat out into the stream and raise the red flag. This
outbreak was suppressed with a heavy hand, and a number of those
suspected of complicity in the plot were arrested. As the Governor had
power of life and death over them it was assumed that the extreme
penalty was visited on some of them at least, but no publicity was given
to the proceedings. The effect of the tragedy upon our arrival, however,
was marked. The town was in a most unquiet state and there were vague
rumours of danger to be met on every hand. We were not permitted to go
ashore without a heavy guard of bristling Cossacks, and everywhere we
went we were under the closest and most careful protection. It was most
exciting, though in the midst of the cordial hospitality of our Russian
hosts we could not feel that there was the slightest cause for
apprehension. As soon as we dropped anchor in the harbour we were
welcomed to Vladivostok by the Governor and General Commanding. He
assigned Prince Bariatinski, Colonel of a regiment stationed at
Vladivostok, to act as Mr. Taft’s aide during our stay, and from
Saturday until Tuesday he and the Princess, both of whom spoke English,
were with us constantly, adding much to our enjoyment. Our visit
concluded with a dinner and ball given by the Governor, and the next
morning we bade good-bye to the _Rainbow_ and Admiral Hemphill and made
our way, surrounded by Cossack guards, to the railway station where the
train waited to start on its twelve days’ trip across Siberia. The
government provided us with a large private car of the armoured variety
which contained a number of compartments that were fully as spacious and
comfortable as an average steamship cabin and we settled ourselves in
them quite as we would have done on a trans-Pacific liner.

The trip across Siberia is exceedingly interesting. One anticipates
endless monotony, but only the landscape lacks variety. For days
together the train runs along through a country which looks exactly like
South Dakota or Nebraska and which is interesting only in its wonderful
possibilities. It is one of the world’s open spaces, undeveloped but
capable of producing anything. I had always imagined Siberia as a
country filled with sadness and I expected it to depress me, but it
arouses no such feeling. We met trainload after trainload of happy
Russian colonists on their way to the new settlements, and at all the
well built stations along the way we saw a great number of sturdy
peasant farmers and their families who looked thoroughly comfortable and
contented. We whiled away the hours with bridge and books, and, though
the train never made more than two or three stops a day, the time passed
quickly. Throughout the journey our car was guarded by stalwart Russian
soldiers in most picturesque uniforms, stationed on both platforms, and
each time the train stopped this guard was changed with considerable
ceremony. Also at every station near an army post Mr. Taft was greeted
by the Commander of the District with strict military form, all of which
added colour and interest to the journey.

Mr. Willard D. Straight, then United States Consul at Mukden, met us at
Vladivostok with plans for our reception at Mukden. When we arrived
there we were welcomed by a company of Chinese soldiers dressed in the
old Mongolian custom, and by a squadron of Cossacks. We were hurried in
a carriage behind two fast trotting Orloff horses to a hotel where all
the consuls assembled greeted us with cakes, champagne and very short
speeches. There was considerable excitement among the consuls with
regard to the toasts to be drunk and the order of precedence in which
the rulers of the different countries were to be named, but Mr. Straight
was diplomatic enough to mention every proper name in right order and
the result was a round of congratulation and merriment. In the meantime
the leisurely and accommodating train was waiting, so we hurried back to
the station at the terrific pace usual to the Russian with his beautiful
horses. No people not inherently fine could ever produce the kind of
horses one sees in Russia. And the Russians love them. I can think of
nothing more pleasing than the picture of a great, shaggy, gruff-voiced
Russian coachman on the box of his carriage or droshky, gently urging
his well-kept horse on to his best speed in terms of endearment. “On,
Little Brother!” says he.

At Moscow we were right royally entertained by the Governor-General of
the city who did everything possible to make our visit memorable. We
arrived late Saturday night and on Sunday the Kremlin was opened for our
especial benefit and we were given full opportunity to see every part of
that ancient and interesting home of Russian autocracy with all its
collections of priceless treasures. A hurried round of entertainments,
which included a special ballet performance at the Opera, ended with a
dinner given by the Governor-General, and we left on the midnight train
for St. Petersburg. We had not been there more than an hour or so the
next morning when we received a telegram announcing that a woman
Nihilist had thrown a bomb at the Governor’s sleigh which had exploded
under the horses, killing them and the coachman and throwing the
Governor and his aide backward into the snow unharmed. As these
gentlemen had both been very kind to us it brought home in a startling
way the danger that attends high position in Russia.

In St. Petersburg we dined with the Minister of Foreign Affairs, M.
Iswolski and Madame Iswolski, and with them received the Diplomatic
Corps. Mr. Taft and General Edwards had an audience with the Czar and
attended the annual Saint’s day celebration of a famous regiment
numbering about 3,200, no man of which measures less than six feet two.
They were also present at a luncheon which the Czar gave to the officers
of this regiment at the Czar-KoeSelo Palace. In the Czar’s suite there
were two or three gentlemen who remembered Mr. Taft’s father as Minister
to Russia, so he very greatly enjoyed the experience of meeting them.

Our visit was a hurried one, and after a stay of three days we left for
Berlin. Mr. Roosevelt and Mr. Root were not disposed to have Mr. Taft
visit any of the courts of Europe except at St. Petersburg and that only
for the purpose of conveying his grateful acknowledgment of the
courtesies shown us in our long trip across Siberia. Nor in the state of
his mother’s health, which we knew to be precarious, was he disposed to
accept the invitations which he received from the German Emperor, the
King of Belgium, the President of France and others, to visit their
countries and become their guest. At Berlin we had just time to dine
with the American Ambassador and Mrs. Tower, and to meet a few American
friends whom they had invited in, then Mr. Taft and the other members of
the party went to Hamburg to take the Steamship _General Grant_ at that
port, while I, with Mrs. Post Wheeler, rushed down to Paris to do a few
hours’ shopping, planning to join the _Grant_ at Boulogne the next
evening. In the meantime a terrible storm began to rage along the coast,
and when we reached Boulogne there was some question about our being
able to get to the _Grant_ which lay at anchor just outside the
breakwater. However, we boarded the little tender and she started for
the very wild looking open channel. She had no sooner struck the heavy
seas before she had broken her rudder and was being buffeted about in a
really terrifying manner. We managed in some way to get back inside the
breakwater where some repairs were made, then we started out again. We
repeated this performance several times, listening meanwhile to
generally voiced predictions that nothing on earth could save us from
going to the bottom, and, although it was only nine o’clock in the
evening when we boarded the little vessel, it was four o’clock in the
morning before she came alongside the _Grant_ and discharged her
dilapidated and exhausted passengers.

Mr. Taft had waited up for us and had seen the tender come out of the
harbour and go back, and, assuming from what was told him that no
attempt would be made to transfer the passengers before morning, he went
to bed. When I got aboard the steamer, filled with excitement over the
dangers through which I had passed, and found him peacefully sleeping in
his cabin, I declined to accept any explanation. A French sub-prefect,
who had been sent out by the Minister of the Interior of France with
greetings and compliments, and who had come in his full regimentals with
a cocked hat, was waiting to see Mr. Taft and I was cruel enough to
insist that he should get up and receive him. Throwing a long fur coat
over his pajamas the Secretary of War of the United States walked out
into the salon to meet the polite representative of the politest of
peoples, but after a grave exchange of formal salutations the situation
proved too much for their gravity. They burst out laughing at each
other, to the immense enjoyment of the bystanders, and the gloom of the
wee sma’ hour was lifted.

When we touched at Plymouth that afternoon we received a despatch
announcing the death of Mr. Taft’s mother. The funeral took place in
Cincinnati, at the home of Mr. Charles Taft, several days before we
could reach New York.

On our return to the United States we found that my husband’s rivals for
the Republican nomination had been making great headway. Mr. Roosevelt
was quite impatient at the loss of ground that Mr. Taft’s candidacy had
suffered and he urged him to take a more active interest in the
situation. He insisted that Mr. Taft should change the subject of a
speech which he had agreed to deliver in Boston from the Philippine
problem to a discussion of the financial situation which was then acute
after the depression which had taken place during our absence. Mr.
Roosevelt’s forcible expression was that the business and political
public had no more interest in the Philippines than in the subject of
“nature faking.”

I cannot go into the details of the preliminary convention fight. My
husband’s brother Charles devoted a full year to it, established
headquarters in Ohio and Washington, and bore the brunt of the contest.
The afternoon of the convention when the voting came, we all assembled
at my husband’s office in the War Department and received the news over
the telephone as it came in. I have a series of photographs, taken by a
friend, of the expressions on my husband’s face as the results of the
voting were being announced. Soon after the nomination was made, on the
first of July Mr. Taft resigned from the Cabinet, and we established
ourselves at Hot Springs, Virginia, where he spent some weeks preparing
his address of acceptance. This he submitted to Mr. Roosevelt and Mr.
Root before he went to Cincinnati to deliver it. Mr. Charles Taft made
elaborate preparations to receive and entertain the Committee of
Announcement, and on a platform in front of his fine old house, in Pike
Street, on one of the hottest days of the summer, my husband delivered
his acceptance. We then returned to Hot Springs and spent another month
in preparation for the campaign. From Hot Springs we went to Middle Bass
Island on Lake Erie to spend a week or more there. We then went to
Cincinnati. Upon this latter trip Mr. Taft made a good many speeches
from the platform of our car. In September Mr. Bryan’s campaign looked
very hopeful. The opposition of Mr. Gompers and organised labour seemed
formidable. Mr. Taft determined to meet this issue fully and frankly. He
was attacked because he had delivered a number of labour decisions
supposed to be against the interest of labour. He had sent to jail, for
six months, the chief lieutenant of Debs in the Debs railway rebellion
of 1894, breaking it up in Cincinnati and the vicinity. He did not
apologise in any way for the action he had taken. A meeting of the
railway trade organisations was called in Chicago at Orchestra Hall, and
there he explained his action, defended it, and avowed that were the
same questions presented to him again, he would do the same thing he had
done, and that he had no excuses to offer. From that point he made a
long trip in the West, upon which I did not accompany him. I remained in
Cincinnati with Mrs. Charles Taft and my sister Mrs. Anderson. It was
the first political campaign in which Mr. Taft was a candidate before
the people. The reports that came indicated that he had lost his voice,
and I was greatly concerned lest he might break down in his strenuous
labours and new experience. The ups and downs of such a campaign, the
prophecies, the hopes, the fears aroused by favourable and opposing
newspapers were all new and trying to me, and in a way I think I was
under as great a nervous strain as my husband was, without the steadying
help of the hardest kind of work. However as the campaign drew near to a
close, the Republican confidence grew stronger and stronger, so when we
were assembled finally under the hospitable roof of Mr. and Mrs. Charles
Taft, with a company of friends to receive the dispatches on election
night, the news of the great success that came did not surprise us.



                              CHAPTER XVI
                     PRESIDENT OF THE UNITED STATES


Shortly after my husband’s election, having spent a couple of restful
weeks at Hot Springs, Virginia, we went to Augusta, Georgia, and took
the old house known as the Terrett Cottage, near the Bon Air Hotel. To
me the weeks we spent there were exceptionally happy ones and I should
like to mention each friend—friends then and friends still—who
contributed to our constant enjoyment, but there were too many of them
and their kindnesses too numerous.

Mr. Taft, of course, immediately became engrossed in the difficulties of
securing a Cabinet which would satisfy everybody and disappoint none,—an
impossibility,—as well as a thousand and one other matters not connected
in any way with the daily games of golf on Augusta’s sandy links which
attracted such wide attention. But even then my own problems became to
me paramount and I began to give them my almost undivided attention and
to neglect the political affairs which had for many years interested me
so intensely. Perhaps with my husband safely elected I considered all
important affairs satisfactorily settled. At any rate I found little
time or inclination at the moment to worry about who should have the
high offices in the new President’s gift, or what policies should be
pursued during his administration.

At my request Captain Archibald Butt came down to Augusta to consult
with me as to changes I wished to make in the White House service, and
together we went over the whole situation. As President Roosevelt’s aide
he knew the whole lexicon of customary White House social formalities.

I had been a member of Washington’s official family for five years and
knew as well as need be the various phases of the position I was about
to assume, so my plans were not so difficult to put into form, however
difficult I may have found them to put into execution.

[Illustration:

  THE WHITE HOUSE AS IT LOOKED ON THE EVENING OF THE FOURTH OF MARCH,
    1909
]

We made a trip to Panama in February before the Inauguration and did not
reach Washington until the end of the month when we went to stay with
our friends, Mr. and Mrs. William J. Boardman, and their daughter, Miss
Mabel Boardman, at their residence on Dupont Circle. We spent with them
a busy week as the recipients of varied and delightful hospitality,
which was terminated by a splendid reception in our honour on the
evening of the second of March.

Captain Butt, who was to be continued as aide to President Taft, called
on me at once upon my arrival in Washington to assure me that my
instructions had been carried out and that the new régime, fully
organised, would go into effect at the White House on the morning of
March fifth.

Some time before the Inauguration, indeed shortly after Mr. Taft’s
election, President Roosevelt expressed a desire that we should dine
with him and Mrs. Roosevelt on the evening of the third of March and
spend that night in the White House as their guests. This was breaking a
precedent, but it was Mr. Roosevelt’s plan for bidding us a warm welcome
to the post which he was about to vacate, and my husband accepted with
grateful appreciation. My impression is that neither Mrs. Roosevelt nor
I would have suggested such an arrangement for this particular evening,
but, it having been made for us, we naturally acquiesced.

The third of March, a stormy day, was filled with innumerable
minor engagements and small incidents, with instructions and
counter-instructions and, especially, with weather predictions and
counter-predictions, so it was not until shortly before eight
o’clock that Mr. Taft and I, having dressed for dinner, arrived at
the White House. The other guests at the dinner were Senator and
Mrs. Lodge, Senator and Mrs. Root, Admiral and Mrs. Cowles, Mr.
and Mrs. Nicholas Longworth and Miss Mabel Boardman.

Now there is always bound to be a sadness about the end of an
administration, no matter how voluntarily the retiring President may
leave office, no matter how welcome the new President and his family may
be. Mrs. Roosevelt seemed depressed, not, I am sure, over the prospect
of leaving the White House,—Presidents’ wives are always given plenty of
time to prepare themselves for that event,—but for other reasons which
one easily could surmise. Her husband and son were about to start for a
long and, possibly, dangerous trip into the jungles of Africa, and she
was looking forward to a year of anxiety. She was leaving a full and
busy life; she had occupied her high position for nearly eight years,
during which she had made a host of friends, and a great number of them
had called during the afternoon to say farewell and to express their
deep regret at her departure. I knew all of these things, realised their
depressing effect and sympathised with her deeply. The President and Mr.
Taft, seconded by other guests, did their best with stories and
conversation, made as general as possible, to lighten the occasion, but
their effort was not entirely successful.

As my husband had an engagement to attend a “smoker” which was being
given to him at the New Willard Hotel by a large gathering of Yale men,
the party broke up very early and, as soon as the last of the guests had
gone, I went immediately to my rooms. We had been assigned to the suite
in the southeast corner, known in the White House as the Blue Bedroom.

This Blue Bedroom gave me food for interesting reflection. Conspicuous,
under the mantel against the side wall, I found, on a bronze plate, the
following inscription (which I read as I struggled with my hooks): “In
this room Abraham Lincoln signed the Emancipation Proclamation of
January 1, 1863, whereby four million slaves were given their freedom
and slavery forever prohibited in these United States.” It is only a
state bedroom now, having been made so by the plans of the McKim
restoration which was accomplished during the Roosevelt administration,
but it was once Lincoln’s Cabinet room, a room in which he lived through
many terrible days during the Civil War. It seemed strange to spend my
first night in the White House surrounded by such ghosts.

I went to bed reasonably early, hoping that I might have a good, long
sleep and get up refreshed and ready for an eventful day. But the press
of circumstances was against me. My mind was never more wide awake. In
spite of my determination to rest, I went carefully over the whole
Inaugural programme. I wondered if this had been done, if that had been
attended to. I worried over many petty details with which I had no
reason to be concerned. I suppose I must have been excited, a condition
quite rare with me, but then, too, the weather had something to do with
it. Never was seen such a night in Washington. It will be remembered
that Mr. Moore, the Chief of the Weather Bureau, had prophesied that the
storm of the third would pass and that the Fourth of March would dawn as
clear and bright as any Inaugural Committee could wish. He made himself
very popular with the anxious officials, who were expending their
energies in the preparation of a fair weather programme, but his
popularity was short lived. He afterward learnedly explained that some
wholly unprecedented thing had happened in the wind currents, causing a
“flareback”—whatever that may be. It was a memorable “flareback” in any
event, not to be forgotten by those who were so seriously inconvenienced
by its results.

After I had fallen asleep in the early morning hours, thinking—with
faith in the prophet—to wake up and find a smiling world, I was roused
by loud, crackling reports which seemed to be in the immediate vicinity
of my windows. I got up and looked out. It was light enough for me to
see that the world was ice-bound and that the storm, instead of abating,
had increased in violence. The crackling I had heard was the noise of
twigs and tree limbs breaking with the weight of the ice which encased
them. It didn’t look hopeful for the Inaugural Ceremonies, and I had a
ludicrous vision of a haughty, gold-laced parade sliding, rather than
marching with measured precision, down Pennsylvania Avenue, striving to
maintain its dignity while it spasmodically lost its footing. But mine
was rueful mirth.

In the morning Mr. Taft found President Roosevelt in the great hall
below, genially alert.

“Well, Will,” he exclaimed, “the storm will soon be over. It isn’t a
regular storm. It’s nature’s echo of Senator Rainer’s denunciations of
me. As soon as I am out where I can do no further harm to the
Constitution it will cease.”

“You’re wrong,” said Will; “it is my storm. I always said it would be a
cold day when I got to be President of the United States.”

It was really very serious. Railroad and telegraphic communications were
paralysed all along the Atlantic Coast. Wires were down in every
direction and traffic of all kinds was at a practical standstill.
Thousands of people, on their way to Washington for the Inauguration,
were tied up at points outside the city and it was impossible for awhile
even to get a telegram in or out. However, Inaugurations do not wait for
fair weather and the programme had to proceed.

About half past ten I saw the President and the President-elect, in a
closed carriage, accompanied by Senators Knox and Bacon of the Inaugural
Committee, and a brilliant mounted escort, start on their slippery way
toward the Capitol. The Inauguration ceremonies would not take place
until twelve o’clock, but there were a number of bills waiting for the
signature of Mr. Roosevelt, and it was necessary for him to go early to
the office of the President at the Capitol to attend to this and other
final business details.

Before they left the White House it had not yet been decided whether or
not the Inauguration would take place out of doors. Mr. Taft regretted
exceedingly the necessity for disappointing thousands of people, but at
the same time he recognised the danger of exposing the crowds to the wet
and penetrating cold, and he considered, especially, the impossibility
of asking Chief Justice Fuller, who was then over seventy years old and
very frail, to brave a blizzard, even for the purpose of administering a
Presidential oath. However, he decided to wait until the weather had
given its ultimate indication before changing the programme. He said
afterward that as he drove to the Capitol there were many brave citizens
in the streets who gave voice to as hearty cheers as could possibly be
expected under the circumstances.

I was being taken care of by Captain Archibald Butt, so I had nothing
except the weather to worry about. With a last hopeless look out of
doors I proceeded to don my Inauguration finery, feeling duly thankful
that it was not too springlike in its character. The newspapers say I
wore a purple satin suit, and a small hat trimmed with gold lace and a
high white aigrette. This is as good a description as any, though it
might have been more flattering, considering the importance I attached
to the subject. I remember the hat perfectly. The aigrette was not quite
as high as it started out to be. It had nearly met an untimely end at a
reception the day before where it collided with a lighted gas-jet.
Fortunately it was put out before it was greatly damaged, but it had to
be trimmed down some, and I imagined that it exuded a faint odour of
burning feathers.

At least two years before the election, when no one could anticipate who
would be the next President, President Roosevelt had announced at a
Cabinet meeting that he did not intend to ride back to the White House
with his successor. It was a precedent which he did not like and which
he desired to break. Mrs. Roosevelt went, with her family and friends,
directly from the White House to the station to wait for her husband to
join her after the Inauguration. It was about half past eleven when
Captain Butt and I started in a limousine for the Capitol where we
arrived to find the “scene set” for the ceremonies in the Senate
Chamber.

Our children were already in the gallery, waiting eagerly. It was an
event in their young lives never to be forgotten, and I believe that
Robert and Helen were in properly receptive moods. My son Charlie,
however, seems not to have been so confident. Charlie is a great lover
of adventure stories and it is a favourite tradition in the family now
that he carried with him to the Senate Chamber a copy of “Treasure
Island” with which to while away the time in case the Inaugural address
should prove too long. Charlie was only eleven years old and I consider
it a great tribute to his father’s eloquence that “Treasure Island” was
not opened that day.

This Inauguration was said to be, by persons who had seen many, one of
the most impressive ceremonies that ever opened the administration of a
President. The oath of office is usually administered and the Inaugural
address delivered from a large platform erected in front of the Capitol
before which ten thousand people can assemble. But the ten thousand
people are sure to have been waiting in a massed crowd for an hour or
more; they are always tired and uncomfortable, so when they finally
discover that few of them can really hear anything, and that they have
seen all there is to be seen, they begin to move about and talk, the
noise and agitation greatly detracting from the impressiveness of the
ceremony. Because my husband’s Inauguration took place in the Senate
Chamber it was no less “in the sight of all the people.” There was room
on the floor of the Chamber for the whole official personnel of the
Government of the United States, resident in Washington. There were the
retiring President and his Cabinet, the Justices of the Supreme Court in
their robes of office, the Senate and the House of Representatives,
besides the foreign Ambassadors and the whole Diplomatic Corps in their
brilliant uniforms, while the galleries were crowded with official
families and a substantial number of unofficial auditors.

[Illustration:

  MR. AND MRS. TAFT RETURNING TO THE WHITE HOUSE MR. TAFT’S INAUGURATION
]

It was a great presence; and the taking of the oath and the delivering
of the Inaugural address before assembled national authority and the
world’s representatives, in a solemn silence in which every word could
be heard, left a deep impression.

As soon as Mr. Taft had finished speaking Mr. Roosevelt walked rapidly
up, and giving his hand a mighty grasp, said something which sounded
like “Bully speech, old man!” and hurried out of the Chamber accompanied
by members of his Cabinet who were to see him off at the station. My
husband told me afterward that what he really said was: “God bless you,
old man. It is a great state document.”

Since the ex-President was not going to ride back to the White House
with his successor, I decided that I would. No President’s wife had ever
done it before, but as long as precedents were being disregarded I
thought it might not be too great a risk for me to disregard this one.
Of course, there was objection. Some of the Inaugural Committee
expressed their disapproval, but I had my way and in spite of protests
took my place at my husband’s side.

By the time the Inauguration ceremonies were concluded the skies had
cleared and the sun had come out. Mr. Taft left the Senate Chamber with
the Committee, followed by the assembled dignitaries in the order of
precedence. With Captain Butt I hurried from the gallery and joined him
in the great hall under the Dome, on his way to the platform on the
North Side where the Inauguration would have taken place but for the
weather. In front of the temporary structure many people had gathered,
and as we descended to the front they called for the new President. In
response he stepped to the platform where the Inaugural oath was to have
been administered, and bowed repeatedly.

A platoon of mounted Police and our escort, the Cleveland City Troop,
with their elaborate and beautiful uniforms somewhat bedraggled by the
morning’s sleet and mud, met us at the steps leading down from the
platform. We entered the official coach and four and were slowly driven
down through the Capitol grounds to Pennsylvania Avenue, and thence to
the White House. As I have said, the clouds had rolled by; the day was
cold but bright; the expected and expectant crowds were thronging the
sidewalks and filling the stands, and our greeting from them was all
that my fancy had pictured it.

For me that drive was the proudest and happiest event of Inauguration
Day. Perhaps I had a little secret elation in thinking that I was doing
something which no woman had ever done before. I forgot the anxieties of
the preceding night; the consternation caused by the fearful weather;
and every trouble seemed swept aside. My responsibilities had not yet
begun to worry me, and I was able to enjoy, almost to the full, the
realisation that my husband was actually President of the United States
and that it was this fact which the cheering crowds were acclaiming.

There was nobody at the White House to bid us welcome except the
official staff and some of our own guests. But it didn’t matter. There
is never any ceremony about moving into the White House. You just drive
up and walk in,—and there you are. The aides and ushers who greeted us
at the entrance, treated our occupation of our new residence so much as
a matter of course that I could not help but feel something as
Cinderella must have felt when her mice footmen bowed her into her coach
and four and behaved just as if they had conducted her to a Court Ball
every night of her life. I stood for a moment over the great brass seal,
bearing the national coat-of-arms, which is sunk in the floor in the
middle of the entrance hall. “The Seal of the President of the United
States,” I read around the border, and now—that meant my husband!

But I could not linger long because my duties as a hostess began at
once. I was not unused to the accepted regulations of official life, so,
in spite of a slight feeling that the whole thing was unreal, I was not
embarrassed as I walked into the great dining-room and took my place by
the door to receive guests for the first time as mistress of the White
House.

I had left to the efficient management of Captain Archibald Butt as many
of the details of the day’s programme as was possible. Some time before
I had carefully gone over the plans with him, we had provided for any
reasonable emergency, and I knew my instructions would be carried out.
Captain Butt—later Major Butt—had been military aide to President
Roosevelt; we had known him well, both in the Philippines and in
Washington, and we were glad to have the opportunity of continuing him
in that capacity. Whatever Major Butt did was done faultlessly—always.
During the three years he was with us—day in and day out, upon every
possible occasion, in the closest intimacy—I never ceased to wonder at
his genius for work, his comprehensive grasp of important matters and of
small details, his extraordinary accuracy. His very presence inspired
the utmost confidence. Archie Butt, as everybody called him, became our
close and dearly loved friend. Indeed, we felt that he belonged to us,
and nothing in all our experience ever touched us as deeply as the
tragedy of his death. Returning from a short vacation abroad, he went
down on the _Titanic_, facing death like a soldier, after the lives of
nearly all the women and children had been saved.

We had invited a large number of people to the usual Inaugural luncheon.
The cook and several of the staff of servants were to accompany Mrs.
Roosevelt to Oyster Bay, but they remained until the afternoon of the
Fourth when the staff I had engaged were installed. There are a few old,
official servants who remain in the house from one administration to
another, keeping in operation an uninterrupted household routine, so
there was no reason why the Inaugural luncheon should not be carried
through with the same smoothness and despatch to be expected on ordinary
occasions. But again we reckoned without the weather. The difficulties
of traffic, added to the crush on the avenues, made it impossible for
our guests to arrive on time and they continued to straggle in
throughout the whole afternoon, each one wishing to apologise in person
and make special explanation. This, of course, made anything like
systematic reception out of the question and the result was that the
luncheon really ran into and became a part of the tea for my husband’s
classmates of Yale, which was scheduled for five o’clock. There was some
confusion, but much goodwill and frank enjoyment and the fact that the
President was not there to receive his classmates caused nothing more
than a few repetitions of, by that time, familiar comments on the
elements.

Mr. Taft was reviewing the Inaugural Parade and the last of it did not
pass the reviewing stand until after nightfall. He came in, however, in
time to exchange greetings with old-time, enthusiastic friends, the
members of the Yale class of ‘78, and to hold them longer than they had
intended to remain. When the last of them had wished us Godspeed and
said good-bye, we stood, the five of us,—my husband, my three children
and I,—alone in the big state dining-room, and tried to realise that,
for the first time, the White House was really our Home. The great
walnut-panelled room, with its silvered chandeliers and big moose heads,
seemed very empty with only the Taft family in it, after all the clatter
and chatter that had been sounding there all day. We gazed at each other
for a moment, with slightly lost expressions on our faces, and then
nature asserted herself in the new President.

[Illustration:

  © Harris & Ewing.

  THE PRIVATE DINING-ROOM OF THE WHITE HOUSE, AND THE FAMILY
    SITTING-ROOM AT THE END OF THE LONG UPSTAIRS CORRIDOR
]

“Let’s go up stairs, my dears, and _sit down_!” said he.

Poor man, he had not experienced the blissful sensation of sitting down
since early that morning; so we proceeded out to the elevator, which
Charlie, true to his boy nature, had, of course, already learned to
operate. For once, I am glad to say, it did not stick between floors.
This was a habit to which it became addicted in later days, a habit it
was sure to indulge on occasions when the President proudly used it for
taking a large party of men upstairs after dinner. But this time he was
able, without delay, to reach the best easy-chair in the sitting-room
where he remained until I prodded him once more into activity by
reminding him that he must get into evening clothes else the Inaugural
Ball could not take place.

Not having been taxed so greatly, I was not yet ready to succumb to
fatigue; besides I was now eager to roam around the house, to
familiarise myself with the mysteries of my new home and to plan the
assignment of rooms among various members of the family who were to come
to us that very night.

The second story of the White House, where all the family living rooms
are, corresponds in spaciousness with the floor below, which, with its
broad hall, its great East Room, its large reception rooms and state
dining room, is familiar to the public. Upstairs there is a very wide
hall running the entire length of the building. The rooms occupied by
the President and his wife are in the southwest corner and at that end
of the house the hall is partially partitioned and screened off and
pleasantly furnished with desks, sofas and easy-chairs to make a fairly
large and very private family sitting-room. It was here that I left my
tired husband while I went on my first tour of exploration.

At each of the four corners of the house there is a suite; all arranged
on the same plan, exactly alike, except as to decoration. Each consists
of an exceedingly large bedroom with a spacious bath, and a smaller room
adjoining which may be used as a bedroom or dressing-room. I went first
into the large bedroom which my husband and I expected to occupy. The
windows of this room look out on the White House gardens where the large
fountain plays, and, beyond, on the Washington Monument, the Potomac
River and the distant Virginia hills. This, I think, is the most
glorious vista in Washington, which is a city of splendid vistas, and
seeing it that March night by the long line of lights which stretch
across the Potomac bridge and meet the lights of Arlington, it was,
indeed, inspiring.

The room was the room where Lincoln slept, indeed, where every President
since Jackson has slept. A tablet under the mantel states this fact. It
is the room which must necessarily have more intimate and personal
association with the men who have occupied the White House than any
other. Other parts of the house have been the scenes of great historic
events and of magnificent hospitality, but here, one after another, the
Presidents of the United States have really lived and been at home.

Its furnishings have, undoubtedly, been changed many times and yet I
found it to contain many old and interesting pieces. The most striking
object in the room was an enormous four-poster bed with a great curved
canopy of wood, decorated with carved and gilded eagles and upholding
heavy draperies of blue and white brocade. In this bed, we had been
told, the Prince of Wales slept when he visited this country in 1860,
but on the first night I discovered that, whatever its historic
interest, I did not like it as a bed to sleep in. I soon replaced it
with two smaller mahogany beds and I dispensed altogether with the
draperies. There were canopies of the same gilded eagles over the
windows, and the curtains suspended from them, as well as the upholstery
of the sofa and chairs, were of the same blue and white brocade. Some of
the furniture was colonial, some Victorian. The colonial furniture in
the White House is very good and there is quite a lot of it in all the
bedrooms, but many of the bureaus and wardrobes are of the
scarcely-to-be-called beautiful style of the Victorian era. I secured
for our room, later on, the beds, a dressing-table and some chairs, all
colonial. These were about the only pieces of furniture I bought for the
White House. I also substituted heavy chintz for the brocade draperies
and upholstery, and did away with the canopies entirely, as they seemed
to me to be too heavy for a sleeping room. The small room in the corner
of our suite Mr. Taft used for a dressing-room.

The corresponding suite across the hall I gave to Helen, my daughter. It
had been occupied by both of the Misses Roosevelt and before them, I
believe, by Mrs. McKinley. It had been fitted up in pretty flowered
chintz for Miss Ethel Roosevelt, after Miss Alice had married, and we
left it unchanged.

I strolled down the hall, which contains only a large table and a few
portraits of Presidents for which there is no wall space down stairs,
and looked into the Library which is exactly in the center of the house
on the south side. It is oval like the Blue Drawing Room beneath it and
it is a little dark in the daytime, being shaded by the roof of the
south portico. This was Mrs. Roosevelt’s favourite room and it had been
fitted most charmingly with many of her own belongings, but as they were
now gone and my own had not yet been moved in, it looked rather bare.
The furniture had not been upholstered for many years and it was a
little shabby. Later on I had it all recovered and the walls of the room
retinted, and when I had put in some of the Oriental tapestries and
handsome pieces of furniture which I had brought with me from the Far
East it made a very beautiful and livable room. We used it a great deal,
especially when there were guests, but for the family the sitting-room
at the end of the hall was always the favourite gathering place.

Opposite the Library a short corridor extends to the window under the
roof of the front portico and on each side of this doors open into
smaller bedrooms; smaller, that is, in comparison with the four large
ones. Even these would be considered large in an ordinary house. One of
them I assigned to the housekeeper and the other to my two sons. The
boys’ room was rather dark, with its windows directly under the roof of
the portico; and it was furnished, moreover, in dark red, a colour which
does not add light to gloominess, but the boys got it because they were
the members of the family who would care the least and who would be the
most away.

The great staircase descends from the central hall just beyond these
rooms and facing the staircase is the President’s Study. The eastern end
of the building was all used as offices until the new offices were built
and the house restored in accordance with the original plan. The
Presidents with large families must, indeed, have been in an
uncomfortable situation when they had to confine themselves to the rooms
in the west end, the only rooms then available for living purposes. The
facts are that such families found the house to be less commodious than
a “five-room flat,” as the wife of one President expressed it. I believe
the Roosevelts, until the house was remodelled, were unable to
accommodate one guest.

[Illustration:

  © Harris & Ewing.

  TWO WHITE HOUSE BEDROOMS SHOWING FINE OLD COLONIAL BEDS
]

There is a story that when Prince Henry of Prussia was in Washington,
President Roosevelt invited him to ride. The Prince accepted and just
before the appointed hour appeared at the White House in his street
clothes, accompanied by a valet bearing his riding clothes. He had very
naturally expected to change at the White House, but it happened that on
that day there was not one room that could even be prepared for a Royal
dressing-room, so the President was compelled to request His Highness to
return to the German Embassy to change. I believe this incident had the
effect of hastening the deliberations of the members of the
Appropriations Committee of the House who were then leisurely figuring
on the amount necessary for the restoration.

Senator McMillan, who was at the head of the District Committee in the
Senate, and who, in his lifetime was the leading spirit in the
improvement of Washington, in the revival of the L’Enfant plan, and in
the creation of a Commission of Fine Arts to pass upon contemplated
structures and changes, conferred with Mr. and Mrs. Roosevelt and with
Senator Allison of the Appropriations Committee, and by an amendment in
the Senate, in the spring of 1902, to which Speaker Cannon and the House
Appropriations Committee assented, the necessary funds for this
restoration were eventually provided and, most fortunately, the whole
work was committed to Mr. James McKim, of McKim, Meade and White, who,
among all the architectural monuments to his genius which he left, left
no greater evidence of his mastery of his art than this. He added the
gracefully beautiful terraces on either side, equipped with electric
light standards, and in accord, really, with the original plan of the
house, and utilised them in a most ingenious way. He made of the one on
the west a very dignified and convenient approach, through the basement,
for large companies attending state entertainments. Cloak stands for the
accommodation of thousands were fitted into each side of this passageway
and guests now are able to dispose of their wraps and proceed to the
staircase leading up to the main hall on the first floor without the
slightest interruption or discomfort.

The ample and airy space beneath the high portico on the south side was
used for domestic offices and servants’ quarters, thus greatly
increasing the capacity of the house, and the construction of the very
convenient executive office building, reached by a covered, or
cloistered passage from the White House basement, was carried out on
lines so like in style and appearance to the north portico, so low and
classically simple, that it detracts nothing from the general effect and
interferes in no way with the dignified outlines of the home of the
Nation’s Chief Magistrate.

During the reconstruction the President and Mrs. Roosevelt lived either
at Oyster Bay or in a house a few steps from the White House on
Lafayette Square. Mr. McKim frequently consulted Mrs. Roosevelt as to
interior changes and many of her views were adopted, so that the woman’s
side of the new White House was well looked after.

The work took longer and cost more than was expected and this elicited
much criticism of the architect as well as of the architectural result.
His aim had been to make as little outward change in the main lines as
possible and yet to make as great a change as space would permit in
interior accommodation. Considering what he had to accomplish his
success was remarkable. But the Philistines among the Congressmen and
Senators, who don’t like architects anyway, found much to complain of.
In their daily visits to the President they did not, by Mr. McKim’s
plan, reach him through the historic front entrance, supported by the
great, white pillars, but they were relegated to a business office,
simply and conveniently equipped, and it offended the sense of due
proportion of some of them as to who were the real power in the
government, the legislative representatives calling on business or the
social guests of the President.

But now, after all the ignorance, ill-feeling and prejudice displayed in
the most unjust attacks upon Mr. McKim, those whose judgment is worth
anything, and that includes the whole body of the people of the United
States, rejoice in their hearts that the greatest of American architects
was given a free hand to adapt to modern needs, but also to preserve in
its dignity and beauty, this most appropriate official home of the Head
of the Republic.

These observations may not be in place just here, but they occurred to
me on the first evening of my occupancy of the White House, and I
congratulated myself that I was to enjoy the results of that successful
reconstruction of what had been a most uncomfortable mansion.

The President’s Study, as it is now called, is the only room of the old
Executive offices which has not been changed into a sleeping room. It is
now the President’s more personal office where he can receive callers
more privately than in the new office building. A small bronze tablet
under the mantel tells, in simple words, the history of the room. Here
all the Presidents since Johnson held their Cabinet meetings, and here
the Protocol suspending hostilities with Spain was signed in McKinley’s
administration. A picture of that event, painted by Chartran, hangs in
the room and conveys a remarkably vivid impression of the men who had a
part in it. The faces of President McKinley, of Justice Day, who was
then Secretary of State, and of M. Cambon, the French Ambassador, are
especially striking. This room, in which there had been a great many
personal mementos gathered by Mr. Roosevelt in his interesting career,
also looked, after their removal, rather bare on that evening of my
first inspection and, save for the pictures and the tablet, had little
in its character to make real in one’s mind the great events that it had
witnessed. Yet, as I roamed around that evening, the whole house was
haunted for me by memories of the great men and the charming women whose
most thrilling moments, perhaps, had been spent under its roof, and I
was unable to feel that such a commonplace person as I had any real
place there. This feeling passed, however, for though I was always
conscious of the character which a century of history had impressed upon
the White House, it came, nevertheless, to feel as much like home as any
house I have ever occupied. That Study, which seemed at the moment so
much a part of American history and so little even a temporary
possession of the Taft family, was later hung with amusing cartoons
illustrative of events in Mr. Taft’s career, with photographs of his
friends, and with what are called at Yale “_memorabilia_” of his varied
experiences, and it became, in time, for us all, peculiarly _his_ room.

The Blue Bedroom, where we had slept the night before as guests of the
Roosevelts, belongs to one of the four corner suites and I planned to
give it to my sister Eleanor, Mrs. Louis More, and her husband, while
the smaller room in the same suite I assigned to Miss Torrey, our Aunt
Delia—and during our administration apparently the country’s “Aunt
Delia.” She had been staying with us at the Boardmans’ and was probably
enjoying the Inauguration of her nephew more than anyone in Washington.
The last of the suites, which was exactly like the blue suite except
that it was hung in pink brocade, I gave to my husband’s sister and
brother-in-law, Dr. and Mrs. Edwards of San Diego.

When I had finished my explorations and arrangements I glanced at the
clock in the Pink Room and discovered that I had no time to lose before
beginning that important toilet which would make me ready for the
Inaugural Ball, the last, but not the least of the Inaugural functions.

I hurried to my room and found the hairdresser waiting for me. I sat
down with a feeling of great comfort and submitted myself with hopeful
patience to her ministrations. But she was so overcome by the greatness
of the occasion that, although she was quite accustomed to the
idiosyncrasies of my hair, she was not able to make it “go right” until
she had put it up and taken it down twice, and even then it was not as
perfectly done as I had fondly hoped it would be. I believe this
hairdressing process made me more nervous than anything else in the
whole course of the day.

While it was going on, my new gown lay glittering on the bed, where the
maid had placed it, and I was very anxious to get into it. It had given
me several days of awful worry. It was made in New York and the
dressmaker had promised that I should have it at least a week before it
was needed so that any necessary changes could easily be made. But day
after day went by and no dress,—the third of March arrived and then I
began, frantically, to telegraph. I finally received the reassuring
advice that the dress was on its way in the hands of a special
messenger, but the special messenger was, with many other people, held
up for hours by the blizzard and did not arrive at the Boardmans’ until
after I had left for the White House, wondering, disconsolately, what on
earth I should wear to the Inaugural Ball if it happened that the
messenger couldn’t get there at all. The suspense had been fearful and
it was a comfortable relief to see the gown all spread out and waiting
for me.

It was made of heavy white satin which I had sent to Tokyo to have
embroidered, and the people who did the work surely knew their art. A
pattern of golden-rod was outlined by a silver thread and cleverly
fitted into the long lines of the gown, and no other trimming had been
used except some lace with which the low-cut bodice was finished. It
fitted me admirably and I hoped that, in spite of all the mishaps in my
preparations, I looked my best as I descended from the White House
automobile at the entrance of the Pension Office.

The Pension Office was not built for balls, Inaugural or otherwise, and
on the evening of March Fourth, 1909, after a day of melting sleet and
snow, the entrance was not especially inviting. Neither was the
dressing-room which had been assigned to me. I suppose that for years it
had rung with the ceaseless click of scores of typewriters and that its
walls had beheld no more elaborate costume than a business blouse and
skirt since the occasion of the last Inaugural Ball which had marked the
beginning of the second Roosevelt administration four years before. But
as I needed to do very little “prinking” it really didn’t matter and I
quickly rejoined the President and proceeded, on his arm, to the
Presidential Box, this being a small round gallery above the main
entrance of the great ballroom which is itself, in everyday life, the
principal workroom of the Pension Office.

A brilliant, an almost kaleidoscopic scene spread before us. The hall is
of tremendous proportions, pillared with red marble and with walls
tinted in the same colour. Every inch of floor space seemed to be
occupied. The bright colours and the gleam of women’s gowns met and
clashed, or harmonised with the brighter colours of diplomatic uniforms.
Officers of the Army and Navy, in full regalia, mingled with the
hundreds of men in the plain black of formal evening dress. It was a
wonderful glittering throng, more magnificent than any I have ever seen.
It was not possible to distinguish individuals except in the space
directly below the box, but there, as I looked down, I saw a great
semi-circle of faces—thousands, it seemed to me—smilingly upturned
toward us. The din of human voices was terrific; even the loudest band
procurable had difficulty in making itself heard. But the scene was so
gay in colour, and the faces that gazed up at us were so friendly and
happy that I felt elated and not at all overwhelmed.

The first person whom my eyes rested upon in the box was Aunt Delia,
already installed in a chair near the back and drinking in the scene
with visible pleasure. Aunt Delia, at that time, was eighty-three years
old, but not for anything would she have missed one feature of this
crowning day of her life. Having no children of her own, she had for
many years given the greater part of her thought and interest to her
nephews and nieces, and she followed every step in my husband’s career
with an absorption, not to say an excitement, as great as my own. All
day long she had travelled from ceremony to ceremony, conducted by
Lieutenant Reed, one of the Naval aides. She would arrive, leaning on
his arm, among the first at each appointed place, ready and eager for
any new event. She didn’t miss even the late supper of birds, salads and
ices which was served to us later that night, before we left the Ball.
And now she sat in the President’s Box, her soft, white hair arranged by
the best hairdresser, gowned in rich, old-fashioned, black velvet,
adorned with all the good old lace which she had been treasuring for
years for an occasion justifying its display.

The Vice-President and Mrs. Sherman arrived shortly after we did and
shared the box with us. They also had with them a large family party and
were both so jolly and so much in the festive spirit that formality
disappeared. Many friends and officials of distinction came, in the
course of the evening, to pay their respects; and members of our own
family came and went at intervals as they were inclined.

I may as well say here that my husband and I both came from such large
families that all Washington, at the time of the Inauguration, seemed
filled with our near and dear relatives. Mr. and Mrs. Charles P. Taft
took a comfortable house for ten days, while Mr. and Mrs. Henry Taft and
Mr. Horace Taft were at the New Willard.

About eleven o’clock the President and I descended to the ballroom
floor, followed by Vice-President and Mrs. Sherman and, as is the
custom, proceeded slowly down the length of the hall and back between
the closely packed rows of people who stood aside to make room for our
promenade. This ceremonious parade was not as trying for me as it may
sound, for not only did I have the reassurance of my husband’s arm, but
the crowd was too large to seem very personal. So I was quite serene,
except for frequent spasms of anxiety lest my gorgeous length of train
be stepped on.

Except for this ceremony, and for a short supper which was served to us
and a few invited guests in a private room, the President and I remained
in the box until shortly after one o’clock when we once more descended
and made our way to a waiting automobile which very quickly whisked us
away to much needed rest.

However, I must still have had energy enough left to worry over domestic
arrangements since the last thing I remember of that eventful day was a
hearty laugh from my husband when I exclaimed in sleepy tones: “I wonder
where we had all better have breakfast in the morning!”



                              CHAPTER XVII
                            THE WHITE HOUSE


The members of my family, and especially my children, are prone to
indulgence in good-natured personalities and they like to make the most
of my serious attitude toward my domestic responsibilities, saying that
I make them three times as difficult as they need be by a too positive
insistence on my own methods.

Perhaps I did make the process of adjusting the White House routine to
my own conceptions a shade too strenuous, but I could not feel that I
was mistress of any house if I did not take an active interest in all
the details of running it.

The management of the White House is, of course, a larger task than many
women are ever called upon to perform, and, incidentally, the same
“white light that beats upon a throne” sheds its sometimes uncomfortable
radiance upon the usually unprepared heads of America’s Chief Executive
and his family. Accustomed as I had been for years to publicity, yet it
came as a sort of shock to me that nearly everything I did, and
especially my slightest innovation, had what the reporters call “news
value.”

I have lived too much in other countries ever to underestimate the
importance of outward form, yet I think I may claim a wholesome regard
for and a constant acquiescence in the principles of democratic
simplicity, though not the kind of “democratic simplicity” which is
usually written in quotation marks.

I made very few changes, really. As a matter of fact no President’s wife
ever needs to unless she so desires, because the White House is a
governmental institution thoroughly equipped and always in good running
order. Each new mistress of the house has absolute authority, of course,
and can do exactly as she pleases, just as she would in any other home,
but in the beginning I confined my efforts largely to minor matters
connected with the house service itself. I wished to install certain
members of the house personnel of my own choosing, and this I did. Later
I made some changes in a few important social usages.

There are certain duties connected with the White House routine which
have been performed by the same employés throughout one Administration
after another and each new President’s wife finds these men invaluable
and wonders, I am sure, how the White House could ever be run without
them. For instance, there are Mr. Warren S. Young, who has been for
thirty years the Social Executive Officer, and Colonel W. H. Crook, who
became Chief Custodian under Lincoln in 1865 and is holding the same
office to-day. The duties of each of these men are delicate in the
extreme, but they know their work down to the minutest detail and it
would be difficult to measure their value to the woman who, in public
opinion, is wholly responsible for the White House.

As to my own innovations, I decided in the first place to have, at all
hours, footmen in livery at the White House door to receive visitors and
give instructions to sightseers. Before my time there had been only
“gentlemen ushers” who were in no way distinguishable from any other
citizen and many a time I have seen strangers wander up to the door
looking in vain for someone to whom it seemed right and proper to
address a question or to hand a visiting card. The gentlemen ushers I
retained, the head usher, Mr. Hoover, having become invaluable through
similar service under every Administration since Cleveland’s first, but
I put six coloured men in blue livery at the door, two at a time,
relieving each other at intervals, and I think many a timid visitor has
had reason to be thankful for the change. Incidentally they lend a
certain air of formal dignity to the entrance which, in my opinion, it
has always lacked.

These footmen received everybody who sought to enter the White House. If
it happened to be a party of tourists they were directed to such parts
of the building as are open to the public at stated hours; if it were a
caller, either social or official, he or she was conducted to one of the
drawing rooms. But sensible as this innovation seemed to me, it met a
varied criticism from the adherents, sincere and otherwise, of our too
widely vaunted “democratic simplicity.”

Another change I made was the substitution of a housekeeper for a
steward. I wanted a woman who could relieve me of the supervision of
such details as no man, expert steward though he might be, would ever
recognise. The White House requires such ordinary attention as is given
by a good housekeeper to any house, except, perhaps, that it has to be
more vigilantly watched. Dust accumulates in corners; mirrors and
picture glasses get dim with dampness; curtains sag or lose their
crispness; floors lose their gloss; rugs turn up at corners or fray at
the ends; chair covers get crumpled; cushions get crushed and untidy;
things get out of order generally; and it is a very large house. Kitchen
helpers grow careless and neglect their shining copper pots and pans and
kettles; pantry boys forget and send in plates or glasses not polished
to perfection; maids forget to be immaculate and linen is not properly
handled; they are just like employés in other homes and they need a
woman’s guidance and control. I engaged my housekeeper before my
husband’s Inauguration and she reported for duty on the morning of March
fifth.

If I could remember how many turkeys the President gives away every
Christmas I could tell just how many persons there are in the White
House service. I know it is something like one hundred, but they go to
employés of all kinds, to important house officials, to minor officials,
to servants of high and low degree, to gardeners, stable boys,
chauffeurs and all.

The staff of the White House proper is not so numerous, eighteen or
twenty perhaps, including cooks, kitchen maids, butlers, boys,
housemaids and laundresses. There was one coloured cook, Alice, who
prepared the meals for the servants’ dining-room and who had been in the
White House twenty years.

My head cook, whom I engaged, was Swedish. She was a miracle of a cook,
but she displayed a romantic tendency as well. She must have been about
forty, apparently quite staid, when she acquired a husband, a policeman
on duty at the White House, and, in due course, a baby. She had been
married only a little over a year when her husband contracted
tuberculosis. We had always been very much interested in her, deploring
the home-making tendency which took her away from us, so when we learned
of her misfortune Mr. Taft immediately took steps to have her husband
sent to Ft. Bayard, the Military Tuberculosis Sanatorium in New Mexico.
The cook, who earned seventy-five dollars a month, put her baby out to
nurse and returned to the White House, where we got regular reports as
to the progress of the invalid and the infant, each of whom proceeded to
do as well as could be expected.

The other servants in the White House are paid the usual wages, from
twenty-five to fifty dollars, and are no more and no less efficient than
other good houseworkers in other homes. The entire White House staff is
paid by the Government, the only private servants in our employ being a
Filipino valet who had been with Mr. Taft for a number of years, and my
personal maid.

[Illustration:

  © Harris & Ewing.

  TWO CORNERS OF THE WHITE HOUSE KITCHEN
]

In fact, all White House expenses are paid by the Government except
actual table supply bills, and Mr. Taft is fond of insisting upon his
conviction that the country treats its President exceedingly well. He
was the first President to receive a salary of $75,000.00 a year, and
when the subject of his nomination was uppermost in political
discussions he did not hesitate to say that he thought this increase
from $50,000.00 was an absolute necessity. He did not expect to spend
$75,000.00 a year, but he knew by careful calculation and by a knowledge
of President Roosevelt’s expenditures that he would have to spend at
least $50,000.00 a year and he thought he had a citizen’s right, even as
President, to provide a small competence for his family, a thing which
in his twenty years of poorly paid official service he had never had an
opportunity to do. He was fifty years old with two sons and a daughter
in school and college and, as Secretary of War at least, he had long
been working for a wage which was insufficient. But the country really
is good to its President. It does not make him rich by any means, but it
enables him to banish the wolf a fair distance from his door if he is
sensible enough to assist its generosity by the exercise of a mild form
of prudence.

My first inspection of the White House on the evening of my husband’s
Inauguration was casual, but the next day I assumed the management of
the establishment in earnest and proceeded upon a thorough investigation
which resulted in some rather disquieting revelations.

Mrs. Roosevelt, as the retiring Mistress of the White House, naturally
would make no changes or purchases which might not meet with the
approval of her successor, so I found the linen supply depleted, the
table service inadequate through breakages, and other refurnishing
necessary. There is a government appropriation to meet the expense of
such replenishments and repairs, and every President’s wife is supposed
to avail herself of any part of it she requires to fit the mansion for
her own occupancy.

Perhaps nothing in the house is so expressive of the various
personalities of its Mistresses as the dinner services which each has
contributed. For my part I was entirely satisfied with the quiet taste
displayed by Mrs. Roosevelt and contented myself with filling up the
different broken sets in her service to the number necessary for one
hundred covers.

I always enjoyed, however, using some of the old historic plates and
platters at small luncheons and dinners. There are enough plates left of
the Lincoln set to serve a course to a party of thirty. Though I speak
of the different designs as expressive of personalities they represent,
perhaps, various periods of popular taste rather than individual
preference. Samples of all the different services, displayed in cabinets
in the long eastern corridor, are among the most interesting exhibits in
the White House.

From the day my husband became President I never knew for certain until
I entered the dining-room just how many persons there would be at
luncheon. He always did credit me with a miraculous ability to produce
food for any number of persons at a moment’s notice and when he was
Governor of the Philippines and Secretary of War I always had to keep an
emergency supply cupboard, but I did not feel that I could carry with me
into the White House the happy-go-lucky attitude toward the formalities
which I had enjoyed in those days, so meeting his sudden demands became
a slightly more serious matter. His haphazard hospitality was of more
concern to the servants than to me, however, and I think it is only his
own gift for inspiring respectful devotion on the part of his household
staff that ever enables me to keep a cook more than a week at a time.

During our first spring in the White House Congress was in extra session
for the purpose of revising the tariff and Mr. Taft was in constant
conference with the different Senators and Representatives. We had
members of Congress at luncheon and dinner daily, and at breakfast quite
frequently.

Always, in consultation with my housekeeper and the head cook, I made
out the daily menus.

“How many for luncheon, Madame?” was the cook’s invariable question.

“I haven’t any idea,” was my invariable reply.

If no guests had, to my knowledge, been invited I would give
instructions to have luncheon prepared for the family only, emergency
provision being a thing understood. My day’s plans would then be sent
over to Mr. Young, the Executive Social Officer, who had his office in
the Executive wing of the building, and I would go on about my
accustomed duties and pleasures knowing that no surprise would find us
quite surprised.

Along about eleven o’clock the house telephone would ring, or a note
would be sent over, and announcement would be made that Mr. So and So
would lunch with the President and Mrs. Taft. The table would be laid
while the kitchen staff stood calmly by awaiting final orders. In
another half hour might come the announcement of a second guest, or
group of guests, whereupon the amiable butler would have to make a
complete change in table arrangements. Only about a half hour before the
stated luncheon hour did the cook ever consider it safe to begin final
preparations, but too often for the maintenance of entire smoothness in
domestic routine Mr. Taft would come across from the Executive offices
anywhere from a half hour to an hour late, bringing with him an extra
guest, or even a number of extra guests whose coming had not been
announced at all.

This system, or this lack of system, obtained throughout my four years
in the White House, but I and my capable and willing staff, all of whom
were devoted to the President, eventually adjusted ourselves to it and I
began to take great delight in the informal meeting of so many
interesting and distinguished men at our open luncheon table.

I tried to insist that the dinner hour should always be properly
respected, and it usually was. While we gave many informal, small
dinners,—nearly every night as a matter of fact,—there were crowded into
my first season from March until I became ill in May most of the big
official functions which are a part of White House life always, as well
as a number of entertainments which were a part of my own scheme of
innovations.

Our first official entertainment was the Diplomatic Tea on the 12th of
March, just eight days after the Inauguration, and before I had time to
settle myself in the midst of my own belongings which were to fill the
empty spaces left by the removal of Mrs. Roosevelt’s personal effects.
At this tea we received the entire Diplomatic Corps, including all heads
of Missions, and all Secretaries and Attachés, with their wives.

Nothing could be more statelily important. It was the first presentation
of the Diplomatic Corps to the new President and though, having been for
several years in Washington society, we knew many of them quite well,
the method of procedure was as formal as the State Department could make
it. Explicit directions as to the manner in which they were to present
themselves were sent in printed form to every diplomatic representative
in Washington, but while an almost oppressive dignity marked the
proceedings, our wide acquaintance made it possible for us to depart
somewhat from the rigid form decreed and to lend to the occasion an air
of general friendliness it could not otherwise have had.

It might be interesting to those not familiar with Washington life to
know just what the prescribed ceremonies are for such an event. I
confess that at first they seemed to me to be rather formidable,
accustomed as I was to the dignities of government.

The guests are not received by the President and his wife as they
arrive. They are requested to “present themselves (in uniform) at the
East entrance and to assemble in the East Room at a sufficient interval
before five o’clock to enable them by that hour to place themselves in
the order of precedence, each Chief of Mission being immediately
followed by his staff and ladies of his Embassy or Legation.” They are
met in the East Room by the Secretary of State and other State
Department officials, and by some of the aides-de-camp on duty at the
White House.

In the meantime the President and his wife take their positions in the
Blue Room and exactly at five o’clock the doors are thrown open and
announcement is made in the East Room that they are ready to receive.

The Dean of the Diplomatic Corps then steps forward, past the military
aides stationed at the door leading into the Blue Room and is presented
by the senior military aide to the President. He in turn presents each
member of his suite, all of whom pass promptly on and are presented by
another aide to the President’s wife, the head of the Mission being
presented to her at the end of these ceremonies. Each Ambassador or
Minister, in strict order of precedence, passes by with his staff, and
they all proceed through the Red Room and into the state Dining Room
where tea and other refreshments are served.

At the conclusion of the presentations the President and his wife
usually retire and leave their guests to be entertained for a few formal
moments by whomever has been invited to preside at the tea-table, but
Mr. Taft and I followed them into the dining-room to have tea with them.
I knew this was a departure from established custom, but it seemed a
perfectly natural thing for us to do. I forgot to take into
consideration the attitude of our guests, however. Our unaccustomed
presence rather bewildered the diplomats for a moment. There were no
rules to guide them in such an emergency and they didn’t know exactly
what was expected of them. I had finally to instruct one of the aides to
announce unofficially to the wives of some of the more important of them
that nothing at all was expected, and that they should retire without
making any adieus whenever they so desired. I was told afterward that
nearly everybody was pleased with the innovation, and in the official
White House Diary—kept for the purpose of establishing precedents, I
suppose—it was recommended that it be followed on all future occasions
of a similar nature.

At our first state dinner, given to the Vice-President and Mrs. Sherman,
there were thirty-two guests, all Cabinet Officers, Senators and
Representatives. To prove my claim to a natural tendency toward simple
and everyday methods I need only say that even as the President’s wife
it seemed strange to me to have our guests arrive without immediate
greetings from their host and hostess. Many a time at Malacañan Palace
and in other homes I have gone through the not unusual experience of a
hostess who spends the last possible moments in putting “finishing
touches” to preparations for a dinner, then hurries off to dress in
record time that she may be able to meet her first arriving guest with
an air of having been ready and waiting for ever so long.

But at the White House the guests assemble in whatever room may be
designated and there, grouped in order of rank, await the entrance of
the President and his wife. At this first formal dinner of ours the
guests assembled in the Blue Room, the Vice-President and Mrs. Sherman
being first, of course, and nearest the door leading into the corridor,
while beyond them were the Cabinet officers, then the Senators and
Representatives in order of seniority.

Upon our appearance the band began to play “The Star Spangled
Banner”—which, let me say parenthetically, is almost as difficult a tune
to walk by as Mendelssohn’s Wedding March—and played just enough of it
to bring us to the door of the Blue Room. After we had shaken hands with
everybody the senior aide approached Mr. Taft with Mrs. Sherman on his
arm and announced that dinner was served, whereupon Mr. Taft offered his
arm to Mrs. Sherman and started for the dining-room.

[Illustration:

  © Harris & Ewing.

  THE EAST ROOM
]

For my first dinner I chose pink Killarney roses for table decorations
and it would be difficult to express the pleasure I felt in having just
as many of them as I needed by merely issuing instructions to have them
delivered. The White House greenhouses and nurseries were a source of
constant joy to me. I had lived so long where plants are luxuriant and
plentiful that a house without them seemed to me to be empty of a very
special charm and the head horticulturist remarked at once that during
my régime his gems of palms and ferns and pots of brilliant foliage were
to be given their due importance among White House perquisites. I filled
the windows of the great East Room with them, banked the fireplaces with
them and used them on every possible occasion.

The state Dining Room is one of the many splendid results of the McKim
restoration and, next to the East Room, is the handsomest room in the
White House. It is not so tremendously large, its utmost capacity being
less than one hundred, but it is magnificently proportioned and
beautifully finished in walnut panelling with a fireplace and carved
mantel on one side which would do honour to an ancient baronial hall. A
few fine moose and elk heads are its only wall decorations.

We had table-tops of all sizes and shapes, but the one we had to use for
very large dinners was in the form of a crescent which stretched around
three sides of the room. For any dinner under sixty I was able to use a
large oval top which could be extended by the carpenters to almost any
size. Indeed, I have seen it so large that it quite filled the room
leaving only enough space behind the chairs for the waiters to squeeze
their way around with considerable discomfort. On this table I used the
massive silver-gilt ornaments which President Monroe imported from
France along with his interesting collection of French porcelains,
clocks and statuettes which still occupy many cabinets and mantels here
and there in the house.

These table ornaments remind one of the Cellini period when silversmiths
vied with each other in elaborations. Based on oblong plate glass
mirrors, each about three feet in length, they stretch down the middle
of the table, end to end, a perfect riot of festooned railing and
graceful figures upholding crystal vases. Then there are large gilded
candelabra, centre vases and fruit dishes to match. In their way they
are exceedingly handsome, and they certainly are appropriate to the
ceremony with which a state dinner at the White House is usually
conducted.

The White House silver is all very fine and there are quantities of it.
It is all marked, in accordance with the simple form introduced at the
beginning of our history, “The President’s House,” and some of it is old
enough to be guarded among our historic treasures.

When I went to live at the White House I found, much to my surprise,
that this silver had always been kept in a rather haphazard fashion in
chests, or boxes, in the storeroom. I decided to remedy this even though
in doing so I was compelled to encroach somewhat upon the White House
custodian’s already limited quarters. These quarters are a good-sized
office with the house supply rooms opening off it, and a smaller room
adjoining. They are on the ground floor just across the wide corridor
from the kitchen. At one end of the smaller room I had built a closet
with regular vault doors and combination locks. I had the space divided
into compartments, with a special receptacle for each important article,
and velvet-lined trays in drawers for flat silver, each one of which
could be slipped out separately. This silver closet became the joy of
Arthur Brooks’ life, he being the War Department Messenger who was my
right hand man all the time my husband was Secretary of War and who was
appointed White House Custodian at our request a short time before Mr.
Taft was inaugurated.

I was “at home” informally at the White House about three afternoons a
week when my friends came to see me and when I received many ladies who
wrote and asked for an opportunity to call. I always received in the Red
Room which, with fire and candles lighted, is pleasant enough to be
almost cosy, large and imposing though it be. I usually had twenty or
more callers and I found this a delightful way of meeting and getting
close to people as I could not hope to do at the great formal
receptions.

As an example of one of these, I might cite my first afternoon reception
to the Congressional ladies for which something like four hundred
invitations were issued. I intended to carry this off without
assistance, other than that rendered by the ladies I had asked to
preside over the refreshment tables, but in the end I asked Mr. Taft to
receive with me, a task never very difficult for him. There were no men
invited, so he had the pleasure of shaking hands and exchanging
pleasantries with several hundred women, and he did it without a single
protest. I made the mistake on this occasion of receiving in the East
Room as the guests arrived, thinking that by so doing I could make the
party somewhat less formal. But I only succeeded in having the stairway
leading up from the east entrance overcrowded and in making the affair
much more formal than it would have been had I followed the usual course
of permitting the people to assemble in the East Room and to be received
in the Blue Room on their way through to the Dining Room. It amuses me
to find that Captain Butt in the Official Diary has carefully recorded
all my mistakes as well as my successes for the supposed benefit of
other Mistresses of the White House.

I do not wish to convey an impression that life in the White House is
all a public entertainment, but there are a certain number of set
functions during every season which are as much a part of Washington
life as is a Congressional session. But even with teas, luncheons,
musicals, small dinners, garden parties and dances coming at short
intervals between the more official entertainments, we still had many
evenings when there were so few guests as to make us feel quite like a
family party. Indeed, once in a while we dined alone.

We began immediately, as our first spring advanced, to make almost
constant use of the porches and terraces which are among the most
attractive features of the White House. The long terrace extending from
the East Room I found to be a most delightful promenade for guests on
warm spring evenings, while the corresponding terrace leading out from
the Dining Room proved most useful for large dinner parties at times
when dining indoors would have been rather unpleasant.

With Congress in session nearly all summer Mr. Taft gave a series of
Congressional dinners and the last one he had served on this terrace. A
curious incident marked the occasion for special remembrance. It was
known that one of the Senators invited had never crossed the White House
threshold because of his unfriendly feeling toward the administration.
He paid no attention whatever to his invitation—a formal one, of course,
requiring a formal answer—until the day before the dinner. He then
called the White House on the telephone and asked if he would be
expected to wear a dress suit. Mr. Hoover, who received the inquiry,
replied that evening dress was customary at White House dinners,
whereupon the Senator mumbled something at the other end of the line.
Mr. Hoover asked him whether or not he intended to come. He replied that
he guessed he would, and abruptly rang off.

The next evening the party waited for him for a full half hour before
they decided to sit down without him, and even then his vacant place was
kept open for him. He did not come nor did he ever offer any kind of
apology or excuse for his extraordinary conduct. There are certain
manifestations of so-called Jeffersonian simplicity in this country of
ours that I am sure Jefferson would deplore if he lived in this day and
generation.

[Illustration:

  MRS. TAFT ON THE POTOMAC DRIVE
]

The north verandah of the White House is pleasant enough, but it lacks
the charm of seclusion peculiar to the south portico which runs around
the oval Blue Room and looks out upon the broad south garden with its
great fountain, and with Potomac Park, the River and Washington’s
Monument in the background. This soon became our favourite retreat and
we used to sit there in the ever lengthening spring evenings, breathing
the perfume of magnolia blossoms, watching the play of lights on the
tree-dotted lawns and on the Monument—which is never so majestic as in
the night—and realising to the full the pleasant privilege of living in
this beautiful home of Presidents.

Mr. Taft had a Victrola in the Blue Room and he never failed, when
opportunity offered, to lay out a few favourite records for his
evening’s entertainment. Melba and Caruso, the Lucia Sextette, some old
English melodies, a few lively ragtime tunes; in those delightful
surroundings we found a Victrola concert as pleasant a diversion as one
could desire. With no applause, no fixed attention, no conversation, no
effort of any kind required, my husband found on such quiet evenings a
relaxation he was fully able to appreciate during that first trying
summer.

That Manila could lend anything to Washington may be an idea that would
surprise some persons, but the Luneta is an institution whose usefulness
to society in the Philippine capital is not to be overestimated. At
least it was so in my day; and for a long time before Mr. Taft became
President I had looked with ambitious designs upon the similar
possibilities presented in the drives, the river-cooled air and the
green swards of Potomac Park. I determined, if possible, to convert
Potomac Park into a glorified Luneta where all Washington could meet,
either on foot or in vehicles, at five o’clock on certain evenings,
listen to band concerts and enjoy such recreation as no other spot in
Washington could possibly afford.

The Army officer in charge of Public Buildings and Grounds had a
bandstand erected in an admirable location at the end of an ellipse, and
we decided that the long drive theretofore known as “The Speedway”
should be renamed Potomac Drive. Arrangements were made to have band
concerts every Wednesday and Saturday afternoon from five to seven
o’clock.

Saturday, the 17th of April, the concert began, and at five o’clock Mr.
Taft and I, in a small landaulette motor-car, went down to the driveway
and took our places in the throng. The Park was full of people. As many
as ten thousand crowded the lawns and footways, while the drive was
completely packed with automobiles and vehicles of every description.
Everybody saw everybody that he or she knew and there was the same
exchange of friendly greetings that had always made the Luneta such a
pleasant meeting place. I felt quite sure that the venture was going to
succeed and that Potomac Drive was going to acquire the special
character I so much wished it to have.

I also thought we might have a Japanese Cherry Blossom season in Potomac
Park. Both the soil and climate encouraged such an ambition, so I
suggested that all the blooming cherry trees obtainable in the nurseries
of this country be secured and planted. They were able to find about one
hundred only. Then the Mayor of Tokyo, having learned of our attempt to
bestow the high flattery of imitation upon his country, offered to send
us two thousand young trees. We accepted them with grateful pleasure,
but one consignment was found to be afflicted with some contagious
disease and had to be destroyed. I watched those that were planted later
with great interest and they seem to be doing very well. I wonder if any
of them will ever attain the magnificent growth of the ancient and
dearly loved cherry trees of Japan.

One of the delights of living in the White House is in being able to
entertain one’s friends from a distance with a confidence that they are
being given a real pleasure and an experience of an unusual kind. More
often than not we had house guests, old friends from Cincinnati, from
New Haven, from the Philippines, from here, there and everywhere;
friends with whom we had been closely associated through the years and
who felt whole-hearted satisfaction in my husband’s attainment of the
Presidency.

To be stared at is not pleasant because it keeps one selfconscious all
the time, but one gets more or less used to it. And anyhow, I enjoyed a
sort of freedom which Mr. Taft did not share in any way. While he would
probably have been recognised instantly in any crowd anywhere, I found
that in most places I could wander about unobserved like any
inconspicuous citizen. It was a valued privilege.

My daughter Helen likes to tell about an experience she had one day in
Philadelphia. She was a student at Bryn Mawr College and she went in to
Philadelphia to do some shopping. Among other things she had to get
herself some shoes. At the shoe store she was waited on by a girl who
was anything but intelligently attentive. She had tried Helen’s patience
considerably by suggesting in a certain nagging way that her superior
knowledge of what was “being worn” deserved respect, and that Helen
didn’t know what she wanted anyhow.

Helen selected some shoes and decided to have them charged to me, and
she thought what a satisfaction it was going to be to reveal her
identity to the patronising and offensive young person. The young person
produced pad and pencil to make out the check.

“Please have them charged to Mrs. William Howard Taft,” said Helen with
what I am sure was her loftiest air.

“Address?”

“Washington.”

The salesgirl held her pencil poised over the pad and with the familiar
expression of satisfaction over a sale accomplished said pleasantly:

“D. C.?”

[Illustration:

  THE SOUTH PORTICO FROM THE END OF THE GARDEN
]



                             CHAPTER XVIII
                      SOME WHITE HOUSE FORMALITIES


My very active participation in my husband’s career came to an end when
he became President. I had always had the satisfaction of knowing almost
as much as he about the politics and the intricacies of any situation in
which he found himself, and my life was filled with interests of a most
unusual kind. But in the White House I found my own duties too
engrossing to permit me to follow him long or very far into the
governmental maze which soon enveloped him.

I was permitted fully to enjoy only about the first two and a half
months of my sojourn in the White House. In May I suffered a serious
attack of illness and was practically out of society through an entire
season, having for a much longer time than that to take very excellent
care of myself. During this period my sisters, Mrs. Louis More, Mrs.
Charles Anderson, Mrs. Laughlin and Miss Maria Herron, came from time to
time to visit us and to represent me as hostess whenever it was
necessary for me to be represented.

But even in my temporary retirement, as soon as I was strong enough to
do anything at all, I always took a very lively interest in everything
that was going on in the house, and from my apartments on the second
floor directed arrangements for social activities almost as if I had
been well.

I didn’t even have the privilege of presiding at all my first year
garden parties, though this was a form of hospitality in which I was
especially interested and which, I believe, I was able to make a notable
feature of our administration. Garden parties are very popular in the
Far East and I think, perhaps, I acquired my very strong liking for them
out there, together with a few sumptuous notions as to what a garden
party should be like.

The Emperor and Empress of Japan give two each year; one in the spring
under the cherry blossoms to celebrate the Cherry Blossom season, and
one in the autumn in the midst of chrysanthemums and brilliant autumn
foliage. These are the events of the year in Tokyo, marking the opening
and the close of the social season, and society sometimes prepares for
them weeks ahead, never knowing when the Imperial invitations will be
issued. The time depends entirely on the blossoming of the cherry trees
or the chrysanthemums in the Imperial Gardens. When the blooms are at
their best the invitations are sent out, sometimes not more than two
days in advance, and society, in its loveliest garments, drops
everything else and goes. It would be very nice, of course, to have
always some such special reason for giving a garden party, but it is
only in the “Flowery Kingdom” that the seasons are marked by flowers.

Nothing could be finer than the south garden of the White House. With
its wide lawns, its great fountain, its shading trees, and the two long
terraces looking down upon it all, it is ideally fitted for entertaining
out of doors. And I must mention one other thing about it which appealed
to me especially, and that is the wholesomeness of its clean American
earth. This is lacking in the tropics. There one may not sit or lie on
the ground, breathing health as we do here; the tropic soil is not
wholesome. Not that one sits or lies on the ground at garden parties,
but the very feel of the earth underfoot is delightfully different.

I determined to give my first garden party at the White House as soon as
spring was sufficiently far advanced to make it possible. I issued
invitations, 750 of them, for Friday, the 7th of May, planning at the
same time three others to complete the season, one each Friday during
the month.

In order to put possible bad weather off its guard, I made the
invitations simply for an “At Home from 5 to 7 o’clock,” because all my
life the elements have been unfriendly to me. Whenever I plan an outdoor
fête I begin to consult the weather man with the hopeful faith of a
Catherine de Medici appealing to her astrologer, but for all my humble
spirit I very frequently get a downpour, or else a long drawn out and
nerve-trying threat. Quite often the lowering clouds have passed and my
prayers for sunshine have been rewarded, but quite often, too, I have
had to move indoors with an outdoor throng for whom no indoor diversions
had been arranged.

By way of preparation for my first garden party I had a large
refreshment tent put up in the northwest corner of the garden where it
would be handy to the kitchen and serving rooms, while under the trees
here and there I had tables spread at which a corps of waiters were to
serve tea during the reception. The Marine Band I stationed behind the
iron railing just under the Green Room. For any kind of outdoor
entertainment at the White House the band had always been placed in the
middle of the lawn between the south portico and the fountain, but I
thought, and correctly, that the house wall would serve as a sounding
board and make the music audible throughout the grounds. I arranged to
receive under one of the large trees in a beautiful vista looking south.

No sooner were my plans completed, however, than the weather man
predicted rain. It was coming, sure. Of course, I knew it would, but I
had had too much experience to think of coming in out of the rain before
it began to come down. I always sustain my hopeful attitude until the
deluge descends.

About half past three it began to rain in torrents and I saw all of my
festive-looking preparations reduced to sopping wrecks before there was
even time to rush them indoors. By five o’clock, when it was time for
the people to begin to arrive, it had stopped raining, but the lawns
were soaked and the trees were dripping dismally, so I directed the band
to move into the upper corridor, as usual for afternoon affairs, had the
refreshment tables spread in the state Dining Room and took my by that
time accustomed position to receive the long line of guests in the East
Room.

A week later I had better luck. I sent out the same kind of invitations,
made the same kind of preparations, slightly elaborated, and was
rewarded with a perfect mid-May day.

The guests arrived at the East Entrance, came down the Long Corridor,
out through one of the special guest dressing-rooms, and down the long
slope of the lawn to the tree where Mr. Taft and I stood to receive
them, with Captain Archibald Butt to make the presentations. At the next
garden party I requested the gentlemen to come in white clothes, in thin
summer suits, or in anything they chose to wear, instead of in frock
coats. Some young people played tennis on the courts throughout the
reception; it was warm enough for bright-coloured parasols and white
gowns; the fountain made rainbows and diamond showers in the sun, and
altogether it was a most pleasing picture of informal outdoor enjoyment.
Each year after that the four May garden parties were among the most
popular entertainments of our social season.

The question of a “Summer Capital,” as the President’s summer home is
called, was quite a serious one for us to settle. We had been going to
Murray Bay for so many years that we had few affiliations with any other
place, and we were most uncertain as to what we might be able to do.

We finally selected a number of likely places and made our choice by the
process of elimination. One location was too hot, another had a
reputation for mosquitoes, another was too far away, another hadn’t
first-class railway, postal and telegraph facilities, and another, worst
drawback of all, had no good golf links. It wouldn’t have been a livable
place for Mr. Taft without golf links because golf was his principal
form of exercise and recreation. Also the whole family agreed that we
must be near the sea, so our search finally narrowed to the
Massachusetts coast. I decided on the North Shore, as the coast from
Beverly to Gloucester is called, because it had every qualification for
which we were seeking, including excellent golf at the Myopia and Essex
County clubs. Then, too, it had a further attraction in that the summer
homes of a number of our friends were located there, or in the near
vicinity.

[Illustration:

  © Harris & Ewing.

  THE WHITE HOUSE GARDEN AND WASHINGTON’S MONUMENT FROM THE SOUTH
    PORTICO
]

I went up in the spring to Beverly Farms, with my friend Miss Boardman,
and inspected houses for three days, finally selecting one, principally
for its location. It stood near the sea and its velvety green lawns
sloped all the way down to the sea-wall. From its verandah one could see
out across Salem Harbour to Marblehead.

The house itself was a modern frame cottage, as simple as anything well
could be, with a fine verandah and a dormer windowed third story. It was
large enough for the family and for such visitors as we inevitably would
have to accommodate, but besides the Taft family, which was numerous
enough at that time, there were Captain Butt and a large corps of
secretaries and stenographers, to say nothing of the Commander of the
_Sylph_, the President’s smaller yacht, who all had to be within call
when they were wanted. Then, too, there was the necessity for Executive
Offices and I didn’t think it would seem like having a vacation at all
if the Executive Offices could not be somewhere out of sight so that
they might sometimes be out of mind. The President didn’t expect to be
able to spend much of his time away from Washington the first summer but
when he did come to Beverly I wanted him to feel that he was at least
partially detaching himself from business. So another house was found in
the town, yet on the seashore, and was fitted up for Executive Offices
and as a home for the office staff and Captain Butt. The secret service
men, like the poor, we had with us always, but it never seemed to me
that they “lived” anywhere. They were merely around all the time. They
were never uniformed, of course, and looked like casual visitors. They
used to startle callers by emerging suddenly from behind bushes or other
secluded spots—not I am sure because of a weakness for detective
methods, but because they concealed comfortable chairs in these
places—and asking them what they wanted. It was sometimes most amusing
and sometimes rather trying, but as long as there are cranks and
unbalanced persons such precautions will be necessary for the protection
of Presidents, and anyhow, one gets so used to the men as almost to
forget what they are there for.

We did not go to Beverly the first summer until the third of July.
Captain Butt preceded us to make final arrangements for our reception on
the Fourth, and the servants and motor cars had been sent on several
days before. I was still in such ill health that it was necessary to
avoid the excitement of the inevitable crowds, so when our private car
“Mayflower” arrived in Beverly the welcome ceremonies were purposely
subdued. A great crowd was present at the station, but at Mr. Taft’s
request no speeches were made. Shortly after we arrived at the house the
Mayor of Beverly, with a committee of citizens, called, an address of
welcome was delivered, to which Mr. Taft responded and cordial relations
were established. But nothing more occurred even though it was the
Fourth of July.

Mr. Taft spent just one day with us, then hurried away to keep a
bewildering number of engagements here and there before he returned to
Washington, where Congress was still in stormy session over the tariff
bill.

He came back in August to spend a month with us, and then the little
sea-side colony, which we had found as quiet as the woods, except for
the lavish hospitality of its people, became indeed the nation’s summer
capital. Nobody found it inconvenient to come to Beverly to see the
President and he was just about as busy there as he ever was in
Washington. He had a game of golf every day on the Myopia links and grew
jubilant over his scores, but for the most part he seemed always to be
attending to the business of being President. There was an Executive
Office, as I have said, but nearly always one could find four or five
men sitting on the verandah waiting to see him. Fortunately he had a
large room to himself with a private entrance, but we grew so accustomed
to running into strangers that we came almost not to notice them and to
enjoy our supposed privacy as if they were not there.

The most interesting callers we had that summer were their Imperial
Highnesses, Prince and Princess Kuni of Japan, who were making a tour of
the world. They were accompanied by Madame Nagasaki, the wife of the
Court Chamberlain who officiated at my husband’s first audience with the
Emperor, by Colonel Kukurita, a military aide and Mr. Matsui, Chargé
d’Affaires of the Japanese Embassy in Washington. They were escorted by
representatives of both the State and War Departments. I had never met
these Imperial personages, but when Mr. Taft and Miss Alice Roosevelt
were in Japan they had been presented to their Highnesses, so Mr. Taft
invited Miss Roosevelt, then Mrs. Longworth, and her husband to meet
them.

The day following the visit of the Prince and Princess Mr. Taft left for
a long trip through the West and I didn’t see him again until the late
autumn when we all returned to Washington.

The social season in Washington always opens with the Cabinet Dinner in
December. This is one of the regular State Dinners which are carefully
scheduled and jealously regarded as such. The others were formerly the
Diplomatic Dinner and the Supreme Court Dinner, but we inaugurated a
Speaker’s Dinner, so there are now four. These are state functions pure
and simple, but by the exercise of a little art one can manage to make
them most enjoyable affairs. To the Cabinet Dinner only the
Vice-President and his wife, the members of the Cabinet and their wives
and a few especially distinguished outsiders are invited.

The hostess doesn’t have to worry about seating the Cabinet officers
because it is all a matter of precedence and is attended to by the
Social Executive Secretary. The rank of a Cabinet officer is determined
by the date on which his office was created and not, as one might think,
by the relative importance of his official status.

The only time when a friendly democracy presents itself to the President
_en masse_ is on New Year’s Day. At the New Year’s Reception he receives
just as many persons as he can shake hands with between the hours of
eleven in the morning and half past two or three in the afternoon. His
wife, the wife of the Vice-President and the ladies of the Cabinet
receive with him as long as it is physically possible for them to do so.
While writing in the third person I am thinking in the first, of course.
These were our customs.

Yet if anybody unfamiliar with Washington life imagines that a New
Year’s Reception means throwing open the White House doors and admitting
the public without consideration of rank or the rules of precedence he
is mistaken. The Reception, up to a stated hour, is as carefully
regulated as any other function, and I consider the list of the
especially favoured most interesting as a revelation of the complexity
of Washington’s social life.

[Illustration:

  THE TAFT COTTAGE AT BEVERLY, MASSACHUSETTS
]

Announcement is made that the President will receive at 11:00 A.M.—the
Vice-President, the members of the Cabinet and the Diplomatic Corps; at
11:20 A.M.—the Supreme Court, members of the Judiciary of the District
of Columbia, former Cabinet officers and former diplomatic
representatives of the United States; at 11:30—Senators, Representatives
and Delegates in Congress; at 11:45—Officers of the Army, the Navy, the
Marine Corps and the Militia of the District of Columbia; at 12:15
P.M.—Regents and Secretary of the Smithsonian Institution, all the
various Commissions, Assistant Secretaries of Departments, the Solicitor
General, Assistant Attorneys-General, Assistant Postmasters-General, the
Treasurer of the United States, the Librarian of Congress, the Public
Printer, heads of all Bureaus and the President of the Columbia
Institution for the Deaf and Dumb; at 12:30 P.M.—The Secretary of the
Cincinnati, the Aztec Club of 1847, the Associated Veterans of the War
of 1846–47, the Military Order of the Loyal Legion of the United States,
the Grand Army of the Republic, the Medal of Honor Legion, the Union
Veteran Legion, the Union Veterans’ Union, the Society of the Army of
Santiago, the Spanish Minute Men, the Sons of the American Revolution
and the members of the Oldest Inhabitants’ Association of the District
of Columbia; at 1:00 P.M.—Citizens.

As all the men present themselves in the dress uniform of their various
services or orders, or wearing the decorations they have won in
epoch-marking events, one gets a most illuminating view of organised
American patriotism.

There is an old system obtaining at the White House known as inviting
guests “behind the line.” This means that a chosen few are permitted as
special guests to be present in the Blue Room while a reception is in
progress. It is a system which has at times been so carelessly regulated
as to engender jealousies and dissatisfactions, and we determined if
possible to avoid on all occasions any appearance of favouritism. So at
our first New Year’s Reception we decided to limit special privileges to
the Diplomatic Corps, the wives of Assistant Secretaries and our own
house guests. This made the distinction a mere matter of official rank
and did away with all possibility of unpleasant comment from
distinguished members of civilian society.

For instance, there has always been a delicate question in connection
with the Judicial Reception as to whether or not on this occasion the
Justices of the Supreme Court take precedence over the members of the
Diplomatic Corps. The Justices have always contended that at their own
Reception they do, but the unwritten code has it that no person under
the rank of President or Vice-President ever takes precedence over an
Ambassador who is the direct representative of his sovereign.

We settled this question by inviting the heads of all Missions to the
Blue Room where they were greeted by the President before he took his
place in the receiving line, and where they were permitted to remain as
long as they desired, being, as it were, a part of the receiving party.
This was a solution which satisfied everybody and pleased the Diplomats
particularly.

A great many special arrangements are necessary for a New Year’s
Reception at the White House. For every state occasion or any large
function there are always many extra footmen, policemen, guards,
waiters, cloak room attendants and ushers on hand, but on New Year’s Day
the array of them would be most imposing if they were not almost lost in
the midst of a thronging populace. All the people who come to these
receptions do not pass the receiving line. Many of them find points of
vantage in the vicinity merely to look on, and yet the President shakes
hands with from six to eight thousand of them before the gates are
closed. I have seen the line of waiting people stretching out through
the spacious grounds, down the street, around a corner and out of sight
at a time when I had already given up in utter exhaustion. And the way
the carriages come and go in perfect order, without a hitch, each
coachman with his card of a particular colour telling him just where to
make his exit, was a thing I never could understand.

The corps of aides arrange all these details and each department,
including the police and the secret service, has its printed and
explicit orders for the day a long time ahead. Some of the police orders
are interesting. For instance: “No person under the influence of liquor,
disorderly in his behaviour or bearing any advertisement will be allowed
in line. Conspicuously dirty persons will not be admitted.” Also:
“Except in the most aggravated case a coachman will not be taken from
his box and put under arrest. It will be sufficient to take his name and
address and arrest him on the following morning.”

After a New Year’s Reception the White House is a sorry sight, even
though by using extra strips of carpet to protect the polished floors
and by removing fine rugs and breakable bric-à-brac every possible
precaution is taken to make the damage as slight as possible. But it
doesn’t take long to restore the house to its normal condition. The way
the crowd of workmen used to go about putting the place in order after
an invasion of this kind always reminded me of the well-drilled stage
hands at a hippodrome who manage to set different scenes and keep things
spic-and-span without even interfering with a continuous performance.

Very shortly after the New Year’s Reception, three days later in fact,
we gave the next big event of the season, the Diplomatic Reception. It
is understood, of course, that one of the chief occupations of the
President of the United States is shaking hands. I am moved to this
observation by memories of uncounted hours by my husband’s side in a
receiving line at the White House when thousands of guests passed by,
each separately introduced to both the President and to me and each
extending an untired hand to give and to receive the hearty grasp which
all good Americans so highly regard. And there is no conceivable form of
work or exercise more fatiguing. If it were not for the mental stimulus
afforded by the friendliness of a gay throng, by music and lights and a
general festive atmosphere, it could hardly be borne.

For Mr. Taft it was never so hard because in his long public career, and
especially through a political campaign, he had had considerable
training for it. But for me it was somewhat more difficult. My friends
used to wonder how I could stand it, but when I was well I never found
it so much of a strain that I could not very quickly recover from it.
When I was not feeling particularly strong I would resort to all manner
of innocent pretexts to give myself short intervals of rest. I would
turn around and engage in important conversation with someone behind me;
I would consume minutes in taking a drink of water; or I would get into
serious difficulty with my flowers or something. Then, too, I sometimes
would sit frankly down and let the crowds pass by.

To me the long standing was the real strain and I soon came to a point
where I was willing to sacrifice appearance to approximate comfort by
wearing wide flat slippers with low heels.

The Diplomatic Reception is undoubtedly the most brilliant of the set
state functions which are given at the White House each year, but to me
it was never as interesting as the Diplomatic Dinner which follows it.
There are thirty-nine foreign Embassies and Legations in Washington.
Each Ambassador and Minister has his own distinctive and sometimes very
elaborate regalia; each attaché, military and naval, wears the uniform
of his service, in many cases very picturesque and often positively
flamboyant; the foreign women, gowned exquisitely, are many of them
crowned with tiaras and laden with jewels, and when they are all
gathered around one great, glittering and gorgeously decorated table
they present such a picture of varied colour and magnificence as is not
to be seen on any other occasion in Washington.

[Illustration:

  © Harris & Ewing.

  THE CRESCENT TABLE IN THE STATE DINING-ROOM ARRANGED FOR THE
    DIPLOMATIC DINNER
]

I used always to wonder how they managed to get along with each other.
There is an impression quite general among us that we are the only
nation on earth that sends abroad diplomatic representatives without any
knowledge of the French language. This is not quite true. There are a
good many diplomats in Washington who do not speak French, and there are
more diplomats’ wives. But as both men and women are seated at the
Diplomatic Dinner in strict order of rank, there is no chance to take
into consideration the seemingly important question as to whether or not
dinner partners will be able to communicate with each other very freely.
They do speak English, of course, but many of them imperfectly, and,
taking them all, with exactly thirty-nine different accents. Imagine the
wife of the Chinese Minister sitting between the Minister of Salvador
and the Minister of Cuba, or the wife of the Japanese Ambassador having
on one hand the German Ambassador and on the other the Minister of Costa
Rica!

It all depends on how long they have been in Washington. When I first
went to the White House the Italian Ambassador was the Dean of the
Diplomatic Corps, with the Austrian Ambassador next, while among the
Ministers those from Siam and from Costa Rica, I think, had precedence
over all others. If the Minister of Haiti remained in Washington long
enough he could outrank the Minister of Spain. The Minister of Haiti is
the only negro diplomat in the Corps and his place at table in my time
was with a group of envoys of almost equal rank who sat together near
one outer end of the great crescent.

It was not possible to invite many outsiders to the Diplomatic Dinner
because there were enough of the Diplomats themselves with their wives
and attachés to tax the capacity of the State Dining Room. But Mr. Taft
never did take space limits into consideration. For both Receptions and
Dinners I used always to go over the invitation lists and do my best to
keep them within bounds. Regretfully enough would I cut them wherever I
found it possible, but my husband, according to his fixed habit,
invariably added more names than I took off, so, thanks to him, we have
to our credit the largest dinner parties ever given in the new Executive
Mansion. Mr. McKim in his report on the restoration of the White House
says the Dining Room will hold one hundred, but strained to its utmost
capacity ninety-two was as many as I could ever crowd into it, and then
everybody was aghast at the number. We might have put a star in the
hollow of the crescent so as to accommodate a few more, but I never
thought of it until this moment. I’m glad it never occurred to Mr. Taft.
With his expansive disposition he certainly would have had it tried.

The Reception crowds I did manage to cut down. It simply had to be done.
When more than two thousand people get into the White House it is a
literal “crush” and nobody has a good time. We not only introduced
dancing in the East Room at Receptions, a feature which delighted
everybody and especially the young people, but we always served
refreshments to every guest within our gates.

This was, I suppose, the most generally approved departure from
established custom that was made during my administration. It was made
possible by cutting down the list of guests one half and inviting one
half to one reception and the other half to the next. As a matter of
fact, preparing a buffet supper for a company of 2,000 people is not
much more of a strain on ordinary household resources than serving a
nine or ten course formal dinner to eighty or ninety guests. Neither
undertaking is particularly simple, but the White House kitchen and
pantries are large and adequate, we had an efficient staff and we never
had any mishaps or embarrassments that I remember.

Several days before a large reception my cooks would begin to turn out
piles upon piles of small pastries and to do all the things that could
be done in advance. Then on the day of the reception, with plenty of
extra assistants, it was found easily possible to prepare all the salads
and sandwiches, the ices and sweets, the lemonades and the punches that
were necessary. Nor did we find that it interfered in the least with the
usual household routine. We took our meals in the small family dining
room adjoining the State Dining Room, and even gave small and successful
dinner parties while the State Dining Room was in the hands of the
carpenters and decorators.

Referring to the serving of refreshments reminds me of an incident which
gave us some uneasiness shortly after Mr. Taft’s election. It was during
that phase of his career which all Presidents pass through, when his
most casual remark was likely to be construed into an “utterance,” and
his most ordinary act was likely to become a widely heralded “example.”
It was while he was still being held up as a model of all the
excellencies—framed in a question mark: “What will he do?” In other
words it was before his Inauguration.

He was at a dinner at Hot Springs, Virginia. As the wine was being
served one of the diners turned down his glass with the remark that he
had not taken a drink for eighteen years. Mr. Taft, in the most usual
and commonplace manner, followed suit, saying that he had been a total
abstainer for nearly two years and expected to continue so. The incident
was made the basis of a sensational newspaper story which created the
impression that he had acted with great dramatic effect and that his
remark amounted to a declaration of principle which he would turn into a
Presidential policy.

Immediately he was overwhelmed with memorials, with resolutions of
commendation framed by some of the most worthy and admirable Christian
and temperance organisations in the country. It was taken for granted
that he would banish alcohol in every form from the White House. In
simple honesty he had to tell all the reverend gentlemen that he had
made no pronouncement with regard to limiting White House hospitality,
that he had no desire to interfere with any normal man’s personal habits
and that as President he had no intention of trying to do so.

The truth is that he is a total abstainer because never in his life has
he indulged in stimulants to any extent; they have no attraction for him
whatever, and he found in those days that with so much dining out, it
was wiser to decline all wines and liquors. Being naturally abstemious
he has always rather objected to being given personal credit for such
virtue.

It was about this time that I, too, got into trouble of a peculiar sort.
In the mass of correspondence which began to roll in upon me as soon as
my husband was elected, there were requests of every possible kind from
all parts of the world. Among these came a letter from a society of
women engaged in political and social reform work in one of the newer
Balkan States, asking me to lend my aid in forming a similar society in
the United States.

I declined with as much grace and courtesy as I could command and
thought nothing more about it. Imagine my surprise to find almost
immediately that my reply had been construed by its recipients into a
sort of expression of personal interest in and sympathy for the people
of their country in general. I was proclaimed the warm friend of the
young State and an enemy to all her enemies. The incident became the
subject of an exchange of diplomatic notes in Washington, and it took a
bit of the suavity of the State Department to extricate me from the
tangle in which my alleged active participation in the trouble in the
Balkans had placed me. It taught me a lesson.

[Illustration:

  MRS. TAFT’S OWN PICTURE OF THE WHITE HOUSE
]

Throughout my four years in the White House my mail contained surprises
every day, but I soon learned not to be surprised at petitions for
assistance in various forms. It is extraordinary how many of these a
President’s wife receives. The greater number came to me from small
charitable organisations throughout the country. It seemed to me that
nobody ever thought of organising a bazaar or a church fair without
asking me for some sort of contribution, and before holidays, especially
Easter and Christmas, I was simply besieged. They did not want money
ever; they wanted something that could be sold as a souvenir of myself.
I never, to my knowledge, refused a request of this kind. Mrs. Roosevelt
had used a photograph of the White House, and I decided, finally, to do
the same. I chose a view of the South Portico eight by ten inches in
size which I thought very nice, and asked to have it reserved for me.
With my signature across one corner it became a most satisfactory
souvenir. I hesitate to hazard a guess as to the number I signed and
sent away, but, ordered by the hundreds, they didn’t cost very much, so
contributing them to good causes became a pleasure unmarred by a sense
of unjustifiable extravagance. Handkerchiefs, too, were in great demand
and I always kept a supply of them on hand.

I see I have wandered away from the receptions and dinners and my
attempt to tell in some sort of consecutive fashion what a social season
at the White House consists of, but remembering the crowds I lived in
for four years it seems to me that everybody must know just as much
about these things as I do. I have to keep reminding myself that I am
not writing altogether for people who live in Washington, but for the
people in the far places who have never been to Washington, but who have
just as much of a personal property right in the nation’s capital and
just as much interest in the proper conduct of its affairs whether they
be legislative, administrative, diplomatic, or merely social, as any
President ever had.



                              CHAPTER XIX
                               CONCLUSION


Our second summer at Beverly began with a call from Mr. Roosevelt. When
the ex-President returned to the United States, on the 18th of June,
1910, after an absence of a year and a half, Mr. Taft sent two members
of his Cabinet, the Secretary of the Navy and the Secretary of
Agriculture, and his aide, Captain Butt, to New York to meet him and to
extend to him a personal as well as an official welcome home. According
to Captain Butt’s Official Diary:

“Immediately upon the arrival of the S.S. _Kaiserin Auguste Victoria_ at
Quarantine the Presidential party scaled the sides of the steamer by
means of a rope ladder and proceeded to the staterooms of Mr. Roosevelt
where each member of the party greeted the ex-President. Then Captain
Butt, who was in full dress uniform, saluted Mr. Roosevelt and presented
to him the letter of welcome entrusted to his care by the President. Mr.
Roosevelt read it and expressed his great appreciation of the honour of
the receipt of the letter, as also for the ordering of the U. S. S.
_South Carolina_ and other vessels to accompany him from Quarantine to
New York. Captain Butt also presented to Mr. Roosevelt a letter (from
Mrs. Taft) supplementing the President’s invitation to Mr. and Mrs.
Roosevelt to pay them a visit at the White House now or at any time when
it might be convenient for them to do so.... Mr. Roosevelt took occasion
to send his sincere appreciation and profound thanks to the President by
Captain Butt both for the official and personal welcome extended to
him.”

I removed the Presidential household to Beverly the week Mr. Roosevelt
arrived and did not see him until after Mr. Taft joined me about ten
days later. Again to quote from Captain Butt’s carefully kept record:

“June 30—At 3:30 o’clock ex-President Theodore Roosevelt, accompanied by
Senator Lodge, called to pay his respects to the President. He was met
at the entrance by Captain Butt, who announced his arrival. The
President immediately came out and greeted his visitor most
affectionately, addressing him as Theodore.

“Colonel Roosevelt took both hands of the President, and said,

“‘Mr. President, it is fine to see you looking so well.’

“‘But why “Mr. President”?’ laughed the President.

“‘Because,’ replied Colonel Roosevelt, ‘it used to be “Mr. President”
and “Will,” now it must be “Mr. President” and “Theodore.”’

“The President conducted his distinguished predecessor to the side porch
where they started into a series of delightful reminiscences of the past
Administration.... Colonel Roosevelt remained two hours, during which he
gave the President an interesting account of his trip.”

I was present at this interview and remember it as being remarkably
pleasant and entertaining. Everybody will recall that the question of
Mr. Roosevelt’s attitude toward my husband was even then a debatable
one, but Mr. Taft had resolutely refused to believe that it could ever
be anything but friendly. I did not share his complete faith, but I was
glad on this occasion to find the old spirit of sympathetic comradeship
still paramount and myself evidently proved to be unwarrantably
suspicious.

Mr. Roosevelt had just been in England where he acted as the
representative of the President of the United States at the funeral of
King Edward, and that solemnly magnificent event seemed to have
overshadowed in his mind every other experience he had had during his
long absence. He described the stately ceremonies and the mediævally
picturesque procession in vivid detail and did not fail to emphasise
their grave and reverential aspects, but he dwelt particularly, and to
our great amusement, upon the humorous side of the situation in which he
had found himself.

It will be remembered that among Kings and Emperors and Czars, and even
lesser potentates, the rank of Presidents was a difficult thing to
determine. Should minor royalties take precedence over the
representatives of the French Republic and the United States of America,
to say nothing of Mexico, Brazil, Switzerland, and all the other great
and small democracies?

Mr. Roosevelt had great difficulty in finding his place. Then, too, he
was constantly running into kings and other royalties to whom he,
naturally, owed ceremonious respect. They were so numerous in London at
the time that familiarity with them bred carelessness in one whose
tongue had not been trained to the honorifics of Court life, and he
found himself making extremely funny blunders. He told us many stories
of his adventures with the world’s elect and, with his keen appreciation
of the ridiculous and his gift of description, gave us as merry an
afternoon as we ever spent with him.

I dwell on the memory of this agreeable meeting with Mr. Roosevelt and
the entertainment it afforded me, because by his manner he succeeded in
convincing me that he still held my husband in the highest esteem and
reposed in him the utmost confidence, and that the rumours of his
antagonism were wholly unfounded. I was not destined to enjoy this faith
and assurance for very long.

In mid-July of that year we started off for a short cruise on the
_Mayflower_, the only one we ever made. It is not really possible for
the President to have a vacation, but if he happens to be a good sailor
I know of no better way for him to get short intervals of rest than by
boarding the Presidential yacht and steaming away, out of the reach of
crowds.

We had only a small party with us, my husband’s brother, Mr. Horace
Taft, my sister, Mrs. Louis More, Miss Mabel Boardman and the Assistant
Secretary of the Navy, Mr. Beekman Winthrop, and Mrs. Winthrop; and
Captain Butt, of course, was with us always.

We headed north for the Maine coast with Eastport as our first stopping
place. The mayor of that interesting city of fisheries came on board as
soon as we dropped anchor, made a felicitous speech of welcome and
proceeded to lay out a programme of sightseeing and festivities which
would have kept us there for a considerable longer time than we could
stay if it had all been carried out, and this experience was repeated
everywhere we went. We had to decline everything except a motor ride
about town for the purpose of getting a glimpse of the weir fisheries
and the sardine canneries, but a President doesn’t visit Eastport very
often, so the people thronging the streets made it seem quite like a
holiday.

Then a committee from the Island of Campo Bello, which lies a short
distance off the coast and which is a British possession, waited upon us
with an invitation to come across and go for a buckboard ride around a
part of the island. It sounded like such a homely and restful form of
amusement that Mr. Taft was sorely tempted to break the unwritten law
which decrees that a President may not set foot outside United States
territory, but he concluded that he had better not. The rest of us,
however, decided to go and we had a jolly, jolting ride which ended at
the summer home of Mrs. Franklin Roosevelt.

Everywhere we went we were most delightfully entertained, finding
beautiful homes and merry summer hosts at every port and town. At
fashionable Bar Harbor we found a colony of friends whose winter homes
are in Washington and Mr. Taft got some excellent golf. There were
luncheons and dinners, of course, every day and everywhere, to say
nothing of teas and large receptions, and Mr. Taft had to make speeches,
too, and meet all the Maine politicians. But there were the long restful
nights on the _Mayflower_, steaming along among the crags and rocks of
the broken, picturesque coast, or lying at anchor in some quiet harbour
with only the soft water sounds to break the stillness, and it would not
have taken much persuasion to have kept me aboard indefinitely.

The _Mayflower_ is used ordinarily for official purposes in connection
with naval reviews and other naval ceremonies, and at such times, with
the President on board, there is a punctilious formality to be
encountered which makes a mere civilian feel like a recruit under the
eyes of a drill-sergeant. But it is very interesting. One gets so used
to seeing everybody in uniform standing stiffly at attention as the
President passes that one almost forgets that it isn’t their natural
attitude.

And then the guns. They shake one’s nerves and hurt one’s ears, but they
are most inspiring. The President’s salute is twenty-one guns. It is
fired every time he sets foot on the deck of the _Mayflower_, or any
other naval vessel, and when he passes, on the _Mayflower_, between the
lines of naval vessels on review he gets it from every ship in the
fleet, not one by one, but altogether, so I think I know what a naval
battle sounds like.

Shortly after we returned from our little cruise on the Maine Coast we
received a visit from the President of Chili, Señor Montt, and Señora
Montt. He was on his way to Europe, having been ordered abroad on
account of ill health. He stopped in New York at the request of his
government, and at Mr. Taft’s invitation came to Beverly to pay his
official respects to the President of the United States. He made the
trip to Boston by special train and was there met by the _Mayflower_ and
by Captain Butt.

President Montt was very ill indeed. On the way down to Beverly he had a
heart attack which alarmed everybody and made it seem very probable that
he would not be able to land. But he recovered sufficiently to become
the most cheerful and confident member of the party and we found him and
Señora Montt to be among the most delightful of all the distinguished
visitors we had the pleasure of entertaining during our term in the
Presidency. After the ceremonious presentation and the exchange of
international compliments were disposed of they took luncheon with us
and we spent several most interesting and memorable hours together. The
members of his numerous _entourage_ for whom there was no room in our
modest summer cottage were entertained at luncheon on board by Captain
Logan of the _Mayflower_ and by Captain Butt. We were told afterward
that they managed to create quite an _entente cordial_, toasting each
other’s Presidents and armies and navies and ministers and attachés and
everybody else they could think of with great enthusiasm and gusto.
Señor Montt died a week later just as he reached England on his
health-seeking trip. In his death Chili lost an eminent citizen.

Mr. Taft remained with us at Beverly, playing golf, attending to routine
business, seeing the never-ending line of visitors and preparing
speeches until September when there began for him one of those whirlwind
seasons, so many of which he had lived through. With a printed itinerary
in his pocket he was off from Boston on the third of September to attend
the Conservation Congress at St. Paul. With two speeches to be
delivered, one at the Congress and one at the State Fair in Minneapolis,
to say nothing of another in Chicago and numerous short speeches from
the rear platform of his train, he was still back in Boston on the
eighth to be present at an aviation meet where together we saw the
performance of the best aviators of that day.

A short interval of rest and he was away again to New Haven to attend a
meeting of the Yale Corporation, then out to Cincinnati to the Ohio
Valley Exposition and back to Washington as quickly as a long programme
of speeches and hospitalities could be disposed of.

The political skies were then beginning to cloud up in earnest; he had a
Democratic Congress to prepare messages for, and I suppose the
approaching winter looked anything but alluring to him.

For the first time in the history of the Executive Mansion it was turned
into a bachelors’ hall during my various absences. My husband always had
one or more men staying with him, he would move his aides and
secretaries into the White House, and so arrange things that my frequent
desertions of him never weighed very heavily on my conscience.

When he arrived in Washington this time he organised a Cabinet House
Party so that Washington and the newspaper correspondents had something
to worry about for quite a while. He gathered all the members of his
Cabinet under his roof and kept them there where he could have three
Cabinet meetings a day besides the ones he called in the Executive
Offices. People made wild guesses at all kinds of crises and at all
manner of important disclosures to be made, but it was only a house
party after all. There were a great many problems to be solved, proposed
legislative measures to be discussed, and with every woman in the
Cabinet off summering somewhere it was an excellent opportunity for the
Executive branch of the Government to do extra work.

The distinguished gentlemen had to “double up” in rooms, too, so I have
often imagined that they got very little rest at any time. The Secretary
of State and the Secretary of the Treasury had the southeast room; the
Secretary of the Navy and the Secretary of the Interior had the
northeast room; the Attorney General and the Secretary of Commerce and
Labour had the northwest room; the Postmaster General had Robert’s room;
the Secretary of Agriculture had the housekeeper’s room, and the
Secretary to the President had my son Charlie’s room. I think probably
as a house party it was unique, but if there had been any more
Departments of Government the President would have had to fit up a
dormitory.

[Illustration:

  © Harris & Ewing.

  THE LONG EASTERN CORRIDOR THROUGH WHICH GUESTS ARRIVE FOR STATE
    FUNCTIONS
]

[Illustration:

  © Harris & Ewing.

  THE MAIN STAIRWAY LEADING TO THE PRESIDENT’S PRIVATE APARTMENTS
]

At this point in Archie Butt’s record I find the note: “Mrs. Taft left
this morning for New York to fit her son Charlie out in long trousers.”

That brings up unpleasant memories. Like any sensible woman I never
would admit that I had reached the high point in life as long as I had
one son still in knickerbockers, but with one son at Yale, with a young
lady daughter ready to be presented to society, and with Charlie going
into long trousers I felt that the day was approaching when the unhappy
phrase “getting on in years” might be applied to me.

The very rapid lengthening of Charlie’s legs had been a subject of much
discussion at Beverly during the summer and the necessity for bestowing
upon him the dignity of man-style garments had been manifest to
everybody sometime before I would consent to recognise it.

One day the telephone rang and Helen answered it. A voice at the other
end of the line said:

“I’d like to speak to Master Charlie Taft, please.”

“Somebody wants to speak to you, Charlie,” said Helen. Then sister-like
she stood by to see who it was and what he could possibly want with her
unimportant younger brother. She was surprised to hear this half of a
very earnest conversation:

“Who said so?”

“Certainly not!”

“Well, somebody has been giving you misinformation.”

“An absolute denial.”

“Well, if you want to quote me exactly you may say that I said the
rumour is false; wholly without foundation.”

“All right. Good-bye.”

Helen was sufficiently startled to place Charlie under cross-examination
at once. She had visions of grave complications wherein he played the
unfortunate part of a President’s son who had forgotten the rigid
discretion exacted of him by the nature of his position.

Charlie admitted that it was a reporter who had called him up.

“Couldn’t you tell that from the way I talked to him?” said he.

He had heard enough such conversations to have acquired the natural
“tone,” but he insisted that the subject of his conversation with his
reporter was “purely personal” and had nothing whatever to do with his
sister nor yet with any matters of high importance to the Government.

The question had to be referred to the President, his father, before he
would admit that the reporter wanted to write something about his going
into long trousers.

“And if that isn’t a personal matter,” said he, “I should like to know
what is.”

To his intense delight, his “absolute denial” to the contrary
notwithstanding, I fitted him out, kissed my baby good-bye and sent a
young man son off to school in his stead, feeling vaguely thankful that
I should have until Christmas to get used to the thought of him before
having to see him again.

Shortly afterward I returned to the White House and to the routine of a
social season. The Cabinet officers having all gone to their respective
homes we gave the Cabinet Dinner with all its accustomed formalities,
then came musicals, luncheons, small dinners, teas and parties of
various sorts until near the end of the year when I introduced my
daughter to society.

Helen had gone out in Washington and had attended my entertainments
during the winter of 1909 whenever she had been at home from college and
when I was ill had even acted as hostess in my place at a dinner we gave
for Prince and Princess Fushimi of Japan, but she had never “come out,”
so I gave two parties early in the winter of 1910 in honor of her début.

We began with an afternoon At Home, for which, as my daughter says she
“got all the flowers there were in Washington,” and later I gave a ball
on the night of December 30th, when the East Room was filled with
hundreds of young people clamouring for “just one more dance” until two
o’clock in the morning.

The New Year’s Reception was followed in quick succession by the
Diplomatic, Congressional, Judicial and other state functions; the
winter passed like a dream; the Garden Party season was upon us; then
came the greatest event of our four years in the White House, our Silver
Wedding.

Twenty-five years married and all but a single year of it spent in the
public service. It did not seem unfitting to me that this anniversary
should be spent in the White House or that we should seek to make it an
event not to be forgotten by anybody who happened to witness it. I
thanked the happy fate that had given me a summer wedding-day because I
needed all outdoors for the kind of party I wanted to give. That silver
was showered upon us until we were almost buried in silver was
incidental; we couldn’t help it; it was our twenty-fifth anniversary and
we had to celebrate it.

I am not going to try to remember or to take the trouble to find out how
many invitations we issued. I know there were four or five thousand
people present and that a more brilliant throng was never gathered in
this country.

It was a night garden party with such illuminations as are quite beyond
description. Every tree and bush was ablaze with myriads of tiny
coloured lights, the whole stately mansion was outlined in a bright
white glow; there were strings of bobbing, fantastic lanterns wherever a
string would go; the great fountain was playing at its topmost height in
every colour of the rainbow; while on the gleaming point of the Monument
and on the flag stretched in the breeze from the staff on the top of the
White House shone the steady gleam of two searchlights.

My husband and I received the almost endless line of guests under a
large tree about midway between the South Portico and the fountain; the
entire house was thrown open and was filled constantly with people
seeking the refreshment tables laid in the dining rooms and vestibule. I
have a right to be enthusiastic in my memory of that party because
without enthusiasm it could not have been given at all. And why should
not one be frankly grateful for success?

With the passing of another season, in no way different from those that
went before, I come to the end of my story. There is another story to
tell, longer and fuller, but it does not belong to me. It belongs to the
man whose career has made my story worth the telling.

After Mr. Taft was renominated, or rather after the second convention in
Chicago when the Republican party was divided, I began to make plans for
the future in which the White House played no part. I stopped reading
the accounts of the bitter political contest because I found that the
opposition newspapers made so much more impression on me than those that
were friendly to my husband that I was in a state of constant rage which
could do me no possible good.

Mr. Taft had never been subjected to bitter criticism and wholesale
attack until his term in the Presidency and I suppose I had formed a
habit of thinking that there was nothing to criticise him for except,
perhaps, his unfortunate shortcoming of not knowing much and of caring
less about the way the game of politics is played. Such criticism of him
as Mr. Bryan’s supporters were able to create for their use in 1908
amounted to nothing. His record of twenty years’ uncriticised service
stood, and he stood on it. I think we both avoided much perturbation
after we became convinced of the unfairness and injustice of much that
was said by hostile newspapers, by not reading it. Mr. Taft took much
satisfaction from those words of Lincoln’s which Mr. Norton, his
Secretary, had photographed and placed in a frame on his office desk:

“If I were to try to read, much less answer, all the attacks made on me
this shop might as well be closed for any other business. I do the very
best I know how—the very best I can; and I mean to keep on doing so
until the end. If the end brings me out all right, what is said against
me won’t amount to anything. If the end brings me out wrong, ten angels
swearing I was right would make no difference.”

I wanted him to be re-elected, naturally, but I never entertained the
slightest expectation of it and only longed for the end of the turmoil
when he could rest his weary mind and get back into association with the
pleasant things of life. Fortunately we are a family that laughs. Both
Mr. Taft and the children manage to get some fun out of almost
everything, and I and my matter of factness have afforded them lifelong
amusement. They like now to tell a story about me which doesn’t impress
me as being particularly funny.

During the last campaign I was at Beverly alone a good part of the
summer, but when Mr. Taft did join me for short intervals he brought
Republican Headquarters with him, more or less, and a few political
supporters were sure to follow for consultation with him.

There was one good old enthusiastic friend who had always supported him
and who was then making a valiant fight in his behalf. And he had faith
that they would win. He assured me they would win. He told me how they
were going to do it, pointing out where Mr. Taft’s strength lay and
telling me how kindly the people really felt toward him.

“Mrs. Taft, you mark my word,” said he, “the President will be
re-elected in November!”

“Well,” said I, “you may be right, but just the same I intend to pack
everything up when I leave Beverly, and I shall take the linen and
silver home.”

                  *       *       *       *       *

At a dinner given by the Lotos Club in New York, just ten days after Mr.
Wilson’s election in 1912, Mr. Taft said:

“The legend of the lotos eaters was that if they partook of the fruit of
the lotos tree they forgot what had happened in their country and were
left in a state of philosophic calm in which they had no desire to
return to it.

“I do not know what was in the mind of your distinguished invitation
committee when I was asked to attend this banquet. They came to me
before election. At first I hesitated to accept lest when the dinner
came I should be shorn of interest as a guest and be changed from an
active and virile participant in the day’s doings of the Nation to
merely a dissolving view. I knew that generally on an occasion of this
sort the motive of the diners was to have a guest whose society should
bring them more closely into contact with the great present and the
future and not be merely a reminder of what has been. But, after further
consideration, I saw in the name of your club the possibility that you
were not merely cold, selfish seekers after pleasures of your own, and
that perhaps you were organised to furnish consolation to those who
mourn, oblivion to those who would forget, an opportunity for a swan
song to those about to disappear....

“The Presidency is a great office to hold. It is a great honour and it
is surrounded with much that makes it full of pleasure and enjoyment for
the occupant, in spite of its heavy responsibilities and the shining
mark that it presents for misrepresentation and false attack.... Of
course the great and really the only lasting satisfaction that one can
have in the administration of the great office of President is the
thought that one has done something permanently useful to his fellow
countrymen. The mere enjoyment of the tinsel of office is ephemeral, and
unless one can fix one’s memory on real progress made through the
exercise of presidential power there is little real pleasure in the
contemplation of the holding of that or any other office, however great
its power or dignity or high its position in the minds of men.

“I beg you to believe that in spite of the very emphatic verdict by
which I leave the office, I cherish only the deepest gratitude to the
American people for having given me the honour of having held the
office, and I sincerely hope in looking back over what has been done
that there is enough of progress made to warrant me in the belief that
real good has been accomplished, even though I regret that it has not
been greater. My chief regret is my failure to secure from the Senate
the ratification of the general arbitration treaties with France and
Great Britain. I am sure they would have been great steps toward general
world peace. What has actually been done I hope has helped the cause of
peace, but ratification would have been a concrete and substantial step.
I do not despair of ultimate success. We must hope and work on.”


                                THE END

------------------------------------------------------------------------



                          TRANSCRIBER’S NOTES


 1. Silently corrected obvious typographical errors and variations in
      spelling.
 2. Retained archaic, non-standard, and uncertain spellings as printed.
 3. Enclosed italics font in _underscores_.
 4. Enclosed blackletter font in =equals=.




*** End of this Doctrine Publishing Corporation Digital Book "Recollections of full years" ***




Home